UC-NRLF THE PHILOSOPHY OF THE HUMAN VOICE EMBRACING ITS PHYSIOLOGICAL HISTORY; TOGETHER -WITU A SYSTEM OF PRINCIPLES, BY WHICH CRITICISM IN THE ART OF ELOCUTION MAY BE RENDERED I N T E L I (H B L E, AND INSTRUCTION, DEFINITE AND COMPREHENSIVE. TO WHICn IS ADDED A BRIEF ANALYSIS OF SONG AND RECITATIVE. BY JAMES RUSH, M.D. AUTIIOn OF A 'NATURAL HISTORY OF THE INTELECT,' AND OF 'HViMLKT, A DRAMATIC PRELUDE IN FIVE ACTS.' SEVENTH EDITiCN, 'RbvisEI). PHILADELPHIA: J. B. LTPPINCOTT & CO. 1879. Copyright, 1879, by The Library Companv of Philadelphia. •••.;;••:;•:'•.;•::,.:/;*./ CONTEN^TS. INTRODUCTION, SECTION I. II. III. Page. 45 IV. VI. VII. VIII. IX. X. XI. XII. XIII. XIV. XV. XVI. XVII. XVIII. Of the General Divisions of Vocal Sound, with a more particular acount of its Pitch, Of the Radical and Vanishing movement ; and its diferent forms in Speech, Song, and Reci- tative, Of the Elenientarj^ Sounds of the English Language ; with their relations to the Radi- cal and Vanish, Of the Influence of the Radical and Vanish, in tire production of the various ))henojnena of Sylablcs, Of the Causative Mechanism of the Voice, in relation to its diferent Vocalities and to its Pitch, Of the'Expresion of Speecli, Of the Pitch of the Voice, Of the Melody of Speech ; with an inquiry how far the terms Key and Modulation are aplicable to it. Of Vocality of the Voice, Of Abruptness of Speech, Of the Time of the Voice, Of the Intonation at Pauses, Of the Grouping of Speech, Of the Interval of the Rising Octave, Of the Interval of the Rising Fifth, Of the Interval of the Rising Third, Of the Intonation of Interogative Sentences, Of the Interval of the Rising Second, (iii) 25822(3 69 88 101 IK 128 156 169 174 192 194 196 220 229 239 241 24.3 246 278 IV CONTENTS. SECTION XIX. Of the Interval of the Kising Semitone; and of the Chromatic Melody founded thereon, 282 XX. Of the Downward Radical and Vanish, 29.5 XXI. Of the Downward Octave, 299 XXII. Of the Downward Fifth, 301 XXIII. Of the Downward Third, 303 XXIV. Of the Downward Second and Sejiiitone, 307 XXV. Of the Wave of the Voice, 309 XXVI. Of the Equal- Wave of the Octave, 315 XXVII. Of the Equal- Wave of the Fifth, 31 G XXVIII. Of the Equal- Wave of the Third, 317 XXIX. Of the Equal-Wave of the Second, 318 XXX. Of the Equal- Wave of the Semitone, 328 XXXI. Of the Wave of Unequal Intervals, 330 XXXII. Of the Intonation of Exclamatory Sentences, 340 XXXIII. Of the Tremor of the Voice, 354 XXXIV. Of Force of Voice, 364 XXXV. Of the Radical Stress, 360 XXXVI. Of the Median Stress, 371 XXXVII. Of the Vanishing Stress, 375 XXXVIII. Of the Compound Stress, 377 XXXIX. Of the Thoro Stress, 378 XL. Of the Loud Concrete, 381 XLI. Of the Time of the Concrete, 382 XLII. Of the Aspiration, 383 XLIII. Of the Emphatic Vocule, 387 XLIV. Of the Gutural Vibration, 389 XLV. Of Acent, 390 XLVI. Of Empha.sis, 395 Of Emphasis of Vocality, 396 Of Emphasis of Force, 397 Of the Radical Emphasis, 398 * Of the Median Emphasis, 399 Of the Vanishing Emphasis, 400 Of the Compound Emphasis, 401 Of the Emphasis of the Thoro Stress, and the Loud Concrete, 402 Of the Aspirated Emphasis, 408 Of the Emphatic Vocule, 404 CONTENTS. V SECTION XLYI. Of the Gutural Emphasis, 405 Of the Temporal Emphasis, ib. Of the Emphasis of Pitch, 407 Of the Emphasis of the Rising Octave, 409 Of the Emphasis of the Rising Fifth, 411 Of the Emphasis of the Rising Third, 412 Of the p]mphasis of the Rising Semitone, 413 Of the Downward Concrete, 415 Of the Downward Octave, 417 , Of the Downward Fifth, 419 Of the Downward Third, 420 Of the Emphasis of the Wave, 422 Of the Equal-Single-Direct Wave of the Octave, 423 Of the Equfll-Single-Direct Wave of the Fifth, 425 Of the Unequal-Single Wave, 42G Of the Emphasis of the Tremor, 428 A Recapitulating View of Emphasis, 430 XLVII. Of the Drift of the Voice, 437 Of the Diatonic Drift, 438 Of the Drift of the Semitone, 439 Of the Drift of the Downward Vanish, ib. Of the Drift of the Wave of the Second, ib. Of the Drift of the Wave of the Semitone, ib. Of the Drift of Quantity, 440 Of the Drift of Force, ib. Of the Drift of the Loud Concrete, ib. Of the Drift of Median Stress, ib. The Partial Drift of the Tremor, ib. The Partial Drift of Aspiration, 441 The Partial Drift of Gutural Vibration, ib. The Partial Drift of Interogation, ib. The Partial Drift of the Phrases of Mclodj'', ib. XLVIII. Of the Vocal Signs of ThOt and Pasion, 448 Note. On the Voice of Sub-animals, 456 Of Th6t or Pasion indicated By the Piano of the Voice, 461 By the Forte of the Voice, ib. By Quicknes of Voice, ib. By Slownes of Voice, 462 VI CONTENTS. SECTION XLVIII. By Vocality of Voice, 462 By the Rising and Faling Semitone, ib. By the Eising and Faling Second, ib. By the Rising Third, Fifth and Octave, 463 By the Downward Third, Fifth and Octave, ib. By the Wave of the Semitone, ib. By the "Wave of the Second, 464 By the Waves of the Third, Fifth and Octave, ib. By the Radical Stress, 465 By the Median Stress, ib^^ By the Vanishing Stress, ib. By the Compound Stress, 466 By the Thoro Stress, ib. By the Tremor of tlie Second, and Wider In- tervals, ib. By the Tremor of the Semitone, ib. By the Aspiration, ib. By the Guttural Vibration, 467 By the Emphatic Vocule, ib. By the Broken Melody, ib. XLIX. Of the Means of Instruction in Elocution, 478 Of Practice on the Alphabetic Elements, 483 Of Practice on the Time of Elements, 487 Of Practice on the Vanishing Movement, 488 Of Practice on Force, 489 Of Practice on Stress, ib. Of Practice on Pitch, 490 Of Practice on Melody, 492 Of Practice on the Cadence, ib. Of Practice on the Tremor, 493 Of Practice on Vocality, ib. Of Practice in Rapidity of Speech, 495 L. Of the Rythmus of Speech, 504 LI. Of the Faults of Readers, 517 Of the Faults in Vocality, 529 Of Faults in Time, ib. Of Faults in Force, 580 Of Faults in Pitch, 588 Of Faults in the Concrete Movement, ib. Of Faults in the Semitone, 534 CONTENTS. VU SECTION LI. Of Faults in the Second, 685 Of Faults in the Melody of Speech, 686 First Fault in Melody, ib. Second Fault in Melody, 637 "third Fault in Melody, ib. Fourth Fault in Melody, 638 Fifth Fault in Melody, 639 Sixth Fault in Melody, ib. Seventh Fault in Melody, 640 Of Faults in the Cadence, 643 Of Faults in the Intonation at Pauses, 646 Of Faults in the Third, 646 Of Faults in the Fifth, ib. Of Faults in the Downward Movement, 647 Of Faults in the Discrete Movement, ib. Of Faults in the "Wave, ib. Of Faults in Drift, 649 Of Faults in the Grouping of Speech, 652 Of the Fault of Mimicry, 653 Of Monotony of Voice, 656 Of Ranting in Speech, 657 Of Afectation in Speech, ib. Of Mouthing in Speech, ib. Of the Faults of Stage-Personation, 561 Conclusion, 676 A Brief Analysis of Song and Recitative, 685 Of Song, 686 Of Recitative, 617 TO THE READER. All the reprints of this Worlt have sucesively receved aditions. The recorded analysis and principles of the First edition having been derived from exact observation and experiment, remain almost without alteration. The arangement has however been slightly changed. Three new sections^ severaly on Pitch, Abruptnes, and Exclamatory sentences, with other di- visions, have been added, in amplification of preceding views : and there will be found thruout the Work, aditional facts, principles, and ilustrations, to- gether with esthetic reflections on the subject of vocal Science and Art ; while variations without number have been made in the explanatory phraseology. It would have been both embarasing and useles to have marked the places of all the aditional facts, principles, divisions, and nomenclature. It is enuf, to state the amount. The several editions, without the prefaces, and deduct- ing the blank portions not comon to all, contain respectively in leters, esti- mated by pages and lines, about the folowing numbers : EDITIONS. CONTAINS ABOUT PUBLISHED. First 742,000 leters, January, 1827. Second 814,000 " June, 1833. Third 8-50,000 " December, 1844. Fourth 1,024,000 " January, 1855. Fifth 1,232,000 " May, 1859. Sixth 1,248,000 " April, 1867. The first writing of the Work ocupied about three years of leisure from Profesional and Social engagements. The subsequent aditions may alto- gether have employed about eighteen months. NOTICE IMPROVED SPELLING IN THIS WORK. To prevent surprise and misapprehension, on the subject of the unusual orthography in the present Edition, we here give a short ac- count of tlie purpose, the motives, and the manner of its application. As somebody first omitted the superfluous u from tlie English word labour, it is here the intention cautiously to remove the un- pronounced t, of several words similar to perceive, and to lessen the double consonants of tlie language. We are no more bound to respect an old literary habit of spelling, when advantage is to be gained, and only prejudice to be shocked by the change, than upon proof against it, to respect a conventional creed on any other subject. Orthography has been variously altered for the worse, as well as for tlie better, by ' nobody knows who,' as if the inno- vator feared to be caught by the norma loquendi or fashionable rule of the pen. The little here offered is directed by the Grammar, which teaches to give the letters that make the sound of the word ; and we add, to give no more : following the classical Latin, which gives much nearer than we do, letter for sound ; though it is yet too soon always to do this. We must except from our propasal of improvement, cases that would have a temporary awkwardness to the eye ; and that from the deficiency of our vowel symbols, afford no habitual rule to direct tlie sound of a sylable. Nor have we been mindless of euphony, and therefore prefer the smooth and gliding quantity and sound of impunc to the half hiccupy catch of impugn; have given the strong accent to 6r 2 (ix) X NOTICE OF THE IMPROVED and grd in orthography, to avoid the like guttural og; and have changed the lip-issuing eu {yeu or ceu) to the free oral u, in via- nuver. If it be said, these words are so pronounced: then write them so. Ours is the English language; we have therefore, when justified by the ear and the eye, rejected or changed the consonant sylables, vre, tre, and que, of the French. Thus individually trymg to do slowly in part, what the crowd of Reviews, Magazines, News- papers, and Governments, with their influence and patronage could, under a wise commission, accomplish by a broad and rapid sweep. To an observant and reflective Reformer, it would be as easy in principle and rule, to correct a false orthography, though as diffi- cult in practice, as to change a metaphysical and corrupt religion ; for it is only returning to Nature's ordination of sound and sign, in the former case, and in the latter, to the simplicity of humble submission to that physical superiority of God and Nature over the mind and conduct of man, which the reflective study of their works will always insure. But as the crowd of writers of what- ever class, and the vulgar may corrupt, yet never reform, the pro- posal and attempt are left for the adventurous individual who must take the fearful odds against him. Who, except a corrector of the Press, and a drilled memorial scholar, knows always, unhesitatingly how to spell ? Nobody ! This both with the studious and the ignorant arises, in the English language, from there being a deficiency of the vowel symbols, and a redundancy of consonants. It would then seem easy, to add a few to one, and to reduce the number of the other. This however, in opposition to scholastic usage, would be a hopeless task : for the self-relying personal power of the wonder-working Hercules has not reached our time: though we do not mean like Bishop Wilkins, and otliers, to offer a ' Real Character,' or a newly invented alphabet of symbols: an attempt, however philosophic, as practically vain, as trying to change a man to a Seraph by feathering-out his arms into wings ; which the Satirist on the learned and ingenious Prelate's ' Essay ' seemed to have thought, in his Fable of a flying humanity. The sixth Edition of this Work, besides other changes, shows a partial rejection of the double consonants. Here it is proposed to reject them all ; for they are almost universally unnecessary, es- pecially at the end of words, where even the self excusing pedant SPELLING IN THIS WORK. XI cannot find an apology for applying them: and though they are sometimes improperly used to indicate the character of a preceding voAvel ; this would be done more precisely, by increasing the num- ber of the vowel symbols, and denoting their proper time and sound. As an exception to the above general rule, I have not removed the redundant consonants from monosylables, and a few dissylables ; it would be at present awkward, and might draw attention and pro- voke opposition by its oddity; though a reader might in time become reconciled to the change when others effect it. It is shown in the third section and elsewhere in this work, that the physiology of consonant sounds does not only prove the doub- ling to be unnecessary, but practically forbids it. All the conso- nants close their utterance either by a faint vocal or by an aspirate jet, a vocula, or little voice or vocule as I have called it; more audible as an aspirate severally in the final k, p, and t, in nick, skip, and hate; and slightly, in what has been called, guttural murmur, at the close of all the vocal consonants. This vocule is the means of the easy coalescence of the consonants with the vowels ; making all the consonants flow severally into them. Now vowels having no final vocule, two or more do not coalesce vnth each other; nor do double consonants, even with their vocule, unite into one syla- ble; therefore two proximate vowels, and two proximate conso- nants, if pronounced, must respectively make two sylabic efforts. And hence double consonants, within a sylable, cannot together, be uttered by a single vocal impulse. I have looked over the dictionary with reference to double con- sonants. At the end of a word and within a sylable, they are as above stated, useless to the voice. They appear however, double at the connection of successive sylables, as in the Avord command. Are they necessary here? Only in some cases. In the grciitcr number, the consonant at the end of the preceding sylable coalesces with the preceding vowel, and would coalesce with the vowel of the succeeding sylable, if the second consonant did not prevent it. In the hasty current of speech, and of declamation, the second m is not pronounced, and is therefore useless ; the final consonant of the preceding sylable skipping the second consonant, and gliding into the next vowel a. If the utterance is slow, or the second sylable, as in commdnd is emphatic, then the a is to be strongly XU NOTICE OF THE IMPROVED SPELLING IN THIS WORK. exploded; and this is to be eiFected by making a momentary pause before the second m, and bursting by its vocule into the emphatic a; in which case the double consonant is used. Or this may be done by the same process with the first m; rejecting the second. Some sylables are altogether consonants, as ble, and Jle, in bubble and shuffle; but these are no exception to the rule of the single conso- nant, at the junction of sylables, and of its gliding into the following vowel, for these and their similars are pronounced, bubel and shufel. I have omitted the silent guttural gh wherever it occurs, and propose to supply its place by the letters, au, o, u, ou or uf, as in thaut, tho, thru,plou, and enuf. The same gh is omitted as useless in might, right, sight, and that family of words ; e being added to mite, and the rest, to indicate the long sound of i. From would and its family I is rejected. So far as I have reduced these changes to prac- tice, they are easily legible by the literal sound. Thaut and caut, site and mite, wud and cud, while acceptable to the ear, will soon cease to shock the eye. The distinction between mite the auxiliary, and mite the noun, and mite the insect will at once be determined by the connection of the first with the verb, and the use of the last two in the nominative or objective case. And so of rite the adjective and of rite as a noun ; of site, vision, and of site, situation, where the grammatical construction will make the distinction obvious; and so of the rest not stated here ; upon all which, the facilities of one side may explain and justify the difficulties of the other. I leave the desperate case of the redundant and deficient vowels to some future Hercules, to use his club on the thousand forms of Antaeus that will continue to rise against him. If this work would not at present be strangled in the attempt, it would propose and use a new and simple analogical type, for three of the form of a; but we leave these and other reforms in spelling to futurity. What is here proposed and exemplified in part, will be sufficient to make the hair of the literary formalist and the reviewer stand on-end, at this havoc with their language. Let them calm their horror; it will not tear it up by the roots, to prevent its lying down again, and covering the baldness of their superanuated error. The reform here offered will be acceptable to those who dare to use it. Others will stone the innovation as the metaphysical and stiffnecked Israelites served their unconforming Prophets. PREFACE SIXTH EDITION. After the publication of tlie ' Xatural History of the Intelect/ the Author was disposed to dilate the former Title-page of the present Work to what it was originaly intended to embracej the promise of a description of the voice, as the preparatory part of that ' History.'* The purpose of the History was in the mind of the Authorj with only short memorandums of his penj for nearly half a century, interupted however, time after time by profesional, and by social engagements ; but finaly gathered, and reduced to a writen system, within the few last years of that period. Before it apeared in print, he declared to no one, either relative, or other asociate, the subject of his inquiry : thereby preventing all antici- pative or conjectural scientific, or literary gosip which might in a friendly maner, or otherwise have interfered with the quiet secrecy of his ocupation. He has however, for causes, left the title of the Philosophy of the Human Voice unchanged. To the observant Reader of the two publications, any altera- tion is unecesar)^ ; for he will find certain principles, remarks, and prospective views contained in the ' Philosophy,' systematicaly un- folded in the 'HLstor}';' which if developed earlier, in the 'Phi- losophy,' would have been premature, not comprehended, or most probably unoticed ; but which must now show him the maner of a * For an acount of the purposes of the double coma here introduced, see a note on the first page of the Introduction. (xiii) XIV PREFACE TO THE SIXTH EDITION. direct conection between the functions of the mind and the voice. For it will be learned that the two Works are to be considered as the first and second parts of one great interwoven vocal and in- telectual subject: there being in the ' Philosophy of the Voice' constant reference to its mental aplication; and in the 'History of the Intelect/ ocasional cals for knowledge of the thdtive and expresive power of the voice. And here the Author adds. to this Sixth Edition, a record j how the ' Philosophy ' continues to be regarded by the ocupants of the eminent and influential places of instructionj with orators, players, and other suitors to the ear of the public ; who finding they can suced, each to his own satisfaction, in his limited purposes of Elo- cutionj after the old fashion of learningj leave this Work to the patronage of those early instructors and improvers, who are thus laying the foundation for some lasting usefulnes and pleasure in science and in art. Philadelphia, November 27, 1866. PREFACE FIFTH EDITION. What has been ofcrecl in the several Prefaces to this Work, is to be taken as only a brief notice of the maner in which it has been regarded, within the period of thirty years from its publica- tion ; and is intended, rather for an ocasional inquirer of a future age, to whom it may be interesting, than for the present genera- tion, who, while indiferent to the AVork itself, can have no curi- osity about its early progres and its subsequent fate. Having however, thru more sources than one, heard the remark, that its prefaces are looked upon as the only inteligible part of the Volumej I have, to avoid driving even an unwiling intelect alto- gether away, retained them in their present places and not transfered them as I had intended, to an Apendix ; being further induced thereto, by the consideration, that with the record of its progres, which is the principal object, they contain ocasional reflections, in- timating a general view of its design. Still, if the future Reader should feel no interest in early opinions, either friendly or adverse to it, he may pas on to the Introduction ; which as a constituent part of the subject, regards what the Art of Speech has already acomplishedj and what is yet to be done in its purposes, both of Instruction, and Taste. But to continue the record. Since the date of the fourth edition, in eighteen liundred and fifty-five, thftse who hold a certain influence, in the higher depart- ments of learningj still true to the Mede-and-Persian normality of the Majesterial mind, which docs not alow itself to altcrj con- (XV) XVI PREFACE TO THE tinue to maintain, with here and there a rebelious exception, the same indiference to the Analysis ; with a sly, if not an open opo- sition to its creeping advancement: altho they might find in its pages, something they have pretended to be in search of. There is however another, tho humble class, for until our pur- poses and means are comprehended, we are obliged so to call our- selvesj who are still laboring with gradual succes to enlarge the number of scholars and advocates of the New Elocution, and who, in their unheeded exertions, are contented with this sarcastic reflec- tion on the lazy pride and unproductive favoritism of Scholastic Patronagej There never was a wise or holy reformation, that the Lowly and Despised did not first assist the master of it. But in regarding their exertions, especialy thruout the Northern Statesj under the influence of Mr. William Russell, Principal of the Normal Institute at Lancaster, Massachusetts, and of his able Coadjutors j in extending the work of widely reforming, if not founding anew the whole Art of Speech, without a single Judas to desert, for he could not betray them ; I was acidentaly told, that in an English Review, of high authority, and extended circulation, Some Body has, for the thirty pieces of silver, come along with the servants of the High Priests of the old elocution, to lay, and this is all I would hear, not only unmerciful hands on the ' Philosojjhy of the Human Voicej ' but unmerciful sneers on its Author : being in his hardy onset, safely asured, that none of our company would defensively think of cuting off an ear, from one so deaf to the sound of the speaking voice, as to furnish the verdict of his having already lost both of his dull, and as a ' paid volun- teer' in partizan-acoustics, his criminaly dull and worthies ears in some other way.* * If we were disposed to be sportfuly clasical, we might, from our presump- tuous Keviower having the knack of so readily transmuting pen, ink, paper, and ignorance, into pay^ have otherwise represented him as the ' ingenium pingue,' the gross-wittcd Midas; for whose audacious decision against the musical claims of Apolloj the indignant yet compromising God did not cut-off, but only closed his ears from music and speech, in providing for their sub- animal wants, by the apropriate gift of greater extension. Nee Delius aurcs Humanam stolidas patitur retinere figuram : FIFTH EDITION. XVU Besides, we profess to be only like peaceful and industrious bees, gathering from nature an abundant store for future use; yet wishing it to be remembered, that the busy colectors are, by some wise ordination, provided with the means of defease, under suficient provocation ; which means however, the quiet laborers of our litle hive have not yet had, and trust they may not have, cause to employ. In the second page of our Introduction, I early declared my resolution, neither to read, nor seriously to consider, any objec- tions against tliLs Analysis and system, that are not the result of a scrutinizmg comparison of its descriptions with the phenomena of nature herself: which is only stating in other words, a precept of Baconian science j that justifies us in disregarding every objec- tion to observations and experiments, not drawn from observa- tions and experiments, more extensive and exact ; for this method saves much il-conditioned and wasteful argument. Certainly then, if our mercenary asailant, in rejecting the facts on which we have endeavored to raise a Natural Science of speech, does not, with a more atentive ear, give us the facts by which he rejects themj he must look to his own self-inflicted mortification, if we neither read what he writes, nor take particular notice of any report upon it. While in England some years ago, a Publisher proposed to me, and ofered on liLs own partj notwithstanding school-book copy- right and other oposing influences of British Elocution^ to print a London edition of the New Analysis. But knowing from the sovereignty of Truth and Time, in their unfailing patronage of every deserving efort m science, that with wisdom in cause and consequence, they always bestow it in their own procrastinating way ; and considering that certain contrivances and subornations of Trade, are esential to present succes ; I declined making what I then considered a useless submision of the Work, either to the Sed trahit in spatium ; Induiturque aures lente gradientis aselli. Ovid Met. B. XL I. 174. The God to punish such presumptuous pride, Yet still with justice swayed to mercy's sidej To those so dull and tunelcs cars decreed A bounteous length, to servo the Ass's need. XVUl PREFACE TO THE negative eifect of Foreign indiference, or to that anticipated Foreign oposition, which has presented itself in the form of a thotles, and I must supose a reversible condemnation. For a ' cry of critics 'is by no means to be let loose in our case, as in that of the great-baby-ism of a banquet speech ; an every-day marketable fiction ; some threadbare history, a thousand times re- writen; and the ' light reading ' biographical gosip on a popular career ; which with the comonplaces of knowledge, a habit of scholarship, and the haste of uncorected thot, may be whiped-over in an evening, by a run and skip of the pen. Nor will more than thrice 'ten sterling pounds per sheet,' pay for the Pauses and Plunges, the re-pausing and re-plunging, necesary for a deep and thorou inquiry into the new analysis and clasification, and for an impartial and responsible decision upon it.* This Work is to be thoroly studied as a whole, and taught in all its fulnes ; not to be here and there sketched-oif, in a few pages of a quarterly journal, and poorly ilustrated by ocasional examples of its good or indiferent quality. If, in executing it, we had thot of the Reviewers, we would have prefigured an individual of those ready scribesj as Horace denotes the genus, standing on one foot, and writing without fatiguej taking his text from the Title of the Workj peeping between its uncut leavesj mistaking its themej un- dervaluing its contents, for the purpose of concealing the use of themj and then extracting what would suit his sory ambition to furnish a useles article, he might choose to cal an original essay of his own. Having learned however, that at least one or two oixiers for the * To Jeifrey go, be silent and discreet, His pay is just ten sterling pounds per sheet. English Bards, I. 70. See the whole of Byron's retortive method of distiling down to a caput mor- iuum, the enlarged spleen and personal gal of his merciles Scotch Reviewer : who tho ' self constituted Judge ' in the Court of the Muses, could not make himself Prophet enuf, to forese in the youthful Poet, tho potential pen, and the future actual vengeance of his intended victim : and who showed quite as much il-natured surprise, at the bare thOt of a Noble Lord presuming to pub- lish a poeinj as our Englishman of tho thrice ten silver pieces has done, at tho suposition of one whom he takes to be a Democrat, daring to uter some origi- nal truths, which from their not being yet vulgarized, ho, himself a demo- cratic thinker and writer, canot comprehend. FIFTH EDITIOX. XIX book had come from England ; and suposing, that without being an object of general interest, it might here and there atract a curious reader, if set l^oforc hinij I proposed to the American publishers, to try an exjyeriment tcith it, on the noisele.s, candid, and unhired English intelect. Fifty copies of the fourth edition •were sent : and imediately thcreujion, one of the most powerful and popular Periodicals of the Kingdom, suportcd by its full share of an aray of the ' intelect, learning, research,' and of the pen-paying, and mind-impairing Journalism of the Nineteenth Century-, has determined for all those Mho do not read and think for themselves, that even if there could be the human imposibility of a Natural Science of Speech j the ' Philosophy ' has not the mi- raculous Gift of ear and tongue, nor the descriptive and clasifying pen to furnish it. And yet to record fairly, I have met \nth one instance, from which it does apearj there is not a univei^sal deafnes to the voice of the Work, in our over-critical, over-compiling, and comjiared with what she has been, and with what she rightly should be, in iutelectual fertility-, our present under-producing Mother Island. But notwithstanding the candid admission by Better England her- self, of the decline of the originality and vigor of her intelect, into the desultory and garbling method of Criticism, which under its meanly masked, and iresponsible Oligarchy, has at last brot-down the debilitated pen with its ' th riling' naratives, ' startling' fictions, and threadbare truths, to seek the protective patronage of the reading milion ; still we should not altogether adopt the comon opinion, that a critical age, more than the declining life of man, tho it may generally, should be necesarily and without exception, garulous on every-day thots and thingsj and turn -drowsy over the tasking pages of original truth ; should be given up to fond- ling the pets of a family ; and to being peevish, or rude, or va- cantly ' sans ears ' to the voice of the stranger without the gate of its calculating generosity. For we have all heard that Cato, the Censor, tho of the ruf Roman Horde, the piratical archetype of our boasted Anglo-Saxon race, did in his old age, lay open his mind to new and refined instruction, even thru the embarassing inlet of a foreign tongue. The slightest clearing however, of the brow in a frowning XX PREFACE TO THE parent deserves our grateful acknowledgment ; and it is justly to be recorded here, that about eight years ago, there fell into my hands, and it is now before me, a new edition of ' Grarrick's man- ner of reading the Liturgy j ' prefaced with a ' Discourse on public reading,' by one caling himself a ' Tutor in Elocution,' and pub- lished at London, and Cambridge, in eighteen hundred and forty; thirteen years after the date of the * Philosophy of the Human Voice.' There is loosely scatered over this Discourse, and am- bitiously apropriated to itself, tho poorly comprehended, some of the facts and principles taken without acknowledgment from the ' Philosophy ; ' while its Author is quoted by name, in an out-of- the-way foot-note, for g, single term of his nomenclature. On the undefined and limited ground of these disjointed facts and principles, the Tutor anounces a * forthcoming work on the human voice, and its expresion in speech ; ' derived, as his own confident promise and his means lead us to conclude, from some other source than that of his own observation and reflection. If after nineteen years, this great work has not forth-come, we must think, from what he has already in comon with the ' Philosophy,' and from his vague maner of defining and dividingj that it would save both himself and his readers much trouble, to republish if permited, the work, of which he seems so clearly to aprove, rather than furnish a strong resemblance to its contents, in his own maner of describing them.* He who claims the right to a discovery already published, asumes either to be the first and ful author of it, or to have had an obscure hint of it, in some maner, he is not often forward to tel. On which of these two grounds then did the Tutor get the general fact, that the intervals of the diatonic scale, with the exception of the second, may be perceptibly and nameably aplied to individual sylables, for the purpose of vocal expresion ; and that the second alone is used for unimpasioned discourse ? How did he draw from * The Tutor has more recently published two small pamphlets, under the respective names of an ' Introductory lecture,' and ' Acoustics and Loj^ic ; ' in which his aprobation of our new Analysis and system of the voice is fur- ther shown by his free, yet still garbled use of its pages. In the present com- ents, I refer indiscriminately to each of these three scrap-sketches; which may be resolved into cases either of sad halucination or of unblushing plagiary. FIFTH EDITION. XXI a little corner of his mind, the comprehensive induction, that Em- phasis, in a broad arid scientific definition, should include the dis- tinguishable detail of every mode of the voice? From whose extended view did he sketch, on his fitYy-ninth page, a synopsis of the whole of Analytic speech? What taught him to make the long overlooked but remarkable distinction between the diatonic mehxlyj which he awkwardly calls, ^speech melodyj' and the con- trasted expresion of other intervals, when laid upon it ? Who told him of that threefold and nice distinction in sylabic forcej caled in the * Philosophy ' the Radical, Median, and Vanishing Stress ? W'here did he learn, that the usual elocutionary terms, found even in his own Editorial little-book, are from the want of analytic de- scription, altogether indefinite and uninstructive ? And who told him, without seeing an exact system in his ' mind's eye,' if he has one, or somewhere in print, the fact of the Old Elocution being so vague, imperfect, and impracticable, that we therefore now require a new, precise, and Scientific Institute of the speaking voice ? The history of the voice contained in the following Work, far from being only as the Tutor could comprehend and represent itj a hast}' catching-up of unconected details, to suit a compiler's purpascj embraces generalities of related phenomena, deliberately gathered within that ever audible, yet till lately, unentered field of Intonation ; where the natural voices of thot and pasion had long floated on the air, inviting, but still awaiting, the event of a careful clasification and nomenclature. No aimles and hasty catching here and there, at unasorted sounds, astray from inter- comunion with the vocal unity of that field, could have brot them together even as awkwardly as the Tutor has done. He did not find them in Mr. Steele, or Mr. Walker, or in Authors who have adopted their limited and vague, or erroneous descriptions ; and if they were not picked at random, from the ' Philosophy of the Human Voice,' or taken out of some American school-book, care- lesly representing a few of the facts and principles, detached from that ' Philosophy,' it might be inferedj they were also original with him. But an original and pcn'ading truth never stands still, nor travels alone in the mind ; and if he who may claim to have discovered certain important facts and principles of speech, should not himself have seen much further, and more clearly into related XXn PREFACE TO THE truths, he must excuse us, if we conclude^ that he did not first perceve them at all.* The above case reminds me, that about a year after the first apearance of the ' Philosophy j ' the Rector of a church in the State of New York, published as his own, in a worthies little school- bookj with the common promise of a larger workj a hudled compi- lation of facts and principles on the subject of the voice, identical with some of those set-forth in the * Philosophy ; ' and with the very verbal examples, used for their ilustration; thus antedating the Tutor in his claims, by about eleven years. Had he regarded the words of the Evangelist, more than his own hopes, that a fraud undetected might pas for a discovered truth, he would have thot of his Great, but unheeded Mas'ter's liberal and just imperative; which we alter for present aplication. Render his own unto Caesar; and to the literary Pilferer, the Bare-Faeed Nothings that belong to him. This case of the American Rector is here aded, to show that we have no contra-national, nor exclusive views to foreign grand or pety-plagiary : and to say, that could we be alowed to turn from the truth and honor of Science, to a just personal retribution, we might reciprocate the Reviewing-favor of the Periodical stipendi- aryj in kindly drawing British atention to our Title-page, and in hastening the cal for this Fifth edition^ by hanging him up, with his deficient ear, anonymously conspicuous, between two of those who are found with, or use without acknowledgment, or who sneak higly carry away what does not belong to them. There is here no prying curiosity about the names, nor idle thots on the motives of individuals. The rights of truth and jus- tice, from the universality of their claims, shud defend themselves by general means, without descxinding into local or special conten- tion with the temporary interest of men. Our readers will per- haps find, we have something to spare; and we may add, that with a courteous use, and acknowledgment, it might have been taken, * Bad speling, says the Dictionary, ' is disreputable to a gcutlcinan.' For an acount of the disgraceful practical usc/ulncs of the above, and our other instances of bad speling, the Reader is refercd to the preceding Notice. The time is perhaps fur-otf, when perseverance in eror will be considered un- becoming in a gentleman. FIFTH EDITION. XXlll with our recorded thanks for the patronage. This Work was writ- ten fur the fair and profitable use of intcli'ing it away. It is no set-off to this charge of in- ternational freebooting that the instances of piracy by America, on Britain, and Continental Europe, are perhaps more than a thou- sandfold, beyond those of a reverse direction of the Bucaneer de- scent ; for vices thus credited are debtors stil, and are not to be canceled by the balance of an acount between them. We owe this however to the Tutor ; that having used with ap- robation, some of the leading principles of the Xew system ; and promising a fuler detail of them, he has intimated his belief in the posibility of so describing the constituents of speech, as to en- able himself or others, to found a practical method of instruction XXIV PEEFACE TO THE upon them : which is a considerable advance towards 'introducing among his countrymen, a New Order in the Art of speaking ; at whatever time and in whatsoever maner it may be aplied, to explain and justify upon princijjle, any instinctive proprieties, and to corect by rule, any thotles erors, that may be found in their old and imperfect system. But as to our Agressor of the Thirty Pieces, with perhaps no more eye for costume than ear for speech ; why may he not be some Professor under the now declining school of elocution ; who, fearful of losing even his short-lived profits in an ephemeral text- book, and with an inveterate pride in the il-fashioned and thread- bare suit of his mastership, has artfully set himself to prevent others from adopting the new style of Oratorical Pobe, in its Natural cast of vocal drapery ; which on being first presented to him, he must have perceved, could never be made to fold grace- fuly on himself. And it is here to be remarked, that when a critic of the trading sort has a pecuniary, an ambitious, a dogmatic, or a grumbling interest in condemning a workj he is very apt to con- found his argument on the subject, with some querulous feeling towards the author, who may inadvertently have brushed against his temperament, or thwarted his calculations.* It LS for all of us, an excelent Law of Suspicion, that subjects the pretensions of both Invention and Discovery, to the slow and cautious test of Time. For in the present distrusted state of human promises and powers, it afords the only means of protec- tion against the artful haste of an Impostor, by cuting-oif his sole reliance on the chance of imediate suces. It is however no legiti- mate part of this defensive ordination, that even questionable * It is an incident, deserving a place in our present record, that while the thousand hovering Hawks of British Periodicals dive at, and clutch-up any and every sort of game, just as it alights before the public, they should for seven and twenty years have pased by our folded wing, quietly waiting for future flight; thinking us perhaps, too tasteles or tough for their beak; and a kind of nourishment altogether foreign to their habitual proces of asimihi- tion : and yet, to drop our figure; at the moment this Volume was to be dis- tributed from the shelves of a London Bookseller, that it should have rouzed the trading interest of some Fellow of the Selfish Society of School-book Cojiyrights, to atack our proposed substitute for his superanuatod Art of roudiiig; thereby to sustain at once its decrepitude, and his own threatened ocupation. FIFTH EDITION. XXV claims slioukl, with a vain view to put them l)oyond tlie future reach of a just and decisive awardj be presumptuously outlawed by an incompetent Tribunal, before their reg;ular term of trial. But whatever may be the fair or biased opinions of others, one conclusion is quite satisfactory' to the claims of the New Analysis ; and it may in future prevent imecesary dispute on those claimsj that the portion here oferal as original, having been a subject of sneering animadversion, which would certainly spare no contro- verting means, at the comand of European research, during thirty years of oportunitvj there seems to be almost an asurance, that its facts and principles will not be hereafter refered to any other than a modern, and for the practical outwiting of the Reverend Jester- Wit, to a Transatlantic source. . An early and short paragraphic notice of this Work, which I have heard, apeared in an English magazinej far from finding in its broad and leading principles, the traces of any former system, yet perhaps to avoid the obligation of a critical survey of its char- acterj pronounced it to be a century in advance of the age. It may indeed be so. But the truth of to-morrow, is the truth of to-day : and he who so cautiously gave a prospective estimate, in place of an imediate and responsible decision, which the ground of that estimate must have justified j was not quite criticaly honest towards the Work, nor to his own age propheticaly civil ; since in then ofering the hope of that future award, which he acknowl- edged to be justly due, he rather invidiously questioned the capacity of his cotemporaries, by asigning the power of comprehending the Work, to intelects a century in advance of theirs. And yet after all, what have the friends of the New and Pro- gressive System to do with 'the true or false calculation, and the waste-work of the every-day tongue and pen ? Let topics of the hour wrestle with topics of the hour. We offer to posterity', part of the Histor}' of the Laws of Nature, in the human voicej here gathered into a comprehensive, and therefore to the present ma- jority of those it may concern, an incomprehensible Physical Science of Speech. If the critical Journalism of the nineteenth Centurv', tho generally co-even with the conventional knowledge of the times, and not being able to rise so far above some of its e.nbarasments and erors, as to perceve the extricating agency of a 3 XXVI PREFACE TO THE FIFTH EDITION. few original and simple truths j has with the old subterfuge of an indolent or deficient intelect, atempted to beat them down by sneer and denialj all our duty here requires, is to record the story of the harmles asault, in this now unregarded Volume ; which with its still unshaken belief in the future prevalence and sway of those truths, may yet go-forth and endure, because it anounces, and en- deavors to extend them. It was far from our intention to cast any pearls it might contain, before those who, ignorant of their value, disapointed at the unavailable profer, and balked into un- ruly iritation, would only inhumanly turn again and rend us. Finally, it will be learned, from the view we have taken of an inefectual ©position j there can be neither here nor elsewhere, an intentional submision to that criticism, which, if not deceved thru incapacity or ignorance, must know itself to be grosly at fault. The ' Philosophy of the Human Voice,' from its maner of ob- serving and representing nature, does not owe this submision to any unavailing atempt to condemn it. Yet it canot avoid com- iserating that deafnes, and indiference in high places which thus far, it has with all its remedial instruction, uterly failed to cure. Nor do I mean to ofer a responsive defense of the facts and prin- ciples set-forth in this 'Philosophy:' beleving, that under an observant, reflective, and candid investigation, they wil, by the voice of others in unison with the voice of Nature, at some time truly speak for themselves. As a necesary part of this record, I liave unfortunately been obliged, under some prospective views, to notice unoticeable, and to me happily, unknown individualities : but having on this oca- sion taken a nearer view of the ofense than of the ofenders, I have, with generic touches only, and -with a mitigated reaction on their thotles inroad, been careful to treat them as many now, and more hereafter may think, with greater kindnes than their cases deserve. Philadelphia, May 6, 1859. PREFACE FOURTH EDITION. A COXCEIT has for some time been circulating in this country, tending; to persuade every body, that Avliile they are constitu- tionaly the sovereigns over their own destiny in government, they are also sovereign over the rights of individuality, and the re- straints of good-breeding, morals, and law ; with the further claim to tyrannize over independence of thot, and to bind-down the fre- ranging power of originality. This last authority asumes, that originalit}', with its Patents of discovery and invention, often with us, so cruely involved in litigation, canot in justice be the privilege of an individual ; that whatever aparent novelty a person may pro- mulgate, it is only as the spokesman of a committe of the whole human mind, which has previously counseled, matured, and directed, all he has reported. That what was formerly suposcd to be the torch of discovery, in a single hand, is, in this popular era of equal rights and Intclcct-in-Commonj found to be merely a break- ing-out, at one human spot, of the ful-prepared and anticipated light of a colective efort in progresive instruction. This may indeed be true, of gradual changes in the comon afairs of life ; and of politicians, in -whose craft there is now, nothing new under the sun ; of the lawyer, whose slow thinking by the law, is his slow law of thinking ; of the physician, whose rule of progres, is just to keej) along with the jirogrcs ; of the sectary, whose orthodoxy means the comon-doxy of himself and his disciple ; and of the popular Great Man of the day, whose (xxvii) XXVlll PREFACE TO THE endles intimacies so identify him with every body, that his con- cerns in a joint-stock of interest and ambition, both waste hLs mind with reciprocal, and importunate obligations, and take from him the power of thinking for himself. It is likewise true of governments, which, with ocasional comotions, always rise or fal by gradual change ; and of some of the arts, particularly Archi- tecture; for tho by its own principles, capable of any number of distinct and self-unitized Orders, yet being without examplar forms in nature, its improvement and decline have been no more than sucesive variations of preceding designs. It is not true however, of those who outstrip the world by unrestrained obser- vation and reflection ; unawed by the frowns of conventional authority, and far away as possible, from the mischievous delu- sions of the opinions of men. Since the ' idols of the market, ' ' of the theater,' and of the comon mental-exchange, are idols, deaf as well as dumbj and altogether so impotent, that when implored for the favor of original thot, are always implored in vain. Neither is it true of that elegant Art of the Landscape, which with its 'directing wand' transforms to a Garden, the wildernes of Nature ; and which presented, at the ' Improver's word, ' an asemblage of the grand, the beautiful, the varied, and the pic- turesk ; giving to England the claim of ading to the ' Nine, ' another Muse, already in her few counted years, ful-endowed with dignity of character softened into grace ; yet never hoped-for nor expected, because never foreseen. This notion of co-equalityj that no one shall, without penalty for the ofense, have a thot not common to every body elscj is one of the dreams of a popular ' mass-meeting;' and seems to be a confused atenipt to express the simple truism, that no in- vention or discovery is adopted by the world, until every body can make use of it, or is of the same opinion as the author. For it is with the original truth of Science, as with the prudential ofer of practical advice; nobody adopts it, except it confirms his previous belief. But the mass-moeting is stil a mass, and wil have its own stuborn and headstrong way. The Work therefore, of which I here offer the fourth edition nuich enlarged, will I sup- ose be tried, and perhaps condcnuied by its rules. If the united inteligence of the age, joining imediatcly in the advancement of FOURTH EDITIOX. XXIX anv jmint of knowletlgc, is to be the test of its truth, upon the asumal jjround that the mind of the age has, up to the htst step, produced the advancement; the work Iwfore us can offer scarcely a chiim to atention. And I have no pride of authoi-ship to prevent tlie candid declaration, that from its first ajxiarance, to this time, a jwriwl of twenty-seven years, its only direct debt of gratitude is to a comparatively smal number of teachers, some inquiring and musical mechanics, and a few unmusical members of the Society of Friends. For, as far as I can learn, ninety- nine, hundredths of all Physiologists, whose purpose it is to de- scribe the voice ; of Masters of coleges and schools, who teach the art of reading ; of Elocutionists, whose materials of speech are furnished here ; of Naturalists, who thru the wide range of zoology, might take an interest in comparathe Intonation ; of the Votary of the fine arts, who might here see the seventh muse, now crowned by Science; of the Universal Grammarian, who might learn that various modes of mere sylabic sound are no less naturaly significant of thot and passion, than conventional words are significant of a gramatical sentence ; and finaly of the Philosopher of the mind, who might perceve some important and interesting relations of language to passion and thought : Of these I repeat it, there are ninety-nine hundredths, so far from having had directly a preparatory hand in this work, do not, after it has been before them more than a quarter of a century, even yet, as to its systematic and practical aplication, appear to know what it means. Acording to this popular notion of mas-think tng co-equality, and co-laboration, our book stands in a dilema. For on the one side, those who are eminently qualifieiod me a year in Edinburgh. During a subsequent residence in London, FOURTH EDITION. XXXI I procured the small volume of essays by Wharton and others ; and Milner's treatise, together with his History of AVinchester. By means of their chronicle of styles and changes in the artj by their explanation of terms, or an incidentjil use of thenij and by the light of taste, just dawning in the pages of Milnerj I was enabled, after visiting churches, to compile for my own private instruction, and as my own remembrancer, something like an ele- mentary compend : including a description of the structure of the cathedral ; the character and sucesions of its various styles ; an ex- planation of the terms of the art, far as they had then been asigned ; and an acount of the division, distribution and purposes of the Monastery. This little manuscript is dated in eighteen hundred and eleven, and however trifling, is among the earliest, as I am in- formed, in that systematic maner of treating the subject. There was then neither name nor fame in the art ; and the interest in it, was confined to as few perhaps, a.s those now interested in the analysis of speech. On revisiting England in eighteen hundred and forty-five, I found Gothic Architecture had become so popular, that the amatur and compiler had begun to rival the profesional artist. Every gentleman was required to have a smatering at least, of its terms ; and many a rail-car pasenger was ready to tell you of Norman, Early English, Decorated, and Perpendicular styles. My sympathy with an enthusiast, at the Winchester Station, made quite friends of us, as we together traced the Cathedral forms and chronology j from Walkelyn's Norman 'arches broad and round, ' to the grand and graceful unity of Wykeham ; which seems yet to say to the artj Thus far shuldst thou go and no farther, and here shud thy pure and finished style be staid. Perhaps an Englishman might sayj this sudcn intimacy, ' with- out knowing who people are,' even tho the intimacy sprung from congenial knowledge in an elegant artj was * very improper indeed.' But we soon parted, and forever ; yet I beleve, neither has since sufered any inconvenience from our sociability, while I very agreeably receved much satisfactory information. Regarding then the restoration of Gothic architecturej may we ask, if the time will ever come, when the art of analytic speech, now the humble titual practice if not by instinctive ear, the most precise dis- crimination of tunable sounds; are unable to recognize the peculiar music of speech, and even to comprehend the meaning of this XXXVl PREFACE TO THE Workj there is a clasj the Society of Friends, who, by the strictest discipline, shun all the graces of Art ; who never cultivate the ear either by instrument or voice, but fantasticaly corupt it in their public discourse; Avho yet, Avhen adressed by the system, have formed a large proportion of its pupils, and have comprehended its design, tho they may not have always been able, vocaly to execute its rules, A few teachers of Salmody apear to have read the Work ; and far as they have found its discriminations and terms aplicable to their purpose, have adopted them in their Manuals of instruction. Of readers who hold the scientific influence, whatever that may be, of this country, very few have regarded it either with curiosity or favor. But what makes their case remarkable is, that in their own want of capacity, they always supose the deficiency to be on the side of the Author. One says, it is a sealed book ; another, that it might as well have been written in Hebrew. An eminent leader of opinion, on this side of the water, says, it is not worth reviewing : while on the other side, one of the very highest rank, in British periodical criticism, declares, in the frank confesion of an inefable superiority, that * it quite surpases his comprehension.' One, not contented with his own single incompetence, takes the Author into his company, by saying j he himself does not know his own meaning ; and to a high-placed medical Professor, and a practical musician, the work was altogether so uninteligible, that he recomended one of his friends to read it, as a fine example of the incoherent language of insanity. These remarks have a place here, not from their importance either to the author *or his subject; but as minor chronicles, colateral to the early history of the Philosophy of Speech. And I am quite wiling to beleve, that whether they came from igno- rance or from spleen, they were the ofspring of an idle humor, by this time, changed to something else equally foolish or bad. These however may have been words of a moment, and then forgoten. Two, and only two, far as known, have employed time, reflection, argument, public lecturing and printing, in dispute of the claims of this Work. Under the article. Philology, in the 'Encyclopedia Americana,' the translation of a German essay, the President of the American THIRD EDITION. XXXVU Philosopliical Society, after stating, as ^vell as lie coukl compre- hend it, the design of the 'Philosophy of the Human Voice,' gives, ^vllat he thinks, learned and suficient ground for determin- ing, not only that it has not, acording to its purpose, developed and measured the expresive movements of speech ; but that it never can be clone. Xot to contend here -with a gentleman, who, at the head of all the philosophers, denies, what I perhaps vainly supose to have been acomplishetlj I must hand him over to the unknown science and industry of future ages, to argue the case of its future imposibility ; only remarking here, that as it has been done already, in the Work, now in the distinguished President's hands, there can be nothing either imposible or miraculous in its being done again. The other formal decision against the means and end of this "Work, comes, as I am told, from one of the thousand lecturers of the day, at Bostonj whose name I cannot now call to mind. All I have to say of his attempt at refutation, having never seen the article, is, that in addition to the direct demonstration of the truth of the analysis, which the ear has given to some few inquirers, he has unexpectedly furnished us with that indirect proof, caled by logicians, the argumentum ducens in absurdum : meaning in plain Englishj the proposition must be true, M'hen we cannot without absurdity, prove it to be false. I have a few words to add, on the subject of adapting the prin- ciples of this Work to the purposes of practical instruction. Seven or eight gramai's or text-books of elocution, for the use of schools, have already been formed out of a different amount of its materials, and set forth with various degrees of ability. As the object is to render a gramar popular, it has been the aim of the compilers to simplify the system, and to furnish a cheap book ; by accomodating it as they sujiose, to the mental, and other necesi- ties of the learner. This atempt, either by its very purpose, or by the mancr of its execution, has i)erhaps had the efect to retiird the progres of the new system of the voice. For, the superficial char- acter of these books, and mingling })arts of the old method with parts of the new, together with an atempt to give definitiellion agjiinst the Kingly-rule of Po})- ularity, and the Majorative-Despotism of its opinion. Yet upon this very conviction I ofered the Work to the public ; ho))ing, by the difusion of its principles, to bring it into that old and only 4 (xli) xlii PREFACE TO THE j)ath of truth, which begins witli a few and ends with the many ; and, in due season, to suit the country to it. With here and there an exception, the scofers at this Work have been those eternal enemies to all disturbing originality, the Place- men of Learning. Suposing however that, thro the influence of knowledge made light and popular and cheap, the Arts are not so far downward, as to create desjDair of sucesful eforts by a new one, before their entire decay and future revival ; I would say to many of those who hold the places and draw the profits of science, that if they will but continue to sheath their opposition in their feigned contempt, the first humble advocates of this Work may, by a grad- ual rise to those places and profits, see their own enlarged designs of instruction, in the course of half a century, completed. Several teachers in the United States have adopted the system. Dr. Barber, an English physician who had devoted himself to the study of elocution, and who came to Philadelphia about the period of its publicationj was the first to admit its principles, and to defend them against the double influence of doubt and sneer, by an explanatory and ilustrative course of lectures.* Yale College, at New Haven, was early favorable to the system. But the Uni- versity of Cambridge, by apointing Dr. Barber to its department of Elocution, was the first chartered institution of science in this country that gave an influential and responsible aprobation of the Work. As this system furnishes general principles for an x\rt, hereto- fore directed by individual instinct or capricej all who would teach that art by principles founded in nature, must sooner or later adopt it. AVill the influential instructors of Philadelphia be the last? •The objections first made to the ' Philosophy of the Human Voice,' were against its utility ; now the cry among the Learned is; it is too dificult. Too difficult ! Why, all new things are diffi- cult ; and if the scholastic j)retendcr knows not this, let the annals of the Trades instruct him. Just one w^ntury has elai)8al since that comon material of furniture. Mahogany, was first knoA\ii in * Throo years after tho date of the ' Philosophy,' Dr. Barber published at New Haven, 'a Gramar of Eloeution' founded on that Work, as a Text-book to his oral instructions. SE(X)ND EDITION. xllU England. It is recorded that Dr. Gibbons, an eminent physician of that period, had a brother, a West-India captain, who took over to London some planks of this wood, as balast. The Doctor was then building a house ; and his brother thot they might be of sers'ice to him. But the carpenters finding the wood too hard for their tools, it was laid aside. Soon after, a candle-box being wanted in his family. Dr. Gibbons requested his cabinet-maker to use some of this plank which lay in his garden. The cabinet-maker also complained, that it was too hard. The Doctor told hinij he must get stronger tools. AVhen however by sucesful means, the box was made, the Doctor ordered a bureau of the same material ; the color and polish of which were so remarkable, that he invited his friends to view it. Among them, was the Duches of Buckingham, who being struck with its beauty, obtained some of the wood ; and a like piece of furniture was imediately made for Her Grace. Under this influence, the fame of mahogany was at once established ; its manufacture was then found to be in nowise dificult ; and its em- ployment for both use and ornament has since become universal. The master-buildei's of science, literature, and eloquence, declared the 'Philosophy of the Human Voice' to be too hard for their stu- dious energies; and threw it aside as useless. But a few humble Cabinet-makers of learning having somehow or other, got stronger tools, have already made the box ; are under way with the bureau ; and are only waiting for the authoritative influence of some leader of oratorical fashion, to produce a general belief in this simple truismj if we wish to read well, we must first learn HOW. Philadelphia, June 26, 1833. INTRODUCTION. The analysis of the human voice contained in the following essay, was undertaken a few years ago, exclusively as a subject of physiological inquiry. Upon ascertaining some interesting facts, in the uses of speech, I was induced to pursue the 'investigation ; and subsequently atempt a methodical description of the various vocal phenomena^ thereby to include the subject within the limits of science, and assist the purposes of oratorical instruction. By every scheme of the cyclopedia, the subject of the voice is- alotted to the physiologist ; yet upon its most important functionj speech and its expresion, he has strangely neglected his part by borowing much of his suposed knowledge from the wild notions of rhetoricians, and the intermedling authority of gramarians. It is time at last, for physiology seriously to take up its task,* * In the fifth edition of this Work, I submited to the Reader, the first im- printing, and practical use of a Double Coma, as a symbol of Punctuation. The want of a point, for a significant pause between that of a coma and a semi- colon, must have been perceved by exact and thotful writers, in descriptive' and explanatory composition. For brevity, and easy rythmus in enumerating, the points, it may, from the Greek 6lc, tioice, be called Dicoma, The principal, purposes for which I employ it arcj First ; as prefatory to an ilustrative in- stance ; or a question, or the statement of a question ; or a condition ; to indi- cate by the symbol, some notable meaning, shud the mind for the moment askj what is to follow. Second; for cases when the gramar is prone to run. on, and perspicuitj' requires a special suspension j beyond a point of longer rest than that of the coma. Third ; for subdivided short or long periodic sen- tencesj with or without other pointsj to chock the haste of gramatical partsj if disposed to run together; thereby drawing atention to the individuality of members^ to releve the whole from intricacy. Fourth; to bound parenthetic clauses, and in taking the place of the Dash j which is always a formles linear blemish on the compact ncatnes of printj to cary over the meaning and gramar^ thro the space between the pau.ses. Fifth; as a direction to a fulowing jirop- osition ; showing; the punctuativc means for suplying the j)lacc of the demon- strative thai, when this pronoun precedes the word, there, or this, or they, or (45) 46 INTRODUCTION. In entering on this inquiry, I resolved to have no reference to former writersj until the habit of discriminating the facts of the voice should be so far confirmed, as to obviate the danger of adopt- ing unquestioned erors, which the strongest efort of independence often finds it so dificult to avoid. Even a faint recolection of school instruction was not without its forbiding interference, in my first atempt to discover, by the ear alone, the hidden proceses of speech. After obtaining an outline of the work of Nature in the voice, suficient to enable me to avail myself of the useful truth of other observers, and to guard against their mistakesj I consulted every acessible treatise on the subject, particularly the European com- pilations of the day, the authors of which have oportunities for learned research, not enjoyed in this country. Finding, on a fair comparison^ the folowing description of the voice represents its phenomena more exteasively and definitely than any known sys- tem, I was induced to give it the durable form of Print. Many erors may be found in it ; but if the general history, and the ana- lytic development are not drawn from nature, and do not prompt others to cary the inquiry further, and into practical detail, I shall much regret the time wasted in the publication. It becomes me however, to remark, that as the greater part of this Work has not been made-up from the quoted, or controverted, or accomodated opinions of authors, I shall totally disregard any decision upon its merits, that is not the result of a scrutinizing comparison of its descriptions, with the j)henomena of Nature herself. The art of speaking- well, has in most civilized countries been their, or itself repeated, or any other word of striking similarity in sound, which might ofend the ear. Sixth ; to separate, without aresting tlie bearing of the verb, a sucesion of members^ as objects of a previous action^ or as the agents of a prospective efectj which may mentaly indicate a less pause than a semicolon, and greater than a coma between tliem. Seventh ; the aplication of this point, under some of the preceding heads, is so indeterminate that the coma, not the semicolon, may be used with its meaning. All these cases and perhaps more, are exemplified throhout this Volume. iBut punctuation partakes in a degree, of the whiins of the human mind; and 'On this subject rc;iders and writers will in many j)articulars, have cacli a whim of his own. Shud however, this now point be considered worthy of adoption, others may give more precise rules for its aplication. \ INTRODUCTION. 47 fv cliorisliwl mark of tlistinction between the elevated and the Inimble conditions of life ; and has been imediately coneeted with some of the greater pnrposes of justice, religion, instruc- tion, and taste. It may therefore apear extraordinary, that the Avorld, with all its works of philosophy, should have been satisfied by an instinctive exercise of the art, and by ocasional examples of its suposed perfectionj without an endeavor to found an ana- lytic system of instruction, productive of multiplied instances of succes. Due reflection however, will convince us, that even this extended purpose of the art of spciiking has been one cause of the neglect. It has been a popular art ; and works for present })opularity are too often the comonplace product of a comon- place ambition. The renowned of the bar, the senate, the pulpit, and the stage, aplauded into self-confidence by the undiscerning multittide, canot acknowledge the necesity of improvement ; for the rewards that await the art of gratifying the general ear, are in no less a degree encouraging to the faults of the voicx^, than the aprobation of the milion is subversive of the rigid discipline of the mind. Physiologists have described and clased the organic positions that produce the alphabetic elements. This has been done by the rule, and with the succes of philosophy. On other points their atempts have not been so satisfactory. In describing the function of Pitch, or the rise and fall of the voice, which we here call Intonation, they have not designated by some known or in- vented scale, the forms and degrees of such movements; and furnished the required and definite detail in this department of speech. They have rather given their atention to the folowing inquiries : Whether the organs of the voice have the structure of a wind, or of a stringed instrument; how the falsete is madej and whether acutenes and gravity arc formed by variations in the aperture of the glotis, or in the tension of its chords. In their experiments, they removed the orginis from men and other ani- mals, and produced something like a living voice, by artificialy blowing through them. They ciirefuly inspected th(! cartilages and muscles of the larynx, to discx)ver thereby the imcdiate cause of intonation, yet altogether overlooked the audible forms and degrees of that intonation. In short, they tried to sec sound. 48 INTEODUCTION. and to touch it with the disecting-knife ; and all this, without reaching any positive conclusion, or describing more of the audible eject of the anatomical structure, than was known two thoasand years ago. The Greek and Roman rhetoricians, and imters on music, recorded their knowledge of the fimctions of the voice. They distinguished its diferent Kinds, by the termsj harsh, smooth, sharp, clear, hoarse, full, slender, flo^ving, flexible, shril, and austere. They knew the Time of the voice, and had a view to what they called its Quantity in pronunciation. They gave to Force or Stres, under its form of acent and emphasis, apropriate places in speech. They observed the variation of acute and grave in sound ; and were the first to make an exact and beautiful analy- sis on this subject. They discovered two forms of transition be- tween acutenes and gravity ; one that ascends or descends, by a continuous movement or slide : the other, by an interupted move- ment or skip from place to place, in ascent and descent. They also perceved j the former is employed in Speech ; the later, on musical instruments. Tho, from carying the inquiry no further, they suposed, but eroneously as we shall learn hereafter, that one was soley apropriated to speech ; the other soley to instruments. The ancients however, show no acquaintance with the subdi- visions, definite degrees, and particular aplications, of those two general forms of pitchj for the discriminative purposes of oratori- cal use : and if we may judge, from an atempt by Dionysius of Halicarnassus to point out the diference between singing and speech, and from some other descriptions, totaly ireconcilable with the proprieties of modern, and as we shall learn hereafter, of natural and ordained intonation^ we must beleve they made on this point, only a limited analysis ; that the uses of pitch, or of the 'tones' of the voice, as they are caled, were conducted alto- gether by imitation ; and that the means of instruction were not reduced to any precise or available directions of art. No one can read that discourse on the management of the voice, in Quinctilian's elaborate chapter on Action, without alowing to the ancients a power of pcrceving many of the beauties and blemishes of s])ecch. Yet among the numerous indications of tlieir practical familiarity with the art of public speakingj we find no INTRODUCTION. 49 clear description of its coiLstituente, nor any definite instruction. The abundant detail thruhout liLs work more tlian once leads the Author to an apology for its minutcncs ; and therefore precludes the suposition that he designedly overlooked any well known means, by which the various uses of the voice mit be represented with available precision. It is suposcd, the ancient rhetoricians designated the pitch of vocal sounds by the term, Acent. They made three kinds of acentsj the acute, the grave, and the circumflex; signifying, severaly, the rise, the fall, and a continuation of these into a turn of the voice. The existence in Greek manuscripts, of certain acentual symbols, repre- senting these movements, which however were not aplied till about the seventh century, aforded the only data, for modern inquiry into the forms of Greek intonation ; and created a learned disputej that wa.s continued, without one satisfactory result, from the time of the Younger Vossius, to the recent days of Foster, and Gaily. If Greek Scholars had employed other means than wasteful w^rangling with each other, for ascertaining the purpose of acentual marks, it wud long ago have been determined, whether they direct to any practical knowledge of Greek uterance, or are only a sub- ject for useles contention. Had the tongue and the ear, the ritful Masters in this school, been consulted, these symbols wud at once have been regarded as vague and meager representations of the full and measurable resources of the voice. The disputants found that degree of obscurity in the acount of ancient acent, which encourages the profitles labors, and alternate triumphs of party ; which subjects opinion to all the chicanery of sectarian argument ; and shuts out the conclusive inquiries of in- dependent observation. In the distracting fashion of the old dialectic art, and of its modern use, they ' discoursed about truth until they forgot to discover it:' and while they exhibit a distresing waste of time, and temper, by continualy seeking in the flickering indications of unfinished records, the light which would steadily have arisen on their observation, they hold out to the future his- tstruc- tive influence, kept his ful-suficient and undeviating ear on Nature, she would at last have led him up to light. Mr. Sheridan is well known by his discriminating investigation of the Art of reading ; and tho he improved both the detail and method of his subject, in the departments of pronunciation, em- phasis, and pause, he made no analysis of intonation. A regreted omision ! The more so from the ceitainty, that if this topic had receved his atention, his inteligenoe and industry would have shed much light of explanation upon it. Mr. \\'alker, who has writcn usefully on Rhetoric and Philology, devotes a portion of his work to the subject of the rise and fall of the voice, in its aplication to the emphatic sylables of a sentence : and reiterates his claims to originality on this subject. Mr. Walker may have been the first to aply the confused and conjec- tural system of ancient Accnt to a modern language ; but he has 52 INTRODUCTION. scarcely gone beyond the limited analysis, furnished by its history. The Greek writers on music had a discriminative knowledge of the rise, fall, and circumflex turn of speech. Aristoxenus the philoso- pher, a pupil of Aristotle, discovered, or first described, that pecu- liar rise and fall of sound by a continuous progresion, which distinguishes the vocal slid, from the skiping transition on musical instruments. Mr. Walker does triumphantly claim the discovery of the in- verted circumflex acent, or the downward-and-upward continued movement. Yet, if it is corectly infered from the dates of pub- lication, and from Mr. Walker's rather derisive alusion to Mr. Steele's essay, that the latter author preceded him j he mit have found, in Mr. Steele's gravo-acute acent, proof of a previous knowledge of his newly-found function of the voice. Mr. Walker was a celebrated elocutionist, and may have known how to manage his intonation ; but in his atempt to delineate its forms, he is even less definite than Mr. Steele. His insinuation that speech and music, each being varied uses of the same tunable constituents, should not be ilustrated by some analogous notation^ and his own eroneous diagrams of the progress of pitch, are in- stances of a want of reflection and of obtusenes of ear, quite rep- rehensible in one, who, without compulsion, should undertake to investigate the relationships of sound. I have stated the amount, and the sources, of what has been heretofore known of the functions of speech. In a general view, it apears : That the number, the kinds, and the organic causes of the Aljihabetic Elements have long been recorded, with acurate dctiiil ; That Quantity or the Time of sylabic uterance, together with the subject of Pause, had been distinguished only by a few indefinite terms, until Mr. Steele, with discriminative perception, aplied to speech some of the principles and symbols of musiciil notation; That Acent or the means of distinguishing a sylable by sires or intensity of voice, has been definitely described in English pronun- ciation, both as to its place and degrees ; That this sylabic stress, tho attentively regarded in the grammatical institute of the Greeks, is yet in their records, so confounded with some notion of the rising and the falling slid, and the circumflex turn of the voice, tliat we are left altogether in doubt, as to their systematic and separate use INTRODUCTION. 53 of these (liferent functions ; That Emphasis, wlien restricted to the purpose of making one or more words conspicuous, by force or in- tensity, has long been a subject of rlietorical atention; Mr. Walker being the first among modern Elocutionists, who atempted, under the terms upward and downward slide, to conect any view of In- tonation with it : And finaly, that the analysis of Intonation has hardly been extended beyond the recorded knowledge of the ancients. Greek and Roman writers tell us of the acute, grave, and circumflex movements ; and these, with the newly described inverted-circumflex, have, at a recent date, by Mr. Steele and Mr. Walker, first been vaguely regarded, in English speecli. These four general heads of intonation are truly drawn from nature ; yet, with the present indefinite meaning of their terms, they are useles for practical instruction, and no less imperfectly designate the measurable modifications of speech, than the four cardinal terms of the compas describe all the points, distances, and contents of space. The discovery of the above mentioned distinctions in intonation, which must justly form the outline of all nicer discrimination, was the result of philosophical inquiry. A much more abundant, but not more precise nomenclature has been derived from criticism. The folowing phrases are extracted from a description of Mr. Gar- rick's maner of reading the Church-service, and have an especial reference to the Intonation of his voice : ' Even tenor of smooth regular delivery,' 'Fervent tone,' 'Sincerity of devotional ex- presion,' 'Ilei)entant tone,' 'Reverential tone,' 'Evennes of voice,' ' Tone of solemn dignity,' ' Of suplication,' ' Of sorow, and con- trition.' Those who know what constitutes acuracy of language, must admit that such atempts to name the means of vocal expresion, have no more claim to the title of Intel igible description, than be- longs to the rambling signification of vulgar nomenclature. We seem not to l>e aware, that no describablc perceptions of sound are conectcd with such comon phrases of criticism, until required to ilustrate them by some definite forms of intonation. 'Grandeur of feeling,' says a writer, in laying down the rules of elmnition, 'should be cxpresed with pomp and magnificence of tone;' as if the words, pomp and magnificence were specifications of percepti- 54 INTRODUCTION. ble ' tones j' or explanatory and definite terms for some well-known forms and uses of the voice. But as these words describe no audi- ble function, they can in this case denote indefinitely, only a state of mind; and are therefore convertible with the term, 'grandeur of feeling,' which denotes indefinitely only a state of mind. AVe may therefore presume, from their having no reference to assign- able conditions of the voicej if the writer had been, conversely asked, how 'pomp and magnificence of feeling' should be expresed, he would, with no more precision, have answered j 'by grandeur of tone.' Such rules for the expresion of speech, tho abounding in our systems of elocution, are resolvable, into words, with no ex- planatory meaning. Nor can any weight of authority give them the power of description ; since the terms ' sorowful expression,' and 'tone of solemn dignity,' in the precepts of an acomplished Elocutionist, have no more signification as to the modes, forms, degrees, and varieties of pitch, time, and force of voice, than those of 'fine-turned cadence,' and 'chaste modulation,' in the idle criti- cism of a daily gazette. All arts and sciences apear under two diferent conditions. They may be described by terms of vague signification, suited to the limited knowledge and feeble senses of the ignorant, in every caste of society. Those who view them under this condition, in vainly pretending to discriminate, express only their thotless approbation. Again, they may be shown in definite delineation, by a language of unchangeable meaningj and independently of the perversions, which slender ability, natural temper, or momentary humor may create. He who thus surveys an art, will in expressing his apro- bation, always reflect and discriminate. Some branches of the art of speaking are even at this late period scarcely removed from the first of these conditions. This however, will not seem strange, when we for a moment refer to its cause. There is no growth of intelect from a metaphysical nothing; no 'equivocal generation' in knowledge. It always springs from the obvious seeds of itself; and these are first planted in the mind, by definite perceptions and explanatory terms. But the elementary forms of Intonation are an esential constituent of expresive speech ; and tho constiuitly heiird, have never been named : the studious inquirer has therefore wanted a INTRODUCriOX. 55 definite language for those purposes of the voice, which lie must have always obscurely perceved. The fulness of nomenclature in art is directly proportional to the degree of its improvement ; and the acuracy of its terms insures the precision of its systematic rules. The few and indeterminate designations of the modes of the voice in Heading, compared with the number and acuracy of the terms in Masic, imply the diferent maner in which each has been cultivated. The inquirers into the subject of speech have un})roductively given up their opinions to authority, and their pens to quotation. The musician has devoted his ear to observa- tion and experiment, and in their path has persisted onward to succes. The words, quick, slow, long, short, loud, soft, rise, fall, and turn, indefinite as they are, include nearly all the discrimina- tive terms of Elocution. How far they fall short of an enumera- tion of every precise and elegant use of the voice, and how fairly the caiLse of the vague and limited condition of our knowletlge ls here represented, shall be determined on a retrospective view by an age to come, when the ear will have made deliberate examina- tion. A conviction of the imperfect state of our knowledge in certaiii branches of the Art of Speaking, first led the Author to the en- suing investigation ; and a hope that others mit asist in the com- pletion of a desirable measurement and method of the voice, induced him to set the present publication before them. If it shud not furnish a plan for the future establishment of the prin- ciples of Intonation, Time, and Forcej he must still continue to beleve, without controversy, in the atainable and practical benefits of such a work. I canot, at this timej when an unsteady Popularity, in disturb- ing everything else, has presumed to be the directive Master of Tastej withhold a few remarks on the importance of general 2>rin- ciples, in the Fine Arts ; as these ])rinciples are not only the sure Foundation and the Pi-eservative defense of a steadfa'^t Intelectual Taste, distinguished from a Taste of changeable preferences, and capricej but are at the same time, the most efcctive means for exalting it. And altho the entire want of such principles or rules in the use of Intonation, has unecesarily letl to the l>eliefj they canot be instituted, it will be shown in the folowing csay ; they 56 INTRODUCTION. are not only as esential but likewise as atainable in Elocution, as in any other art which elegantly employs the observation and reflection of the intelect. Those persons who receve the highest intelectual enjoyment from the works of art, know well, that its fulness and durability are chiefly derived from that power of broad and exact discern- ment, which is acquired by experience, and time, and by a dis- ciplined inquiry into the rules of taste that direct the production. A knowledge of these rules constitutes the executive facility of the artist, and gives delight to him who contemplates the work. Whatever the physical susceptibility may be, it is not the im- presion of form, or color, or sound, pasively receved by the eye or ear, that creates an enlightened perception of the objects of the fine arts. Delicate organization, call it ' Genius ' here if you please, is essential to this perception ; still it is the united activity of the senses and the brain, in the work of observation and com- parison, together with the development of new, and the aplication of pre-established rulesj which by unfolding the latent tendencies of this physical susceptibility, constitutes the extended, the dis- criminative, and the enduring pleasure of taste. And if there is yet to be discovered some surpasing eficacy of art, for a surpasing intelectual delight, it can never be acomplished, except by the influence of comprehensive and still acumulating precepts ; derived from the study of nature it is true, but aplied to represent her chosen, corected, and combined individualities ; and thereby, under the human eye at least, to generalize and exalt even that Nature, in form if not in purpose, above herself. Besides the sources of contemplative pleasure, and the means of preservation and improvement in an art, aforded by principles, their influence is operative after a temporary decline, or total loss of its practice. They efect a speedy restoration when evil example has passed away, or a tradition of former excelence has produced a desire for its revival. Tlie definite description of elementary constituents, and the statement of the rule of their use, are par- ticularly necesary in the art of speaking- well ; since its pasing exercise leaves no record of itself. The works of art, without an explanation of their meaning and use, are often as deep an enigma, as the works of nature ; and a long course of observation is in INTRODUCTION. 57 cac'li case equaly required, to note and class their phenomena, and to discover their formal, their efficient, and their final causes. Altlio the ancients have left us abundant eulop^istic anecdotes on the art of Painting, they have done little more than alude to tliosc principles of composition, design, shaded light, and coloring, by which their great masters im])roved upon nature, while they ])ro- fesed to imitate her ; and the want of a knowledge of these, even with the benefits of patronage, was one cause of the delay of at least two centuries, in the gradual progres of the art to its full restoration, in modern Europe. Stories of the graces of ancient Design were revolved in the minds of the image-makers of Italy, and of the decorators of cloisters, like the problems of the me- chanical wondei's of Archimedes, that were not to be solved by record or tradition.* Ancient architecture has, by means of the fragments of its ruins, been revived in modern days, to a degree atainable thru precision of measurement ; and under this view, some of its remains have furnished the highest examples for imitation. Delicate observa- tion, aided by a refined taste in other arts, is yet required, to retreve the knowledge of those principles which must have directed the taste of the Greeks ; but of which Vitruvius gave only an imperfect sketch, while compiling a popular book lor Builders ; and which Pausanias, in his hurried tour, forgot to set down, as the proper preface to his Inventory of temples. If the Greek writers on music had not furnished us with a knowledge of the ancient Scales, and of the principles tliat directed their construction and uses, the records of Choragic monuments and the acounts of the Odeum, wud have only ex- cited our wonder at the extraordinary power of instrumental sound. The inv^entivc mind of Guido, instead of completing the modern scale, might have only laid its foundation, by fixing a single chord acros a shell, and the finished system of modern har- mony mit now have been but just begun. Such is the view we take of arts directed by princij)lcs, or pre- * See an acount of the above new term, shaded light, in tlie twonty-flfth Article of the thirty-sixth Section, under the head of Painting, in th(! ' Nat- ural History of the Intelect;' since from the conection of the mind and the voice, I supose the incjuiring Header to poses tiie two Works that describe it. 58 INTRODUCTION. cepts colected from experience, for designing, executing, presers^ing, and reviving the great and desirable works of usefulness and taste : precej)ts acumulated by th§ eforts of close and industrious observation, looking to the eventual aid of Time ; who, himself never working impatiently, becomes the great wonder-Avorker of all intelectual, as well as of all physical creation. The folowing essay exhibits an atempt to describe the constituents of speech, and the principles of their aplication, with a precision that may enable criticism to be systematic and instructivej thereby afording readers at other times and places, the means of compre- hending its discriminations. Discusions on the subject of standard principles, in some of the arts, have always involved the question of their origin ; and nature has generaly been asumed as the source. Nature afords two conditions of her governing rules, for rules are only directive principles. In one, she is taken as the model for exact imitation, in those branches of art which profes to copy her full and actual details^ exemplified by the faultles and ex- quisite artistic delineations, in the various departments of Natural History, and as in every science. Here individual nature is the standard ; and here the excelence of art consists, in the whole- truth of the resemblance, without the least superfluous ideal-touch. In the other, or in the departments of Taste, where it is the jjur- pose to exalt its creations, by a mental corecting of what to our eye, apears to be the exceptionable details of nature, or by a selection from her scatered constituents of beautvj the rule is the result of a congenial knowledge in the art, exhibited in strong similarity among persons of equal instinct and cultivation : v/hich, if it does not prove conformity in taste to be the development of an invari- able law of nature, in the human mind, at least afords education the means of tracing the causes of beauty and deformity ; and of framing a satisfactory and enduring system of laws for itself. The uses of the voice have not yet been brot under either of these conditions. For the first ; Nature or that uncnligjitened, or rather deformed instinct comonly called natural speech, does not aford examples of individual excelence; and has perhaps never furnished a single instance, worthy in all respects to be copied. For the second condition ; from the want of a full knowledge and INTRODUCTION. 69 definite nomenclature of the constituents of speedi, and of careful experiments on the vocal signs of thot and pasionj there has never iK'on tliat dear perception of the characteristic causes of beautv and deformity, which would warant the institution of a standard, either by the method of selection, or by that of the exalting power of creative thot. The highest achievements in statuary, painting, and the landscape, consist of those forms and compositions, never perhaps found singly-existent, or variously combined in nature ; but which in the estimation of Cultivated Taste, and its perfecting agency, may far surpas her individual productions. The folowing analytic history of the human voice will enable an Elocutionist of any nation, to frame a didactic system for his own native and familiar speech. Since it shows that the vocal signs of expresion have a universality, coexistent with the prev- alence of thot and passion ; and that a gramar of elocution, like that of music, must be one and the same for the whole family of man. He will also find the outline of a system of principles and practice, I have ventured to propose, on a survey of those proper- ties of uterance, which seem to me, acomodated to the taste of the cultivated ear ; but which being rarely, if ever acomplished by the human voicej tho still within the reach of natural sciencej must, until so physicaly acomplished, be caled, in analogy with the highest character of the above named arts, the Ideal Beauty of speech. Beleving, that no one age or nation has yet been able to prove its claim to suj^eriority in the Art of speaking, I have pre- sumed to make a universal aplication of the system of the folow- ing Work, on the ground, of the unity of the laws oi' nature, and of the universality of the fixed and describable relations between the states of thot and of pasion, and the vocal sign's^ which re- spectively denote them. This undertaking is directly oposcd to a vidgar error.. The inscrutable character, as it is afirmed, and the suposcd infinity, of the vocal movements, together with the rapid coarse and perpetual variation of uterance, are considered as insuj)erable obstacles to a precise description of tho detail and system of the S|>eaking voice; This objection will be hereafter answered, otherwise than by con- tentious argument. But we may here, otdy ask^ if there is no other oportunity to count the radii of a wheel than in the race; or 60 INTRODUCTIOX. to number and describe the Individuals of a herd, except in the promiscuous mingling of their flight. Music, with its infinitude of details, must still have been a mystery, could the knowledge of its intervals and its time have been caught-up, only from the mul- tiplied combinations and rapid execution of the orchestra. The acuracy of mathematical calculation, joined with the sober patience of the ear over a deliberate practice on its constituentsj has not had more succes in disclosing the system of this beautiful and luminous science, than a similar watchfiilnes over the deliberate movements of speech will aiford, for designating the hitherto un- recorded phenomena of the voice. If there is any purpose in the works of nature, or any ordained eficiency of means to complete the circle of her designs, we shall find, on the development of her vocal system, some uniform and apropriate rulesj within the pale of which the voice should be variously exercised, to give light to the intelect and pleasure to the ear. The acurate sciences, and the fine arts, without our having re- gard to the simplicity of those Primary Causes, in the mind, which the more deeply they are viewed, the more we may perceve only a varied unity in their efectsj have been contrasted by the kinds, rather than as it should be, by the degrees of their claims to truth. The careles argument asumes, that taste is merely a wavering thot, or ' feeling ' among mankind ; and has no rule for the co-perception of grandeur, grace, and beauty-, in the selected, or exalted uses of form, color, and sound. This asumption is one of the delusions of ignorance. But if there is a similar method of perception among persons of equal taste and education, it must be founded on some general principle of the cultivated intelect. The agreement there- fore, arising from the equalizing law of knowledge, gives a char- acter to the principles of taste, analogous at least to that, which by a like constitutional law of the mind, in a general consent on the subject of physical relationshipsj forms the full and unquestiona- ble truth of the acurate sciences. Under this view of the founda- tion of the principles of the fine arts, we must perceve at last the measure of their truth, as that of the truth of the exact sciences, in the agreement of those who cultivate them. He who knows, that all men of education find the same properties in a circle, may learn by a similar perception, that if the mind should ever be INTRODUCTION. 61 clearetl of its human rubbish; particular exeelcncics of the painter, poet, architect, orator, statuary, compaser, hmdscape improver, and actor, will reach the sprin<; of ci^igenial perception, in those who observe and rcHect upon their works, and spread-abroad a varied stream of ever-during aprobation. The claim to acuracy of knowl- edge is the inherent right of every art. It is not consistent with the law of nature, that Truth, upon her simj)le and impartial scat within the mind should have her favorites; let all be equaly thot- free, strict, and studious, and she will reward them all alike. What has been, in the perverse yet often repentant human intel- ect, may l)e; and we learn from the history of the so-ealed saga- cious Greekj who well knew the fixed and useful truths of Ge- ometrvj that those subjects of Natural j)hilosophy, which l)y a 'New Organ' of the mind, are now reduced to the clearnes of ex- perimental knowledge, and taught to the school-boyj were by that very Greek, regarded as too fleeting and disputable, to l)e a mater for observative science, or even to employ the fleeting logic of his endles metaphysical disputations. Though future times may possibly break down the mischevous distinction, which asigns a diferent kind of thot to different depart- ments of inquiry ; and may subject all nature and art, equaly, to the simple and suficient proces of Observation and Clasification ; still it may seem to the present age, that between the perception of beauty in the arts, and of the ratios of mathematical quantity, there is little similarity. But, aside from metaphysical sophistiy, there can be no other ground for an acknowledged certainty, in our per- ceptions of the relationships of magnitude and number, than the undivided and unchanging perceptions and belief, of those who sagaciously inquire into them. They agree upon themj because they all pursue a like conected train of exact observation, or * rea- soning' as this train is usually caledj being therein hapily sepa- rated from the world of wranglers, who taking no part or interest in a mathematical truth they canot overthrow, do not vexatiously disturb their agreement ; again, bet^use they all employ the same precision of terms for these relationshij)s, and are more dispassionate in their investigations, than we are acustomed to be, on the many subjects that involve the distractions of our ])ride, and vanity, and emulation ; because they so closely observe the su(;esions, and 62 INTRODUCTION. SO strictly, by the comanding symbols of analysis, contemplate the bearing of premises embraced in a conclusion; and finally, not be- cause they employ on the exact sciences, a diferent mental method j for the mind, apart from its endles ways in popular and scholastic fiction, has only one methodj but because the ambitious and worldly atractions of other subjects of knowledge, have left the development of these sciences, together with the aplication of the above described Causes of their succes, to the retired and self-con- tented observation and reflection of earnest, exact, and jjersevering inquirers. It is trifling to urge, that the properties of a Conic Section are eternal entities of ' purely Transcendental intelect,' quite independent of our acidental and physical perception of them, and that they would still exist as truths, even if they might never be demonstrated. Ti*uth is a com})arative term, uncaled for by Nature, who has no relative erors within herself, and was only invented for the uses of a disputatious and imperfectly-per- cipient being. Besides, the question before us is of knowledge, not of metaphysical notions. OtherAvise we might, with like proof of an abstract and eternal rule of taste, asert that the proportions of a Greek column exist, unhewn and unseen in the quary ; like that transcendental conceit of old, which declared^ the Venus of Gnidos was not the work of Praxiteles ; Nature herself having concreted within the marble, the boundary' but hiden surface of its beauty; the artist, when the statue came to light, having only produced the fragments of his chisel, and the dust of his file. I speak here against an unlimited asertion of the variablenes of the thotful and efective principles of taste, and not with the presump- tion, at this time, even to feign for them, a comparison with any established principle of the exact sciences. But there are no degrees in truth ; therefore, every mathematical purpose which remains without fulfilment by demonstration, must submit to its clasification with what are called the indefinite precepts of the Esthetic Arts, hapily distinguished from them, in being free from the interference of Ignorance and Conceit. And yet it may be re- marked, in anticipation of what will he shown herejifter, that the Art of Speech, in three of its important modesj namely, Time, with its measurable moraentsj Intonation, with its measurable in- tervalsj and Force, with its measurable dcgreesj if not admissible INTRODUCTION. 63 within tlie pale of exact caleuUition, is yet upon ibi border; and when, by future cultivation, it shall take its destined ])lace among the esthetic arts, it will be found, at least lx?side Architecture and Music, those l^eautiful combinations of taste, with mathematical truth; if indeed, from its principles of intonation being broadly and strictly founded in nature, it may not claim to be before them. Controversies on points involving the leading principles of taste, are generaly, contentions of the ignorant with artists, or with one another; and rarely to any great degree, of the diferences of edu- catelies to those of the downward course, under a reverse movement of the gra(hial slide, and of the interupted sound, on the strinj^. The variations of pitch on most musical instruments are discrete. The violin and its species derive much of their expresive power, from beino; susceptible of the concrete movement; and it is one of the great sources, as will be shown hereafter, of Expresion m the human voice. The several places at which we supose the sounds to be made in the discrete progresion, are numericaly designated in the diagram, and are caled the Places, Points, or Degrees of the scale. Any two degrees are, by relative position, called Proximate, when they are next to each other ; and Remote, when they include more than proximate degrees between them. The distance between any two points in the scale, either proxi- mate or remote, is caled an Interval. A musical interval was by the Greeks, defined to be a ' quantitj^ of a certain kind, terminated by a graver and an acuter sound.' But for particular aplication to speech, it is necesar}' to regard that quantity as either continu- ous sound, or imaginary space; and to consider the efect of the transit of the voice from one degree of the scale to another, as constituting an interv'al, whether the voice is concretely heard, or discretely omited between them. The intervals in their proximate: order, are mea.sured as follows :* The interval, or the quantity of concrete voice, either heard, or omited, between the first and the second places,, numbered in the diagram, is called a Tone.'f atoly with each other: whereas Number is the discrete quantity ; the distinct., sucesion of its constituent units being altogether diferent from the above described continuity. The most familiar ilustration of these terms, aplied to the two kinds of quantity in musical sound, is furnished by the form of a lader, the side rails representing the concrete, and thfl rrvunds the discrete. * The well-informed Reader shjould. regard this general view of the scale, and the manor of its ilustration, %vitb a th(!>lfulnes of my design. I omit the theoretic distinction of greater and leser tone, of diatonic and chromatic semi- tone, and of the nuijor and minor scale, together with other particulars,, both melodinl and harmoniC;} with an intention to notice only what is- preparatory to the description of speech. f The Header must bear in mind, that the word tune in tliis ELjay, desig- 76 DIVISIONS AND EXPLANATIONS. That between the second and third is likewise a tone. That between the third and fourth, which apears in the diagram as lialf the space of a tone, is called a Semitone. The interval between the fourth and fifth, fifth and sixth, sixth and seventh, is each a tone ; and lastly, that between the seventh, and the eighth or first of the next series, a semitone. The intervals between the degrees of the scale, either proximate or remote, are designated numericaly ; the extreme degrees being in- clusively counted. From the second to the third, or from the sixth to the seventh, is the interval of a second or tone ; from the second to the sixth, or from the fourth to the eighth, is the interval of a fifth. And so of the rest; the numerical name of any interval being the same, when taken in an upward, or in a downward direction. The several discrete sounds of the scale are here named acording to their ordinal number ; yet the first, relatively to its rising series, is generaly called the Key-note. Consequently, in two or more series of scales, the eighth sound, or Octave as it is called, of the preceding is always the key-note of the suceding scale ; as in the vertical diagram, the sound at the eighth place is the octave of the first series, and the key-note of the second. The sucesion of the seven sounds of any one series, to which the octave is usualy aded, is called the Natural or Diatonic Scale. It consists of five tones and two semitones ; the latter being the in- tervals between its third and fourth, and its seventh and eighth degrees. The scale then contains these several kinds of intervals j a semitone ; a second, or whole tone ; a third ; fourth ; fifth ; sixth ; seventh ; and octave. nates only a certain interval of pitch; tho comon language aplics it alike to pitch, vocality, force and time; as in the phrases 'high and low tones of the voice,' ' musical, rustic and silver tones;' ' an emphatic or loud tone ;' and a 'deliberate, quick and drav/ling tone.' Even music, with all its scientific 'precision, is not free from slight confusion on this point. For while it em- ploys the word tone, for that interval to which we restrict its use, it also desig- nates vocality, in the terms, ' tone of the flute,' and of other instruments, and the ' pure tone' of the vocalist. The French word timbre, corcsponding to • our vocality, and sometimes aplied to the voice, would, in comon English ipronunciation, soon get into downright ship timber. Let us not be ' frightened at the sound ourselves have made,' but call this mode of the voice, by the plain English term vocality ; tho timid rccolccting, it comes from a word used by Cicero and Quinctillian. DIVISIONS AND EXPLANATIONS. 77 By the diagi-ani, the interval between the second and fourth degrees is numeriealy a third, yet contains but one tone and a semitone ; whereas, from the conservation of the scale, that be- tween the first and third degrees, still numeriealy the interval of a tiiird, contains two whole tones. From this difcrence in con- stituency, and extent, the former is caled a Elinor Third, and the later a Major Third. But the minor third never being used in corect S})eech, the term Third will in this Work, except where the minor is specified, always refer to the major interval. Plaving described the construction of the Musical Scale, I here advise the Reader, who may not be a musician, and who may be ignorant of the efect of the sounds of that scalej to ask, from some qualified master, an audible example of its upward and downward progresion, and of its several intervals. This the teacher will give, under that practical exercise on the scale, caled in the lan- guage of vocal science, Solfaing. Let the Reader studiously imi- tate this exemplification, and comit it to memory. If destitute of what is caled a musical ear, let him not think himself unable to discriminate those intervals, which he has now learned to be a part of music. In comunities where the cultivation of this art is gen- eral, these things are all learned, by thousands who, Avith their natural ear, would never have caut the simplest phrase of a popular song. And surely there is no one, into whose hands this book will ever fall, who can posibly avoid perceving the several diferences of meaning, or expresion, in the speaking voicej when he is adressed in the language of narative, surprise, complaint, authority, or interogation. Now these various expresive efects are perceptible to him, and acurately so, only as concrete or discrete movements of the voice thru certain apropriate intervals of the scale. His ear therefore does realy recognize these movementsj these intervals of the speaking scale. I only give to his mental perception and his tongue, their musical method and names. When an instructor canot be met with, the use of a well-tuned Piano-Forte may asist those who have no acquaintance with the scale. On the key-board of this instrument there is a front row of white keys, as they are called, and a rear row of black ones. A representation of their forms ^md pasitions, is given in the fol- owing diagram ; where a portion of the Greai Scale; or its its 78 DIVISIONS AND EXPLANATIONS. whole extent is caled, the Compas of the instniraentj is shown ; the white keys being numbered above, in continuation as far as twenty-one ; and below, in a repeated series of seven. 1 2 r! 4 5 fi 7 K 9 10 11*1-2 V^ 14 l.". Ifi 17 IS 19 20 21 llllllllllllllll II 12 3 4 5 6 7.1 2 3 4 5 6 7.1 2 3 4 5 6 7 Any one of the series of seven white keys, of which there are three in the diagram^ Avhen struck sucesively ascending from left to right, gives the seven discrete rising sounds of the diatonic scale. The black keys are set between the white ones, to divide the whole tones into semitones. Hence, the black keys are wanting at the semitonic intervals of the scale, where their purpose canot apply. This omision visibly separates the black keys alternately into pairs and triplets. With the foregoing explanation, the Reader can have no dificulty in finding a diatonic series on the white keys of a Piano-Forte ; the key-note or begining of the series always being next below the pair of black keys. Let him then, on that series which suits the pitch of his speaking voice, uter one of the vowels or any of its sylabic * combinations, in unison with the instrumental sounds, both in their proximate sucesion of a tone, and in the wider transitions between remote degrees of the scale j till the whole is familiar to his ear, and at the call of memory. It is true, the Piano-Forte can show him only the discrete movements of pitch. When these are coni- zable, and under comand, the concrete may readily be measural by them. The level, or protracted sound at any of the places of the dis- crete scale, is called a Note. This term notey is to be carefuly dis- tinguished from that of Tone, which as before stated, signifies not a level line of sound, but a rising or faling interval of yiitch ; and in this csay, is aplied, either to the concrete transit of the voice between any two adjoining degrees, except those bounding a semi- DIVISIONS AND EXPLANATIONS. 79 tone, or to the amount of space between such degrees, when the transit is discrete. As the term tone is used for the interval of a second, under tlie two conditions of concrete and discrete j)itch, so are the terms of other intervals included between remote degrees ; for the voice may move concretely thru these intervals, or notes may be made at their bounding degrees, with the omision of the concrete. Let us call the former of tliese conditions. Concrete Intervals, and the latter, Disei'de Intervals: one being, figuratively, a rising or faling stream of voice, the other a voiceles space. The Jirst, third, and fifth notes- of the diatonic scale, to which the octave, as a concording repetition of the first is usualy aded, difer from the other notes in being more agreeable to the ear when heard in combination, and in imediate sucesion. The degrees in this order, are also more readily 'hit' by an inexperienced voice, in an endeavor to execute the several discrete intervals of the scale : and that simple instrument the Jews-harp, and some species of the Horn more readily yield these sucesive notes, under the faltering atempts of a learner. When therefore the pupil takes his leson on the scale, let him familiarize his ear to the sucesion of its first, third, fifth and octave notes ; omiting the intermediate degrees. Frequent reference will be made hereafter, to his perceptions on this point. I give a representation of the maner in which musicians set their symbols for the diatonic sounds, on that linear Table caled the Staff. The staff consists of five horizontal and paralel lines, having four spaces between them. Each space and line represents a degree of the scale ; so that from one space or line to the next line or space, is a second ; and these degrees are caled conjoint or proximate. When the discrete movement is over a wider interval than a second, it is caled a SJcip ; and the degrees are said to be Remote. The sucesion of the scale is here marked by disks, rising 80 DIVISIONS AND EXPLANATIONS. from the lowest line to the highest space of the staff; the intervals of the semitones being designated by a brace. I have thus described the continuous or Concrete movement of sound ; and its discrete or interupted progresion on the diatonic scale. As there are but two semitones in the scale, it is necesary, for the accomodation of instruments with fixed keys, to subdivide the whole tones. The manner of the subdivision is here described.* In any series of seven notes, as the first marked in the pre- ceding vertical diagram of the scale, and in that of the white keys of the key-board, let us asume for this subdivision of whole tones, the Fifth, as the first or key-note of a new order. This with its octave, will extend to the place numbered twelve. Six of its places in their rising order of notes, from five to ten, will have right positions ; and so far, the intervals of tone and semi- tone will exhibit the proper sucesions of the diatonic scale. But the interval between the tenth and eleventh is a semitone, and that between the eleventh and twelfth a tone ; whereas, by the rule for constructing the scale, the order should be revei'sed. For the tenth, eleventh, and twelfth notes marked in the diagrams, are respectively the sixth, seventh, and eighth of the new order, asumed from the fifth. When therefore the tone, or interval from eleven to twelve, is subdivided into two semitones, as shown by a cross in the vertical diagram, and by a black key below the star in that of the key-boardj and the transit is then made from the tenth place, to this point of division^ two semitones, making one whole tone, are pased over ; the interval from this point of division to the twelfth is a semitone, and the constituent intervals of the diatonic scale in this new order, are obtained. To continue a subdivision of the whole tones of the scale, by * The Reader having learned above, the form, and places of the semitone, it is not esential that he should strictly atend to the detailed explanation, in the two folowing paragraphs ; for most of it is not aplicablo to speech. I say this, only in reference to his finding it dificult. In leting him know, there is a sucesion of degrees, called the Semitonic Scale, I describe the maner of its construction ; for with a knowledge of this, his views of the relations between Music and Speech will be more extended and precise. Let him then learn it, if not too troublesomoj being mindful to read the last two sentences of the second paragraph. DIVISIONS AND EXPLANATIONS. 81 risiuf/ a fifth on the previous order, wocl soon carr}' us beyond tlie limit of our diagrams. We must observe, that the fifth above a key-note, liolds the same relative position in a scale, as the fourth below it. If then, for the key-note of a third order, we take the fifth above the key-note of the second order, or the fourth below it, they will be respectively the ninth and the second of the diagrams ; and these are considered the same, because they each have the like position of second in the two orders, of the key-board. A subdivision of the whole tone, between the fifteenth and sixteenth, on the key-board, if the fifth above is taken, or between the eighth and ninth if the fourth belowj will, with the subdivision in the preceding order, give the constituent diatonic intervals of this third order. And progresively, by taking the fifth above the key-note of the previous order, or the fourth below itj and using the previous subdivisions, every place of the scale may become the first of an order ; and every whole tone may thereby be divided, as shown by the black keys in the diagram of the key-board. This division produces a series of semitones. When therefore the progresion is made by them, the order of degrees is called the Semitonic, or more comonly the Chromatic Scale. It is necesary for the future history of speech, that the sucesion of discrete sounds should be exhibited under still more reduced divisions. These consist in a discrete transition over the scale, by intervals much smaler than a semitone; each point being as it were, rapidly touched by a momentary and abrupt emision of voice. This description may be ilustrated by the maner of that noise in the throat caled gurgling, and by the neighing of a horee. The analogy here regards princii)ally the momentary duration, frequency, and abruptnes of sound ; for the gurgling is generaly made by a quick iteration on one unvarj'ing or level line of pitch. In the scale now under consideration, each sucesive pulse of sound is taken at a Minute Discrete-interval above the last, till the series reaches the octave. We canot tell the precise extent of this minute interval, nor the number of pulses in given portions of the scale ; since this function is executed in a maner, and with a ra})idity that eludes discrimination. Nor is this point material now. My pur- pose requires it to be known, that the voice may rise and fall, with short and abrupt iterations, thru the several intervals of pitch, by 82 DIVISIONS AND EXPLANATIONS. discrete steps, less than a semitone. Whether the discrete space is that fractional part of a tone caled a comma, or some division or multiple of it, we leave to be determined by other means than that of the ear alone. Let us then call this species of movement, the Tremulous Scale. We have described four kinds of progresion in pitch ; and in speaking of the concrete, its slide was not caled a scale, since its unbroken line has no analogy with the interupted steps of a discrete sucesion ; yet with a full comprehension of its construc- tion, there can be no objection to its being so called. The human voice has then Four scales of pitch. The Concrete; in which, from the outset to the termination of the voice, either in rismg or faling, there is no apreciable interval, or interuption of continuity. The Diatonic; wherein the discrete transitions are principaly by whole tones. The Chromatic ; consisting of a discrete sucesion of semitones : and. The Tremulous ; which with its momentary impulses, separated from each other by very minute intervalsj has never, as far as I am aware, been employed on musical instruments, in an upward and a downward progresion ; the tremolo being a tremor on a straight line of pitch ; and the Trill or Shake being as will be shown hereafter, a totaly distinct function. The extent of the speaking voice on any of these four scales, within the limits of distinct articulation, is caled the Compas of Speech.* * There is a musical scale, described by the Greeks, but used only at an early period, caled the Enharmonic ; which however, has no relation to the natural system of speech ; yet from the term ' Enharmonic voice,' employed without explanation by Dionysius Thrax, a Greek grammarian, who lived shortly before the Christian craj it seems to have been infored, that the spoken intonation of the Ancients was somehow formed on this scale : and tho Mr. Steele suffered his observation to be so far overruled* by the vague autliority of this inference, as to give the diagram of his j)roposed scale with what he calls an enharmonic di vision j perhaps a short acount of tliis division, may convince * I have made this word an cxcoptlon to the exclusion of donblo consonants, for tlie division is here sylubic and properly pronounced over-ruled, not over-uled : and it is tho same witli words of like construction. DIVISIONS AND EXPLANATIONS. 83 For the purpose of exjjlanation, the scales have been represented separately ; yet in the practice of the voice they are variously the Render, as we procede, that it could not have been employed in the proper intonation of what we shall consider Natural speech. The Greek musical scale consisted of only three intervals, embraced between four degrees, as marked by the strings of their instruments, and was therefore cajed the Tetrachord. The moderns have made their scale an Octachord, or Octave, by joining two sucesive Greek scales, with a tone between them: for in our octave, from C to F, and again from G to C, each of the two sets of four degrees, has the like order of their constituent tones and semitones ; show- ing that the tetrachord scale is just half of ours. Our music employs but one proper scale, the diatonic ; for the chromatic is not an independent one, on which a melody can be made with its semitones alone; but is formed, for ocasional use, by dividing the whole tonesj that the semitones may be em- ployed in other places, than the two which are proper to them, in the natural diatonic sucesion. Neither in music nor in song, do we technicaly recognize the Concrete and the Tremulous Scales : and it was the same with the Greeks. The Greek writers describe six diferent scales ; three chromatic ; two dia- tonic ; and one enharmonic, formed respectively, by certain subdivisions of the scale into intervals of different extent. For ilustration however, we will describe only, what they caled the Intense diatonic, and the Enharmonic. Supose the Tetrachord to be divided into sixty parts ; and let C, D, E and F be the places, or degrees, including its three intervals ; 24 to represent the tone ; 12 the semitone ; and 6 the quarter-tone, caled diesis, or the enharmonic interval. The Intense-diatonic Tetrachord, which is, when doubled, and united by a tone, the same we now emplqyj was aranged as folows : Tone. D Tone. E Semitone. 24 24 12 The Enharmonic tetrachord : C Ditone. D Diesis. E Diesis. F 48 6 6 Now as 48, the double of 24, make two tones ; and six, the fourth or quarter of 24, the diesis ; the enharmonic arangement is that of a ditone or major third and two sucesive quarter-tones. The Greeks themselves state, that the musical use of this scale was very dificult ; and in later times was altogether laid aside: neither of which, as cause or consequence, could have ocured if there had been a natural character in it; for certainly, a continued tune on a sucesion of its intervals would, to a modern and natural ear, until fashion should recomend it, be altogether inefective, or very abominable. Consistently with this view, we shall learn hereafter, that speech makes no specificaly distinct nor apreciable use of the quarter-tone: showing how the history of the human voice has in tliis as in so many other ways, been falsified and confused. The other four scales seem to have had no more of a natural condition, than 84 DIVISIONS AND EXPLANATIONS. united ; speech making use of them all. The concrete is always found ; and we shall hereafter learn in what maner the diatonic, chromatic, and tremulous scales are conected with it. The term Melody is, in music, aplied to a regulated vocal or to an instrumental use of the diatonic and chromatic scales. The full meaning of the term embraces the further relations of time, rj'th- mus, and pause. I here speak of pitch alone. That efect in music called melody, is produced by the use of the seven notes of the scale, in any agreeable order of their possible permutations, either in a Proximate or Skiping progresion. We shall learn hereafter, that the Melody of Speech is founded on a like principle of varied intervals ; yet with peculiarities, arising from a systematic use of its concrete, discrete, and tremulous movements, and from its not being afected by the use of what in music is called. Key. The term Key is aplied to each of the several orders of the diatonic scale, on musical instruments. And as it apears by the diagram of the key-board, that the Semitonic divisions of the whole tones of the scale make twelve placesj from each" of which a diatonic sucesion may be arangedj so the scale of the piano-forte the Enharmonic; and this leads to the conclusion, that like ourselves, the Greeks used the diatonic as the only scale for agreeable melody, and for any harmony they may have known and practiced. But why should all the Greek writers have named their other scales, if they never used them? This we cannot answer: tho we might class the question with the whole design of their metaphysics, which was to dream, write, and wrangle about things, never to be used or even comprehended. But laying aside, for a moment, our prescribed rules for observing, reflecting, and writing, we will ofer a pasing conjecture and no more, upon it. Since the ear for music, like the eye for Euclid's circle and square, and tl>o tongue for wormwood and honey, is the same now, that it was among the Greeksj we can acount for their being satisfied with their unnatural scales, by suposingj First ; that a few particular phrases of ritual chants, or of choral responses^ formed out of the peculiar sucesion of the notes of these scales, on some early and imperfect instrument^ were so closely conected with the Temple Service, the Sacrifice, or the Procesion, or with a Popular Obstinacy in some rude vocal habit, as to reconcile the ear to any odity and disonance. Or, second ; by suposing, the unnatural melodies or sucesions on these scales, to be traditions of the canting shouts of barbarian Festivals, originally excited by some wild religious working on the voicej after its maner of working on the eye, in making to itself, without a revolting of truth or taste, tho graven image of its Gods, in every outrageous contortion of the human form. But these conjectures are apart from the design of this Work. DIVISIONS AND EXPLANATIONS. 85 admits of twelve clifercnt keys ; and these being sulxlividod into Flat and Sharp Keys, make twenty-four in all ; but these have no regard to sj^eech. The first note of the sucesion is caled a-s we said formerly, the key-note. The relationship of this to the other notes of the scale is such, that a melody will apear unfinished, if its last sound be not the key-note of the scale, or the octave to itj which is its nearest concord. It is a condition in music, that a melody formed of the varied permutations of the notes of any one key, shall not employ the constituent notes of another. In the vertical diagram, there is the first order, with its key-note at number one ; and a second with its key-note at five. To form this second order we divided the tone between the eleventh and twelfth pointsj to obtain the second semitone of the diatonic scale; and it apears that all the notes are comon to the tioo orders, except the seventh of the second, marked eleven in the diagram. A melody or tune begun on the first order, canot employ that eleventh, and be agreable to the ear, except with a design to leave the first order, and afterwards to carry on the tune altogether by the order of the second. This transition from one order to another is called Modulation, or Changing the key. It is employed in vocal and instrumental music, but is not apli- cable to speech. The term Intonation signifies the act of performing the move- ments of pitch on any interval of the several scales, whether in speech, in song, or in instrumental use. It therefore regards, only the changes of sound between acutenes and gravity. Intonation is said to be corect or true, when the discrete steps, or concrete slides over the intended interval are made with exactnes. True intonation in speech means further^ the just use of its intervals, for denoting the states of mind in thot and pasion. Deviation from this precision is called, singing, or playing, and it may be hereafter. Speaking out of tune.* * Instead of the term Intonation, which embraces in music, the doctrine of intervals, and their exact execution j the words Inflection and Modulation have been used by writers, to exprcs only a general and obscure perception of some variation of pitch, in the speaking voice. So entirely have thoy seemed to overlook the analogy between the scale of music, and of speech, that the Eng- lish term Intonation, which has been used in the former art, at least a cen- tury, to denote the precise recognition of intervalsj is not, with this meaning 86 DIVISIONS AND EXPLANATIONS. The term Chdence in music, means, a consumation of the desire for a full close in the melody, by the resting of its last sound in the key-note. It will be shown hereafter, that the cadence or close of speech is efected in a diferent maner. I have here tried to prepare the Reader for all that relates to the science and nomenclature of music, in the folowing description of speech. When a full knowledge of the modes, forms, and uses of the voice will have become familiar, by general instruction and practice, the Art of Speaking will seem to ofer less dificulty, by having an admited system and nomenclature of its own. Now, we are obliged to study another art, to make an Art of it. In whatever way a pupil may learn or be taught to recognize and to execute the intervals of the scale, let me here again call his atention to the necesity of making himself familiar with a per- ception of the concrete and discrete movementj when formed not only on simple vowel sounds, but on sylables, the comon ground of intonation in speech. Let the pupil then, on any sylable capa- ble of prolongation, rise concretely, from the first degree of the scale, to the octave ; and from this, imediately return concretely to the first degree, while the efect of the extent of the rising octave remains upon the ear. In like maner, let him ascend and de- scend thru the concrete fifth, third, second, and semitone. For acquiring familiarity with the discrete intervals of speech, the intonation should be performed by means of two sylables. Taking the word gaily, let the pupil begin at the first degree of the scale, with gai, and by a skip, strike the octave with ly: then, in imediate return, while memory of the interval serves him, take gai at the octave, and descend to the first, on ly. In a similar maner, let the voice be exercised on the discrete fifth, third, second, and semitone. Facility in executing the concrete semitonic movement of speech, to be found, as fai* as I can learn, in any of the numberless books on elocu- tion, published within this period. Mr. Sheridan incidentaly employs this term ; but with no reference to intervals and their expresion, and only in the indefinite meaning of the phrasoj ' tones of the voice.' Baily restriots intona- tion soley to music. Dr. Johnson limits it to the 'act of thundering.' In ajilicution to speech, it is at hi%i Jinding itstvay into Dictionaries. I need not say, how often, the description of speech, foundi^d on the identity of its inter- vals with those of music, will hereafter require the use of this term. DIVISIONS AND EXPLANATIONS. 87 Ls to be atained hy plaintively repeating the interjection ah, both ascending and descending, between the seventh and eighth degrees of the diatonic scale. Tiie pupil will acquire a ready coniand over the tremulous into- nation, by practicing the characterLstic tremor of this scale, on the semitone with a plaintive expression, and with laughter, or exulta- tion, on the other intervals. By frequent practice of these several intonations on single syl- ables, the voice will be prepared for the precise use of intervals, in the sylabic sucesions of speech. The preceding explanations have been extended rather beyond what is absolutely neccsary, for comprehending the proper science of Analytic Elocution, now to be first set-forth. The function of Key and of Modulation in music, has been described with some care, altho speech is not constructed upon the principles of either. It may not however, be uninteresting to some inquirers, to know wherein the diferenccs of the cases consist. The term Elocution is aplied thruout this Work to signify the vocal Representation of thot and pasion ; and properly includes ever}'^ form of corect Reading, and of Public, and Colo(|uial Speech. And yet we shall, by license, often aply the terms Reading and Speaking, each as that of Elocution, to designate the whole of the Art. The Avords Recitation, Delivery, and Declamation, as well as those designating public Places, and Pro- fesions, are not here technicaly, if at all, employed in reference to vocal character. Styles of elocution may difer, within the rule for justly denoting pasion and th5t ; and this rule should direct alike the style of the Advocate, the Witnes, and the Judge ; of the Pulpit, the Stage and the Senate ; of the Stump-orator ; and of the varial voices of conversation. Had there been a more abun- dant and precise knowledge, of hoiv language shud be sj)oken, there wud have l)een much less said of the Person and the Place. If I should employ the term Reading-aloud, it Mill not be in contradistinction to ocular perusal. To read, as a term of Elocu- tion, always means to read-aloud. I may however use the term Silent Reading, to signify, not ocular pcrusalj but the future mental reading of a notation on the staff of speech ; in like man- ner as the notes of music are silently read on the staff of song. 88 THE RADICAL AND by the vocalist, and composer ; for I shall hereafter show, that a knowledge of the constituents and principles of scientific speech, is as atainablej and an aplication of them, as practicable and easyj as in the case of scientific music. I adopt from the old Elocu- tionist, the term ' Reading- well,' and preserve it, as a memorial of the style even of his school, having generaly been so bad, that it became necesary to distinguish an ocasional individual from the herd, by his acomplishment in Reading- well. I feel how perplexing it is, I was about to say, it is imposible by description alone, to render the separate parts of a science, so well divided in method yet so closely related in detail, as that of music, clearly inteligible. If what has been said, will enable the Reader to perceve the system and particulars of the Four Scales, and to execute them, he will not have much difficulty in pursuing our further history of a new and beautiful Physical Science of the Human Voice. SECTION II. Of the Radical and Vanishing movement of the voice; and its dif event forms in Speech, Song, and Recitative. We have been wiling to beleve, on faith alone, that Nature is wise in the ordination of speech. Let us now show by our works of analysis, in what maner, and with what a perfection of economy, that canot surpas itself, she manages the simple constituents of the voice, in the production of their unbounded combinations.* * As I profes, in this Work, to draw the history of the human voice, alto- gether from observation by the ear, and experiment with the tongue, it will be convenient, and even necesaryj from the constant reference to the combined agencies that make up the system of speech j to have some brief term to desig- nate what we supose to be the directive principle, or general agent over these subordinate and perceptible agencies. I have therefore in the text, adopted an abstract sign for ail these agencies, and their cfectsj in the word Nature ; a word often taken in eror, and in vain, but not yet obsolete. This Term, this Naturej I use every where, and always with the same meaning wlien person- ified, as the representative of an al-.suflcient, and ever-present sj-stcm of causes ; whicli in the broad wisdom of its ordination, and universal cont.i3tency of its VANISHING MOVEMENT. 89 When tlie Ictcr a, as heard in the ^vor(l flay, is pronounced simply as an alphabetic element, without intensity or emotion, and as if it were a continuation, not a close of uterance, two dip- thonji^al sounds are heard continuously sucesive. The first has the nominal sound of this leter, and isues with a certain degree of ful- nes. The last is the element e, as heard in eve, gradualy diminish- ing to an atenuated close. During the pronunciation, the voice rises continuously by the concrete movement of a tone or second ; the begining of a, and the termination of e, being severaly the inferior and superior extremes of that tone. The character of this concrete rise is visibly represented in the first of the following diagrams. A curvature of lines seeming to aford a more graceful analogy to the ])eculiar efect of the vocal concrete, it Avill thru this Work apear as in the second. If the above description of the concrete shud not, from its deli- cate structure, and momentary duration, be at once recognized, I here give a further explanation of it. That the sound denoted by the letter a, utered concretely, has the dipthongal character, will be obvious on deliberately drawing out the single element, as a question of great surprise. For in this case, its comencement is what I have caled the nominal aj and its termination in e, at a high pitch, is no less distinguishable. By the same use of earnest intcrogation, the fulnes, or greater volume of sound upon a, and the diminishing close in e, will l)C obvious to an atentive ear. Nor is it improbablcj the feeblenes of this last constituent of a, in ordinary pronunciation, is at least one cause, why the dipthongal structure of this element has never, far as I know, been perceved, or described. efectfi, is the bright and unchanging example of truth, and right, and good- nes, and beauty; and worthy of unceasing study and imitationj for begining, without dehisive hopes, the intelcctual, tlic political, the moral, and esthetic refinement of man. 90 THE RADICAL AND That a, utered simply as the head of the alphabet, without re- markable expresion, and as a continuation, not a close of speechj does ascend by the concrete interval of a tone, will be manifest to the Reader, in his ability to intonate the diatonic scale. For let him ascend disci-etely, on the alternate use of a and e, prolong- ing each as a note, and making a slight pause between them. This will render him familiar with the relationship of the two elements, when heard on the extremes of a tone : as ilusti'ated in the follow- ing diagram ; where from line to line is one degree, or a tone of E- the scale ; where the oval figures with their attenuated rising ter- minations, represent respectively the level or protracted note, with its final, faint, and rapid concrete isue in e ; and where the diferent sizes of the subscribed leters may show the proportional duration and volume of voice, in the diferent parts of each impulse of pronunciation. Then let him ascend the scale, by a kind of union of the con- crete and discrete progresions, or begining with a, slightly pro- longed, and proceding to e, in the second place, without breaking the continuity of sound ; and thence after slightly prolonging e, pasing concretely to a, in the third place, as ilustrated in the fol- lowing diagram ; where full notes are conected by slender concretes. This practice will make him familiar with the efect of a concrete rise thru a tone, when the uper extreme is remarkable, by the stres and prolongation it receves at the second place of the scale. A E- VANISHING MOVEMENT. 91 Suposing the concrete interval of a tone to be distingulsliable, when utered with a full voliime of sound on the two extremes a and e, or M'itli what may be caled a double stres or stres on the two extremes of the concrete^ it may be proved in the folowing maner, that the simple uterancc of a in day, pases . thru the same interval. Let the a and e be repeatedly pronounced with this double stres, united by the weaker concrete, till the efect of tlie interval Ls for the moment impresed upon the ear. Then let the stres on e be gradualy diminished in the repetition ; as ilustrated by the scries of symbols in the folowing diagram. The audible A E A — e A — e A-e A-e A.e A^ efect of the last of the series, even with a total cesation of the uper stres, will in intonation, so resemble, yet faintly, the double stres on the first, that the cases will be admited as identical. The tone being then plainly conizable as the first interval of the scale, when both extremes receve the stresj so in returning to the simple pro- nunciation of a, by gradualy diminishing the stres at its uper ex- tremity, the perception of this interval will be kept up during the progress of the change. In the above experiment we have, to suit the order of our history, begun with the limited interval of a tone ; but for proof of the concrete function, it will be more obvious when made on the expresive interval of the fifth or octave. If there shud be a doubt, as to the extent of the concrete inter- val, let stres be aplied at its sumit. When the interval is a tone, the two stresed sounds will form the first two notes of the diatonic scale ; for with a little experience, the course of this scale can always be recognized, in the execution of its first and second djegrees. The simple dipthongal sound of a, Mithout the sumit-stres, djoes. then, as we have ilustrated it, pass thru the concrete interval of a tone or second ; the movement being divided between the sounds of a and c, the first gliding into the ktst. But as the distinction here refers to the extent of the interval traversed, to its upward 92 . THE RADICAL AND direction, and to its concrete progresj it is necesary to uter the literal element, without the least expresion ; for if it be with plaintivenes, surprise, or interogation j or as a positive comand, the concrete will be some other interval than the tone ; this tone or second, being the maner of utering simple thot, exclusively of the excitement pasion. The peculiar structure of the concrete movement led to the di- vision of it by terms, into two parts ; and the use of these terms, for explanatory purposes in the folowing history, will show their propriety. I have caled the first part of the concrete, or that of a, in the above instance, the Radical movement ; since, with a full begining or opening, the subsequent and diminishing portion of the concrete procedes from it as from a base or root. I have called the last part, or that of e, in the example, the Vanishing movement, from its becoming gradualy weaker as it rises, and finaly dying away in the uper extreme of the tone. It must strike the Reader, that the above terms can have only a general reference to the two extremes of the concretej for the gradual change of the radical into the vanish prevents our asign- ing an exact point of distinction between them. When a single vowel sound, capable of prolongation, is utered with propriety and smoothnes, and without vocal expresion, it comences full and somewhat abruptly, and gradualy decreases in its upward movement, until it becomes inaudible ; having the in- crements of time and rise, and the decrements of fulnes, equably progresive. Or, suposing a gradual diminution of fulnes, in the gradual rise thru a tone to be efccted in a given timej one half or smaler fraction of that rise and diminution will be efected in one half or smaler fraction of that time. Let us call this form of the radical and vanishing movement, the Equable Concrete. The varied forms of the vocal function in Song and Recitative, may ilustrate the character of this equability in the intonation of speech. The long-dra^vn voice of one continued pitch, licard in song and recitative, is produced in two ways. First; by giving a greater proportion of time and volume to one continuous and level line of sound, in the radical place ; and VANISHING MOVEMENT. 93 by subsequently rising concretely, lightly, and rapidly, tliru the superior portion of the interval. Let us call this, the Protracted Radical. Second ; by rising concretely, lightly, and rapidly thru the in- ferior portion of the interval, and then prolonging the voice with greater volume, on a level line at the highest point of the vanish. Let us call this, the Protracted Vanish. Thus far, intonation exhibits three modifications of the radical and vanishing movement : The Equable Concrete of speech ; the Protracted Radical, and the Protracted Vanish, both of which are used in song and recitative. AYe shall learn, as we procede, the various relationships of the concrete to all the simple and compounded intervals, to the alphabetic elements, to time, and to force. I have spoken of the radical and vanishing movement through a tone, to explain by that interval, the formation of the concrete rise, and its threefold division. In taking a wider survey of the subject, we learuj the radical and vanish is made on every other interval. Ascending concretely, from the seventh to the eighth degree of the scale, by a and e, in the maner of the diagram on the ninety-first page ; that is, by laying a stres on the two extremes of this intervalj the voice has a plaintive character, very diferent from that of the tone, or interval between the first and second. The interval from the seventh to the eighth place of the diatonic scale, is a semitone. This plaintive concrete therefore, when aten- uated, and made equable by gradualy diminishing the stres at its uper extreme, shown in the sucesive symbols of that diagramj is the radical and vanishing or equable concrete movement of a nemitone. Again, in ascending concretely upon a and e, from the first to the third place of the scale, with a stres on e, in that third place, the efect of this continuous movement difers from that of the tone, and the semitone ; for it resembles a moening fulnes, direction, and diminution of the radical and vanishing movement. The distances between the radicals of the concrete seconds, thirds, fifths, and octaves, severaly represent the discrete intervals. Time is represented as in music : the open elipse signifying the longest ; the small head and stem, with its two hooks to denote the duration of the vanish, being in this case, the sixteenth part of the open elipse. Except for the protracted radical, and vanish, the notation of Time will not be here employed. A use of the measurable relations of Time, \vith the proportional value of its symbols, is indispensable to the me- lodial rythmus, and to the concerted harmonies of music. Speech being a solo of intonation, and requiring no conformity in time with other voices J the use of Quantity on sucesive sylables, is left to the thot or pasion which directs the apropriate utterance. These diagrams represent three of the five modes of the voiccj Pitch, Abruptnes, and Time. Vocality has never, to my knowl- edge, had a symbol cither in music or speech : yet there is no cause why it mit not and shud not, when remarkable in its difer- ences, be so represented. Force is vaguely indicated by the usual gramatical marks for acent and emphasis, and by italic type. Should this analysis and system be ever generaly adopted ; and the purposes of speech require itj apropriate symbols for Vo- cality, Force, and Time, may without much dificulty be conectcd with the forms of the equable concrete, and the wave. 98 THE EADICAL AND I have not given symbols for the concrete and discrete minor third, and semitone, since their representation on the staff may be easily made. o 03 Eh O ^ 2 t- !> t^ I — ^ 1 1 — ^ 1 ^ S C3 > O .5 > o •■- «< ►* CC (^ H ^ J - ;s U .t: S S ^ s ft ^ P .s ■B^ggg -^W^j-^^^. Forms of acentual fulnes or stres on the Concrete. 4 T In the above notation, there is no meaning in the curve of the vanish, except on tlic wavesj nor in the circular enlargement of VANISHING MOVEMENT. 99 tlie radical. In this, as formerly remarked, the eye oidy was consulted ; yet I cannot say, the engraver has, in all cases, done justice to the drawing furnished.* I have here described, under its various forms, an imj)ortant and delicate function of speech. There is a peculiarity in the human voice which has never been copied by instrumental con- trivances. The sounds of the horn, flute, and musical-glass, may severaly equal and even surpas in vocality a long-drawn and level vocal note: still there is something wanting, that distinguishes their intonation from that of speech. It is the want of the equa- ble gliding, the lesening volume, and the soft extinction of the yet inimitable radical and vanishing movement. And further ; the simple uterance of the radical and vanish seems to be an instinctiv^e and uncontrolable function of the voice : for to my observation, even the very shortest vocal impulse on a voAvel or sylable, is not, so to speak, a mere point of sound with- out dimensions, but is necesarily made upward or downward by some, however rapid movement. This remark is true of the voices of many sub-animals. Does it aply to all ? and even to comon mechanical noises? In the course of this esay, I shall endeavor to obviate the efect of that repetition of its nomenclature, which the purpose of ex- planation and the newnes of the subject mit rcquircj by the use of various abreviated but equivalent terms. The Concrete func- tion will, according to the general or specific purpose in its use, * On first observing the peculiar character of the radical and vanish ; when my atcntion was sometimes misled by hasty conclusions, and wliile doubtfuly experimenting on the form of melodyj I drew, partly after the putern of a musical note, the symbol of the concrete as it still remains. And see, how that deceitful thing the mind with its resemblances, as we are prone to use them, should be watched. Upon the first draft of the ilustrations, the grace- ful lines of a Greek scrol seemed analogous to the delicate impresion of the vocal vanish ; and the form then given to the symbol subsequently so influ- enced my perception, that perhaps I am not yet quite free from tiio tliOt that induced it. Altho aware from the first, that the figurative rejjroscntation of the radical and vanish should be by the outline of a spire, still the wcdge-liko symbol, espccialy if set obliquely on the staft", apeared too awkward a i)icture of this mastery no, this mistres-principle of tho voice. I here offer an apology for my departure from corectncs in the iliistration. If I have comittcd a fault I much regret it; ajid thereupon write tliis note, to prevent a false impresion on the mind of the Header. 100 THE RADICAL AND VANISHING MOVEMENT. be variously caled the radical and vanishing movement ; the con- crete movement, progresion, interval, or pitch ; or simply the radical and vanish, or the concrete ; or the radical and vanishing concrete tone, semitone, third, fifth, and octave. The Discrete function will be caled the discrete movement, progresion, change, skip, or pitch ; or the radical movement, change, progresion, skip, or pitch ; or the discrete tone, semitone, third, fifth, and octave. Each of the above phrases may have the specification of rise or fall, upward or downward, ascent or descent, according to the re- quired purpose, or to any desirable variation of terms. Shud the direction of the concrete, or of the radical not be specified or implied, the term is used for either rise or fall. As a general designation of the extent of intervals and wavesj all greater than those of the semitone and second will be called wider, to form a better rythmus than wide, in qualifying those terms of intona- tion. Let the Reader then not be alarmed at the variety of these terms. At present he need only regard them for future reference, if he should hereafter find it necesary. When he requires them, he will perhaps perceve, they are phrases conected so necesarily with the subject, that he himself might have made them. Indeed, a future wide companionship in the knowledge of speech, may have a shorter and more convenient nomenclature of its own. Let him however not be discouraged, by his first dificulty in discriminating the intervals of speech. There was much to per- plex and to threaten with despair, in the course of observation by which these intervals were first measured and described. Yet even these now palpable phenomena were not perccved at a mo- ment, as perhaps they mit be, under a simple and real education of the senses and of thot. For the miror of the mind obscured and distorted in its imagery, by a habitual ocupation with little else than Fictionj and Argument, too often the provocative of fictionj is not prei)ared to reflect the realities of nature without dimnes or delay. The first perceptions by the author of this esay were full of indistinctness and doubt ; far grciitcr ])crhaps, than the inteligcnt Reader may experience from the dcscrij)tions in this section. Yet after three years familiarity with the different inter- vals of intonation, their various degrees were nmch more percep- ALPHABETIC ELEMENTS. 101 tible to him, than tlie discrimination of colors without direct comparison ; and quite as distinguisliable by their efect upon the ear in deliberate uterance, as tlie vocality, time, and force of sylabic sound. SECTION III. Of the Elementary Sounds of the English Language ; with their Relations to the Radical and Vanishing Movement. The term Element is aplied to the most simple form of the articulate voice ; and is not otherwise used in this Essay. The element as a sound adresed to the ear, is to be distinguished from its visible symbol or leter ; which is sometimes specified as an alphabetic element. The radical and vanishing concrete, under all its forms, is em- ployed on a limited number of these elementary sounds, said by some writers, whom I here follow, to amount in the English lan- guage, to thirty-five. It seems useles to raise a distracting ques- tion on the subject of the kind and number of the elements. As long as the human mind prefers contention, to practical agreement, there will j>erhaps be refinements and diferences on this point. The thirty-five here asumed, aford all the distinctions required for the uses of this Work. And they have been found suficient for prac- tical purposes, by those who have no time nor fondness for useles discovery or for dispute.* * English philologists have, acording to their real or afectod nicety of car, difered on the subject of the number of the elements in our language. The diferences refer to the character of the sounds, or to the time, or maner of pronouncing them. The broad sound of a in all, and of o in occupy have been enumerated as diferent. If there is a diference, it may consist in the abrupt uterance of oc, or the sudencs with which the sound breaks from the organs. A like distinction has been made between o in oor.c, and « in htiW j where the explosive acent seems to give the perceptible diference to the short vowel. Now this abruptnes of voice is a generic function, or mode, aplicable to all vowels, and tbercfore not a ground for specific distinction. It is how- ever, of little practical consequence, whether cases like these arc decided one way or the other. 102 ALPHABETIC ELEMENTS. An alphabet should consist of a separate symbol for eveiy ele- mentary sound. Under this view, the deficiencies, redundancies, and confusion of the system of alphabetic characters in the Eng- lish language, prevent the adoption of its common grammatical subdivisions here. The sounds of the alphabetic elements are the material, and their combination into significant words, the formal causes of all language. It apears to me however, that a clasification, acording to their uses in other phenomena of speech, besides that of its ar- ticulation, wud be practicaly useful as well as definitively just. But as Intonation is an important mode of speech, the arangement of the elements if practicaly regarded, should have some reference to it. In the present section therefore, these elements will be de- scribed and clased, acording to their use in intonation.* * I set aside, in this place at least, the sacred division into vowels, conso- nants, mutes and semivowels. The complete history of nature will consist of a full description of all the interchangeable rehxtionships, not of notions after the metaphysical maner, but of perceptible things. "We receved the clasifi- cation of the elements from Greek and Roman gramarians : and their division, acording to organic causes, into labial, lingual, dental, and nasal, is now strictly a part of the physiology of speech. But whatever cause, conected with the vocal habits of another nation, or the etymologies of another tongue, may have justified the division into vowels and consonants acording to their definition, it does not exist with us. Without designing to overlook or de- stroy arangements, truly representing the relationships of these sounds, it is only intended in this esay to add to their history a division, grounded on their important functions in intonation. The strictnes of philosophy should not be so far forgoten, as to sufer the claim of this clasification to be- exclusive. Let it remain as only a constituent portion, of new and wider prospects, yet to be opened in the art. Passing by other asailable points of our imemorial system, the contradis- tinction of its two leading divisions is a misrepresentation. Had he an ear who said, and belevedj a consonant cannot be sounded without the help of a vowel ? Among the thousand mismanagements of literary instruction, there is at the outset in the horn-book, a pretence to represent elementary sounds, by sylables composed of two or more elements, asj Be, Kay, Zed, double U, and Aitch. These words are used in infancy and thru life, as simple elements in the proces of synthetic speling. But no eror or oversight of the school shud ever make us forget the realities of nature. Any pronouncing dictionary sliows, that consonants alone may form syla- bles ; and if they have never been apropriated to words which might stand solitary in a sentence, like the vowels a, i, o, a-/i, and a-ji^c, it is not because ALPHABETIC ELEMENTS. 103 As the number of elementary sounds in the English language excedes that of tlie literal symbols, and as some of these symbols, cspeciuly those of the vowels, are made to represent various sounds, without a rule for discriminationj I propose to suply this want of precision, by using short words of known pronunciation, contain- ing the elementary sounds with the leters that represent them, marked in italics ; which the Reader may exemplify to himself. Let him begin to utter the word all. The moment the sound of a is completed, let him pause ; and that initial sound gives one of the elementary sounds of a. In a like experiment with other in- itial vowels of selected examples, he will hear the precise sounds of the other vowel elements. Again, for the consonants. In the word bee, let him pause after the obscure 'guttural murmur' of its first sound, and he will hear the element represented by the letter b. Or, otherwise : let him, in the instance of both vowel and con- sonant, prolong unusualy the first element, before joinmg it to the next ; and the single elementary vowel, and the single elementary consonant will be respectively heard in that prolongation. The thirty-five Elements are now to be considered under their relationships to the radical and vanish. And as the properties of this function are, prolongation of sound, and variation of con- crete pitch, with initial force and final feeblcnesj these elements should be regarded in their varied capacity for the display of these properties. With this view, our elements of articulation may be aranged under three general heads. The first division embraces sounds with the radical and vanish in its most perfect form. They are twelve in number; and are heard in the usual sound of the separated italics, in the folowing words: ^-11, a-rt, a-n, a-le, oiir-r, t-sle, o-ld, ee-1, oo-ze, e-rr, e-nd, and t-n. From their being the purest and most manageable means for intonation, I have called them Tonic sounds. they cannot be so used ; but because they have not that full and manageable kind of vocality, which exhibits the quantity, force, and intonation of an unconected element, with suflcient emphasis and with agreeable efect. 104 ALPHABETIC ELEMENTS. They consist of (liferent sorts of Vocalityj, or of that kind of voice in which we usualy speak, and here contradistinguished from whisper or aspiration. They are produced by the joint functions of the larynx, fauces, and parts of the internal and external mouth. The tonicsj pronouncing the o broad, as in o-r^ are of a more tunable voice than the other elements. They are capable of in- definite prolongation ; admit of the concrete and tremulous rise and fall, thru all the intervals of pitch ; may be utered more forcibly than the other elements, as well as with more abruptnes ; and while these last two characteristics are apropriate to the fulnes and stres of the radical^ the atenuative prolongation, on their pure and controlable vocalit}^, is finely acomodated to the vanishing movement. Universaly, they havej for the purposes of an agreable intonation j a eidony, briefly so to call it, beyond the other elements. The second division includes a number of sounds, posesing variously among themselves, a character similar to that of the tonics ; but difering in degree. They amount to fourteen ; and are marked by the sound of the separated italics, in the folowing words : 5-0 w, c?-are, ^r-ive, u-ile, 2-one, y-e, w-o, th-en, a-z-ure, si-n^r, Z-ove, m-ay, n-ot, r-ose. From their inferiority to the tonics, for all the emphatic and elegant purposes of speech, while they admit of being intonated or caried concretely thru the intervals of the scale, I have called them Subtonic sounds. They all have a vocality ; in some it is combined with aspiration. B, d, g, ng, I, m, n, r, have an unmixed vocality ; v, z, y, to, th, zh, have an aspiration joined with theirs. We have learned that the vocality of the tonics is in each, peculiar. The vocality of some of the subtonics is aparently the same ; and among all, it does not greatly difer; resembling that of certain five of the tonics, to be described presently. Like the vocality of the tonics, it is formed in the larynx ; but the sound in its outward course may have a modifying reverberation in the fauces, the mouth, and the cavities of the nose. A few subtonic vocalitics are purely nasal, asj m, n, ng, b, d, g. Others are purely oral. The nasal are soon silenced by closing the nostrils ; the rest are not materi- ally afected by it. The vocality of 6, d, and g, may not be imedi- ALPHABETIC ELEMENTS, 105 atclv pcrcevecl by those who have not, on the separate elements, atained the full coniand of pronunciation. Writers have spoken of the vocality of these elements, under the name of 'gutural mur- mur/ and have regardeeech employs all the elements, the abrupt and atonic must necesarily divide the time of one expiration into diferent sylabic impulses. From the four kinds of elementary sounds employed in the con- struction of sylables, let us now supose the atonic and abrupt to be rejected, and consequently the last mentioned cause of limitation to be removed. Why is it imposible in this case, to give indefi- nite length to a sylable formed by the union of a tonic with any numl)er of subtonics ? Or, why is such a sylable otherwise limited tlian l)y the term of expiration ? When a tonic precedes a subtonic in the formation of a concrete inter\'al, it gives up a portion of its concrete movement to the sub- 9 122 ON SYX,ABICATIOX. tonic, which then caries on and completes the vanisli. In this way, the radical and vanish may consist of a tonic and one, ts\'o, three, or at most, four subtonics. But the number cannot in easy pro- nunciation, be extended beyond these. In the sylable strandzh (strange) the concrete rise begins on a, and continuing thru n, d and zh, vanishes on the last. With two more subtonics v and m, subjoined to this word, as in strandshvm, few speakers could make one pure sylabic impulse of the combination. The cause of this dificulty, or as we may call it, imposibility, will apear in the folowing remarks. In an ordinary use of the voice, the concrete rises or falls thru the intervals of a tone, or third, or fifth ; and employs therein a certain portion of time. The concrete and the time of these in- tervals may be executed on one tonic, combined with several sub- tonics ; yet there is a limit to the number, uterable by an easy efort in corect speech. For each constituent requiring a certain dura- tion, to render it conizable as a variation of pitchj and to insure distinct pronunciation, each should consume a portion of the time of the concrete; and it is found j each constituent does consume so much, that not more than four subtonics together with the preced- ing tonic, can in easy uterance be compressed into the time and space of the radical and vanish, or of the wave. In pronouncing a combination of tonics and subtonics, greater than can be included in a single concrete, or a wavej either two sylables must be formed by two separate concretes, or some one of the tonic or subtonic constituents must be protracted on one line of pitch. And tho this last would not necesarily produce two syl- ables, yet by asuming the characteristic note of song, it would be very diferent from the efect of the truly equaljle sylabic-concrete of speech, and therefore not to be regarded in the question before us. Admitting, a sylable might be prolonged, to the extent of expiration, on what we called in tlie second section, a continued wave ; still the prolongation being here made on a single tonic or subtonic of the sylabic compound, the case would not be regardeer of b, d, and g, considered by Holder and his folowoi^s as identical with the atonies p, t, and k, is to my ear at least, faintly distinguisluible from them, by having a loss ea*ictures, which with their characteristic dimnes or misrep- resentation, have been in all ages, substituted for the unataiuable delineations of the real processes of nature. There is a harsh kind of voice called Guturalj produced by a vibratory curent of air, between the sides of the pharynx and the base of the tongue, when aparently brought into contact above the glotis. If then the term ' voice from the throat' which has been one of the unmeaning or indefinite designations of vocal science, were aplied to this gutural sound, it would definitely assign a locality to the mechanism. In acknowledging my ignorance of the mechanism of the oro- tund, it nuist be addedj that its function wherever performed, may yet be improved by studious exercise. And as the best and only pure instances of this voice are the result of cultiva- tion, I here propose some elementary means by which it may be acquired. It would seem to be suficient for a teacher of elocution to ex- emplify the orotundj that his pupil might imitate it. Vocalists in their lesons on Pure Tone do little more. But singing has long been an Art; and its many votaries have rendered the public familiar with its leading terms and principles, and acustomed the ear to the peculiaritias of its practice. Whereas elocution apcars to be with the vast majority, no more than a sub-animal instinct ; by which, some only low, bleat, bark, mew, chatter, whinny and bray a little beter than others. In describing tliercfore, without the oportunity of ilustrating, it becomes necesary to adress the pupil, as if he has of these states to Lmguage, make a coresponding division of the vocal signs, or- dained by Nature severaly to represent them. In the detail of this THE EXPRESION OF SPEECH. 159 arangement, it may be necesary to refer to some of the topics of future sections, yet wc sliall use uo term, without a present or previous definite explanation. The First state or condition of the mind is its simple perception of things, their actions, and other relationships^ with no reference to the exciting interests of human life. We apply to both this state of plain thot, and to the vocal sign that denotes it, tlie term Thulire. Its vocal sign consists in the simple rise and fall and shorter wave of the interval of the second; of an unobtrusive V(x?ality ; with a moderate degree of Force; and short sylabic Time or Quantity. The Second, or intermediate condition has that relation to human life, which excites moderately self-interesting reflections in the mindj and embraces dignity, pathos, awe, serious admiration, reverence, and other states congenial in character and dcgre with these. We call this condition of the mind, and its vocal signs, the Inter-thotive, but preferably the Admiratlve or Reverentive. Its signs are variously the inter\'al of the semitone, the second, oca- sionaly tlie third and fifth, with their waves; an extended time; a full orotund vocality; with a moderate but dignified force. The Third condition has a more imediat-e and vivid refereiKJe to human life, its reflective interests, and actions, under the im- presive forms, degrees, and varieties of pasion. We call this state of mind, and the signs which denote it, the Pasionative. Its signs are the semitone, and wider rising and faling intervals, with their waves; either a short, or an exterided time; a striking and varied vocality; abruptnes; with high degrees, and impresive forms of force. I have in these divisions, used the terms Inter-thot, and Inter- thotive, briefly to denote, the intermediate condition between thot and pasion ; but as these words are at first startling, and are not altogether exact, I will gencraly designate the forms of this division of the mental state and its vocal signs, as Admirative, or Rever- entive, and use the term Inter-thot, merely for brevity of ])hraso. These terms for the three divisions, do not as it apears, belong to our language; and conveying no other meaning than here ascribed to tlicm, cannot be confounded or mistaken: and their final particle including tlie idea of agency, properly designates the 160 THE EXPRESIOX OF SPEECH. influence of the state of mind on tlie vocal sign, and that of tlie vocal sign on the ear. Thus, the thoughtive state produces the thoughtive sign j and the thoughtive sign produces a thoughtive state of mind in the hearer. The case is similar, in the influence of the inter-thotive and the pasionative states respectively on their vocal signsj and of their signs, on the hearer. The efect of the signs of the iuter-thotivej or as I would call it, the admirative or the rev- erentivej and of the pasionative divisions, constitutes, in its varie- ties and degrees, what we have named, at the head of this section, the Expresion of Speech. We have considered only the single or individual sign, and the single or momentary state of mind that directs it. This state of mind may with its sign, be extended to the curent of discourse. The continuation of the same state of mind and of its apropriate vocal sign forms a Curent maner or Style. Of this we make three divisions. Each consists of a sucesion of its own peculiar con- stituents of mental state, and vocal sign ; and may be severally called, the Thdtive, Inter-thotive, and Pasionative Style of reading and speech. The motive for taking a separate view of the indi- vidual instance of the state of mind, and of its vocal signj and of their continued stylej and for aplying the same nomenclature in each casej is, that we shall sometimes refer separately to a single state of mind, and its signj and sometimes to a continued curent style : and as the style is only a continuation of this single state and sign, it is proper to aply the same terms to identical constituents in the two cases. In here dividing the subject of the states of mind from their vocal signs ; and in denoting the individuality of these states and their signs, as well as their sucesion in a curent style, by the same termsj we ofer a simple, and for present pnictiail purposes, a sufi- cient outline of a clasification of the relationshij>s between the mind and the voice. And were we describing Nature, to those only who can throw-aside the habit of an old, limited, and dis- tmcting nomenclature, for one more recent and precise, ^^•e Mould not at this time, encumber her simplicity. But the atempts of the meta])hysical schools to discriminate the states of the miiul, and the void j^erceptions of extreme longevity. The power of giving indefinite prolongation to sylables, is not comonly posesed by si)eakers. It is truej the daily use of the THE TIME OF THE VOICE. 199 voice frequently calls for extended quantity ; but daily discourse is often simple narative, or if directed by an excited state of mind, is that of active argument, or of contending interests, Avhich employ for the most part, the short time of sylables and the rapid course of uterance. Still, the asertion that a long quantity is not easily practicable, may seem to be questionable : since persons M-ho sing can readily extend their time to an indefinite length ; and all uter cries in the same maner. But these voices are generaly made on protracted notes ; the dificulty to which we here alude, is in the execution of the equable concrete of speech. We have shown that diferent forms of the radical and vanish are respectively em- ployed in speech, and song. Without atention to the use of these forms, it is not always easy to restrict them to their apropriate places. A reader who has not by practice, a facility in executing the long quantities of speech, will be liable, in extending his syla- bles, to fall into the protracted radical or protracted vanish of song. On the other hand, when persons without a musical ear and a singing- voice, imperfectly remember and endeavor to imitate, the melodial succesions of song, they are apt to change many of its notes, into the equable concrete of speech. Prolonged cries, and interjections which are only more moderate cries, are always made either by the protracted notes of song, or by movements over the wider intervals and their waves ; and tho these intervals and Avaves are both proper to speech, yet the prolonged cry and interjection are the forced efect of ocasional pasion ; and this not often ocurring in ordinary uterance, the cause is not continued, and the vocal practice not confirmed. The foregoing notice of the exclusion of the peculiar intonations of song from speech, furnishes one cause why persons of great accomplishment as singers, are nevertheles indiferent readers or comonplaco actors. Other causes will hereafter be asigned for the general want of interchangeable facility in the exercise of the arts of song, and speech. That arising from the different stnictures of the radical and vanish in the two cases, is not the least influen- tial. The endowed singer may have at comand all the means of expresion, employed in song: but these means, as we shall learn, are peculiar to song, and are not transferable to speech ; and while he is able to clothe every feeling of the Composer, with the nielo- 200 THE TIME OF THE VOICE. dious sucesion of his long-drawn notes, his disqualified atempts at speaking intonation, strip off or tear to pieces, every expresion, to be spread by the equable concrete, over the language of the Poet. To return from this acount of diferent forms of the concrete, to the consideration of the uses of its varied quantity. An immu- table, mutable, and indefinite time, has each its apropriate manner of fulfiling the purposes of expresion. It is however, upon in- definite sylables that the most graceful and dignified effect of into- nation is acomplished ; as we shall learn in future parts of this essay. Readers who are ignorant of the principles of quantity, do yet perceve the necesity of a deliberate movement, for a grave and admirative expresion. They therefore, endeavor to suply the want of a long sylabic time, by slight pauses after words, and even between sylables. Propriety and taste however, alow here no compensation : they require most of the prolonged time in digni- fied uterance, to be spent on the sylable itself, and reject the other means, as ofensive monotony or afectation. Eminent mstances of the esential importance of long quantity may be shown, by considering the sylabic construction of sentences with reference to expression : for as the vocal signs of certain states of mind require the prolonged time of indefinite sylablesj it may hapen that such states are to be expresed on the limited dura- tion of a mutable, or the mere moment of an imutable time. This may be ilustrated by a pasage from the fourth book of Paradise Lost, where Satan is brought before Grabriel. In the dialogue between them, one of the replications of Satan is as folows. Not that I less 'endure,' or shrink from pain, In-swZ^-ing angel ! well thou know'st I stood Thy /ferc-est, when in batle to thy aid, The blasting volied thunder made all speed. And seconded thy else not dread-Qdi spear. But still thy words at random, as before. Argue thy inexperience what behoves From hard assays and ill succcses past A faithful leader, not to hazard 'all' Thru waj's of danger by himself untried: 'I,' therefore, ' I' ' alone' first undertook To wing the desolate abys, and spy This new created world, whereof in Hell Fame is not silent, here in hope to find THE TIME OF THE VOICE. 201 Bcter abode, and my aflictod powers To setle here on earth, or in mid nir; Tho for posession put to try once more "What thou and thy gay legions 'dare' against: Whoso easier busincs were to ' serve ' their ' Lord ' High up in Heaven, with songs to hymn his throne, And practis'd distances to ' cringe,' not fght. The language of this extract variously embraces argument, narative, and pasion. We here refer to the last. I have marked in italics, some of the sylables representing that state, but which are incapable of prolongation. The sylables, less, shrink, suit, fierce^ else, and dread, belong to our class of mutables, yet they cannot l)e extended, without making in the several cases, the pro- longed radical on /, e, and r; and this would change pronunciation to a drawl. We supose less, taken with endure, to embrace the mental conditions of sufering and resignation^ shrink, those of taunt and exultationj suit, those of complaint, pride and roproachj fierce, that of scornful defiance^ else, a contingency of self-confi- dence and contempt^ and dread, when interpreted by the preceding exceptive, else, a similar contingency of self-relying courage. The expresion of all these states, as we shall learn hereafter, calls for a prolonged quantity', on the wider intervals of pitch, and on the wave ; which the shortnes of the elemental sounds, in tlie above emphatic sylables, does not alow. The emphasis of stress might indeed be laid upon them, but this would not expres their pur- pose. The last line however, afords a more marked ilustration of the subject before us : for of the words not fight, the former is only^ mutable ; and the latter being strictly imutable, they cannot b& extended, without a disagreeable departure from corect pronuncia- tion. Tiiis i>lirase representing a mental state of strong contempt and exultation, its expresive intonation should be made upon in- definite sylables. A reader of delicate perception can never satisfy his ear on these restrictetl quantities. J have thruout tiie extract, marked with inverted commas, a few words, embracing states of mind that (tdl for wide intervals on an extended time ; and these words by their power of intlefinite prolongation alow the required expresion. I add here another exem])lification of this subject, from the gen- eric, brief, and magnificent description of Satan's Imperial Presence U 202 THE TIME OF THE VOICE. in Pandemonium, at the opening of the second book of Paradise Lost. High on a throne of royal state, which far Outshone the wealth of Ormus and of Ind, Or, where the gorgeous East with richest hand Showers on her Kings barbaric pearl and gold, Satan exalted sat. In these lines, Milton, with a just instinct of versification, has employed long quantities, in hapy adaptation to the admirative dignity of the description. I use here, rather remarkably, the term, instinct of versification, not in oversight of the inteligence with which this Extraordinary Man executed every high design and every tittle of his work ; but because it is clearly seen he did not intend to construct the measure of his poem by the rules of quantity alone. • The development of the full resources of an acentual versification by Milton, was a new and absorbing labor. Had this advance-step preceded him, the originality and restles enterprise of his intelect, would most probably have aded to the many available principles of Greek and Roman composition, so hapily transfered to his own language^ the acomplishment of the suposed imposibility of adopting the rules of their prosody. In most of the words of the above example, where the majesty of his th5t so secured the homage of quantit}^, some of the sylables sudenly arest the perception of extended movement and deliberate dignity, produced by the indefinite time of those words. The sylables, state, rich, and sat, are too short for the otherwise good iambic temporal measure : and the word barbaric occasions some iregular contrariety in the impresions of quantity and acent. In the simple pronunciation of this word, the first sylable, bar, is somewhat longer tlian the second, which will not, in this case, bear unusual extension. And as the longer sylable is here in the place of the weak sylable of iambic acent, the impresivenes of exceding length reverses the sucesion of the prevailing measure. Nor does the simple meaning of the epi- thet barbaric, alow a suficient degree of acentual strcs on the second sylable, to overrule the impresivenes of greater length in the first. If the Reader, excusing the rhetorical change, will substitute the adjective orient, for barbaric, he will perceve by THE TIME OF THE VOICE. 203 comparison, the diference between the acentual and the temporal imprcsion. Showers 6n | her kings | hgr 6r | i^nt pearl | and g6ld. Mlietlier the first and the fourth section of this line are con- sidered respectively in order, a trochee and an iambus, as here marked, or as a dactyl and an anapest, as they may be read, by license in our iambic measure^ the admisible prolongation of the indefinite sylable o;*-e, produces an admirative dignity of uterance that cannot be efected on the short time of the acented sylable of barbaric. And it may be aded further, that this line does fulfil the conditions of poetic quantity, as completely as any line ever constructed with Greek or Roman words.* To a bad reader, nearly all sentences are alike, however im- properly constructed for vocal expression. He who looks abroad for excelence, thru all the ways of the voice, must often find the tendencies and demands of his uterance restricted, by the unyield- ing character of an imutable phraseology. A limited discernment, and the comon uses of quantity often sufice to set forth the thots of an author ; but an admirative or a pasionative expresion will in many cases be imperfect, or lost, if tried on the imutable time of sylables. A reader who can asume the mental state of the poet, will not be able to give the prompted expresion to part of the last line of the folowing example. It is taken from Gabriel's answer to Satan's apology for his flight from Hell, just quoted, and is a coment on the title of faithful leader, vaunted by Satan. * If the Reader would know how certain words may be pronounced as a foot or prosodiul section, either of two or of three sylables, let him recur to our principles of sylabication. The word showers is one sylable, wlien the e is omitted ; the dipthongal tonic oii, vanishing directly into the subtonic r, as in s/iotors. If the sound of c is retained, that element requires its radical and vanish, and the word becomes thereb}' of two sylables, as in s/ioiv-ers. The trisylable orient, is reduced to a disylable, by withholding a radical from the sound represented by t, and thereby droping that sound as a distinct sylable. In the trisylable, i represents the sound of ec-1, and ec-\ by readily changing into the subtonic y-e, coalesces with the suceding tonic e-nd ; thus y taking the place of ce-1, joins itself to the subtonic n, to form the contracted sylable yent. The word orient, in corect pronunciation, is a true dactyl in quantity. I have set it as an iambus, not intending to defend the propriety of tlie change, but to form thereby, a regular iambic line, and to ilustrate one of the princi- jiles of Englisii pronunciation. 204 THE TIME OF THE VOICE. O name, O sacred name of faithfulnes profan'd I Faithful to whom ? to thy rebelious crew ? Army of Fiends, Jit body to Jit head. The six s}- lables of this last phrase are short, and all the em- phatic ones are imutable. They contain a degree of admiration at the well marked felowship, bet^veen a ringleader and his creM^, ming-led with scorn at the wicked faithfulnes of the rebelious out- cast : and these states of mind, we shall learn hereafter, cannot be eminently shown on the abrupt shortnes of the sylabic time here employed. With an acomplished sj^eaker, the management of this phrase would resemble the efforts of a musician of feeling and skill, on a limited instrument ; and the diferent efect of his voice, on the above short sylables, and on indefinite quantities embracing the same states, would be like that of the inexpresive chatering of the harp or piano-forte, compared with the gliding resources and swayful concrete of intonation, from an Andante movement on the violoncelo. The harsh and unyielding character of the short sylables in the above example, would be striking to a good reader, by its contrast with the preceding phraseology ; in which, the two interjectives, the words name, profaned, whom, thy, crav, army, Jiends, and perhaps faith/itZj being all of indefinite time, and some of them emphatic^ aford the most ample means, for a true and elegant intonation of the admirative and partly pasion- ative states of mind they convey. Although abrupt and atonic elements produce many instances of short sylabic construction, that do not admit the extended forms of intonated expresionj yet most sentences contain the amount of prolongable sylables, which the state of mind may require. For it is not necesary, that every word should bear the full expresion, conveyed by an extended intonation. One or two emphatic long- quantities, assisted by an accordant, even if faint intonation, on the short and unemphatic sylablesj in a maner to be described hercafterj will suficiently convey the thot and pasion embraced by the sentence. The indefinite sylable par in the folowing line has a variable quantity, which, without impropriety, may be doubled or more, in expresive uterancc ; and the same may be said of bleed. THE TIME OF THE VOICE. 205 Pardon me thou bleeding piece of earth, That I am meek and gentle with these butchers. Tlie circumstances of the scene in Julius Cccsnr, from which this is taken, inform us tJiat Marie Antony's mental states, ex- presed in the first Ime, are those of love, grief, and wmtrition ; his revenge does not apear until the second. The former, it will be shown hereafter, call particularly for an extension of sylabic time ; and we here regard the words jxirdou and bleeding as em- phatic, since they respectively picture tlie special object of the 8upliant, and the disastrous asasination, that with self-reproach, he had delayed to punish. The acented sylables of these words freely receve the temporal prolongation ; and the employment of the required expresion on their indefinite quantity, togetlier witJi the asistance of a slight prolongation on the short and unaccented sylables, directs the stream of that expresion every where thruout the line. In the preceding ilustrations, the Reader may now perceve some ground for our arangement of sylables, acording to their time, and in reference to the subject of expresive intonation ; and may there- upon, admit the usefulnas of its nomenclature, for the purpascs of criticism and instruction. Yet there is another view to be taken of the efects of sylabic quantity. From the limited resources, and tlie necesarily generic character of language, the same word may in diferent sentences have a variation, so to speak, in its thotive meaning. It is still more comon to find the same word w'ith a diferent reverentive or pasionative expresion, in its change- able combinations with other words. Some states of mind being only properly represented by a short and abrupt uterance; it folows that the shortnes of a word or sylable, which on one oca- sion cannot denote the state of mind that requires a prolonged intonationj may on another, fulfil the purpose of forceful expres- ion with its i mutable quantity. It was shown in a former ex- ample, that the word fight was incapable of the extension, there neccsary for the full display of scorn. When Hamlet in the violent scene with Laertes saysj Why, I wiUJif/hi with him upon this theme, Until ni}' eyelids will no lunger wagj 206 THE TIME OF THE VOICE. the quick time of the whole sentence, is generically inclusive of the short time of its constituent sylables ; and the imutable quantity of the word fight, admiting of abruptnes and force, may fuly denote the resolute rage of the Prince. The mterjection is the only Part of Speech, employed exclu- sively for expresion. Those comon to all languages, consist of tonics, that freely admit of indefinite prolongation. Interjections are the instincts of the animal voice ; and universaly have an ex- tendible quantity required for pasionative expresion. Other parts of speech are sometimes the picture of thot, and sometimes of pasion ; and acomodated to this, there is a diference in the time of sylables. Had words been invented as signs of inter) ective ex- presion only, most of them would have been made Avith an ex- tended voice. Yet as the tonic elements may be utered either as long or as short quantities, and the abrupt and atonic, in certain positions, inconveniently produce a short quantity, it might be infered, that a language consisting entirely of tonic sounds, man- ageable both for longer and for shorter time, would beter fulfil all the purposes of speech, than a language containing in part, ele- ments of imutable quantity. But some states of mind are well represented by a short quantity, and a suden isue of voice ; and the abrupt elements are in certain positions, the best contrived means for producing that sudennes with the greatest variety and force.* And further, the atonies, with the exception of k, p, and tj tho not properly explosive, yet arest the concrete progres of vo- cality, and alow a suceding tonic readily to take on the explosive opening. A language made up of sounds, having the varied character of our tonic, subtonic, atonic, and abrupt elements, is therefore well accomodated to the system of those expresive signs, ordained thruout all vocal creation. f * Those who delight in searching for undiscoverable things, may institute an inquiry^ whether the abrupt elements derive their existence in speech, from the suden uterance which anger and other animal pasions instinctively asumed, at that nonenity of date, the origin of language. The only origin of language we know, is that of a new term, invented for a new thOt, or for an unamed physical fact. f This remark will scarcely be aceptablc, to those who have always thotj the greater the proportion of vowels to other elements, the greater tho har- mony, as it is calod, of a language. And hence the sneer of Grecian scholar- THE TIME OF THE VOICE. 207 The employment of prolonged time, in the emphatic places of discourse, with a view to expresive intonation, seems never to have been thot of by ordinary writers ; and has been so far overlooked in the schools, that it has never receved formal notice either in Rhetoric or Elocution. Dramatists, to whose taste and duty this re- mark is espccialy applicable, frequently neglect that proper adapta- tion of time and acent, which would aford an Actor the means of ading the finishing touches of his voice, to the vivid and forcible picture of thot and pasion : for a rythmic style is more easily read and more forcibly declaimed than a loose and unjointed con- struction. The judicious use of the variations of quantity is the very life of elocution, and the right hand of dignity in the measure of poetry and prose. The human ear has conizance of two kinds of Proportion in the sucesions of sound : one embracing the relationship of its forces ; the other of its duration. The First consists in the perception of unequal /orcf^ alternately sucesive. Of this we have many species, derived from the order of sucesion, or the number of the varied impulses ; as exhibited in the folowing ilustration : where the first species shows a heavy impulse folowed by a lighter one ; the second, one heaxj folowed ship at our barbarian cacophony ; if I may with a repugnant car, thus lay an example of classical harmony on an English page. A language that would give to a, e, i, o, «, oi, and ou, an over-share of speech, would be very monoto- nous, and might perhaps remind us of its vowel-roots among the sub-animals: but in sound alone, it would interupt fluency by an increase of hiatus, and be far from the harmonious. The term harmony, taken from other arts, has not a very descriptive meaning, when aplied to language. Architecture, Music, Painting, and the Landscape, require, respectively, a unity in their varied distribution of sound, color, form, and surface, and a variety in the unitizing power of contrast, to make up the engaging efects of their harmony : and each has its peculiar maner, if I may so speak, of Preparing, and Striking, and Resolving its discords. What the literary critic calls harmony of language, is in reality a perception, not of consonant, but of different, impressions on the ear, and consists in the varied and agreeable sucesions and contrasts, of the forms of Force, Vocality and Time, with the intersections of pause; shown in Knglish Composition, by a due aportionment of tonic, subtonic, and atonic elements, to mutable, imutablo, and indefinite sylables, under the name of Kythmua. 208 THE TIME OF THE VOICE. by two lighter ; the third and fourth being respectively the reversed order of the other two. #9 @e ®® I #®i^ @3@ I »# @© I «9# es^ The Second kind of proportion consists in the different duration of two or more sounds. Of these the species are formed upon the relations of long and short, and from the direct or reverse order of their diferences, ilustrated in the folowing diagram ; where the first section is meant to represent a sound of given length, suceded by one of half or leser fraction of its time ; the second shows a given length folowed by two of shorter time ; the third and foiu'th being respectively the reverse in order, of the times of the first and second. The Reader can audibly ilustrate these schemes, by tonic sounds respectively, of different force, and duration. We can at present, reach no further in the investigation of this subject, than to knowj the measurement of these proportions is an agreeable exercise of the cultivated ear : and that we are more pleased witli varied percusions, and varied durations of any me- chanical sounds, of these or other symetrical arangements, than with one unvaried order of percussions and durations, except regular pauses are interposed between any given order of them ; as in the following diagram : where the space of a pause is repre- sented between a series of two, and of three similar sounds. %^ e® ©o s e«® eeo «ee As the voice has the power of this momentary peivusion, and sylables have diferent degrees of duration, both of the above pro- portional forms of force and time may be aplied to speech. The perception of the former is called Accent j that of the later, Quau- THE TIME OF THE VOICE. 209 tity. To one who has equaly exercised his ear in these two kinds of measurement, the alternation of quantity is by far the most agree- able. For in the case of accent, no momentary sound or ' ictus ' can be tunable; whereas a prolonged quantity is the esential of this agreeable tune. If then the perception of equal momentary acents, with pauses between the given agregates, or of unequal momentary acents, alternately continued, is agreeable, the percep- tion of a similar order of difering tunable quantities must be more so. Since the accntual function may be conjoined with quantity, by giving the abrupt ictus to the beginning of a prolonged sylable; and pauses may be interposed between agregates that make up the sucesion of quantity. The above view regards only the acentual stress, or the time of sound, considered in itself. When quantity carries the intonation of the concrete, and thus Ijecomes susceptible of vocal expresion, its claims over acent are incalculable. The preceding remarks refer especialy to the measure of verse : and a principal cause of the diference between a good and a bad reader therein, lies in a varied ability to attain an efective and elegant comand over acent and quantity. The efect upon the ear, and the silent perception in the mind, of an agreeable variety in the sucesions of force and time, together with the division by pause, both in prose and verse, is caled the Rythmus of Speech, It may be suposed, I alude to the Latin and Greek languages, when speaking of the quantity of verse. Noj it is to the English language, and to the partial tho unsot use of quantity, at present prevailing in its measure : and I wish further to intimate a posi- bility of the future construction of its rythmus, on the sole basis of quantityj if the scholastic formalists of literature can be made to belevej the subject of ancient prosody has, for ages past, been exhausted ; that the labors of wrangling compilation arc inferior to the works of inventive improvement; and that the investiga- tion of their own respective languages may asure to them the first births of originalityj and to their productions, if aml)itious of such things, the consequent undivided heritage of fame. About the time we are tat to measure the sylables of Homer and Virgil, by the relations of long and short, we are toldj our 210 THE TIME OF THE VOICE. own tongue does not admit the rythmus of quantity ; and that the prosody of the English as well as of other modern languages, is restricted to the use of the alternately strong and weak percusive acent. For the sake of the general principle in some important maters, we do well, perhaps, in the present make-shift state of the human mind, to rely implicitly, for a time, on the authority of our teachers ; but many find cause to regret the necesit}^ of this confidence in particular instances. From the finely governed and varied quantities of Mrs. Siddons, I first learned, by beautiful and impresive demonstration, that the English language poseses sim- ilar, if not equal resources, with the Greek and the Latin, in this department of the luxury of speech : and I found myself indebted to the Stage, for the opening of a source of poetical and oratorical pleasure, which the more virtuous pretences, and the hack-instruc- tion of a Colege, either knew not or disregarded. AVhrle listening to the intonations of this surpasing Actress, I first felt a want of that elementary knowledge which would have enabled me to trace the ways of all her excelence. I could not however,* avoid learn- ing from her instinctive example, what the apointed elders over my education should have tat me ; that one of the most important means of expresive intonation, both in poetry and prose, consists in the extended time of sylabic utterance.* I do not here mean to sayj the quantity of English sylables has not been recognized by prosodians ; or its beauty not been per- ceved by a good ear, wherever it has been well used by design, or acidentaly, in English versification, and in the well adjusted sylabic arangement of prose. I mean to convey a regret that its poM'ers have been undervalued; that its elegant and dignified r}'thmic combination with acent and pause, have been overlooked in the * I had the good fortune to hear this acomplishod Actres, both in Edin- burgh and London, while pursuing my medical studies, from eighteen hun- dred and nine, till eighteen hundred and eleven. On the first publication of this Work, in eighteen hundred and twenty-seven, it came into my mindj perhaps scarcely warranted, even by my admiration both here, and subse- quently expresedj to send her a Copy : not however without suficient warn- ing, from some floating anticipation, that the book itself would be regarded by that peculiar Actor-ism of Actors, as an unwelcome, if not a presumptuous ofering on the Theatric Altar of Anti-docility and Self-sufiicient 'Genius.' I think it was then, and now after seven and twenty years, when I add this note, I more than think it is still so regarded. THE TIME OF THE VOICE. 211 modern afectation of the unfluent plalness of a coloquial style; and that it ha.s been exoludal from its place in elementary rhetor- ical instruction ; thereby depriving the ear of one of its highest prerogatives of perception, in poetry and speech. We may ver>' properly askj whether a clasical scholar is gravely in earnest, or only vain of a colege-liveiy, in declaring his enjoy- ment of Greek and Latin temporal rythums, while ignorant of similar resources of neglected quantity in his own language. The Greeks and the Latins have left us their gramar, their writen words, sylables, and elements ; but our uncertainty of the true voice of these elements both individually and combined, has given rise, among modern scholars, to a difference in the pronunciation of them. Asuming the English manerj the subject of Greek and Latin prosody may be resolved into its simple principles, and briefly described. Long sylables, or their temporal efects, are made in two ways : First, by the absolute duration of sylables, constituted like those we called indefinite : Second, by the short time of those we called imutable and mutable, folowed by a pause ; the time of pronunciation aded to the time of the pause, being equal to that of a long sylable. Short sylables are made by the short-timed pronunciation of indefinite sylables ; or by imutable ones ; and there is nothing in this acount of Ancient quantity, not true of the English language. And further, not only are these general principles of sylabic construction the same in Greek, Latin, and English, but the very sylables themselves are comon to these three languages ; nay, it may be said, to all languages. For we must bear in mindj there Is in all languages, severaly about the same number, both of vowels and consonants ; that most of these elements themselves are comon to all ; and that universaly, no sylable ever includes more than one tonic, or vowel. The average number of audible consonants in every sylable being about three to one vowel, the law of permu- tation in this case would not furnish sylables enough to alow a diferent set, respectively to all the languages of past and present time : and it apears on comparison, not suficient to make a dis- coverable diference even between two. If the Reader will try ever}' line of Homer, and Horace, he will find scarcely a sylable that does not form the whole, or part of some word in his own 212 THE TIME OF THE VOICE. tongue ; both as regards the elemental sounds, and the most exact coincidence of quantity. But it is on sylables alone, the rules of quantity are founded in every language. When therefore we deny that the English tongue admits of the temporal measure, we must come to the absurd conclusion, that identical sounds have in Greek type the most finished fitnes for sylabic quantity, and in English have none at all.* These remarks refer principaly to the time of sylables separately considered. There may be some diferences in the several words of these languages, that render it easier to construct a rythmus of quantity in one than in another : we however, here speak of the admision of the system of quantity into English, and not of the cc^mparative ease of its execution when adopted. There may be some facilities in the Greek for certain kinds of measure, arising out of the greater length of the generality of words in this lan- guage. The Greek may possess an advantage over the English in some of the purposes of vocal expresion and poetic quantity, by having a greater number of indefinite sylables, and by making less use of the abrupt elements, in positions that produce an imutable time. Greek sylables have, in general, fewer letters than English ; and they more frequently end with a tonic element. * That this may not be regarded as an exagerated conclusion, I add, from among a thousand authorities that might be quoted for the same purpose, the folowing substantial support to it. In the chapter on versification, in an English translation of Baron Bielfeld's 'Elements of Universal Erudition^' after many remarks on the subject of ancient quantity and modern accent, which in nowise qualify the folowing extraordinary asertion, the author saysj ' Propei'ly speaking, there are not, therefore, in modern languages, any sensible distinctions of long and short sylables, but many that are to be lightly pased over, and others on which a strong acent, or inflection of the voice, is to be placed.' This was writen towards the close of the last centurj-, by the ' Pre- ceptor to a European Prince, and the Chancelor of all the Universities in the Prussian dominions.' Even before his time, some prosodians were not without the sense of hearing; and tho the existence of long and short sylables in modern languages has, since the epoch of his deep deafnes, been goneraly admited, yet it is still held to be imposible to make agreeable measure out of their relations. In candor, it should be stated:! the Baron was a comi)ilcr ; but such writers generaly represent curent opinions, and they always know more of indexes, popular books, and other men's notions, than is cither known or coveted by those who ' observe, and read, and tliink, l\)r themselves.' THE TIME OF THE VOICE. 213 Tlic employment of quantity in English prose composition, sometimes acidentaly produces the regular measure of Greek and Latin lines. If these ocasional passages of temporal rj'thmus are well accomodated to the 'genius' of the English language, it does not apear, why the studied contrivance of a poet might not use those existing quantities, in the continued course of verse. The folowing sentence luus not the acentual form of any of our estab- lishal meters, and is therefore,' in its rythmus, purely English prose: Rome, in her downfall, blazoned the fame of barbarian conquests. This sentence, independently of its impresive tonic sounds, with stres and time upon them, derives its character, from the relative position of its long and short quantities ; which is exactly that of a Latin and of a Greek hexameter line, here shown by comparison. Dactyl Spondee Dactyl Dactyl Dactyl Spondee. Ev dzTTS I f7£ !^wfT I rrjfjc a | p-qpori | -upoq o | ifrroq. Si nihil | ex tant | a supe | ris placet | Qrbe re | linqui. Rome in h§r | downfall | bliizOn'd the | fame 6f bar | barian | conquests. When this last sentence is read with its proper pauses, and with deliberate pronunciation, it coresponds in measure with the long and short times of the superscribed Latin and the Greek. Let us not however think it strange, for anticipation takes oiF the edge of surprisej if a clasic scholar should deny the identity of its tem- poral impresion, with that of the colated lines. We are so little acustomed to regard English sylables in reference to their quantity, that it is diiicult at first, to make it even a subject of perception. For he who, acording to vulgar persuasion belevesj there is an openes of tlie senses to first physical impresions, greater than that of the mind to new subjects of thot, plainly indicates that he has overlooked the ways and ])0wers of both the senses and the mind ; the senses having cqualy their ignorance, obstinacy, and prejudice; equaly perceving what is familiar, and for a long time j)erceving no more. And perhaps when the powers of observation, and experimental reflection shall be directed to the mind, exclusively as a physical phenomcnonj the now contradistinguished functions of 214 THE TIME OF THE VOICE. the senses and the mind will apear to be one and the same, in most of their ways and means. A cultivated and searching eye and ear are as rarely found, as a well discijjlined and self-dependent mindj the latter being produced by the former ; and a wise master, in human policy and morals, would not have more dificulty, where interest is not inimical, in efecting his designs of melioration, than an original observer in physical science Avould experience from the massj I was about to say of the Philosophic worldj upon solicit- ing an imediate asent to the realitj' of a manifest development of nature, or of some useful invention of art. It is a pasive and an easy thing to look and to listen ; but, with a purpose of inteli- gent inquiry, it is a labor of wisdom to see and to hear. In speaking of the indefinite sylables of the English language, it was saidj their time might be varied without deforming pro- nunciation ; and we must recolect, that the abrupt elements, M'hich generaly terminate imutable sylables, have necesarily after the oclusion, a pause which alows them, with the adition of the time of that pause, to hold the place, and fulfil the function of a long one. AVith these materials for the construction of a temporal rythmus in English versification, nothing but deafnes or prejudice prevents our perceving that its institution has been strongly prompted by nature, and is already half established in our poetry. We alow a reader full liberty over the quantity of sylables, for the sake of expresion in speech ; and song employs tlie widest ranges of time on tonic sounds ; why should we refuse to the measure of verse, a less striking departure from the rules of comon pronunciation. Mr. Sheridan, who does not overlook the existence of quantity in the English language, and its use in the expresion of speech, but Avho nevertheles, maintains that the ' genius ' of our tongue is exclusively disposed to the acentual measure^ seems to ground his opinion on the special rules of Greek and Latin prosody, not being aplicable to the cases of varying time in English pronunciation. He might as fairly have concluded, that the good English style of his own lectures could not be as perspicuous as a Latin con- struction, because its arangement is diferent from the apropriate inversions of the later tongue. On this subject we have briefly to inquirej Has the English THE TIME OP THE VOICE. 215 language long and short sylables ; and can these varying quanti- ties be arange'=!age is quoted, lias a pause after Rome. As the purpose of the flight consists in alowing the shortest time between the uterance of related words, it would suply the omision of this pause, to make a slight one after easily. This tends to prevent the adverb from passing as a qualification of keeping his state, which certainly cannot be the meaning of the author; but which on instant hearing, might otherwise, be mistaken for it, without the aid of the altered pause and the flight. This is not the place to speak of the nice points of emphasis and of melody, to be em- ployed M'ith the flight in this pasagej to give clearnes and strength to its effect. Say first, for Heaven, hides nothing fro7n thy view Nor the deep tract of Hell. To make it apear at once in speech, that the deep tract of hell is equaly with heaven, a nominative to hides'^ the phrase of the mono- tone must be aplied at vieio, with the flight of the voice on the portion marked in italics ; and a pause set after heaven, and re- moved from view, where the editor has marked it. If the gramarian should raise objections to any of these proposed changes of punctuation, he must recur to the design of this section. AVe speak now of the means of adresing the ear ; and its jealous demands sometimes require a separation of close grammatical re- lations ; and sometimes justify a neglect of the usual temporal rests, from the thot and expresion in these cases being more ob- vious without them. The art of reading-well may com|)ensate for voluntary faults on some points, by the acomplishment of eminent efects on others. What we call the Punctuative Reference, or grouping, is another means for bringing together words, or clauses, separated by gram- atical construction ; as in the folowing example : Having the wisdom to forescej he took measures to prevents the disaster. Here the fact of the disaster should be imediately conected with 16 234 THE GEOUPIXG OF SPEECH. the thot both of foreseeing, and preventing : yet by construction, foresee is separated from disaster; and without a pause at prevent, the momentary ateution to the imediate agency of this verb on disaster, might obscure the relation between foresee and disaster. In this case, foresee might pass for an intransitive verb. With the dicomas, the similar pauses at foresee, and prevent, by making them emphatic words, asign the former to its objective casej and conecting these words as fellow transitives, throw, by punctuative reference, their action together on disaster. > Take another example, from Thomson's charming episode, of Lavinia, By solitude, and deep surrounding shadesj But more, by bashful modesty^ concealed. Here, without the directive grouping of the dicoma at shades, and at modesty, the j)icture of Thot might be obscuredj and we should perhaps overlook the beautiful contrast between the uncon- scious and closer self-concealment, and that of the previously described humble and retired cottage in the vale. The following, from Co^\'}^er's picture of the Empres of Russia's Palace of Ice, in his ' Winter Morning Walk,' may be taken as an instance under this head. Less worthy of aplauso;? the more admired, Because a novelty, the work of man, Imperial Mistres of the fur-clad Russ^ Thy most maijnificent and mighty freak. The wonder of the North. The four parenthetic phrases in these lines, between applause and Muss, produce a slight intricacyj which requires the dicoma and its rest at these words, to bring togcthci', on the field of ateu- tion, the clause that precedes the former, and folows the latter ; and to make the impresive comparison between the works of na- ture, previously described, and this fantastic efort, in the works of art. I here remind the Reader that the use of the dicoma, in punc- tuative grouping is pointed out under the fourtli head of our ex- planation of the jnirposcs of this symbol; in bounding a ]>arcnthcsis, and directing ateution to the extremes of the included member ; THE GROUPING OF SPEECH. 235 for the punctuative reference; as well as tlie emphatic tie to he presently explained, is one of the aplications of the principle of parcnthotio elocution. In the folowing sentence, the punctuative grouping may give clearnes to the reading ; but this cannot reconcile us to the aM'k- wardnes of its disjointed syntax. After he was so fortunate as to save himself from^ he took especial care, never to fall again into^ the poluted stream of ambition. ]\Iueh more might here be properly said on the clasification of sentences, and on the time of pausing. With the Principle here exemjilifieil, furtlier inquiry is left to the discrimination and taste of others. Both reading and speech abound with ocasions for the use of this punctuative reference ; but care must be taken to avoid the afectation of its use, in gramatical arangements, where the style may be rendered perspicuous without it. "We have made a distinction between the Clausal limitation M'ithin the boundary of pauses, and this Punctuative grouping. The former keeps together sectional groups of conected thots ; the later brings together separated clauses and words, with their thots; and both unite their influence, for the just and expresive elocution of those parentheses, usualy bounded by the linear Dash. We have therefore dispensed with the use of this symbol ; its purpose being cfected, both in silent perusal and in speech, quite as efica- ciously, and with greater neatness to the eye, by the dicoma, with its punctuative reference; which suspends the mciining of tha- member preceding the first pause, for continuation, after the second. By the grouping of Emphasis or what is here called the Em- phatic Tie, I mean the apiication of stres, and perhaps in some cases, of vocality, quantity, and intonationj to words, not other- wise requiring distinction^ for joining those words and thots which cannot, by any other means of vocal syntax, be brought together- or exhibited in their true gramatical conection. The agency of this form of grouping, like that of the last, which we may now call the Punctuative Tic, is easily ])ercevedj for related words- however separated, are at once brought together in their real rela- tionships, within the field of hearing, whenever they are raised 236 THJ5 GROUPING OF SPEECH. into atractive Importance, by pause, or by force or other means of emphasis. The following lines, from Collins' 'Ode on the Passions/ embrace a construction, requiring the emphatic tie. When Cheerfulnes, a Nymph of healthiest hue, Her bow acros her shoulder flung, Her buskins gemm'd \yith morning dew, Blew an mspiring ai?-} that dale and thicket rung;} The hunter's call, to Faun and Dryad' known. . The last two lines have an embarassing construction. The phrases inspiring air, and hunter's call are in aposition ; but there intervenes a clause, that might make rung pass for an active verb, and thereby render call the objective to it. To show therefore, that by hunter-'s call the author means the inspiring air, pre- viously mentioned, the words marked in italics should receive emphatic stres. This is the best means for clearly impresing on the ear, that close relationship, which, is interupted by the con- struction. ^. ,■.,.'-]■ %;.a\ f./.;^ ,r.orir..r •■ ..This emphatic tie is often employed in combination with other means of grouping. In the several examples ilustrating the use of the phrases of melody, their influence will be asisted by aply- ing this conecting emphasis to comet and fires; children's and posed; peace and faith. In the examples of the flight, the rela- tionships between the words brook'd and easily; and between heaven hides nothing, and nor the deep tract of hell; and in the punctuative grouping, the reference of disaster to both foresee and prevent^ of concealment to shades and modesti/j and of mighty freak, to applausej will be more manifest, by the additional use of the emphatic tie. It is sometimes necesary to employ all the means of grouping upon a single sentence, for conecting an iregular syntax, and suply- ing an elipsis to the ear. The extreme distortion of English idiom in the folowing lines, must be excedingly perplexing to a reader ; and, far as I perceve the meaning and the graniar, can be rendered somewhat less embarassing, only by the use of all these means. The example is taken from the fourth book of Paradise Lost, at the end of Satan's addrcs to the sun. THE GROUPING OF SPEECH. 237 Thus while he spake, each pasionj dim'J his face Thrice chaiig'd with palej ire, envy, and despair; "Which mar'd his borow'd visage, and betray'd Him counterfeit, if any eye beheld. Milton uses the word pale, here, and again near the close of his tenth book, as a substantive. Its comon adjective-meaning tends to throw some confusion into the sentence. Ire, envy, and despair, are in aposition with pasion, and are severaly concordant witli the distributive pronoun each. The only maner in which I can aproxi- mate towards a clear representation of this blamable piece of latinity, is by making a quick flight over the portion, dim'd his face thrice changed with pale, and by an abatement thereon ; by laying a strong emphasis on each pasion, and on ii'e, envy, and despair, to mark the concord, by the emphatic tie ; by using the punctuative reference at pasion and pale; and by aplying the dicoma, with the mono- tone or the rising ditone, to both these words. After all, it is a hard picture to paint, for a taste that will have true colors, well laid-on. Perhaps another hand, under the direc- tion of our principles, may efect its expresion by some more apro- priate touch. In this and the preceding section, we have been more ocupied with the audible means of marking the thotive meaning of dis- course, than with the signs of expresion. But some meaning in language must always be embraced by what we distinctively caled the pasionative style. ' ^- ' ' "" I would here point out to the clasical scholar, a resemblance in the proces and purpose of the punctuative reference, and of the emphatic tie, to that of the circumspect atention, always exercised in construing a Latin sentence. The English language has few variable terminations of noun, pronoun, verb and adjectivej by which their concord and government might be instantly perceved, however the parts of speech might be in positicm disjoined from each other. In English tliereforc, as in some other languages, the eoastruction is indicated, principaly by the proximate, or what is calearts of this esay, tlie cx- emplifiaitions are chiefly extracted from two ilustrious Poets; and from some of those who, directed by the same great Principles of their Art, are next to them in the briglit brevity of the truthful and expresive Practice of it ; since the boundles r.uigc of their expresive reflectionsj the aresting, but resolvable intricacy of their THE RISING OCTAVE. 239 stylcj the thotful bearing of their emphasisj together with the in- sii^nificjiiice of scarcely a wortlj aford every variety of j)lain and of pa.'^ionative construction, for exercising the ful-suficient, and ilunii- nating jx>wer8 of the voice. And as the greater includes the less, I am persuaded, that should the principles therein esta])lishod be adoj)tetl by the Reader, he will have no great dificulty in aplying them, to more simple styles of conversation, of narative, and of impasioned discourse, both in poetry and prose. Yet when drawn aside, from the ]>erfection of Nature in the human voice, to eulo- gize the admirable things of intelect, which it is intended and ready to display ; let me again repeat j I have taken upon me, not the part of the Rhetorician, but merely of a Physiologist of Speech. SECTION XIV. Of the Interval of the Rising Octave, Ix the foregoing sections, the efect of Pitch was described, only as it is heard in the radical and vanishing movement thru the interval of a single tone. It was shown, under the head of the melody of simple Nara- tive style, that the vanish never rises above the interval of a tone ; and that changes of radical pitch, either upward or downward never excede the limits of this same interval. Now, such plain melody as then suposed is rarely found of long continuance ; but to avoid confusing the subject, I defered the notice of those vari- ations of concrete and of discrete interval, which are ocasionaly interspersed thruout its curent. Tlie wider intervals of jiitch used for Exjiresion in the course of a diatonic melody, are now to be described. By the term rising Octave, whether concrete or discrete, aplied to sjKjech, is meant the movement of the voice, from any asumed radicid place, thru higher parts of the scale, until it terminates in the eighth degree above that radical place. This interval is em- 240 THE RISING OCTAVE. ployed for interogative expression ; and for surprise, astonishment, and admiration, when they imply a degree of doubt or inquiry. It is further used, for the emphatic distinction of words. Nor is it limited to phrases, having the comon gramatical forms of a ques- tion ; for even declaratory sentences are made interogative by the use of this interval. The pitch in interogation, and emphasis, may sometimes rise both concretely and discretely, above the octave of the natural voice, and even into the falsetej still the octave is the widest in- terval of the speaking scale, technicaly regarded in this Work. It expreses therefore the most forcible degree of interogation, and of emphasis ; and is the pasionative interval for questions acom- panied with sneer, contempt, mirth, railery, and the temper or triumph of peevish or indignant argument. From the time required in drawing-out the concrete interval of an octave, this form of interogation can be executed conspicuously, only on a sylable of extended quantity. How then can the inter- ogative expresion be given to a short and imutable sylable ? The means for efecting this, will be described hereafter, with particular reference to interogative sentences. It may be here transiently ilustrated by the folowing notation : ——A — ^^^—f£ — cT — ^ — -/- In this diagram, after the first concrete rise of an octave, on a long sylablej a discrete change or skip is made from the line of its radiad, to a line along the hight of its vanish. Now imutable sylables, in an interogative sentence, are transfcred by this discrete or radical change, to a line of pitch at the sumit of the concrete interogative intervalj and discretely prcxluce tlie expresive efect of that interval, yet less remarkably than the indefinite sylables which pass the same extent of the scale by the concrete rise. As there are more short and unacentcd than long and ai'ented syla- bles in discourse, the radical change here described contributes largely to the character of an interogative intonation. The dia- THE RISING FIPTH. 241 gram shows, that after the radical pitch of a short quantity has asumeerience of those who gain knowledge from books, that what is worth reading at all, should be read more than once ; diferent parts of a system being OF INTERROGATIVE SENTENCES. 263 the best expositors of each other. The Student of Nature is al- ways, again and again, going over the Pandect of her self-explaining Volume. After some words about the late King, our extract from the dialogue begins hercj Hor. My lord, I think I saw him yester-night. Ham. Saw? who? Here seem to be two separate questions. The First is eliptical ; either for the declaratory iuterogative phrase, you sawf or for the comon question, did you seef and refers soley to the fact of an aparition : since Hamlet's thot is, for the moment exclusively directed to the impossibility of the King, his father, having been seen. The Second is ungramatically eliptical either for, saw whom? or for, whom did you see f and refers to tlie person of the aparition. By taking these as two separate questions, we are enabled to give more force and variety to their intonated expresion. They each expres astonishment and inquiry, the former predominating ; and this, we shall learn hereafter, calls for a wide downwardj and the question, for a wide rising interval. These diferent expresions in the first question are therefore conected and reconciled by the faling continued into the rising octave ; forming what we call the inverted wave. The astonished interogation of this wave, is then to be aplied to the first question sawf The second question, whof by an eror in case, is eliptical for, Who did you see ? It is not however, j^rojierly a declaratory word, requiring a rising interval ; as an inierogaiive pronoun, it does even when alone, always convey the meaning of a condition or question. But the question has already been emphaticaly made on saw f With a moderate joause after this word, the astonishment may therefore be expresed by an empluitic downward octave on who ; forming what will be de- scriljod hereafter, as the Exclamatorj- question. In this way, the expresion of these two words, both forcible and true, is efected with more variety, than if the same intonation were used on each. Hot. My lord, the King, your father. Ilam. Tlie King, my father ? This being a declaratory question, under a state of astonishment, 264 THE INTONATION calls for an impresive thoro interogation ; wliich may be made, as in the last case, by the invertetl wave of the octave on King ; and as the short quantity of the sylable/a, will not bear the prolongation of the wave, and perhaps, not even the simple rise of an emphatic octave, without deforming its pronunciation j the interogative ex- presion might be efected, by taking fa, at the curent level of the voice, and then rising with the?', by an upward skip of radical pitch, to the hight of an octave, as exemplified in the fourteenth section. Horatio having then detailed the circumstances of the Ghost's visitation, Hamlet asksj But where was this? What was said, in ilustrating the intonation of sentences con- structed with the adverb and pronoun, aplies here : for as the question emphatically regards the placej where must have either a simple interogative rise of an octave, or fifth, or a union of these respective intervals, in the form of an inverted wavej and, was this asumes the first duad form of the cadence. Mar. My lord, upon the platform where we watch'd. Ham. Did you not speak to it? This is a negative question. All that was said formerly of the examplej Hath not a Jew eyes, and of the other like cases, may be refered to, and aplied here; with the exception however, that the present question is less vehement, and therefore less confident in its asumed belief, and in the hope of an acording answer. The greater energy in the former case required the thoro expresion ; here, the interogative may be either thoro or partial, as Hamlet's asumed degree of belief may direct. If however, as it apears to me, there is, in the thot that Horatio should, yet might not have spoken to it, some pasing disposition to reproof on the part of Hamlctj the intonation should be partial, to expres the reproof, perhaps on the word not, by a positive downward interval. llor. My lord, I did ; but answer made it none. Ham. 'Tis very strange. Hor. As I do live, my honored lord, 'tis true. Ham. Indeed, indeed sirs, but this troubles me. Hold you the watch, to night? OF INTERROGATIVE SENTENCES. 265 This is a question of ix^al iiKjuirv, which by our goncral rule, ciills for the thoro intonation. 8till there may be another cause for it hero. Thinkiui; nu-n in their purposes, either good or bad^ if indeed, that exalted agent real tliinking ever stoops, as fictional tliot often does, to an unworthy purjwsej always have a motive for them. When therefore, Shakspeare makes the whole company at once, answer this question, we must supose it is to show, the ques- tion is not adressed to any one, but to all. Consequently, the in- terogative expresion should be thrown over the Avhole sentence, with a slight emphasis on, to night; the time being the unknown ; as liolding the watch, and the sentinels to be set, are the given quantities, so to speak, in the mind of Hamlet. All. We do, my lord. Nam. Arm'd, shv you? This is not strictly, a question of real inquiry. For Horatio having formerly described the king, ' arm'd at point, exactly, cap- i-pe,' Hamlet is aware of his having so apeared. Still, in cases where the mind is unprepared for a new impresion, and hardly receves itj Hamlet recurs, by the phrasej say you, to the former report by Horatio, and asks for a confirmation of it. This, from the colateral inference, being then a question of belief, might seem to call for the partial intonation. Yet as the thot comes back to Hamlet, with some surprise ; as an earnestnes is implied in the desire to have the former statement repeated ; and as the question consists of only three words, and those, important to the point, each should receve the interogative expresion. Ilor. Arm'd, my lord. Ham. From top to toe? This is a declaratory question, and requires the thoro interoga- tion. Hor. My lord, from head to foot. Ham,. Then saw you not his face? This is a negative question, with its lusumed degree of belief; yet as its temper is earnest; as the last word is emphatic, and 18 266 THE INTONATION requires an interogative interv^al, the whole question calls for the thoro expresion. Hor. ' O, yes, my lord ; he wore his beaver up. Ham. "What! Look'd he frowningly ? I cannot at once determine for myself, the grama tical character of the first word of this question : tho inclined to take it for an exclamation, rather than an interogative. In each case it must be considered an elijjsis ; in the former, perhaps for ichat a wonder ; in the latter for what was his apearance f As a pronominal interogaiory, it requires a wide rising interval ; and the folowing phrase, looked he frowningly , being a question of real inquiry, with the thoro expresion, we have unecesarily, and with seeming levity of voice, two consecutive interogations. In the other case, taking the pronoun as an eliptical exclamation, with a do\vnward fifth or octave, and a subsequent pause, the gravity of this interval would contrast agreeably with the thoro rising interogation, and give greater dignity to the whole expresion. Hor, A countenance more in sorrow than in anger. Ham. Pale, or red ? This is a declaratory eliptical question, and slionld receve a thoro interogative. But j)ei'haps we may find an overruling cause why it should take the partial. These words make an em- phatic contradistinction ; and as that distinction must be denoted by the voice, we would give to pale, a rising interogative; and to red, a downward positive intonation. Were the quantity of this last word greater, it might rccevc, with more j^ropricty, the direct wave ; its first or rising interval, moderating by its interogative efect, the positivenes of its downward termination. Yet even with the single intervals above proposed, the question is marked, and tlie w.ords are contradistinguislied, by an emphatic and varied intonation. This example forms one of the exceptions to the very general rule, tliat declarative questions should receve the thoro interogative expresion. Yet it is to be remarked in tliis case; the doubting disjun(!tive or, overrules, in a degree, its declaratory character. OF INTERROGATIVE SENTENCES. 267 Hot. Nay, very pale. Ham. And fixed his eyes on you ? This, if a question, is a declarative one ; and requires the inter- oo:ative intervals throuout. There seems nevertheles, to l)e an in- dication of belief in this sentence, which should make it an atirma- tive remark, requiring a downward intonation. If so, perhaps the question, as noted by the editor, is anuled, upon this colateral inferencej that a ghost apearing to a person, would very probably fix his eyes on him. Hor. Most constantly. Ham. I would I had been there. Hor. It would have much amazed you. //«m. Very like, very like. Staid it long? The last three words, are here the question ; and containing a real inquiiy, call for the thoro expresion. Hor. While one with moderate haste might tell a hundred. Mar. Ber. Longer, longer. Hor. Not w^hen I saw it. Ham. His beard was grizl'd ? No? Hor. It was, as I have seen it in his life, a sable silvered. There seems to be some dificulty in this last question. If the phraseology were completed thus : His beard was grizl'd, was it not? the case would be quite clear. For, taking the first phrase under this form, as a declaratory question, it would receve a thoro interogative intonation : the second, being a "proper gramatical question, with its rising intervals, and folowing the first, would have the propriety and force of an emphatic repetition of the question, under a negative and apealing form. But when, as in the dialogue, the construction of the last phrase is reduced by elipsis, to the mono.sylable no, and both the phrases are then made intonated question.s, it renders in some degree, the elocu- tion awkward, and the meaning obscure. Every edition of Shak- spcare I have examined, makes each of these phrases, a separate interogation. If they are so, the first is a declarative question, and therefore mu.st have the rising interval on eveiy word ; i\o, being always declarative must have that meaning anuled by its rising interval. The question having however, been distinctly 268 THE INTONATION expresed by the first phrase, an endeavor to enforce it, nnder this brief monosylabic construction, would produce only an inefectual vocal repetition. For a single interogative interval on the word no, that in meaning and gramar never conveys a doubt, does not here, give the impresion of the question, which is efected, by a like interogative intonation, on the above proposed and full gram- atical question, was it not f If the Reader will give a thoro ex- j3resion to these two diferent forms of the sentencej His beard was grizl'd ? no ? and j His beard was grizl'd ? was it not ? he will perceve in the laterj the inquiry is clearly enforced, by its repeti- tion under the diferent form of a negative apeal ; in the former, there is some verbal contrariety and consequently an undetermined character in the elocution. For in this case it might seem, with- out due reflection, that Hamlet having first inquired whether the beard was grizled, imediately ansAvers his own question, by a dec- laration that it was not. But taking this single word acording to the text, as a question, even a wide interogative interval on no, has not the power to destroy entirely, the usual and strongly declara- tive meaning of this negative monosylable. And this produces, a confusion, which the full gramatical question^ was it not, would entirely obviate. There is another view to be taken of this example ; for Elocu- tion is a curent of divided, and sometimes diverging streams. The phrase. His beard was grizl'd, may be taken as a positive afirmation by Hamlet, from a full recolection of its living color, and used as aditiojial means of identifying the aparition with his father. In this case, it should have the downward intonation of a comon asertion. The phrase being so regarded, Hamlet seems, for a moment, to question his own conviction ; and thereupon, by the declaratory question, no, here an elipsis for^ was it not grizl'd ? asks Horatio, by a rising fifth or octave, on this negative mono- sylable, if it was not so. My own ear and reflection incline me to this maner of treating the example. But under ignorance of the full verbal and mental analysis of the subject, the two parts of the sentence, being universaly marked as real and separate ques- tions, I did, on that condition, in the first case, propose for them, what seemed to me a suitable intonation. To the scientific and practical Artist-Reader of another age, OF INTERROGATIVE SENTENCES. 20 9 skilod in the principles, and if we may so speak, in tlie design, liulit and shade, color, and perspective, of Elocution, wc may predict: that without some further discernment, or a change of language, in ids day, the structure of this sentence will never alow a quite satisfactory intonation. As however, Hamlet must speak from recolection, I would propose, acording to the maner just described, to make the first clause a simple asertion, with a downward intonation ; and no, with a wide interogative intervaj. Yet this, from the influence of the usualy unconditional meaning of no, does not satisfy me ; and perhaps it is only a poor apology for my own inability, to sayj the sentence, however it might be vocaly That, should never have been writen, to be read aloud, or spoken ; and tho awake to a conventional expresion, yet here, Shakspeare, the Actor, slept. I have said little on the emphatic words, and other points in these questions ; and have only ocasionaly noted the extent of the intervals ; the object being, to describe some of the forms of partial and thoro interogation, and the general character of their expresion ; tho it may here be remarked, that nearly all Horatio's answers should have thruout, the downward interval of a third or fifth, acording to the degree of expresion required : the intonation being apropriate to the solemnity of the scene, the confidence of the answers, and to the seriousnes with which Horatio sympathizes with the wonder of Hamlet. Add to the propriety of this down- ward movement, the contrast with the earnestnes of the rising intervals of Hamlet's comon and declaratory questions. Perhaps in the last example, the several answers of Horatio and the two oficers, having taken an argumentative and more familiar turn, the intonation should be enlivened by a mingling use of proper rising intervals. Among the purposes of this Work, the title-page anounces, its design to render criticism in elocution, inteligible, thru the study, and j)romulgati()n of its system and princijiles. I have therefore aimed to show, by the preceding explanatory criticisms, how these principles may bo aplied ; leaving others, with competent knowl- edge, and an observant industry to make particular aplications for themselves. Personal Authority has always laid such a stupefying weight on the human mindj it is hoped this book may be consulted, 270 THE INTONATION only for those submited principles which observation, experiment, and well-watched thinking, may hereafter confirm ; and not as critical opinions intended by the author, only to ilusti*ate his subject; an ilustration being often, no more than an analogy to the meaning of a proposition, not an examplary proof of it. We have another instance of the thoro intonation, produced by an excited state of mind, in the retort of Cleopatra, to Proculeius, the friend of Csesar. Know, sir, that I Will not wait pinioned at your master's court; Nor once be chastised with the sober eye Of dull Octavia. Shall they hoist me up, And show me to the shouting varletry Of censuring Rom,e 9 Kather a ditch in ^gypt Be gentle grave unto me. The repulsive indignation of this question cannot be fairly rep- resented, without an earnest degree of interogation. As there seems however, to be some implied apeal, in the word, shallj it might be suposed, the question is one for partial intonation. But under this, or any other exceptive condition, the pasionative state of mind would overrule it. Should the last sylable of a question be emphatic, and its into- nation not directed to tlie partial expresion by the preceding rules, particularly that, regarding the seriesj the last sylable bears tlie interogative interval. Should the sentence be short, or consist of a single member, the expresion will have a thoro aplication. In the dialogue between the murderers of Clarence, the second speaker exclaims and asksj What, shall we stab him as he sleeps? From the answer of his companion it is plainj the question points at the act of sleeping, and this protluces an interogative emphasis on the last word. Had the inquiry been whether the victim should be stabbed, or otherwise put to dcatli, the word stab would carry the emphatic intonation, and the sentence might end with a diatonic cadence. It will be shown in a future section on Exclamatory sentences, that a phrase, with the gramatical form of a question, yet having ! OF INTERROGATIVE SENTENCES. 271 tlio intorogative purpose overruled hy oolatoral influences, is not properly cxpresed by rising intervals, but by a contrary movement. Having brought the subject of thoro and of partial interrogative intonation, into something like a describable form, I leave the corection of its erors, and the amplifying of its aproved hints, as a work for the beter ear, and closer attention of others. Let as analyze more particularly, the maner of employing the interogative intervals on individual sylables. Prefatory' to this investigation, it is necesary to consider the rad- ical and vanishing movement, when aplied to short and imutiible sylables. In the second section I described the means by which the various concretes may be exemplified on long quantities; and there aserted, that no sylalile however short, can be utercd without pasing thro the radical and vanish, under some form of intonation. Per- haps the Reader is now prepared to receve proof, that the concrete does rapidly pass by wider intervals, even on immutable sylables. We will suppose, he is familiar with the interogative expresion of a slow concrete rise by a third, fifth, and octave, on prolonged sylables. Then let him pronounce the i mutable sylable top, without meaning or pasion ; and again, as an earnest question. He will perceve, in the last case, that however quickly utered, it will still have the peculiar interogative expresion. This interogative ex- presion, on the slow time of an indefinite sylable, is audibly and measurably made by the wider interval of the fifth or octave ; and as there is no other means for producing concretely this interogative efectj the inference is fair, that the voice in producing that same efect on a short sylable, must have pa.sed, however rapidly by one of those wider intervals. For it cannot in this case, procede from a peculiar voeality ; nor from an impresive degree of force ; and that it is not produced soley by a radical skip of the sylable to a high place of pit<'h, may be heard in the folowing experiment. Let the Reader rise step by step thru the musical scale, on the word top', taking care to give it no more than the concrete of a second at each degree : yet with this discrete rise to any hight, there will be no interogative efect. To what then is this effect, on an imutable sylable to be ascribed, if not to a momentary concrete flight of the \'o\QXi, on an interogative interval? The audible efect justifies the conclusion ; tho the increments of time and sj)ac(! on 272 THE INTONATION the scale, so distinctly perceptible in the slower concrete, are on the imutable sylable, altogether beyond measurement. From this view of the diference in time of the radical and vanish, on indefinite and on imutable sylables ; and with reference to the uses of their diferent times in the intonation of interogative sentencesj let us call the measurable movement of the voice thru an indefinite sylable, the Slow Concrete : and its momentary flight thru a short and an imutable one, the Rapid Concrete. It apears by the trials above proposed, that the interogative efeet is producible on the shortest sylables; and similar experi- ments warant the general conclusion, that every interval of the scale in whatever time, is practicable on every sylabic quantity of speech. It is however to be remarked that the rapid flight of the wider intervals thru short sylables, compared with their slow move- ment on the indefinite, has a feeblenes of interogative expresion, directly proportional to its rapidity ; and consequently, that the slow and distinctly measurable concrete on indefinite sylables pro- duces a more marked impresion on the ear. Yet it is desirable that the thoro expresion should be equaly diffused over the sen- tence ; and as all sylables have not sufficient length, to bear the slow and most impressive interrogative concrete, it follows that other means besides those already described, must be employed on short sylables, for effecting with uniformity, the intonation of a question. The means for strengthening the comparative feeble- ness of interrogative expression on short sylables, consists in raising them, by change of radical jMtch, by the interrogative interval, to the line at the summit of the slow concretes on in- definite quantities; as the following notation of an instance of thorough expression will exemplify. Give Bru tus a sti^t- — -uo with his an ces tors ? j=rjf=i/-j=J=:/= p^ £ f Eg In this case tlie interrogative intonation is made by tiie fifth on every sylable. On the iirat two, which are indefinite and emphatic, the slow and measurable concrete is used. The third beiue: iramut- OF intp:rrogative sentences. . 273 able, cimnot bear tlie slow concrete ; the j)itcli is therefore sud- denly transfered by radical chanj^e to the hio;ht of the precedinji; vanish ; where, at the stimc moment, the sylablc takes on the rapid concrete o£ the fifth as represented by the diminished syinbol. The melody continues at this hight, on all the following unemphatic sylables, or which, if cm])hatic as may be said of stat, are of im- mutable quantity. From /roar of a thousand brutal throats; and tho cautious absence of a ' non-comiltal' 284 THE CHROMATIC The semitone is employed for moderate degrees of expresion ; and rarely for great energy, harshnes, or violence of pasion. It afects generaly a slow time and long quantity. The interjeetive exclamations of jjain, grief, love, and compassion, are prolonga- tions of the several tonic elements on this interval. The effect however of its rapid concrete is distinctly perceptible, on the short time of imutable sylables. For it will be found by experiment, that the word cup, with other imutables, can be utered with a plaintive intonation, even in its shortest time. As this plaintis^e- nes, so distinctly measurable on short quantity, is always produced by the concrete semitone, and not by any other known interval^ it may be fairly concluded, that when heard on an imutable sylable, the semitone is rapidly performed, even tho the gradual course of its time and motion is imperceptible; showing the plaintive use of the semitone, to be within the general laAV of intonationj and that every interval is heard, in both the slow and the rapid concrete, as the diferent times of sylables direct. In the next section, we shall learn the uses of the downward vanishing movement. It is necesary however, to consider here transiently, the downward vanish of the semitone ; this being one of the constituents of the chromatic melody of speech, now to be described. The downward radical and vanishing semitone may be exem- plified on the scale, by pasing from the eighth to the seventh on the word fire, as one sylablej and descending, alternately by the subdivisions fi and yer to the second, where the single sylable is again to be used. The concrete movement on the single sylable fire, from the eighth degree to the seventh has a plaintive expres- ion ; whereas the movement on the same sylable, from the second to the first, has quite a diferent character. When therefore the republican police. After the Imperial Roman had robed-out every Treasury, ever}- Temple, and every private purse, within reach of his qnarelsome and ruthless sword, his avaricious courage failed ; and the i3arbarian came back, and down upon him in righteous revenge. We, by rapacious Treaties, and Civilized Craft, are pursuing and exterminating the Native Indian from his Land. But Hah ! with retributive justice, he seems, in the forced submi.sion of his retreat, to have tlirown to the winds, his gros and unlawed temper; which now, like a national malaria, is spreading an avenging savagism among his conquerors. MELODY OF SPEECH. 285 voice rises on the single sylable, concretely by the semitone, at the summit of the scale, and imediately in continuation descends by it, this repetition of the interval must prolong the plaintive imprcsion. As the pathetic state which dictiites the semitone usualy afects a slow time, and an extension of sylabie quantity, the expresion is generaly made by continuing its upward into its downward con- crete, in the form of a Wave. This answers two important pur- poses. It denotes more impresively the state of mind, by a repe- tition of the interval, and in extending the equable concrete in the line of contrary flexure, alows a prolongation of voice, without its liability to pass into the protracted radical or protracted vanish of song. The expresive efect of this doubled semitone may be ex- emplified on the word fire, as a single sylable, by making an ime- diate return in the downw'ard direction, on the subtonic r, after ascending from the seventh to the eighth of the scale on the tonic i of that word: for this exactly resembles the plaintive uterance of a prolonged sylabie time in speech. The states of mind expresed by the semitone, are sometimes re- stricted to individual words ; sometimes they extend over phrases and sentences, and even thruout discourse. These last ocasions, requiring the semitone on every sylable, necesarily produce a melody consisting of a continued sucesion of that interval. We learned in the eighth section, that the curent of the Diatonic mel- ody is formed by sucesions of sylabie pitch on the interval of a whole tone. The curent movement we are now describing, being by the sylabie pitch of a semitone, may be caled the Semitonic or, termed in music, the Chromatic Melody. Ijike the former, it is subdivided into the curent melody, and the melody of the cadence. Its course may be resolved into seven Phrases, similar to those in the diatonic progres. Yet the change by radical pitch in the chro- matic curent, a.s it apears to me, being by the interval of a tone, only when it descends, and not when it ascendsj the use of the nomenclature must be pardoned, when I denote the several semi- tonic phrases by the terms asigncd to those of the diatonic melody. There is in the Chromatic Melody of speech, as in the Diatonic, neither Key, nor Modulation. A similar use of the seven phrases at the pimctuative rest, for cf)ntinuing, susp;;n& Second. J third J fifth or t octave. f Second ■ a Semitone. J ^^ird J fifth or V. octave. The thiril con- stituent being either a ■ an Octave. r Semitone /- 2d 3d or 5th. I second J Sem. .3d or 5th. ^ third or \ Sem. 2d or 5th. (fifth. ( Sem. 2d or 3d. a Fifth. a Third. -a Second. {Semitone second tliird or octave. /• Semitone J second \ fifth or (^ octave. f Semitone I third S fifth or (^ octave. /' Second a Semitone.^ ffor (^ octave. /'2d 3d or 8th. ' Sem. 3d or 8th. I Sem. 2d or 8th. [^Sem. 2d or 3d. r2d 5th or 8th. I Sem. 5th or 8th. Sem. 2d or 8th. ^ Sem. 2d or 5th. - 3d 5th or 8th. Sem. 5th or 8th. Sem. 3d or 8th. Sem. 3d or 5th. 3d 5th or 8th. 2d 6th or 8tii. 2d 3d or 8th. 2d 3d or 5th. 21 314 THE WAVE OF THE VOICE. From a comprehensive view of this table it is manifest^ there might be other methods of aranging its details. Each of the dis- tinctions given above might be taken as tlie generic heads of the wave ; and the others might be included as species. We might take the five intervals, for heads of as many divisions, and under each, for instance the octave, consider. First; the equal form of this interval, and its combination with other intervals into the unequal form ; Second ; its direct and inverted, and Third, its single and double forms. Or we might take the distinction into single and double for the two generic heads, and under each of these, enumerate the species, as being equal or unequal, direct or inverted : and so of any otlier asumed order of these distinctions. I shall, acording to the arangement in the table, divide the phenomena of the wave into two great clases, the Equal and Unequal, and subdividing each of these by the terms of the five intervals of the scale, shall under the heads of these intervals, consider the direct and inverted, the single and double forms. The pains taken to define the technical terms of this esay, to- gether with the exemplification by diagram, in the second section must have rendered all the movements on the scale, quite familiar to those who realy desire to learn. Tlie description of the wave may therefore be so easily comprehended, that without a further notation, the Reader can readily picture its various forms, as we shall hereafter aply them. To learn the purpose, and expresion of the wave, let us recol- ect that it is compounded of a rising and a faling interval, the several characteristics of which have already been described. It will therefore be found, that the Avavc 2)artakes respectively of the expresion of its various constituents : and further, that its con- tinuous line of contrary flexures enables the voice to cary on a long quantity, without the risk of faling into the protracted into- nation of song. The expresion of the wave in all its forms, is modified by the aplication of stress to diferent parts of its course; at the begining, or at the end, or at the place of junction of its constituents. THE EQUAL WAVE OF THE OCTAVE. 315 SECTION XXVI. Of the Equal Wave of the Octave. The Equal AVavc of the Octave is made by a movement of the voice, in its ujnvard, and continuously into its downward interval. It may be either single, consisting of two constituents ; or double, consisting of three ; tho this double form is scarcely used. It may also be difercntly constructed, by the first constituent ascending, and the second descending, forming the dircctj and by a reversed sucesion, the inverted wave. The equal wave of the octave in its single form is rarely em- ployed in serious discourse. If used in the lower range of pitch, to avoid the sharpnes of the falsete, it gives an apropriate ex- presion to the highest state of astonishment, admiration and com- and. When it asumes the higher range, as it is apt to do, it loses its dignity as an impresive sign. Children sometimes employ it for mockery in their contentions and jests. Its double form ha.s the same exprcsion, under a more continued quantity. The re- verse order of its constituents gives a diferent character, respect- ively to its single-direct, and to its single-inverted turns ; for the later by ending in an upward concrete, has the intonation of a question, under what we called the Interogative Wave ; the former, by a downward final movement, has the positivencs and surprise of the simple faling intervals. When the direct and the inverted wave of the octave is respectively double, the rule of final expresion will be reversed ; for the double-direct will then end with the rising or interogative movement. The double form of the wave, particularly of the octave, claims atention rather as a part of our physiological history, than as a subject of oratorical ])ropriety and taste ; and may, in point of use and expresion, be rather clased with theatrical outrages, and vulgar mouthings. 316 THE EQUAL WAVE OF THE FIFTH. SECTION XXVII. OJ the Equal Wave of the Fifth. Enough has been said of intervals, to explain the Equal Wave of the Fifth. Its name is descriptive of its structure. Nor need it be shown particularly of this, nor indeed of the suceding sec- tional heads of the wave, in what maner the single and double, the direct and inverted forms are made. The equal wave of the fifth, is used as one of the means of emphatic distinction ; and has therein an expresion varying with its form. The equal-single-direct wave of the fifth consists of an ascending and a descending concrete ; the first expressive of in- terogation, and the last of positiveues and surprise. But a junc- tion of these oposite constituents takes in a great degree, from the rising, its indication of a question ; and leaves to the faling, the full character of its positivenes and surprise. There is however, another efect of this junction, besides the overruling of interoga- tion. When a state of mind requiring the simple downward fifth is grave or dignified, it is expresed by prejoining the rising fifth j to form a direct wave ; and this direct wave is used instead of the simple fall, to give time to the sylable that beare it; for should the emphatic sylable require an extended quantity, the wave takes the place of the simple interval, which under unskilful intonation might, in the efort to extend it, pass into the protracted radical, or vanish of song. The inverted wave of the fifth has the compound expresion of surprised interogation, produced by the termination of its last con- stituent in the upward vanish. And it apoarsj the direct wave of this, as well as of other wider intervals, retiiins a degree of intero- gation ; and the inverted, a degree of positivenes and surprise. There is not much diference between the expresion of the single, and of the double wave of the fifth, except what arises from a change of structure by the adition of a third constituent. The double-direct here assumes an interogative expression, from the vanishing rise of its last constituent; and the double-inverted has THE EQUAL WAVE OF THE THIRD. 317 the moaning of surprise from its downward termination. Perhaps there is a little scorn conveyed by the double form of the equal wave of the fifth. This is certainly the case when the last con- stituent receves greater strcs than the others. On the whole how- ever, this double form is not very frequently used as a sign of expresion. SECTION XXVIII. OJ the Equal Wave of the Third. The Equal Wave of the Third, in the degree of its expresion, bears such a relation to the equal wave of the fifth, as the simple rise of the third bears to the simple rise of that interval. In all its forms, whether single or double, direct or inverted, the expresion resembles respectively, but in a more moderate de- gree, that of the diferent species of the equal wave of the fifth. From its less impresive character, it is more frequently employed for emphasis in the admirative and reverentive style, than the fifth and the octave, which arc especialy apropriate to the earncstnes of coloquial dialogue, and to the pasionative intonations of the drama. It also serves, like the other waves, to extend the quantity of syla- bles in deliberate and dignified discourse; and to preserve, at the same time, the characteristic equable-concrete of speech. The equal wave of the Minor third, we have said is not ad- mLssible into speech ; but if improperly introduced, as it often is, the efect of its inverted form does not difcr much from that of its direct. 318 THE EQUAL WAVE OP THE SECOND. SECTION XXIX. Oj the Equal Wave of the Second. We have now to consider the equal wave of the second, which, if ever the time for a Natural, and thereupon a Scientific System of Elocution shall come to pass, will be regarded as a very impor- tant and interesting part of intonation. The dificulty of perspicuously defining and dividing the details of a subject, altogether as new to the author himself, as to his Reader ; and of giving a full description of parts that are element- ary and closely related, and that must be sucesively explained, obliged him to procede in the maner of gradual and partial de- velopmentj of changeful arangementj and of frequent reconsidera- tion, which produced this first, and so fiir, only full and instructive method of Analytic Elocution. In improving, or completing many of those sucesive systems of Science, which thru years or cen- turies, have been progresively extended, retrenched, and simplifiedj method after method has been adopted, altered, and rejected ; and every subsequent observer, knowing the atempts and failure of his predecesors, has been enabled to suply the deficiencies, and corect the erors of former clasifications. For plan and purpose, in this ofered system of intonation, there was no preceding out- line either of fiction or of truth ; no instructive sketches of cor- ected erors, to save the author from his own ; and as yet, even no friendly-enmity of criticism to ' pluck ' them from his pages and ' throw them in his face.' He was therefore at first, and has been, in preparing suceding editions, obliged to ask the arduous, but wiling asistance of his own endeavors, to suply his oversights, and corect his faults : too often a vain and fruitles labor.* In acord- * "What is here said of the kindly slaps of criticism is no longer literally true ; thanks to the friendship of enmity ; fur it has corected our over-estimate of the intelectual capacity of the old elocutionist. I may differ from some of my Readers, who beleve that truth and jus^tice can never lose thoir dignity, however they may descend to the comonality of persons and things ; yet I am wiling, under the privilege of a Note at least, to make, if it so seems, a sacrifice of dignity and taste to a humorous thot, reminding mo that in THE EQUAL WAVE OF THE SECOND. 319 ance with the maner of Dividing and Instructing here employed, our acount of the diatonic melody, regardc threw the whole Work itself ' to the dogs; ' not consideringj how quick an ear these animals have for the high and low, long and short, strong and weak, harsh and gentle, and particularly for the barking abruptnes in the human voice. We wait to see whether trusty Ponto can make more of the subject than his distrusted Master. 320 THE EQUAL WAVE OF THE SECOND. bles ; the direct or inverted wave, on all that are at the same time of long quantity, either acented or emphatic ; and where the prin- ciple of the faint rapid concrete, on short and unacented sylables is aplied even to the interval of the second. High on a throne of roy al state, which far f^d 4 t^ ■•^♦v A 1 Out— — shone the wealth of Or mus and of Ind, ^ •^ • • ^ • ^ ^^^ ^ ^ • \_y • Or where the gor geous East with rich-est hand 4 <^^ ^4 • tt ^^^ \ \ \ Show ers on her Kings bar — ba — ric pearl and gold, i-^n. fx ^ 4~i fN «r Sa tan ex — alt — — ed sat. K -4 •^ ^ ^ ^ This is a fine pasagc of descriptive poetry : and the intonation here directed, seems, to me at least, upro})riate to its character. There is great grandeur in the generic thought of the Ocjision ; the language is richly imprcsivc, and the comparisons, striking and magnificent. But the description is not ])romptod by that excited state which we distinguished, as pa.sionative : nor should it excite that condition in the mind of an audience. The subject is pre- THE EQUAL AVAVE OF THE SECH:)ND. 321 seuteil by the narator, for dignified and grave atention. We are invited to look up at the 'bad eminence' of this royal exaltation, and behold the splendor, surounding a superhuman greatncs. It is however, only the Stil-life of the imperial Throne, and has not aa yet arouzed a ]>asion. The poet, without himself stooping to overcome the beholder with the vulgar disturbance of wonder, elevates his pic^ture to the refined and inter-thotive state of admi- ration. For this requires no wider rising and faling thirds or fifths or octaves ; no semitones ; no florid waves ; no tremors, nor percusive acentsj in short, no excesive nor extraordinary use of vocal ity, time, force, abruptnes or pitch. The diagram shows the simple upward or the downward rapid concrete, on all the short and unacental sylables; and the direct or inverted wave of the second, on the long and acented. The feeble cadence is set on the word gold, as this terminates the description of the Throne, but not the sentence ; which is finally closed by the faling triad : and this is made more complete, by the radical descent of a third on the sylable tan, forming the Prepared cadence : which however, by the continuation of the text, is not here required. I have so aranged the intonation, as to give variety to the curent of the melody. The prevailing phrase of radical pitch is the monotonej whether the concrete rises or falls, or the wave is direct or invertedj yet this line is broken ocasionaly by the rising and faling ditone. The phrase of the monotone here used, is strictly apropriate to that deliberate and solemn style, formed by ading what we have caled the inter-thoughtive signs, to narative or descriptive dis- course. And tho we cannot, consistently with' our phrase, narative thot, properly ascribe expresion to the monotone, yet we perceve, it has a remarkable character.* * Sometimes a subject is more clearly viewed, in the broad li,2;bt of its con- trary. Let our extract then be read in the Falseto, with every kind of inter- val and wave, mintjling as if they had been given us, only to run up and down the voice, and tumble over sylables, without a steady regard to thOt or expresion. Such outrages always raise their contrasts; and we close our ears upon the nuisance, to supose the lines, utercd in a full orotund, with a well adjusted intonation of the diatonic melody, by a Garrick or a Booth. It may perhaps be too ludicrous an ilustration, even for a Note: but just think of that reverentive Anthem; ' Before Jehovah's Awful Throne,' sung by u single Soprano, with the acomj)animcnt of a fife and a violin ! 322 THE EQUAL WAVE OF THE SECOND. I have refered to the necesary use of the rapid concrete, on short and unacented sylables, in the diatonic melody ; and in tlie admi- rative here ikistrated ; when this style is designed to be impres- ively deliberate, there may be a slight extension in the time of the rapid concrete. If cautiously guarded against drawling on imu- table sylables, it softens the contrast between the slow and the rapid quantities, gives a varied unity to the vocal curent, and smoothly extends and leads the concrete towards the wave. . And this under the impresive subsonorous fulnes of the orotund, will at some after time, give to the then instructed Speaker himself, and his enlightened audience, that inteligent satisfaction, which must surely flow from the analytic and esthetic principles of an exalted style of epic, dramatic, and not merely a church, but a God-with-Nature adoring elocution. I am left so alone with my subject, that it is social even to feign a companion. I therefore supose the Reader may with me, recolect, that the imediate sucesion of the rising and the faling ditone, forms what was caled the phrase of Alternation. When this is employed in a curent melody, the constant variation of the radical pitch, to- gether with a short sylabic time, and a use of the simple concrete, broadly distinguishes its efect, from that of a long quantity and the monotone, in the preceding example. The folowing notation of the description of Abdiel's encounter with Satan, in Milton's sixth book, will ilustrate the character, we must not call it the expresion of the alternate melodial phrase. So 7 — ing, & no ble stroke he lift — ed high, 44-^^4- Which hung not, but so swift with tern pest fell Y~trf~*~Vir^ THE EQUAL WAVE OF THE SECOND. 323. On the proud crest of ISa tun, that no sight, gr^^-giz-v-jL , 4 ^i ^ Nor mo tion of swift th6t, less could his shield, 4-^ _ a3ZI'Z*I'Z533: Such ru in in tor ccpt. 4-4^ On f'om])aring this with the preceding diagram, we find a pre- dominance of monotones, in tlie former, and of the alternation in the later ; the line of the monotone in the former, being broken by an ociisional ditone ; and the alternation in the later by an oca- sional monotone. In the example before us the active character of the description asuraes a varying radical pitch, suitable to the vigorous ])liraseology of the Poet. Consistently, as it seems to me, with the language, and with the rapid energy of the scene, I liave set the wider interval of the third, only on four sylables ; and the wave of the second, on four : nor should these intonations have more than a limited quantity. The Fourth or Feeble form of the cadence is set on the last sylable of saying : the phrase, as the sequel to an antecedent declaration, being slightly terminative. All the rest of the intervals are simple rising and faling rapid concretes, and are well acomodated to the drift of the descrip- tion. The ciirnest purpose of the action does not alow a full and * The three early editions of ' The Philosophy of the Human Voice ' have the epithet quick, instead of swift tlwt. How this oversight occurred I cannot tellj yet it was not until preparing the fourth, and coni])aring our examples with the originals, that the error was discovered. For my own reading, I might draw a motive, both from intonation and from rhetoric, why I regret the discovery. But this does not concern the criticism or taste of otiiers. 324 THE EQUAL AVAVE OF THE SECOND. reposing cadence on intercept. I have therefore used a tripartite form, and given the first two constituents, rising concretes. There is a wider range of pitch in the melody ; for tho the radicals are still proximate in their sucessions, their course embraces a greater extent on the staff, and produces a lively contrast with each other. All these conditions give to the lines before us, a character very diferent from that of the former example. A prevalence of the monotone here, might perhaps represent the dignified courage, and calm security of an agressor confident of suces ; but it would be misaplied and faded coloring, for the fictional picture of huried watchfulnes and dreadful expectation, which the description of this descending impetus is calculated to excite. It is true, the above lines are only descriptive of a super-human action. But it seems to be a rule of sympathy in such cases, that he who de- scribes, should himself, in his verbal picture of the scene, take-on to a degree, the state of mind, which he aims to excite in others. The former of the above ilustrations, is purely in the diatonic melody : and tho the later is strictly descriptive, still its character either calls for, or admits the rising and faling thirds asigned to it ; at the same time it afords an example of the use of wider inter- vals in the diatonic current. Others may tliinkj still wider into- nations might be employed. Let it be as they wish. I here propose to set-forth the principles of an art, not to prevent the free-choice of Taste in the thotful aplication of them. In any case however, a diference of opinion on the last example may serve to show how dificult it is, nicely to divide the expresive, from the non-expresive in speech. What is here said of the use of the direct wave of the second, in ading dignity, reverence, and solemnity to a diatonic melody, is also true of its inverted form. I am not awarej the double-equal wave of the second has a character diferent from that of its single form, except what may arise from extending the quantity of sylables. An unusual pro- longation of quantity in the diatonic melody, instinctively produces the double wave ; for the voice may take this serpentine course, thru the second, without producing any unj)leasant snarl, similar to the efect of the double wave on some of the wider intervals. There is what we called a Continued wave, or a progres of the ! THE EQUAL WAVE OF THE SECOND. 325 line of contrary flexures beyond the term of three constituents. It is only on the time of an equal wave of the second in a diatonic mclodv, and of a semitone in the cliromaticj this continued exten- sion, if at all, is alowable. Should some extraordinary state of reverence or other solemnity require an unusualy long quantity ; and should the time of an indefinite sylable not be exhausted, when the voice has pasod over the three constituents of the double wavej it must if still continued, necesarily be caried-on either in the note of song, or in further flexures of the wave. AVhen it takes the course of the flexures, the bad efect of the former case will be avoided ; nor will this multiplied repetition of the rise and fall, by this small interval of a tone, produce any positive or unpleasant impresion.* I have ascribed an importance to the subject of this section, because it is the foundation of a very general principle in elocution. The Reader will now perhaps admit the propriety of our distinc- tion l)ctwecn the efect of a narrative melody formed by a varied rise and fall of the voice thru the interval of a tonej and that })roduced by the ocasional introduction of other and wider inter- vals, constituting what was distinctly caled Expresion. Very few speakers are able to execute this plain melody, in the beautiful simjjlicity of its diatonic construction. Some constantly execute their current, in the simple rise of a third, a fifth, or a semitone, or give every emphatic sylable in an impresive form of their waves. Perhaps these faults proceei -) si — -lence bp- —fore him. €\ 4 4 4 «-^ ar\ ^ ir> • ) • • w V « The curent of this notation is diatonic, except, aZ?, which has the unequal-direct wave of the second and third, or it might be the fifth. It is seen that some of the short and unacented sylables have a moderate length of wave ; giving to the whole, the fulest degree of dignified prolongation : in this extension, however, the Reader must use his taste and discretion, to prevent awkwardnes or afcctation. Of the two sentences, the feeble cadence is set at the first, and the Full, closes the last. Xo one without inquiry on this subject, can be aware of the un- pretending yet dignified force, the diversified sucesion, and severe simplicity of the diatonic melody, when conducted on the principles of the radical change, formerly laid yond the aspirated structure of the single-equal wave. Tliere is a peculiar expresion of the unequal wave, described in the section on Chromatic melody, forming an exception to the general character of scorn, above ascribed to it. I refer to its em- ployment for chromatic interogation. In this case it is necesary to give, on the same sylable, both a plaintive and an interogative expresion ; and this can be acompli.shed, only by subjoining to the last constituent of the equal-direct wave of the semitone, or to the last constituent of its double-inverted form, the rise of the third, or fifth, or octave. But the double and other forms of the unequal wave, cease to be expresive of scorn, by withholding the aspiration, and the gutural vibration from their last constituent. The unequal wave may form the cadence of a chromatic melody, on one sylable. Here the voice rises by the interval of a semitone, and then finally descends concretely a third or fifth. This intona- tion however, from its peculiar expresion, is unsuitable to the repose required in the cadence : for it expreses, particularly if en- forced by stres, plaintive or querulous surprise : and consequently, is admisible on the last long quantity of a chromatic sentence, only when it conveys this state of mind. Should the stres be increased with an aspirated close, it would give the expresion of querulous scorn. As all the forms of the wave especialy require sylables of in- definite time, it is obvious, why long quantities are necesary in giving full dignity to speech, for these alone are capable of bear- ing the wave ; dignity of expresion being an efect of the wave of wider intervals, on gravely emphatic words, and of the wave of the second and semitone, in the respective curents of the diatonic and chromatic mekxly. AVith the light of this principle, the Header may perceve on what defensible ground, it was formerly maintained, that the majestic movement of the first line of the second book of Paradise Lost, is shocked by the limited and insuficient quantity of the word state. Iligh on a throne of Koyal aiaie which far 332 THE WAVE OF UNEQUAL INTERVALS. All the acented sylables of this line, except statey are of indefi- nite time, and will bear the equal wave of the second. The same is true of nearly all the sylables in the three suceding lines of the text : and with the exception here noted, the whole m ad- mirably fitted, by its time, for the vocal representation of this magnificent description, by the Poet of unsurpased Sublimity. From inatention to this subject of quantity, it often hapens that poets use sylables of imutable time, in emphatic places that call for the expresion of the wave. The folowing example, cited in the eleventh section, is here further explained. And practis'd distances to cringe, not jlght. The scornful exultation, conveyed by the words not fight, requires a form of the unequal wave on each ; but from the limitation of their quantity, this movement cannot be employed, without a remarkable departure from corect jjronunciation. In speaking of the various ascending and descendmg concrete intervals, it was shown that a similar, tho diminished efect of into- nation is produced by the leap or change of the 'voice, from the radical line of a concrete, to the pitch of its vanish, without pasing thru the intermediate space. The wave being only a junction of the concretes of its constituentsj it might be suposed that some expresion analogous to that of a concrete wave, could be produced by radical changes to the extremes of its flexures. Such a cor- espondence may be efected on some of the forms of the wave. In the case of the imutable words not fight, an aproximation may be made towards the required expresion of the continuous concrete, by giving not, at a discrete fifth above the line of the curent melody ; tlien returning discretely to that line on fight ; and finaly, rising on fight, from that line, with the ra])id concrete of a third ; thereby producing a kind of discrete imitation of the direct-double-unequal concrete wave of the fifth and third. For if -sve supose tlie radi- cal of cringe, to be on a line, with the curent melody; and its con- crete to be caried from that radical i)hu'e, tiiru the points of the rising and the faling discrete fifth above mentioned, it will, with a final raj)id vanish of the third, form such a wave. This discrete intonation by a wider interval, comes much nearer to the expresion THE WAVK OF UNEQUAL INTERVAL?. 333 of contempt, designed by the exultation of Satan, than can posibly be reached on the triad of the cadence, to which the voice is prone, in this case, from the short time of the syhibles, and their position at the close of a sentence. Another example, given in the eleventh section, may still fur- ther ilustnite this design to convey by radical changes, in a modi- fied degree, the expresion of a wave of equal intervals, when a limited sylabic time, renders its continuous or concrete movement impracticable. Faithful to whom, To thy rebelious crew? Army of Fiends, jit body to Jit head. The words here marked in italics, convey ironical admiration, contempt, and scorn, and not alowing the concrete movement, may be intonated by an alternate skip of radical pitch thru the rise and fall of a fifth. With /?/ on the line of the curent melody, take bod, by radical skip, a fifth above ^f; y again at the curent line, a fifth below bod ; to, also on the curent line ; jit a fifth above this last ; and finaly head a fifth below, at the curent line : observ- ing, that with the radical skips, there is still a feeble and rapid do\vaiward concrete of the same interval, on all the sylables. I offer in the foloM'ing diagram, two notations; one, of what we called a discrete imitation of the concrete wave proposed for the Poet's phrase ; another, with the same number of words taken, as well as I could compose them, to represent something like the char- acter of his short-timed phraseology ; and with suficient quantity to bear the concrete, and the wave. Fit bod — y to fit head. Well paired with all thy sins! jfc*: —^^^ \ mm^ L_A L The First of these notations is described above : tho here the rapid downward concrete of the third is, by a mistiike, put for the fifth. In the Second, the word well has the inverted wave of the fifth, with its rising constituent, expresive of a sert of admiration, ironical it must be, at Satan's preposterous claims to an honorable 334 THE WAVE OF UNEQUAL INTERVALS. faithfulnes. I say nothing of a slight tremor on this rising con- stituent, to show tlie exulting scorn of Gabriel j nor of any form or degree of vocality and stres, for the impresive display of the whole phrase. After the lighter sneer has been intimated, the rest of the words convey a positive asurance on the part of the speaker, of the truth of the contemjjtuous comparison, and should therefore have the conclusive intonation of the downward inter- vals. Paired has the faling fifth ; loith, the feeble and faling rapid concrete of a third, on the line of the curent melody ; all, a positive downward fifth, from the hight of that interval above the curent ; thy, a direct unequal wave of the second and third ; and sins, a feeble cadence to close the phrase. There is in all this, but the plain inteligible up and down of the voice without asistance from any ocult quality, emanating from that 'soul' of the Elocu- tionist, which has never yet been seen, scented, touched, tasted nor heard. In the first of these ways only, by marking the ex- tremes of those intervals, which, upon extended sylabic quantity would be given as a wave, can that open eye of wonder, and snarl- ing of scorn, be substitutively executed. Yet even with every asistance from the radical skip, a reader, if he poseses the power of an educated elocution, must still find it vexatiously restrained within these words. We have had ocasion to aply the term sim])le to the unflexed concrete, to distinguish it from the wave. The above mode of intonation on imutable sylables is an example of what we calcd a discrete com])ared with a concrete wave. It has been shown, that in the purposes of speech, two forms of the simple concrete, the slow and the rapid, are respectively required for long and short quantities. It was early a question with me, whether a rapid movement, thru the 7cave, is perceptible on an imutable sylable. Time and motion together with mater, are the great agents, in perpetual creation ; and in their labors, strive at the greatest and the least ; but are still respectively as untraceable in their minutenes, as ilimitable in their broad e>vten- sion. There is then nothing inconsistent with their functions, in suposing that an instantaneous and jierfoct movement of the wave, may be executed on the shortest sylabic quantity. Yet to me it is not obvious: and tho I would not, with the scholastic axiom, say; RECAPITULATING VIEW OF MELODY. 335 there is no difference between the imperceptible, and tlie ' non- existent;' still, by inference, the wave that cannot be heard, must be useles in speech. I leave the question therefore, not for the endles disputes, but for the observation, and for the determinate Christian 'yea or nay' of others. Let me here recall the atention of the Reader to the subject of sylabication. It was shown, that the construction of sylables is governed by the radical and vanishing movement; that the course of sylabic sound is limited by the extent of the upward and downward concrete; and further stated that the prolonged and perfect sylable is practicable upon another form of pitch. AVe are now prepared to hear that the unbroken curent of tiie s]>eak- ing voice, may be carried through the contrary flexures of the wave, on tonic and subtonic elements, without destroying that singlenes of impresion which forms one of the characteristics of a sylable. This may be briefly explained by what was said on the subject of the alphabetic elements. The wave is a continuous sound, and consequently afords no oportunity in its course, for the outset of a new radical, which, with its folowing vanish would produce another sylable. And it was shown that an interuption of the concrete, whether made designedly by pause, or necesarily by the ocurence of an abrupt or an atonic element, is unavoidably the end of one sylable, and the preface to the begining of another. After the preceding description, of the individual functions of the speaking voice, we may take a more comprehensive view of the subject, by RecajMtulating the acount of these functions, in the conected curent of discourse ; and thereby show them in the joined relations of synthesis, as they have been shown, in the separate individuality of decomposition. We speak with two purposes. First, to comunicate thots, apart from pasion. And Second, to expres thot with pasion. Acording to that diference, the voice should have a diferent set of signs, for each of these purposes : and this, upon inquiry, is found to be the 336 RECAPITULATING VIEW OF MELODY. case. As it is dificult, if not imposible, to draw a strictly dividing line between simple thots, and what are caled pasions ; so the vocal signs, severaly representing them, cannot be clearly divided, in arangement. I have however, in previous parts of this essay, marked out a practical distinction, founded on the more obvious diference of the cases. For the plain narative of unexcited thot, we employ the Diatonic melody. This melody consists of the simple concrete rise of a second or tone, varied by the simple downward concrete of the same interval ; of a radical pitch changing by its several diatonic phrases; with an ocasional emphasis of force or abruptnes, as the meaning may require; and a termination of the melody by the descent of the cadence. The grace and refinement of speech in this case are largely dependent on that equable-concrete structure of the radical and vanish, which displays a full and well-marked opening of the concrete, and a gradual diminution of its force. These are the constituents employed, witli their arangement, for narative, and plain description : and generaly, if such subjects, as the definitions of astronomy, title-deeds of property, and gazete advertisements, are not read for the most part, in this thotive style of intonation, the efect will be unsuitable to their pasionles meaning. In the above described condition, or first form of the diatonic melody, the movement is suposed to be with a triping step and a short quantity. If however, the state of mind should be more serious and composed^ an increase of quantity in the acented sylables, together with a general slownes of uterance Avill be asumed : the concrete still continuing in its simple rise or fall : constituting another condition of the melody, tho still purely thotive or diatonic. Should this deliberate state be further raised into solemn dignity, the melody will asume, on extendible and emphatic words, the use of the direct and inverted wave of tho second, together with an ocasional rising or faling third or fiftii or their waves, and some moderately cxpresive form of the other modes. Here then, the thotive and the pasionative characters meet, and jiroducc the rev- crcntivo or admirative style. Much of the Church-service should have this })lain and yet remarkable intonation. It conveys in full the mcntid state of august composure, solemnity and veneration. RECAPITUL.ATING VIEW OF MELODY. 337 A proi^cr management of the contrary courses of its waves, to- gether with an ocasional radical skip, of a third or fifth on imut- able sylables, gives suficient variety to the melody ; while it avoids tlie unusual force of more impresive intervals, that would overrule the self-posesed composure and grave simplicity of this unobtrusive uteranco. This form of melody includes the means for ])roducing that graceful dignity of voice, which is in vain ateniptcd by the loud-mouthed breadth of ohs and aws ; with strong percussive accents and long pausesj the waves of wider intervalsj and that hearties afectiition which pases without motive or rule, in unex- pecteasionative style. Let the pupil then imitate these so widely diferent styles of speech, until they become familiar to his ear, and under the discriminative comand of his voice ; and with a knowledge of the intervals of the scale, he will perceve, that the narative, thotive, and dignified uter- ance, consists of the simple rise or fall of the second, on the shortj and of the waves of the second, on the longer sylablos. When he is familiar with the audible efect of this plain diatonic melody, he will begin to recognize the state of mind that atends it : and then the whole dificulty of discrimination will be overcome : for there is as clearly a perception of this thotive state of mind, as there is a perception of the state of pnsion. When the natural connection of mind with vocal sign is not overruled by false expresion, this plain thotive stiite will call up the plain diatonic melody, as an excited state of mind will call uj) the pasionative stylo. With atention to this natural law, there will bo a roadinos in executing the plain, distinguished from an ex])resivo intonation, without a confusion of their res})ectivc purposes, as wo hear.it, in tho great majority of readers. If I may state my own case, I do not, on RECAPITULATING VIEW OF MELODY. 339 an ocasion for using the j)laiii melody, direct inyatcntion especialy to each of the rising and faling .seconds, and the waves that con- stitute it : but having previously learned the detail of sounds, and the states of mind, on which the distinction of style is founded, I bring up, or afect, or find-myself-in, the thotive state ; and from the instinctive operation of mind on speech, I do not, or cannot without violence to my natural or acquired Elocution, speak in any other way. There is one ex})resive interval of the scaler the Semitone, some- times employed on single words, and expresing complaint, pity, tenderncs, or supplication ; but more generaly on phrases, and sentences, and thruout discoui'sc. This we caled the Chromatic melody ; and like the two varieties of the Diatonic, its curent is either in the rise or fall of tlie simple interval, for deliberate grief; or, for strong expresion in the equal wave of the semitone, under its direct and inverted, its single and its double forms. Some parts of the Church-service, containing words of complaint, penitence and suplication, call for this dignified wave of the chromatic melody. From the marked expresion of the semitone, its melody never has the plainly Thotive condition. It is always either reverentive or Pasionative. Other constituents contribute to the means of corect, elegant, and expresive si)eech. These were considered under the terms, vocality ; Variations of radical j)itch on its diferent melodial phrases; Pauses, with the proper intonation to be used at them; and Grouping, or the means of impresing on an auditor, more definitely, the syntactic relation of words and phrases, by means of pause, emphasis, and the varieties of time and force. This sumary includes the constituents so far enumerated, which enter into the eomj)osition of melody. Some important functions, yet to be described, will furnish us with other expresive signs. 340 THE INTONATION OF SECTION XXXII. OJ the Intonation of Exdamaiory Sentences. The downward concretes, and the wave, are variously expresive of surprise and admiration ; and as these, with like states of mind, are represented by what is called Exclamation, I shall point out some of the principles that seem to govern the use of these inter- vals, in Exclamatory sentences. Beyond a general admision of the existence, and of the expresion of the 'tones of the voice,' or what we call Intonation in the Art of Speakings this important function has, strangely, receved no further notice of its forms and uses, than that vaguely signified by the comon ' notes ' of Interogation, and Admiration. But as these notes imply only some undescribed peculiarity of voice, without being employed acording to system or rule, they can be consid- ered as no more than gramatical symbols to the eye. The indefi- nite state of knowledge on the intonation of these forms of speech, has been further confused by the vague uses of their symbols. For the note of interogation is often aplied to what are realy interject- ive, or argumentative apeals ; and what, by the light of inquiry, may be shown to be strictly exclamatory. The subjects of Interogative and of Exclamatory sentences are so intermingled in their gramatical structure, meaning, and into- nation, that it requires a comparative view of their several con- ditions to comprehend their relationships to each other. Prefatory therefore, to a description of Exclamatory sentences, I here give a sumary of what has been stated on the divisions, purposes, and forms of interogation. In the seventeenth section, we learned that even in the ques- tions there exemplified, the downward intervals with the. direct and inverted waves are oeasionaly employed for their expresion. Had the Reader been prepared, by previous description of the character of these forms of pitch, it would there have been more particularly stated that some questions with the gramatical form, are made altogether by these downward movements. He may I EXCLAMATORY SENTENCES. 341 therefore now be told, after Mhat has been said of the positive expresion of tlic faling intervals, that Avhenever a question gram- atiraly constructetl, employs only the simple downward movement, or the direct wave, the interogative character is lost in that of the positive state of mind, which requires these adopted intervals. Interogations which employ, e.rch(sivelj/, the downward inter- vals and the direct wave, are in their meaning, what we caledj Questions of Asumed Belief; and are severaly: Apealing, Argu- mentative or Conclusive; and Exclamatory; to which may be aded, as bearing the same intonation, the Imperative question. In all these cases, except the imperative, there is a certain belief in the interogator, of an expected acquiescence on the point of inquiry'; and his perception of this belief is founded on the facts, and influences, embraced within his meaning, which are to be gathered from his maner, or discourse ; constituting what we caled the Colateral grounds of indication in a question. In the want, at this time, of a discriminating nomenclature, we are obliged to take the term, Question of belief, with a latitude of meaning, between a simple intimation by the inquirer, of his knowledge upon the subject of the question j and his full asurance that the answer must acord with the hopes and expectations which prompted the question. For we learned in the seventeenth section, that the negative form varies in its asumed belief, from the slight- est degree, to the fulnes of a triumphant inquiry : and employs, acording to that degree, the various means of a partial interogativej in a wider downward interval, and a wider direct wave. The questions reserved for this section, imply their belief, to a degree that calls universaly, for a thoru and positive downward intonation. I have therefore included the four above name^sive intonation of the wider faling intervals and the direet wave; the very oposite to those which denote an interogative. Acording to the present method of reading, by confusing the ordained laws of the voice, and thereby corupting its practice, these questions might be given with a thoro aplication of the rising intervals. But in this case, the intonation would be apt to asunie the sneering expresion of the double-direct or single-inverted wave, and by its ironical efect, to endue the inquiry with the force of a real negation. And here our history points-out one of the many relations, discoverable between the arts of ' logic,' gramar, and rhetoric, and that of elocution ; or, between all the states or the purposes of the human mind, and the vocal means for denoting them. It has been shown, that the words in italics, of the above examples, are in meaning, positive declarations on the part of the intero- gator, of l)elief in a fact; Avhich by a Figure of speech, is con- veyed in the form of a question : and questions are generaly taken as words of doubt. Consequently in cases like these, where the voice has a positive meaning, it should be able to anul the usual power of the graniatical question. The means for efecting this, is by the use of the most emphatic degree of the downward inter- vals, and direct waves ; for their expresion is contrary to that of the rising interogative voice. And this instance may serve to pre-signify the differences in vocal and grammatical relationships, which the future cultivators of elocution will be caled upon to analyze, and to reconcile, by the extended powers and resources of their art. Strictly, every proposition of a sylogism must either aftirni, or deny. No question of real inquiry can therefore, form part of the proces of sylogistic 'reasoning;' as it neither afirms nor denies. Yet see, in the examj)les, how the voice breaks thru this law of the school, and almost of the mind, by its overbearing intonation; and endues an undetermined gramatical inquiry, with the asumcd power of a positive belief. The Exclamatory Question. The apcaling question, it has been stated, is exclamatory ; and conversely, it may be said here, the exclamatory question embraces an apeal. The only ground for distinguisiiing them is, tliat the exclamatory phraae apears to be 23 346 THE INTONATION OF further removed from the condition of a question, than the apeal, by its seeming the less to require an answer. In Shakspeare's Richard II, the King, in that celebrated descant on the state of princes, saysj I live with bread like you, feel want, taste grief, Need friends ; subjected thus, Hoiv can you say to me} I am a King I The interogative words in italics do not require an answer, for, when interpreted by the two preceding lines, they contain reproof, displeasure, surprise, and conclusive denial, but not inquiry ; and therefore are properly expresed by the use of the downward concrete, and the direct wave. Perhaps the Reader may thinkj the Exclamatory question does not difer from the Apealing, or at best, only in degree. I am but the historian of my tongue and ear. After I have told all they tell me, the Reader may, and I supose will, think as he pleases about it. The Imperative Question. This, although bearing a positive intonation, is not, as above remarked, a question of belief, but takes its downward intonation from the influence of a state of mind, acidentaly conected with its own. There is such a thing {US overbearing impetus in pasionative, as well as in physical mo- mentum ; whereby the expresion, apropriate to one mental con- dition is caried into another, which under difercnt circumstances would not admit of that expresion. The intonation of an impera- tive question, seems to be of this character ; for here two states of mind are embraced by the speakcrj Comand and Inquiry ; and these are in imediate conection with each other. The zeal of the question is exhibited in the vehement desire for an answer, and this desire displays itself in the earnest authority of comand. By this transfer, the comand asumes all the energy of the case ; and seeming to forget, if I may so ilustrate the subject, the rising expresion due to the inquiry, throws the positivencs of the down- ward imperative over the wliole. This is exemplified by jNIacbeth's consultation with the witches. Witches. Seek to know no more, Macbeth. I will be satisfied. Deny mo this, And an eternal curse fall on you. Let nie know, Why siiiks that caldron I and what noise is this! i EXCLAMATORY SENTENCES. 347 Tlie cagcrnes of Macbeth here rises into anger, at tlic ])rospcct of (lisapointment. This anger asumes the comand, in the phrasej let mc knoic ; and the strong downward intonation of this conumd is, by the inn)erative force, continued thruout the two suceding questions. The inteligent Reader will, on trial, at once admit the propriety of this positive intonation, however he may explain it ; for let him, after the angry comand, imediately give to the ques- tions the rising intervals of interogationj and not only will there be a want of apropriate gravity and force, but the violent con- trast of cxpresion will be even ludicrous. Yet without the over- ruling of this imperative energy, the questions would take the iuterogative intervals ; for they contain a real inquiry. In the above instance, the question contains the previous com- and ; where it is wanting, we are to suppose the phrase^ tell me, or some equivalent imperative. Perhaps one of the causes why imperative questions, as we have shown, drop their interogative intonation may be, that the gramatical structure, suficiently indicates the inquiry ; and alows the comand to continue the downward interval beyond itself. Some other states of mind, embraced in a gramatical interogative, require the downward intervals. I have given examples enough on this subject to direct the course of analysis, and a method of clasification. Upon the subject of the comon Note of interogation, we may remark, that as most questions are signified by their gramatical structure, and as this symbol gives no special rule for intonation, it may be regarded as useles, except in declaratory questions, and phrases that without it might be mistaken for imperatives. In these, the mark placed, as long ago proposed, at the begining of a question, would be definite in its purpose, from such sentences always requiring the rising intonation. That the comon intero- gative indication of this symbol may confuse a reader who atempts to direct his voice by itj is a fair conclusion from its being a})lied to sentences which require, as we have now learned, a totaly dif- erent cxpresion. Having in the present, and in a former section, considered the various kinds of interogation, that severaly require either the up- ward or the downward intervals, let us briefly recapitulate them. 348 THE INTONATION OF First. Questions in their Gramatieal construction, are severaly Declarative, Comon, Adverbial, Pronominal, and Negative. Second. In the state of mind or meaning conveyed, they are of Real Inquiry, of Belief, and Triumphant questions. Third. Questions in their various degrees of Force, are Moder- ate, or Earnest, or Vehement; and they may embrace surprise, plaintiveness, mirth, railery, anger, contempt, and all states of mind, not inconsistent with that of a question. These three kinds variously require in their structures, mean- ings, and degrees, either the partial, or the thoro rising intonation ; or a downward interval or wave intercurent with the rising ; which properly belonging to our seventeenth section, are there particu- larly described. Fourth. Those questions which always require the downward intonation, are the Apealing or Argumentative, the Exclamatory, the Imperative ; and there may be others of like character deserv- ing a name ; all of which from having the same downward interval or direct wave, we include under the present head of Exclamatory sentences. In truth they might be caled Figurative Questions by a license of speech, which takes the interogative construction, for the interogative meaning. But in them this meaning is lost under the vocal signs of a do"\vnward concrete and a direct wave, which we shall presently show proper Exclamations require. As the preceding descriptive acount and clasification of Inter- ogative sentences may, in this first atempt to bring order out of imperfect and desultory knowledge, seem intricate and untrace- ablej I here recapitulate the several gramatieal Forms of ques- tions, the states of mind, meaning, or purpose that direct them, and their degrees of Force ; with their Kinds, Structures, and Intonations, under a EXCLAMATORY SENTENCES. TABULAR VIEW. 349 I. Questions under a diferent Gramatical Form. Kind. Structure. Intonation. Declaratory. Comon. Adverbial. Pronominal. Negative. / Either an afirmative, f In almost every case, \ era negmtive sentence. \ thoro. The verb, auxiliary, and nominative, trans- posed. f The 1 ver c adition of an ad- fa to the comon. The adition of a pro- noun to the comon. f The adition of a nega- i tive to the comon, the adverbial, or the pro- nominal. Partial, or thoro, ac- cording to the earnest- nes, or the state of mind. Partial, if not made thoro by earnestues, or the state of mind. Partial, if not made thoro by earncstnes, or the state of mind. Partial, or earnestly thoro; or with a down- ward interval, or a direct wave. II. Questions with a diferent Meaning, or Purpose. Real Inquiry. Asumed Belief. f Comon, or adverbial, f Generally thoro, ex- \ or pronominal. \ cept in series. r Con \ orp ( ativ Comon, or adverbial, ronom i nal , or neg- ve. Partial, or thoro; or downward interval, or a direct wave. (Comon, or adverbial, f Generally \ or pronominal : but .| nest down\ generaly a negative. ( val, or a di Generally with anear- iward inter- irect wave. III. Questions with diferent degrees of Force. Moderate. Earnest. { orT„"Ci '.1'"""' { «™"'"y p"'-'- (Declaratory, or comon, f Thon or adverbial, or pro- } figurt nominal. j down Thoro, except when rative; and then ward. Vehement; with sur- Declaratory, or comon, prise, or other excited I or adverbial, or pro- "'''" nominal, or negative. state. Emphatically thoro, except when figura- tive ; and then down- ward. 350 THE INTONATION OF TABULAR VIEW CONTINUED. IV. Questions under a Figurative Form. Kind. Structure. Intonation. Apealing. -| or pronominal, or neirative. Comon, or adverbial, f a i j • a. i ' • , ' A downward interval, or pronominal, or -^ ,• , ' /. ' or a direct wave, negative. (. (Comon, or adverbial, ( . j j • ^ i ' . , ' A downward interval, or pronominal, or -^ j- ^ /■ ' ) or a direct wave, negative. ( Exclamatory. (Comon, or adverbial, f » j j • x i • 1 ' ) A downward interval, or pronominal, or -< -,. ^ ' '. ' 1 or a direct wave, negative. ( {Comon, or adverbial, f . ■■ j • ^ i ' . , ' A downward interval, or pronominal, or -^ j- ^ ' '. ' 1 or a direct wave, negative. (_ From the detailed description and the Tabular view, on the subject of Interogative sentences, we learn how variously their forms are, in structure, meaning, and degree of force, under re- ciprocal subjection to each other. The gramatical are changed by the meaning, and by the degree of force ; the degree of force by the meaning ; and the jxirtial overruled to the thoro, and even to the downward intonation. Scarcely a single rule can be univer- sally applied ; and all are more or less crosed by exceptions from every side. Such is the unsetled state of the facts colected by our imperfect analytic inquiry : and we leave others to reduce them to a less uncertain arangement. For all the interchanges of interoga- tive intonation are still directed by the uniform laws of Nature, in the Mind, in Language, and in the Voice ; and where Nature, in secrecy, is at her work of wisdom, we shall there find Order, when- ever we, in imitation of her patience, industriously find her out. We here learn that what we call Figurative questions, are by their downward intonation not im])ropcrly included within the section on Exclamatory sentences^ which we now procede briefly to describe. EXCLAMATORY SENTENCES. 361 Many exclamations may be regarded as eliptical sentences. The design of these broken phrases is to give a forcible picture of the state of mind ; and as this is done with a brevity of style, which sometimes might not clearly convey these several states, it is necesary to employ aditional means, for their apropriatc intona- tion. And hence arise the structure and the expresive character of Exclamations. The shortest exclamatory, like the shortest interogative sentence consists of a monosylabic word ; and this may be any of the parts of speech, if perhaps we except the article, conjunction and prepo- sition ; the interjection being the most eomon. And here, as in the monosylabic question, the power of intonation is remarkable ; for it seems to be the art of speaking, almost without words. From the monosylable, exclamations vary in extent from the elipsis, to the full syntax of a sentence ; tho the greater part are abreviated by pasionative haste. Exclamations might then be aranged acording to their structure, as gramatically imperfect, or as complete. I shall class them acording to their state of mind or meaning. The extent of the faling interval or the wave in exclamatory sentences is in proportion to the energy of the expresion. The folowing intcrjective apostrophe, from its moderate temper, might require no more than the direct wave of the second, or semitone on 0, and the triad of the cadence, on the remaining three sylables. O withered truth ! The energetic emphasis of Hamlet's revengeful exclamation at the atrocity of the Kingj O villain, villain, smiling, damned villain! should receve on every sylable, either by slow or rapid concrete, the deep and forcible descent of the octave. Of the many kinds of exclamatory sentences, I shall only notice, the Admiring, the Plaintive, the Scornful, and the Im- I)erative; as these ilustrate the several forms of intonation re- ([uired by this impresive class of phrases. The Admiring Exclamation. Admiration is an earnest apro- 352 THE INTONATION OF batorv state of mind, under new and elevated perceptions. This newnes of objects, or of our reflections upon them, involves in a degree, an inquiry as to their character and cause ; and seems to call for the use of the rising intervals. This state has not the degree of force that requires a gramatical or a vocal question ; yet there is in the character of Exclamation, a positive conviction of the rare admirative importance of the object. It is from embracing these two states of mind, that the admiring exclamation calls for the direct wave, or union of the rising and the faling interval ; the positive character of the exclamation, by the dowuAvard course of the last constituent, predominating over whatever inquiry may be indicated by the previous rise. Let us take as an example, the folowing description of the asembling of the falen Angels at Pandemonium. So thick the airy crowd Swarm'd and were straightened; till the signal given, Behold a wonder I Here the sylables hold and wond require the direct wave of the fifth, which their indefinite quantity freely admits. The Plaintive Exclamation. It was shown in the nineteenth section, in what maner a plaintive interogation may be made, by a junction of the semitonic expresion with the wider upward inter- vals. The plaintive exclamation is produced by a rise of the semitone continued into the downward third, or fifth, or octave, as the energy of the case may require ; constituting a direct wave of unequal intervals. The unequal wave of the rising semitone and faling fifth gives the proper expresion to the acented and long sylabic quantities of the folowing plaintive exclamation of Macduff: O Banquo, Banquo, Our royal master's murdered ! The Scornful Exclamation. It was said in the thirty-first section, that Scorn, acording to its degree, is exprcsed by the simple rise or fall of the wider intervals, or by the various forms of tlie wave, when made with an aspirated or a gutural voice ; the simple rise and the fall being apropriate to sneer ; and the wider waves, to the deepest contempt and cxccmtion. When therefore EXCLAMATORY SENTENCES. .'^53 these states of mind arc conveyed by short emphatic sentences, tliey produce what is here caled the Scornful Exclamation ; as in the foloNvin;;, from the Merchant of Venice. Bassanio. This is signior Antonio. Shi/lock. How like & fawning publican he looks! This last line will be properly exprcscd, if the sylables in italics rcccve the unequal wave of the rising fifth and faling octave, under a slight degree of gutural aspiration ; and the rest of the sentence, the faling fifth, as a rapid concrete, with the like iLsj)iration. The Imperative Exclamation. An imperative pur2)ose in speech universaly requires a doM'nward interval, or a direct wave. Other functions, such as stres, aspiration, and gutural grating^ to be spoken of hereafter, mark the degrees of force or authority in the comand. The folowing- exclamation of Macbeth to the Ghost of Banquo, calls for the downward fifth or octave on every syla- ble ; acording to the degree of energy the speaker may think apropriate to it. Hence horible shadow, Unreal mockery hence ! We need not pui'sue this subject further. Exclamations are but forcible interjective expresions; and there may be as many kinds, as varieties of pasionativc states of mind ; for every montiil energy may be found in discourse, under the exclamatory form. \j(ii others define and divide them. Perhaps the nomenclature, and examples here given, may asist the work of inquiry and clasification : and when hereafter. Elocution shall be raised into a Science, and cease to be, at least in intonation, no more than a comon animal instinctj all those things in the art, that can be to me sul)jccts only of hope, may, in the fulnes of knowledge, be acomplished by others. Upon the subject of the intermingling of Interogative, and Exclamatory intonation, it is to be remarked, that in some cases, emphatic distinction may require the use of a downward interval or a direct wave, among the rising intervals of partial interoga- tives ; and a rising interval, among the downward concretes and 354 THE TREMOR OF THE VOICE. direct waves of exclamation ; the contrasts in such instances, con- stituting one of the characteristics of what is caled emphasis, or an impresive designation of single words. In reviewing our acount of the oposite indications of these two, and of other important divisions of speechj we perceve how they sometimes ajiear to cross and to contravene each other. The prevalent and cloudy, system of Elocution j and much more, our metaphysical and mudled Fictions on the Mind, by resisting the clarifying influence of a strict observation, still keeps us carelesly ignorant of the natural diference between th5t and pasion, with their several vocal signs ; and prevents our exact perception, why their phenomena, tho aparently, are in no way realy, inconsistent with the purpose of their ordination. So it is. And so perhaps, the self-contented and so called philosophic world will have it. Just as in government, religion, morals, the social relations, and medicinej with all our majesterial boasts of power and progresj we have not the perception, knowledge, truth, virtue, and honor, to save us from still prevailing confusion, dispute, and disasterj in our restles atempts to rectify these subjects of conventional trade, human ambition, and for all their pretended purposes, as yet of deplorable failure. SECTION XXXIII. The Tremor of the Voice. If the Reader has borne in mind the explanations in the first section of this essay, he must be aware that the forms of pitch so far described, are, severaly, phenomena of the concrete, the dis- crete, and the chromatic scales. He has now to learn the means of expresion derived from the Tremulous scale. This scale consists of a rise and fall on a tonic or subtonic element, thru the whole compas of the voicej by a more delicate exercise of that ])articular vibration in the throat, caled in comon language, gurgling. Altho the Tremor has always been known THE TRE>[OR OF THE VOICE. 355 as a vocal function, it is lierc first analyzed, and its use and man- agement in speech described. In our first section there is a general acount of the Tremulous scjile. We must now be more particular. It has been shownj every efort of the voice is necesarily in the radical and vanishing movement ; and that the audible character- istic of the several intervals of the scale may be distinctly recog- nized by their ejects^ even on the shortest imutable sylables. As then each of the tonic and subtonic elements does, in its shortest time, always pass rapidly by the concrete, it folows, that however quickly sucesive they may be repeated, each impulse must be a concrete interval. When therefore the tremor is made on any of the above named elements, either alone or in sylabic com- bination, and in this last case, it is still heard only on a single elementj the sucesive constituent impulses of that tremor must each consist of an abrupt radical, and of a rapid concrete thru some one interval of the scale. Let us, for brief and more pre- cise description, call these impulses, or iterations, the Tittles : and the spaces on the tremulous scale, between the tittlesj here asumed to be equal, for so they seem to mej we will call the Minute Tit- telar Skip or interval. Whether these skips here asumed as equal, are of the same extent, under all circumstances, and in every voice, it is not now necesary to inquire. The tremulous scale is then made-up of a sucesion of tittles, each of which, like the comon sylabic impulse, has its rapid radical and concrete pitch. Taking the concrete of the tittle, as a designation, there may be a tremor of the semitone, second, third, filth and octave ; the concrete pitch of each sucesive tittle rapidly rising or faling thru those intervals respectively. In this case the tittelar ski])s are suposed to be on the same line of radical pitch; still it is easy to perceve, that while the rapid concrete of these tittles is moving in its interval, the tittles themselves may, in their chatering radical skips, be caried upward or downward, thru a ])art or the whole of the compas of the voice. These tittelar skips with tiie rapid concretes, are madi; in two ways, as in the folowing diagramj 356 THE TREMOR OF THE VOICE. 12 3 4 5 where a given number of these skips are continued on one line of radical pitch : as in the first and second bars ; the former, having the rapid concrete of a second ; the latter, that of a fifth. The third bar represents a line of skips, with a change by comon radi- cal pitch, thru a second or tone ; and by iterations on a line, with a radical change, by proximate, and it may be by remote degrees, the voice in one manner, ascends the whole compas, of the dia- tonic scale. In another maner, the ascent of the tremulous scale is made, by taking the radical of each tittle, sucesively, a minute interval above the last, as in the fourth and fifth bars ; the rapid concrete in the former being a third, and in the latter, a fifth. In this manner, without the last described linear step by proximate or other deg-rees on the diatonic scale, but with a direct rise or fall bv tittelar skips the whole extent of the voice is travei-sed. We have no means for measuring the space between the tittles, in this direct manner of ascent. It cannot be a semitone. If it were, the tittelar intervals being all equal, the tittelar skips would in all cases, be plaintive ; whereas, it is so only when the concrete of the tittle is a semitone. And it may be infered, that it is not greater than this interval : for if we make the tremulous movement of a major third, the number of tittelar skips will cxcede five ; which is the number of semitones included within the third. How much less than a semitone, the tittelar interval may be, we leave others experimentally to decide.* * Some one, it seems, has gone far boj'ond comon perception in distinguish- ing such minute intervals: as I find the lolowing statement under a Note, on the nine Inindred and twentieth page of an American edition of Dr. Carj)en- ter's recent extended compihition on Physiology. ' It is said that the cele- brated Mme. Mara was able to sound one hundred diferent intervals between [ivithin the limits of) each tone. The compns of her voice was at least three octaves, or twenty-one tones; [notes;) so that the total number of [minute) THE TREMOR OF THE VOICE. 357 Wliat has been said of tlie a,'; abrupt element have only their proper momentary duration. And this disproportionate time of the elements, here asigncd as the cause of indistinctne&s in speech, is still more frequently a cause of inarticulate pronunciation, in the Singing voice. In the instances of the words plain, and more, the time of the concrete should be aportioned equaly among the elements ; and this is necesary in the reverentive style, for the elegant and im- presive uterance of other sylables, having a similar construction. Yet we cannot give a universal rule on this point ; such indefinite sylables, as men, run, I'm, and gel, having their prolongation on the several subtonic, will not bear adition to the short tonic elements. Radical stres is aplied to imutable, mutable, and to indefinite sylables. In the first case, the shortnes of the quantity produces as it were, only an explosive point of sound. It may be used on the initial of all concrete intervals both rising and faling, and on the be'. If she could now he heard, I would point in ilastration to Britain's great Mistres of the voice. Since, alas, that cannot be, let those who have not forgotcn the stately dignity of Mrs. Siddons, bear witnes to the efect of the graceful vanish of her concrete, and of that sweling voice of median energy, by which she richly en- forced the expresion of joy, and surprise, and indignation. Yet why should I be so sparing in praise, as to select her eminent exemplification of the single subject before usj when it seems to my recolectionj a whole volume of elocution might be taught by her instances. It is aparently a partial rule of criticism, but when drawn from delicate perceptions, enlightened by cultivation, it is the bestj to estimate the merit of Actors, by their power of audibly represent- ing the varied thot and pasion of their language, which the con- senting thut, and j^asion of the hearer is whispering to itself. This is the rule, that in my early days of ignorance, but not of unmindful inquiry, set up this great Woman's voice, as a miror for every trait of natural expresion, in which one might recognize his deep, unutered sympathy, and love the flatcring picture as his own. All that is smooth, and flexible, and various in intonation, all that is impresive in force, and in long-drawn time, all that is apt upon the countenance, and consonant in gesture, gave their united energy, gracefulnes, grandeur, and truth, to this one great model of Ideal Elocution. Pier's was that higlit of excclencc, which, defying mimicry, can be made ])erceptiblc in character only by being equaled. Such was my enthusiastic yet unsatisfied opinion, before a 374 THE MEDIAN STRES. scrutiny into speech had developed a boundles scheme of criticism and instruction ; which, in admiting tliat Nature may hokl within her laws, the unrevealed power of producing ocasional instances of rare acomplishment of voice ; yet asures us, that nothing except the influence of some system of principles, founded on a knowl- edge of those laws, can ever produce multiplied examples of ex- celence, or give to any one the perfection of art. There is a per- vading energy in Observative Science which searches, discovers, gathers-together, co-aranges, still amplifies, and completes; and which all the means of uninstructed efort can never reach. I do not wish to be asked, how this ' most noble mother ' of her Art, with only those unwriten ordinations of nature, that still alowed her to incur the dangers of the scanty doctrines of her Schoolj would be acounted by the side of another Siddons, making her selections \vith propriety and taste, from the familiar rudiments, and measurable functions of the voice ; and able, by the authority of a directive and unindulgent discipline, to be a wary critic over herself. With a full reliance on the surpasing eficacy of scientific instruction, still, in the contentment of recolection, I would not wish to answer this question. The vision of the Great Actress is before me ! If I am beset by an ilusion, which another hearing might dispel, I rejoice to think I can never hear her again.* * In the title 'most noble mother,' I refer to the salutation of Coriolanus to Volumnia: for it is in this character Mrs. Siddons always comes like a speak- ing picture, upon my memory; embodying the pathos, the matron dignity, and the indignation, together with the other moral solemnities of the scene of intercesion in the Volcian camp. THE VANISHING STRES. 375 SECTION XXXVII. OJ the Vanishing Strcs. Our description of the simple concrete of sj^ecch, represented it with an initial fulnes, and a gradual decrease. The reverse con- struction indicated by the term of this Stres, does change the simple form of the concrete : but I thot, even with its verbal contrariety, it would be more imediately inteligible, if not more exactly de- scriptive of the function, than any other less simple name. The vanishing stres is an aj>lication of force to the end of the con- crete, both in its rising and faling direction. This must nccesarily give a fulnes, with something like an abrupt termination, at the place of the vanish. The peculiar vocal efect of the vanishing stres may be ilustratcd by the function of Hicup. This hie, catch, ' hitch '-congh, or hex, as formerly caled, has a conventional name, that by etymology, describes its very formation ; and from its being instinctively practicable, may be the subject of experiment. The hiccough or hicup, then, is produced by the gradual increase of the gutural sound, until it Ls sudenly obstructed by an ocluded catch, somewhat resembling the element k, or g ; and if it be compared with a single efort of the comon cough, the abruptnes in each will re- spectively exemplify the reverse diference between the vanishing and the radical stres : for the comon cough has the full acentcd 0})ening of a radical, and the hicup, a full acented closing at the place of the vanish. The hicup however, does not, in all points, resemble the proper vanishing stres of speech, except the sylable which bears the stres, terminates with an abrupt element. The hicup may be made on all intervals of the scale. In ordinary ca'ics, it asumes that of the second or third ; but when atcndcd with great distres, as sometimes hapens in disease, it is heard in the j)laintive interval of the semitone. The efect of the vanishing stress may be heard in the speech of the natives of Ireland ; many of whom aply it to the simple rise, or fall, or to the wave, on all the principal words of a sentence. 376 THE VANISHING STRES. It Is this function which produces that quick and peculiar jerk of sylabic sound, in the earnest pronunciation of the ignorant ranks of that peculiar People. The vanishing stres is practicable on all the rising and faling intervals of the scale. On the wave, it is aplied to the last con- stituent. This stres, as one of the forms of force, gives to the several intervals, a more atractive power over the ear, than belongs to their simple concretes. If perceptible at all, on the plain inex- presive second, it adds that Irish jerk which only deforms without enforcing speech. On the rising third, fifth, and octave, it giv^es intensity to their interogation. On the downward course of these intervals, it increases the degree of surprise and positivenes ; and on the wave, joins force to the expression of its various forms. The efect of the vanishing stress on a semitone, may be heard in the act of Sobing. This is made on a concrete gutural sound, gradualy increasing in force and terminated in some cases by the ocluded catch. The vanishing stres on the semitone in discourse, is as it were, a sobing upon words, and serves to mark intensively, the plaintive expresion of the simple concrete. The character of discourse ocasionaly requires so quick a time, that only the simple rise or fall can be employed; and yet, it may be necesary to designate clearly, the terminative point of the interval. This is acomplished by the vanishing stres. For a hasty uterance of complaint or interogation, which has time for flight only in one direction, will, in marking emphaticaly the extent of the interval, aply this terminative force to the simple rise or fall of the semitone, third, fifth, or octave. It was saidj the radical stres is efective, principaly in distinguish- ing imutable sylablcs. On these the vanishing stres is not coniza- ble. It requires a longer quantity ; and its aplication thereon, gives an equal degree of force with the median stres ; but it has much less dignity and grace than the gradual swell of this last named elegant maner of forcible expresion. THE COMPOUND STRES. 377 SECTION XXXVIII. OJ the Compound Stres. Besides tlio obvious effect of stres, when laid exclusively on the begining, or niidle, or end of the concrete, the cultivated and atcntive ear recognizes the abrupt opening of the radical, and the full termination of the vanishing stress, when used in sucesion on the same svlable, both in a risin"; and faling; direction. The best reference, for ilustrating this Compound stres, is to what vocalists call a Shake : for I shall show hereafter, that the characteristic of this Grace of Song, consists in a rapid iteration of the concrete of speech, when impresed with both the radical, and vanishing streses. The compound stress, tho never aplied to the narow intervals of the scale, is distinguishable, on the wider spaces of the fifth, and octave. It may likewise be executed on the various forms of the wave ; the final stres being then laid on the last constituent. After what has been said respectively of the radical and the vanishing stres, this under consideration being a compound of thenij it is scarcely necesary to add, that it more forcibly denotes the state of mind singly indicated by each constituent. This alter- nation of the radical, with the vanishing stres, is beautifuly ex- emplifie^piration, for the j)urpose of energetic expresion. The dipthongal tonics do not receve the aspiration with the same efect as the monothongs ; there being something in the char- acter of the former that prevents as great a change upon them, as takes place on the monothongs, by the union. It was shown formerly that whispering, which is only the ar- ticulated form of aspiration, has its pitch, upon a succesion of dif- erent alphabetic elements; yet whatever may be the dificulties of this articulated intonationj the simple suflation, when engrafted on the tonics, pases concretely thru all the intervals of the scale, and unites itself with every form of stres. To show how far this function asists in the expresion of speech, let us keep in mind what was said above, on the instinctive union of a vehement exertion of the voice, with its aspiration ; and consider further, two forms under which the simple aspiration is employed. One is a sort of facetious coment of surprise and incredulity, in comon use, consisting of an efort of aspiration modified by the tongue and lips, into what is caled, in the fifth section, the suflated whisper. The movement of this suflated interjection is that of an unequal direct wave ; the first constituent being a tone or wider interval, acording to the required expresionj and the second, a descent to the lowest audible pitch.* The other effort of aspiration, is made by the larynx alone, and * The Elocutionist has certainly not talked without his books; but he seems never to have been concerned at not coniini^ to his hearinc^, among their number and confusion^ and has been, and still is, sorely afraid of ad- mitiiiijj a full and precise nomenclature into them. Our anal^'sis now enables us to point out the form of intonation in the prolonged and derisive inter- jection. Whew, of the gramarian ; tho neither gramar nor elocution has taken the trouble to find it out, and to tell us, what it is. When the Kcader uters this suflated interjection, by a descent from a very high to a very low pitch, he will have an ilustration of what was said in the fifth section, on the scale of Whisper^ for this .suflation, having c-ve at its uper extreme, and 00-7.P1 at its lower, will prove, by tho position of these elements on the scale, that it pases thru two octaves; tho rajiidity of tho concrete movement, as it seems, preventing the clear perception of tho intermediate elements. In this case, the interjection difers from that described in the te.xtj and is the suflation of whew on a double downward octave. 386 THE ASPIRATION. constitutes the function of Sighing. It consists of a simple inspi- ration, followed by an expiration, more or less prolonged on a faling second or Avider interval, or a semitonic wave, acording to the character and intensity of the expression. A sigh is the well known out-pouring of distres, grief, and anxiety, and of fatigue and exhaustion, both of body and mind. As these diferent cases include the general powers of expresion, in simple and natural aspiration, we can infer j what will be the efect when this aspiration is joined with the vocality of speech. It may seem, but can only seem, to be an exception to the con- sistency of nature, that a voice, which can asume the quiet form of whisjjer, should with changeful pur^^ose, be found united with vocality in the most forcible exertion of speech. Yet aspiration conjoined with the vehement forms of stres, becomes one of the signs of the greatest vocal energy. Its union therefore with a rising or faling interval of the scale in the Natural voice, increases the expresive power of that interval ; and perhaps adds the efect of sneer to intonations, that in their purely vocal form severaly convey surprise, interogation, irony, and comand. Should this union of aspiration and vocality be given with an abatement of voice, aproximating towards a whisper or a sigh, it becomes the sign of earnestnes in various states of mind. The folowing lines, when utered in a pure vocality, will not have their proper expresion. Hah ! dost thou not see, by the moon's trembling light, Directing his steps, where advances a Knight, His eye big with vengeance and fate ? Nor would their purpose be efected by an aspirated vocifera- tion. But when subdued to a kind of union of the natural with the whispered voice, the earnestnes of the apealing interogation is at once, obvious and expresive. Should an abated voice be aspirated on the Tremulous move- ment of a second or wider interval, it may denote aprchension or fear. When this abatement is aspirated on a simple rise or fall, or on a wave of the semitone, it is an aproximation to the sigh ; and adds intensity to the plaintivcnes or distres of the semitone on a pure vocality. When a tremor is supcradcd to the aspirated THE EMPHATIC VOCULE. 387 semitone, tlie voice exerts its ultimate means, for denotinj^ the deepest sadnes, without the assistance of crying and tears. Aspiration when combined with diforont forms of strcs, and witli the gutural voice, to be described presently, severaly denotes sneer, contempt, and scorn : hence the means of joining with nearly every interval of intonation the expresion of these various states of mind. J^ven the simple rising and faling movements, indi- cating inquiry, surprise, and emphatic afirmation, may thus be made contemptuous; the efect being more strongly marked by aspiration on the wave in its unequal form. SECTION XLIII. Oj the Emphatic Vocule. We learned, on the subject of the alphabetic elements, that when the articulative oclusion is removed from the atonies and subtonics, there is a slight and momentary but sudden issue of voice which completes their vocality, and is the only sound of the aspirated abrupt elements. This was caled the Vocule. It is a moderate degree of Abruptnes. Like all other voices, it is suscep- tible of force ; and constitutes the function named at the head of this section. The emphatic vocule denotes great energy ; and necefS- arily folows a word, terminated by one of the abrupt elements. The vocules of b, d, and 7, are vocal. Those of k, p, and t, are aspiratedj yet under a forcible emphasis, are sometimes changed to vocality. The use of this unarticulated explosion, at the end of an emphatic word is justified only under a vehement state of mind; and cautious management is necesary to prevent its forcible uter- ance from pasing into rant or afectation. When an abrupt element precedes a tonic, the vocule is lost in the tonic, which then seems to isue directly from the abrupt element. In the word light, the vocule is distinctly heard at its termination ; but if t imediately precedes the tonic i, as in tile, the 388 THE EMPHATIC VOCULE. vocule is lost, and t is then only a peculiar radical opening of i. This is a proper coalescence, except the abrupt element terminates a word. For in this case, a junction of the vocule with the tonic of a folowing word, may confuse pronunciation by destroying that clear limit which should give a separated individuality to every word of a sentence. This fault is sometimes even purposely asuraedj to remedy a want of physical energy in uterance. Per- sons who atempt to give unusual force to their radical stress, and who cannot readily explode the voice on a tonic, avail themselves of the facility of bursting-out from the final abrupt element of a word into a succeding tonic. If the phrase bad angels, should re- quire force, either for emphasis, or for a distant auditorvj the ex- plosion of d into an would produce the coalescence bad dangels, or ba-dangels. But as the arangement of elements is a casual thing, it must hapen that the same word will ocur in discourse, both with and without a preceding abrupt element ; and besides, the comon exertion of force does not require the coalescence. These circum- stances will prevent the effect of the junction becoming familiar to the ear, and pasing for a proper and constant character of the Avord. A forcible pronunciation acording to this methotl, will therefore sometimes create confusion in the perception of words ; and lead in most instances, to that momentary hesitation on the part of an audience, which prevents a ready comprehension of oral discourse. Let the phrase 7nusic sweet art, be pronounced in this manner, and the combination will present an image both ludicrous and contradictory. ' If what has been said, on the means for efecting distinct articu- lation, by a full and clearly formed radical stres, is strictly apliod; the designed purpose of this junction of tonic with abrupt elements may be acomplished without interfering with the perception of a clear outline in the boundary of words ; for this demarkation is riecesary for distinct and dignified uterance, in the thotful purpose of an exalted elocution. In the rapid energy of coloquial speech, and of the pasionate haste of emphatic discourse, this coalescence of the elements is more liable to ocur ; nor in these instances can it always be avoided. THE GUTURAL VIBRATION. 389 SECTION XLIY. OJ the GtUural Vibration. In our section on the -mechanism of the voice, it was said that the retraction of the root of the tongue, together with a closure of the pharynx, produces a contact of the sides of tlie vocal canal above the glotis, and gives a harsh vibration^ from the gush of air thru the straitened pasage. This peculiar sound may be made on both tonic and subtonic elements ; nor is their articulation much afected, by union with this Grating noise. I have caled this func- tion the Gutural Vibration, on acount of its aparent formal cause. This gutural function is practicable on all the intervals of the scale ; and it adds to their respective characters, its own peculiar expresion. This expresion consists in the strongest degree of con- tempt, disgust, aversion, or execration ; and these states are most strongly marked on the intonation of the waves. When the gutural vibration is given with an exploded radical stres, it makes the speaker himself feel, in its disruption, that the efect must spread widely around him ; and by this combined per- cusive influence must, with the fulest power of expresion, break thru the ear, and so to speak, into the very heart of an audience. Having thus described the peculiar forijis and degrees of Vo- cality. Time, Force, Abruptnes, and Pitch, and having shown the aplication of force to the diferent parts of the concrete^ we are now prepared to consider their various uses on single words and sylables, comprehended under the terms Acent, and Emphasis. This detail will form respectively the subjects of the two folowing sections. 390 OF ACENT. SECTION XLV. Of Acent. Agent is defined in philology to bej the Distinguishing of one sylable of a word from others, by the aplication of greater vocal force upon it. This is a true, but limited acount of acentj for it will be found that the acentual characteristic consists in a sylable being brought under the special notice of the ear. This may be done by force ; but it may be likewise efected with other audible means. In a mature language, no word utcred singly, except as an elip- tical proposition, conveys any inteligible relationship or meaning. Acent, as we use the term, is an atribute only of individual words, and cannot therefore embrace what is properly caled expresion. When a word, either from force or other cause, denotes a remark- able meaning, it constitutes what is called Emphasis. If we have here acurately stated the diference between acent and emphasisj Acent may be described in general terms, to be the fixed, but inthotive, and inexpresive distinction between the sylables of a word ; and forming in every word of more than one, that esential and striking feature, by which thut or pasion is, when re- quired, cmphaticaly conveyed. This simple audible-prominence of acent may be efected by radical stresj the loud concretej and a longer quantity on the noted sylable. And First. Radical stres is the apropriate acent of imutable sylables. The word iterated has four short sylables, with the acent on the first. Its brevity not admitting the distinction of a pro- longed quantity, or even of the loud concrete, the acent must be made by a suden burst of the Radical, into a momentary stres. The acent may be readily transfercd to each of the other sylables, by giving the necesary degree of radical abruptncs respectively to them. Second. Sylables of suficicnt length to render the radical and vanishing movement conizable, admit of acentual distinction by the Loud concrete. In the word PacUngton, the three sylables OF ACENT. 391 are of moderate length, and about equal. As the first has quan- tity suficient to prevent the necesity of adopting the explosive radical stres, its high acentual relief can be brought outj and readily transfered to each of the others, by the loud concrete alone. Sylables adapted to the loud concrete may receve at the same time, an adition of the radical stres ; the former however being adequate to the inexpresive purpose of acent, radical abruptnes is unecesary. As the Thoro stres may sometimes be aplied on a moderately short sylable, it might be asigned, as one of the means of acent ; but it is scarcely to be distinguished from the radical stres and from the loud concrete, on these short quantitiesj and therefore does not here deserve a separate consideration. Third. When the time or quantity of one sylable excedes the time of another, that quantity, acording to our definition, may give an atractive or acentual distinction; and even unassisted by loudness or abruptnes, sometimes necesarily asumes it. The word victory, pronounced with the usual degree of radical stres on the first sylable, and the second subsequently prolonged, as if writen vic-toe-ry, has the impresive distinctionj which in this case may be caled the Temporal acentj postponed to that second, if utered with comparative feeblenes, and with all posible omision of abruptnes. Words which consist of sylables of equal time, such as needful, empire, farewell, sincere, and amen, easily undergo a change of acent to either sylable, by a slight adition to its length. The word heaven, pronounced as one sylable, heavn, has the acent in its long quantity : divided into two sylables of equal time, as in heav-en, the place of the acent is doubtful, or the word may be said to have two equal acents. These are the three means for acentual distinction ; acent being the prominent and fixed feature that identifies a word, independ- ently of any peculiar meaning or expresion. And as they are suficient to give importance to sylables, without denoting at the same time thot or pasion, which Ls the purpose of emphasisj we may perceve the line of separation between these functions. It is true, emphasis cannot exist without acent, for the emphatic is always the acented sylable; and the expresive power of intona- tion, time, and stres must give the emphatic sylable that atractive influence which constitutes the esential agency of acent. 392 OF ACEXT. I have pointed out only the radical stresj the thoro conditionaly on shorter quantitiesj and the loud concretej as the causes of acent, derived from force ; for the median, the vanishing, and the com- pound, are more coraonly used as the means of exprcsion: and in the plain j)ronunciation of a single word, surely no one does employ these last named forms of stres. Notwithstanding all the kinds of acent here enumerated, are represented independently of pitch, still they are necesarily aplied on one or other of its intervals. In plain narative or description, the radical stres, and loud concrete, and perhaps the thoro stres, are joined Avith the tone ; and the temporal acent, when not unduly prolonged, may take-on the direct and inverted wave of the same interval. For this gives dignity to uterance by means of its delib- erate movement, without conveying any peculiar expresion incom- patible with the simple purpose of acent. This remark does not refer to acent on single words, which has no character either of dignity or of expression. The use of the three kinds of acent, being in a considerable degree governed by the time of sylables, it is desirable to know the circumstances which render them severally aplicablej make them easily changeablej and give them a predominant and con- troling influence. Sylables, with regard to their time, were aranged under three clases. The Imutable, Mutable, and Indefinite. Radical stres is the means for distinguishing imutable sylables. The loud concrete may be given to the mutable ; as they have suficient length for the display of force, without the necesity of an abrupt explosion. Indefinite sylables admit of the atractive distinction of the temporal acent ; and yet they are sometimes pronounced equaly short with the imutable. Thus lo in loquacUy, and h, as an emphatic inter- jection, exemplify the extremes of duration. Hence, tiio radical stres may sometimes be used on an indefinite sylable, in its shortest time ; as it is in the acent of the words, idlcncs and ordcrhj. Some words, consisting of a long and a short sylable, alow the acents of stres and quantity readily to exchange with each other. In the noun perfume, the length of the last sylable yields to the stres, with a slight extension of quantity, on tiie first : in the verb perfume, the stres as easily gives way to the temporal acent on fume. OF AGENT. 393 Of all the means by which one acented sylable of a single word is embossed upon the ear, if I may so speak, in higher relief than others, the most comon is that of the temporal impresion. In English words the acented sylable is generaly the longest ; and the exces of length alonej without radical abruptnes, or an increase of force on the whole concrete, above the neighboring sylablesj is suficient to answer the purposes of acentual distinction. The majority of writers, without suficient examination, have resolved all acents into exces of force. Inasmuch as the radical is the principal form of stres for short sylables ; and as the loud concrete may be aplied on all but the imutable, it may be inquired, whether stres, or quantity has the greater influence in pronunciation, by its controling or excluding power. In most words, this predominant influence is readily changeable; as in Albano, Cordova, Ontario, comemoration, and purlieu ; the acent, of whatever kind, being in these instances as easily practicable on one sylable as on another. But in words with the arangement, and the habitual pronunciation, of beguile, indeed, delay, and revenge, the temporal acent cannot be de- prived of its supremacy, by a radical stres on the first sylable, except by an efort in exploding the firet, and abreviating the last. For it is sometimes necesary to reduce the quantity of one sylable, that the radical stres may take the lead on another. The acent of the word Emanuel, lies in the extended time of the second sylable. Scarcely any degree of abruptnes can transfer the acent to E, while man retains its quantity. When this is shortened, the first sylable E, may, under a strong radical stres, be made the leading acent ; but the word will hardly be recognized in the change. In regarding the subject of acent, it ought to be borne in mind that a diference in the vocality of the elementary sounds, may in some cases, be mistaken for a diference in stres ; for to many an ear, ee-\, and a-le might seem to be surpased by ou-v and a-we. \ If there is that predominance, then vocality may sometimes be a ■ cause of acent, or may asist its influence. The elements have diferent degrees of susceptibility, in receving the acent. The tonics more easily and conspicuously take-on each of its three forms. The abrupt elements are heard in the vanish- 26 394 OF AGENT. ing stres, and asist the radical explosion on the tonics; yet are utterly incapable of the loud concrete, and the temporal acent. The subtonics with little or no power, under the radical stres, fulfil all the purposes of quantity ; the atonies, tho heard in the emphatic vocule, never, in proper and unafected speech, receve acentual distinction. The impresive agency of acent upon the ear, is fixed in the pronunciation of the English language, on one or two sylables of all words, with more than one. It is an abundant source of va- riety in speech ; forms in part, the measure of our versification ; and when skilfuly disposed, by the adjustment of a delicate ear, produces with the asistance of quantity and pause, the varied rythmic measure of prose. Some gramarians and rhetoricians, with whom the inteligent Mr. Sheridan is to be ranked, have set-forth a rule, that when the acent fals on a consonant, the sylable is short ; and long when on a vowel. At school, I did not regard this great prosodial princi- ple : now, I perceve it has no foundation. For if acent is vari- ously produced by radical stres, the loud concrete, and by quantity^ a distinction of literal place cannot make the suposed diference. The abrupt stres will always be made on a tonic, (or vowel,) not- withstanding the sylable may be opened on a preceding subtonic, or an abrupt element. The loud concrete must be aplied on all the elements without distinction ; and an acentual imprcsion by quantity must consist of the united time of tonics and subtonics^ when the sylable is constructed with these diferent elements. All this however, is only a denial of the trutli of the rule, on the ground of our own history of acent. Let us hear how the rule agrees with the fact of pronunciation. In the word ac-tion, the abrupt stres is on the vowel (tonic) a ; for c (k) in this case, liav- ing no body of sound, is but the ocluded termination of oj yet the sylable is short; and in re-venge, the acent or the greatest im- presion on the ear, is from the quantity of the subtonics (conso- nants) n, and z/ij and yet the sylable is long. Language is full of like examples ; and from the ilustration they furnish, we may learn that the time of sylables beat's no fi^ved relation to stres, nor to other means of acentual agency. The })revalent eror on this subject must be ascribed to the general cause of all erors ; a want OF EMPHASIS. 395 of observation at first, and the asumption of notions, to prevent observation ever after, by those who adopt them. Mr. Walker has given a theory of acent ; making it dependent on the rising and faling inflection, as indefinitely described by him. If the preceding history of intonation is true, and if it has been clearly comprehended, the Reader must conclude, that acent can have no fixed relationship to a rise of the voice, or to its de- scent; for it is efected with every esential characteristic, under either of these oposite movements j their junction into the wavej and under all the changeable phrases of melody. Much has been said by authors, on the aplication of acent. But with the sole means of the Tongue and the Ear, yet with scholastic authority all around me, I began this history of the voice, with a resolution to speak from Nature ; and not after men, too blind or too proud to consult Her ever-open, and Revealing Book of Speech. SECTION XLVI. Of Emphasis, Emphasis is defined to be a stres of voice on one or more words of a sentence, thereby to forcibly impres the hearer with their peculiarity of meaning. Most writers, without seeming to consider the subject of much importance, indefinitely atribute to emphasis, a characteristic * tone;' and Mr. Walker beleved he specified this function under all its conditions, in his general, and vague acount of the upward and downward inflection. But authority aside ; let us try to do something to the purpose, by observing and recording. It was stated, that Acent is the fixed, but inthotive and inex- presive distinction of sylables, by quantity and stres ; alike both in place and character, whether the words are pronounced singly from the columns of a vocabulary, or conectedly in the series of discourse. 396 THE EMPHASIS OF VOCALITY. Emphasis is either the thotlve or expresive, yet only the ocasional distinction of a svlable, and thereby of the whole word, or of several sucesive words, by one or more of the various forms and degrees of Time, Vocalit}^, Force, Abruptnes, and Pitch. As this notable function represents the various states of mind, it is aplied ocasionaly on the curent of discourse ; but it may be employed on solitary interjections, and on one or two words, form- ing an eliptical sentence. It will apear hereafter, that emphasis is no more than a generic term, including s|>ecifications of the use of every mode of the voice, for enforcing thot and pasion. The stated means of quantity and stres which constitute Acent, being included among the enumerated causes of Emphatic distinc- tion, it might be infered, that in these particulars, acent and em- phasis cannot difer from each other. Quantity, radical stres, and the loud concrete, are* the same in both cases ; but their purpose and power in the later, invest them with the atractive influence of thot or expresion. For a detailed acount of the particular ocasians requiring em- phasis when restricted to the means of stres, the Reader is refered to libraries. They contain rhetorical, and critical works, seting- forth this part of elocution, with comprehensivencs, perspicuity and taste. It is our aim, to point-out and to measure the vocal means of this important function. Emphasis produces its efect upon the ear, by means of the vo- cality, force, time, and abruptnes of voice, and the varied intervals of intonation. The particular enumeration of thase means will be given under the folowing heads. Of the Emphasis of VocaUty. The difercnt forms of the mode of Vocality were enumerated in the ninth section. They are variously, thotivc or cxprcsivo, and some of them strongly afect the cnir. IJcsidcs their use in the general curent of speech, they may be ocasionaly aplied as em- THE EMPHASIS OF FORCE. 397 phasis on single words. I do not say, we are to include under this head, those questionable cases of what may be caled, the Pho- nology of Style, in which sound is said to be ' an echo to the sense.' The Reader may, on this point, consult Mr. Sheridan, and other writers^ and judge for himself, how far any individual sound of the alphabetic elements, may be considered as vocality, and aplied as emphasis. The folowing line from Milton's Lycidas, is said to be an example of this kind of expresion. Their lean and flashy songs, Grate on their seranel pipes of wretched straw. If the r, here repeated, be roughened by vibration of the tongue, it may be supposed to represent vocaly the harshnes of the Shep- herd's pipe ; but to me, the expresion, if expresion at all, would be lost in its afectation. And generaly, when cases of this kind do not consist in a resemblance of the sound of the word to the sound signified, or in an influence of the thot or expresion on the sound, they are often a false or a puerile figure of speech.* The gutural vibration as a vocality, is expresive of scorn and execration. The falsete may be emphatic, in the scream of teror. Of the Emphasis of Force. Under the Time-honored, we cannot call it a Satisfactory Sys- tem of Elocutionj Force or Stres seems to have been regarded as the principal, and if we except the vague pretensions of ancient * Buzz, hiss, and a few others, may be identical in sound with what they verbaly represent; but let not the Virgilian Scholar, impresed with theryth- mus of that apologetic maxim, in Roman robbery, of beating down the Proud, ♦ debelare superbos,' be misled into the notion, that the mere sylabic sound of superb^ is, in itself, an echo, as the poor metaphor calls it, to the thot of mag- nificence, or grandeur ; for by the transposition of sylables, which cannot vary the expresive efect of the mere sound, we might have the superb percep- tion of a Royal Banquet, changed^ if we may make the disenchanting and unseemly contrast^ to that of the homely table of Poverty, with nothing besides its Herb Soup and the convenience of a pewter spoon. 398 THE RADICAL EJfPHASIS. Acent and of modern Inflection, as the only means of emphatic distinction. Our system ascribes to it an influential but not an overbearing agency among the Modes of the voice. In the first section, Abruptnes is described as a peculiar function, and altho aparently a form of Force, is classed as a separate Mode. The influence however, of its character and ocasion is limited ; for it has no varied forms, and only a diference in degree. It might be aranged apart, and termed, the Abrupt-radical stres ; as at the opening alone of the concrete^ its efect as a peculiar function, and an independent Mode of speech is recognized. Still as the Radi- cal stress bears a congenial, or at least a clasified relationship to the use of force on other parts of the concrete, I have thot, ^vith this prefatory remarkj the term abrupt stres, even under its claims to a separate arangement, might here be included within the sub- ject of Radical Emphasis. OJ the Radical Emphasis. When an immutable sylable l^ears the acent, in a Avord remark- able by meaning, pasion, or antithesisj the audible distinction can be made only in three ways ; by vocality ; a wide radical change in the phrase of melody ; and an abrupt enforcement of the radi- cal stres. The tvvo former will be noticed in their proi)er places. And with perpetual inroads to alarm, *i Tho inacesible, his fatal throne ; "Which, if not victory, is yet revenge. If the strongly contrasted meaning of the Avortl victory, is not represented by gutural vibration, by aspiration, or some other available vocality; or by a change of radical pitch u])ward or i downward thru the skip of a third, fifth, or octave, the sylable vie must be raised into importance by means of the abrupt radical stres: at least no other form can be cfoctive while the sylable is limited to its usual or conventional quantity. THE MEDIAN EMPHASIS. 399 Let us not pass unoticed the impresive sucesion of sylabic quantity and pause in this closing line ; a prosaic lythmus, yet remarkable for the skilful comparison of the rapid time, and abruptnes of vie, with the long-drawn and gliding voice on venge ; the rest between the contrasted clauses, gradualy preparing the ear, for repose on the indefinite quantity of the terminative cadence. It is true, even an imutable sylable may be caried rapidly over any interval of the scale; still this rapid movement when not joined with the radical change, is of no emphatic importance. Altho the radical emphasis is here aloted to imutable sylables, it may be laid also on those of indefinite time. But these admit- ing of more agreeable fornxs, derived from quantity and intonation, they less frequently require the strong explosion of the radical. This emphasis is the sign of anger, positive afirmation, comand, and energetic mental states of all kinds. It is also the comon means of enforcement, whatever the time of the sylable, when discourse requires a rapid uterance. Of the Median Emphasis. The prominent display of the thot or expresion of a word, by a gradual increase and subsequent diminution of voice, can be efected only on sylables of indefinite time. It has an importance equal to that of the radical stres, under a form of greater smooth- ness, dignity and grace. In the folowing sentence, the word sole conveys the mental state of warm and serious admiration, which this emphasis finely expreses. Wonder not, sov'reign Mistress, if perhaps Thou canst, who art sole wonder ! Here the median stres might posibly be executed on the simple rise and fall of the fifth, and octave, when slowly prolonged, yet it is more frequently, and more efectively made on the wave. In 400 THE VANISHING EMPHASIS. the present case, the emphatic intonation of tlie word sole is given on the equal wave of the second or third ; the swell being at the junction of its two constituents. The Reader must observe, that in asigning the form of stres in this, and the preceding examples, I have been governed by the principles of speech, laid down in this volume ; and that I shall continue to aply them, in ilustrating the other forms of emphasis, included under this section ; for if these examples are read in any of those various ways, resulting from vulgar atempts in elocution, or from scholastic authority^ my meaning will not, in all proba- bility, be receved. Acording to our rule, the lines above quoted should have a plain but deeply admirative character, on the long quantities of its diatonic melody ; giving to the emphatic word the importance of greater time, cither in the wave of the second, or third, or even fifth, and smoothly impresing it by the swell of the median stres. It is not within our present purposej but it might be aded, that thou should have the wave of the second or third, to conect it both by quantity and intonation, under the emphatic tie, with sole ; and that canst should be set at a ditone above thou, to asist the emphatic tie, in carying on the voice, and with it, the meaning of the line. The intonation here proposed, may be taken as an example of the reverentive or admirative style. Of the Vanishing Emphasis. This form of stres is characterized by a degree of force, nearly equal to that of the radical emphasis. Why then arc they dis- tinguished from each other by name? The radical is apropriate to imutable sylables ; the vanishing cannot be recognized on tliem, as it requires some extent of quantity ; and while tlie hasty energy that prompts it, generaly asigns it to a simple concrete, Avith just sufi(!ient time for its execution, it is sometimes efectively made on a prolonged quantity, and on the wave. In the folowing examples, this inversion of the simple form of THE COMPOUND EMPHASIS. 401 the concrete may be employed for the expresion of angry impa- tience in one case, and of threatening vengeance in the other. Oh ye Gods! ye Gods! must I endure all this I Oh ! that I had him, With six Aufldiuses, or more, his tribe, To use my lawful sword. The words here marked in italics, when pronounced with the vanishing stres, have that Irish provincialism which characterizes in a degree, this species of force ; the final abrupt element in these cases contributing to the efect, by its oclusion. The vanishing stres is often used for an energetic, a peevish, or an angry question : in this way, the extent of the interogative interval, with its emphatic boundary, is more forcibly impressed on the ear. A cause of the peculiar expresion of the vanishing emphasis, may be this. From the ordinary habit of the voice in the simple concrete, it is dificult to produce a final fulnes and force, with- out giving rapidity of time to its execution : and this adapts it to the active state of mind represented by the vanishing stres. But we leave the remark to the observation and reflection of others. Of the Compound Emphasis. A DEGREE of emphatic distinction by force, stronger than that of the preceding forms, may be aplied to sylables of indefinite time ; for these, under the direction of a vehement state of mind, may receve their force from a union of both the radical and vanishing stress ; as in the following urgent call. Arm, wariors, arm for fight; the foe at hand, Whom fled we thot, will save us long pursuit This day. 402 THOROUGH EMPHASIS, AND THE LOUD COXCRETE. The imperative words here marked in italics, may receve this double form of stres, either on a wide downward interval, or on an unequal-direct wave, with a wide downward constituent. The vanishing stres being here, on the subtonic m, requires more efort to produce its fulnes, than when the final element is abrupt. The compound stres is however, more particularly apropriate to the forcible emphasis of an interogation : and I here cite an example, from the scene of Hamlet's violence towards Laertes, at the grave of Ophelia. Dost thou come here to ivhine ? To outface me by leaping in her grave? The great earnestnes of these questions, calls for the Thoro interogative intonation ; and the emphatic importance of the word whine, requires, or will admit the rising octave with the compound stres upon it. The radical abruptnes on {, sets-forth the threaten- ing rage of the Prince ; and the vanishing stres on n, conspicuously denotes the inquiry, by marking the extent of the interogative interval. We do not here regard the aspiration, to be joined with the compound stres, for the .expresion of whatever contempt or scorn, the question may contain. It must be confcsed howeverj the discrimination of this species of emphasis, in the curent of pronunciation, is not so easy, as that of the preceding. Still it is heard in the voice. Its efect is pecu- liar ; and by deliberate analysis is clearly resolvable into the double form of stres. Of the Emphasis of the Thoro Stres, and the Loud Concrete. In detailing the asignable forms and degrees of force, those of the Tlioro stres, and tlie Loud concrete, were described as dilercnt from the rest, and from each other. But I am not disposed to insist upon the importance of these distinctions, for the practical purposes of elocution. They exist THE ASPIRATED EMPHASIS. 403 however as forms of stres, and are perhaps used as emphatic signs of thot or expresion. Yet they are not, either in character or degree, when employed on short quantities, so distinguishable from the radical, and the compound stres, and from each other, as to require special exemplification. The peculiarity of these forms of stres, is relative to the time of sylables ; for when this is not so short as to require the radical stres, nor of suficient length to admit of a prolonged aplication of force, the required distinction may be efected on such moderate quantities by the loud concrete, or the thoro stres, as in the marked sylables of the folowing example ; where the first may receve the former, and the second, the later species of emphasis. This knows my Punisher : therefore as far From g7'aniing he, as I from beg\ng peace. On this subject, let it be kept in mind, that altho the thoro stres may be aplied, under the limitation of emphasis, to short, and ocasionaly to longer quantities ; yet when unusualy extended, in a curent melody, it has that rustic coarsenes, described in the thirty-ninth section. Of the Aspirated Emphasis. The earnestnes and other expresive efects of aspiration, may be spread over a whole sentence. The same expresion is sometimes restricted to a single word ; constituting the aspirated emphasis. Many words claim this emphasis from the esential energy of their meaning ; and these, in some cases have the literal symbol of as- piration, as havoc, horor, huza. A similar remark may be made on some of the interjections. I need not quote instances of as- pirated uterance in the exclamations of pasion, and in the pure breathing of a sigh ; the pages of the drama are full of examples. In the folowing dialogue from Julius Ccesar, the efect of aspira- tion in marking an earnest state of mind, is suficiently obvious on the words ay, and fear, set in italics. 404 THE EMPHATIC YOCULE. Brtitus. What means this shouting? I do fear the people Choose Ciesar for their king. Casshis. Ay, do you fear it ? Then must I think you would not have it so. And again, in the Tent scene, the earnest repugnance of Cassius is manifested by an aspiration on the word chastisement. Brutus. The name of Cassius honors this coruption, And chastisement does therefore hide his head. Cassius. Chastise7nent ? When aspiration is combined with the vanishing stres on a simple concrete, or on the various forms of the wave, it conveys an expresion of sneer, or contempt, or scorn. Aspiration may be aplied to sylables of every variety of time, to all forms of force, and all intervals of intonation. Of the Emphatic Vocule. When a word emphatic by force, terminates M'ith an abrupt element, folowed by a pause, tliat slight issue of sound caled the Vocule, generaly receves a continuation of the force; and this, by its explosive efort, becomes the sign of pasionative excitement. On some ocasions, this vocule may be used, with a view to press into a sylable all the power of emphasis. But it comes so close to afectation, that I hesitated about its clasification, as a fault, or as an asistant enforcement of speech. I will not say absolutely, it should be forcibly employed in the folowing linej from the close of the third scene, in the third act of Othello : but when the Avord hate, is jironouneed with the stres required by the pasionative state of the Moor, the emphatic vocide almost necesarily bursts from the t, in the organic opening of the atonic abrupt element. Yield up, O love, thy crown, and hearted throne, To tyranous hate I swell, bosom, with thy fraught. 1^ THE GUTURAL EMPHASIS. THE TEMPORAL EMPHASIS. 405 Oj the Gutural Emphasis. The excited mental states of disgust, aversion, execration, and horor, give their expresion to an emphatic word, by joining the gutural vibration to other means of vocal distinction. It is heard on the daily ocasions for revolting interjectives ; and sometimes on the comon curent of sylabic uterance. It might be properly used on the word detestable, in the folowing lines, from that dreadful malediction upon Athensj at the opening of the fourth act of Shakspeare's Timon; taking care to acent the second sylable, M'hich does not bear a stres, in the measure of the line. Nothing I'll bear from thee But nakedness, thou detestable town I When this gutural vibration is combined with the highest powers of stres and aspiration, it produces the most impulsive blast of speech. Of the Temporal Emphasis. If the quantity of "an emphatic sylable is long, and admits of indefinite exteusionj or the word has only an antithetic, or a thotive meaning, without the force of pasionj or when the distinction has the sole purpose of an emphatic tiej the impresion may be made by the influence of time alone, as on co, in the following addr&s. Hail holy Light, ofspring of Heaven first-born. Or of the Eternal, coeternal beam, May I expres thee unblamed ? Or more conspicuously, in Abdiel's warning to Satan. For soon expect to feel, His thunder on thy head, detJo?lace to thotive admonitions, and to the solemn declarations of retributive justice; and the unimpasioned but conspicuous distinction by temporal emphasis apears well acommodated to the uterance of the 'unmoved, unshaken, unseduced, unterified,' and prophetic Seraph. The Reader must have observed the close conection bet^'een the various vocal constituents ; and that with every atempt, it is im- posible to represent each separately, in the necesary ilustrations. We here speak of the simple extension of quantity as the means of emphasis, when in reality that quantity is in part efective, under the influence of some form of intonation. Extended time on in- terogative sylablesj on those of positivenes and comand, or of a feeble cadencej has an intonation, respectively, on the simple course of the upward or downward third, fifth, or octave. But in plain temporal emphasis, like that of the above examples, and in a dignified diatonic melody, an extension of indefinite sylablcs is always through the direct or inverted wave of the unimpasioned second. THE EMPHASIS OF PITCH. 407 Of the Mnphasls of Pitch. It was stated generaly, in speaking of the pitch of the voice, that its several forms are used as the means of emphasis. We should now precede to the ilustration of this subject ; but as the rising third, fifth, and octave are signs of interogation, and as they have this character even when aplied to a single word of a sen- tence, we may inquire^ how the Interogative efect in discourse is to be distinguished from the Emphatic. There must be even to the comon ear, something like an unwriten rule, to which reference is instinctively made; for notwithstanding the frequent employ- ment of these signs in their diferent meanings, these meanings are rarely confounded. Yet our discriminations on this subject have in time past been fourfooted instincts; let us try to enoble them, by giving them the suport and the exalted step of knowledge and principles. The various interogative sentences were named in the seven- teenth section ; and on that division, the discriminations are here made. In the first case. As the emphatic use of pitch is on a single word, or at most on two or three, there is no liability to mistake emphasis, for declarative questions with the thoro intonation. In the second. It was shown, that the partial interogative is gen- eraly applied to comon, pronominal, and adverbial questions. These, even with only a solitary third, or fifth, or octave, cannot posibly be confounded with cases of emphasis on these same in- tervals, in sentences without the gramatical structure of a question. How far it might be proper to consider a partial interogation, made with a single interogative interval, as conjoining the condi- tions of interogation and of emphasis, thereby justifying the term Interogative Emphasisj may be left for future inquiry and arange- ment. In the third case. Many phrases having the form of a question, seem nevertheles to hang doubtfuly between an interog- ative and an asertive meaning. When such phrases can be fairly resolved into an interjective apeal, or a negative question, or one of beliefj the positive state of mind generaly calls for an intona- 408 THE EMPHASIS OF PITCH. tion in the downward concrete, as shown in tlie thirty-second sec- tion. With these questions emphasis by a rising interval cannot be confounded. The folowing examples are by editorial punctua- tion marked as questions ; but the conditions above stated seem to aply so clearly to them, that I would exclude the interogative in- tervals, and expres these virtual afirmations by a positive down- ward intonation. Casslus. W/iat should be in that Ccesar? Why should that name be sounded more than yours? Casca. What night is this? Cassius. A very pleasing night to honest men. Casca. Who ever knew the heavens menace so ? Shi/lock. Ay, his breast : So says the bond ; Doth it not, noble judge ? Nearest his heart, those are the very words. In the first of these instances, Cassius does positively mean, There is nothing in Csesar, nor in his name. In the second, CJisca would say. It is a dreadful night ; the heavens were never known to menace so. And in the last, Shylock, by his negative question, does triumphantly declare. You know it, noble judge. If then instead of the positive, the interogative intonation should be aplied either thoroly or in part, to these phrases, their meaning would be obscured, or lost. Consequently, no case of rising em- phasis can be mistaken for such interogative constructions. When figurative questionsj those of gramatical construction, with a down- ward intonationj and when real exclamatory sentences, cary their expresion on one or two downward intervals, it may be made a subject for future inquiry, whether tiiis case might be civled the Exclamatory Emphasis. We go on to enumerate the intervals of pitch, employed in emphasis. EMPHASIS OF THE RISING OCTAVE. 409 Oj the Emphasis of the Rising Octave. The concrete rise of the Octave on a single sylable in a curent diatonic melody, remarkably distinguishes it from others bearing the interval of a tone ; and its efect has the true character of emphasis, even without the excesive stres, heretofore considered almost the single esential, in the definition of that term. The Reader has been told more than once^ the intervals of the scale are apreciable, even in the momentary flight of an imutable sylable ; and that the expresion of the octave on these sylables is generaly efected by the skip of a radical, from the level of curent speech to the hight of that interval alx)ve it. The emphasis of the octave apears then, under the form both of Slow Concrete, and of Radical Change ; and let it be remembered that one of these diferent forms of pitch is always implied, when we speak of the emphasis of other wider intervals of the scale. The rising octave is employed emphaticaly, for astonishment and admiration, embracing inquiry or doubt ; and for the especial enforcing of one word above others, in an interogative sentence : but this rarely ; for there is a kind of mewl in its long-drawn con- crete, that excludes it from those elevated purposes of speecli which it is the design of science to investigate, and of taste to approve. The octave sometimes expreses a quick, a taunting, or a mirth- ful interogative; and is rarely used in a calm, serious, and dig- nified question. It would perhaps be admisible in the folowiug sneering exultation of Shylock over Antonio. Monies is your suit. What should I say to you ? should I not say ? Hath a dog money ? Is it posible A cur can lend three thousand duca'ts ? From the temper of the two last questions, they Avill bear a thoro interogative intonation ; but the words dog, and cur, by an emphatic alusion to the previous rating of Shylock by Antonio, convey the exultation of revengej as well as an imediate antithesis to their former contemptuous aplication, by being run up to the 27 410 EMPHASIS OF THE RISIXG OCTAVE. keennes of the octave. Some readers might probably be disposed to set a more dignified form of intonation on tliese questions, by considering them as Apealing ; and employing a general curent of downward thirds, with a downward octave on dog, and cur. I only say, they will bear the asigned intonation, without making jDreference the subject of argument ; tho the manifest sneer seems to claim the rising intervals. The readings proposed in this esay are for ilustration ; and their purpose may be fulfiled, even if they may not exactly acord with comon opinion. There is a best in the works of every art ; but the latitude of admisible variation, within the reach of principles, makes an ample and a liberal grant, that sometimes generously admits even cases of unsucesful search after the highest excelence. Over such failures, the inteligent critic of another age will be neither quarelsome nor severe. The emphasis of the octave by a change of radical pitch, is exemplified in the folowing lines. 'Zounds, show me what thou'lt do : 'Woo'i weep? \ioo^i fight? vf oo't fast? woo't tear thyself ? The exasperated energy of Hamlet, in his encounter with Laertes, calls for the highest pitch of interogation on the words here marked ; but these words do not admit of the slow concrete. To fulfil the purposes of expresion, they are to be imediately trans- fered by radical change to an octave above the word looo't, which in its several places, is at the comon level of the melody. Thp emphatic sylable, when raised, is still further indued with the character of an interogative interval, by the rapid flight of the concrete octave, described in the seventeenth section. In the first seven words of the second line the voice does skip, alternately ascending and descending, between the extremes of an octave. While these lines are before us, we may notice the contrast between the two movements of pitch in the octave ; for tlie word tear, having an indefinite quantity, admits freely of the slow con- crete ; and the voice after being restrained to the discrete skip, on the precaling imutablc sylables, more freely, and with graceful contrast iisumes on this word, the intonation of a concrete or continuoiLS rise. EMPHASIS OF THE RISIXG FIFTH. 411 Oj the Emphasis of the Rising Fifth. The relation of the concrete fifth to the octave, in their inter- ogative character, was formerly shown. As a sign of emphatic thot or of pasion, the fifth is less impresive than the octave j from not having its percing influence. There is however, more dignity in the importance it gives to a sylable. In the folowing lines, from Satan's adres to the sun, the emphasis on thee may be made by the concrete rising fifth, for the expresion of its exultation. Evil be thou my good : by thee at least Divided empire with Heaven's king I hold. It is said here, and we alow the same cautious latitude in other cases, that a certain form of emphatic expresion may be employed ; for ocasionaly, the emj)hasis may be varied; as in the present example, thee might be in the wave of the fifth, or third, or even the second ; in the last case however, a want of the expresive efect of the fifth, must be suplied by a long quantity, and by the use of the radical, or median, or vanishing stres, on the wave of the second so employed. Nay, we will go further with the liberal construction alowed by every broad and self-confiding system; and under the principles of this Work, are ready to acord with the free-choice of any enlightened taste, which in the above example might prefer even the positive emphasis of a downward inters'al. And this, not inconsistently; for by the rules of a w^ell ordered system, such variations will always be made acording to the discretion that liberaly allows them. In the folowing lines, the emphasis of the fifth on the word beauty, is perhaps not absolutely unchangeable; but it certainly produces a brightnes of picture, well adapted to the admirative character, and which cannot perhaps be so well efected in any other way. Tears like the rain-drops may fall without measure, But rapture and beaxdy they cannot recall. The effect in this case will be more finished, if after the concrete 412 EMPHASIS OF THE RISING THIRD. rise of the sylable beau, thru the fifth j ty be discretely brot down to the line of the curent melody. It may be aded, that from the transposed order of sylabic quantity, a reversed order of intonation may be set on rapture ; for a discrete rising skip of the fifth may be made with rap, and a concrete return to tlie curent melody on ture. The emphasis of the fifth, by a skip of radical pitch, is further exemplified in the Une, formerly quoted to show the radical stress. "Which, if not victory, is yet revenge. Here the abrupt stres on vie, requires and receves asistance from intonation, by seting that short sylable at a discrete fifth above the place of not : for this gives expresive emphasis ; and a downward return to the curent melody on to, closes the line with the efect, tho not with the full form, of a prepared cadence. Of the Emphasis of the Rising Third. The striking intonation of the octave and the fifth is suited to the earnest interests and replications of coloquial speech, and to the forcible thots and pasions of the drama. The rise of the third, in still denoting severaly, both interogation and emphasis, produces a less intense, but a more dignified impresion. The rise of the third may be set on the word he, in the folowing lines. Who first seduced them to that foul revolt ? The infernal Serpent; he it was, whose guile, Stired up with envy and revenge. And we may add, that the words infernal serpent, being a positive answer to the question, should have the downward intonation, both for contrast to tlie rising third, on Aej and for emphatic wonder at the revengeful guile of the seducer. Some phrases however are simply interogative, and unacom- EMPHASIS OF THE EISING SEMITONE. 413 panied by those states of mind usualy producing the octave and the fifth. The emphatic distinction in these cases, is made with the moderately atractive influence of the third. Dost thou think Alexander looked o' this fashion, i' the earth? If in this example, Alexander, this fashion, and earth, be taken as emphatic, the distinction will be apropriately made by the third. Should the intonation on these words be in the wider interval of the fifth or octave, it would imply an eagernes of inquiry, and a light familiarity of adres, not embraced by the meaning of the question, nor consistent with the temper of Hamlet's moralizing reflections. It is scarcely necesary to ilustrate the radical skip of the third, in relation to emphasis. The word victory, in a preceding example, may be executed on this discrete interval, if the Reader should think the fifth, there employed, too wide ; for it will exemplify either case, acording to the degree of energy ascribed to it. The third, as shown in the sixteenth section, is employed on the emphatic words of conditional, concessive, and hypothetical phrases. The minor third, together with the rest of the minor scale, is the esential means of plaintivenes in song ; but it is not to be used in the system of speaking-intonation, set-forth in this Work ; and this system regarding it as a fault in speech, we cannot give it a place, in the history of emphasis. Of the Emphasis of the Rising Semitone. I OMIT here, a notice of the tone or second. The Reader must now be too well acquainted with the character of the diatonic melody, not to perceve, that the simple rise of a second, having no atmctive or peculiar expresion, cannot, by pitch alone, be em- phatic. The more impresive intervals, when not compared among 414 EMPHASIS OF THE RISING SEMITONE. themselves, are emphatic only by their contrast with the thStive curent of the second. It is true, a sylable Ls made emphatic by quantity ; and that quantity in plain and dignified uterance, is comonly efected by the doubling of the second into the form of a wave. But the impresivenes is here the result of time, not into- nation. As the semitone has a peculiar expresion, it can fulfil the con- dition of emphasis, when laid ujaon a single word in the course of a diatonic melody. We have an instance of this, in the first line of Hamlet's soliloquy. O, that this too, too solid flesh would melt, Thaw, and resolve itself into a dew I These words are prompted by three diferent states of mind. O, that this solid flesh would melt, is wishful ; this too solid flesh, is declarative that it cannot change ; and the second too, here taking- on the degree of an adjective, is plaintive under the repeated declaration. In these states, Hamlet implores with becoming seriousnes, that his living frame may be dissolved ; yet by the first adverb too, repeated more forcibly as an adjective, expreses his conviction of its imposibility. Under the hard fate of this con- viction, he repeats the word too, with a pathetic despondency, which requires and beautifuly sad, receves a slowly extended and slightly tremulous wave of the semitone. It rarely liapens however, that this semitonic expresion is found so insulated : for the plaintivenes which directs a single word, generaly spreads its efect over the whole phrase or sentence ; con- stituting the chromatic melody, and thereby destroying the solitary importance, or proper emphasis of the semitone. It will then be asked j how emphasis when required, can be efected in a chromatic melody. It may be by stres in its various forms ; and by time ; for the semitone is set on sylables of every quantity. It may likewise be produced by intonation, in the folowing manner. When a sylable calls for the emphasis of a wider pitch in a chromatic melody, it cannot be a simple concrete rise or fall thru the second, third, fifth, or eighth ; for these movements, by over- sliding the measure of a semitone, would destroy the plaintivenes, EMPHASIS OF THE DOWNWARD CONCRETE. 415 which by the conditions of the case should be heard. Yet, when a sylable of the chromatic melody is elevated by a discrete radical change, from the level of the curent, to a third, fifth, or octave above it; and when raised, is there utered however rapidly, in the interval of a semitone, the plaintive or chromatic character will be preserved ; and as the sylable, by a transfer of the radical pitch, is advanced to a higher point of the scale, its semitone by the addi- tional means of this acutenes in position is more forcibly impresed on the ear, and fuly conforms to the definition of emphasis. Of the Emphasis of the Downward Concrete. The downward movement of the voice expreses positivenes and surprise, and on a single long sylable, forms the feeble cadence. We are now to consider the maner of employing this concrete, for the purpose of emphasis, on one or more words, in a curent melody. The wider downward concrete is a very comon form of emphatic distinction, and exerts a powerful atraction over the ear. It can- not however, be used in sentences of thoro interogative intonation; nor is it, in its simple forms employed in the chromatic melody. When necesary in this later case, for denoting surprise or posi- tivenes, it may be introduced as a constituent of the unequal wave; for the rise of a semitone as the first constituent, will preserve the plaintivenes ; and a subsequent continuation downward on the eighth, or fifth, or third, will join to this plaintivenes, the required emphasis of the faling concrete. When we had ocasion in its proper place, to speak of the descent of the voice both by concrete and by radical pitchj that descent was repre^nted, as taking place, only from the line of the curent melody. It is now necesary to describe the particular maner of its movement in emphasis. In the twenty-second section, a notation is given of the folowing line. Seems, madam, nay, it is! I know not seems. In that notation, one of its emphatic sylables is marked with a 416 EMPHASIS OF THE DOWNWARD CONCRETE. downward fifth ; tlie concrete apearing on the staff, with its radical the whole extent of that interval above the curent melody. I then merely pointed out the peculiarity; not Avishing, in that view of the downward concrete, to anticipate the history of its aplica- tion to the especial subject of the present section. Should the word is, in the above line, be utered as a feeble cadence, by the descent of a third from the line of the curent melody, as if it were the close of a sentence, it would not have the impresive efect, required by the meaning. It cannot then, be a simple descent of the voice from the line of a curent melody, which gives an emphatic character to this downward movement. The full efect of the concrete, in this case, is produced by com- encing its radical, on a line of pitch above the curent melody, and descending to that line or below it, acording to the force of ex- presion. The hight at which the outset or radical of the descend- ing concrete is to be taken, depends on the degree of positivenes or surprise, designed in the emphasis. That the expresive efect of the downward concrete precedes from its afinity in form Avith the cadence, I will not asert. There seems however, to be some- thing like an ultimate afirmation implied in a very positive em- phasise as if it meant, this afirmation is beyond doubt, then let the subject here be closed. It may perhaps be askedj why the downward vanish, emphat- icaly used in the curent melody, does not produce the efect of a cadence, and interupt the continuous thot or expresion of discourse. Let it be recolectedj the feeblest form of the cadence consists in the concrete descent by the third ; consequently the downward emphasis can at most, amount but to this feeble form. Again, the proper cadence is continued downward from the line of the curent melody ; whereas the empliatic downward concrete, begins on a degree of the scale above the line of the melwly, and does not always descend below it. •>' And further : speech has two means for convoying the mental states of thot and jntsion. One, by a convontioiml language, which to the ear, can describe them all. Tlie other, by the various Mcxles and forms of the voice, that instinctively expres many of these mental states, when engrafted on words. A s})oken cadence is denoted, both by the vocal sign, in its three descending radicals, EMPHASIS OF THE DO'W'T^WARD OCTAVE. 417 with the final faling concrete ; and by language describing the meaning of the words that terminate the sentence ; for the into- nation of the cadence, together with the meaning and structure of the phrase, and the pause, always marks the close. Consequently, an emphatic downward vanish in the course of the melody, can never be confounded with its termination. The downward emphasis by discrete radical pitch, has the same character as the downward concrete^ and is employed for a skip on an imutable sylable. The cause of a dowuAvard emphasis taking its radical pitch, so far above the line of the curent melody, must be obvious on con- sidering, that by a descent merely from the line of that curent, the octave, the fifth, and perhaps the third would in some cases be inaudiblej and always too feeble for the demands of these impresive downward intervals. Of the Emphasis of the Downward Octave. After what has been said generaly of the downward emphasis, it is scarcely necesary to state, that the octave on a long sylable gives the strongest degree of this species of emphasis. The word hell, in the folowing lines, requires the octave. So frown'd the mighty combatants, that Hell Grew darker at their frown. This is taken from that fine picture of threatful hostility between Satan and Death, in the second book of Paradise Lost. And who- ever would give this part with a forcible and somewhat dramatic efect, will find it dificult to bring out the full meaning of the poet, except by the above directed intonation. The meaning, if we may interpret it, is not to represent simply, without marking its degree, an increase of darknes produced by the figurative gloom of the brows of the combatants. Such a picture would be too tame and 418 EMPHASIS OF THE DOWNWARD OCTAVE. trite for this dreadful edge of batle. Tlie thot becomes worthy of the ociision, M'hen tlie frowns are said to be able to blacken the deep darknes even of Hell. It is not to our purpose to remark here, that a strong downward emphasis on darker, completes the expresive meaning of the Poet. The above forcible intonation is produced by the concrete pitch of the downward octave : and as the downward concrete emphasis always comences at a higher pitch than that of the curent melody, so with the downward emphasis on imutable sylables, the change of radical pitch is likewise from an asumed point above the curent melody. This may be ilustrated by the folowing example from the second book of Milton. Far less abhor'd than these Vex'cT Scylla, bathing in the sea that parts Calabria from the hoarse Trinacrian shore. Others may please themselves, with their own vocal expresion of this first line ; I can satisfy my ear, only by a concrete rising octave denoting an exagerated surprise, on Jar ; then a descent by the radical pitch of an octave, to less, for the emphatic expresion of the degree of abhorence, on that comparative word, by return- ing to the level of the radical of far, in the line of the curent melody. It is not the place, but I may remark, that ab is to be raised an octave by radical pitch ; and hor'd returned by a doAm- ward concrete, of that same interval; thereby completing the forcible expresion, by a faling and a rising discrete skip, on less and ab, between a rising and a faling concrete, on far and hor'd. A similar intonation is aproj^riate to the line that folows in the text of the poem. Nor uglier folow the night-hag. Here, nor rises by a concrete octave ; iig descends discretely by that same interval ; li, from the expresion not being so strong its in the preceding ca.se, may either rise by the discrete third, or fifth, and then descend by its concrete, on er to the level of nor, in the curent melody; or ^/tr, si u red as it wore into one syluble, may receve the direct wave of one of tliese intervals. EMPHASIS OF THE DOWNAVAED FIFTH. 419 In these examples, nothing is said of the stres, or aspiration, necesary for the full vocal display of their expresion. We here regard only the downward movement. If it may be askedj why this emphasis of do^-nward radical pitch has not the effect of a cadencial close ; it may be answered j it has in a degree ; but it is still an imperfect one, and not suficient for a full termination of discourse. For the descent is from a point asumed above the curent line, and its downward reach is to about the level of that line ; whereas the true and final cadence is made by a descent of two radicals below the curent melody. Add to this, the cause asigned in a preceding pa'ge, why the emphasis of the downward concrete is not liable to be confounded with the cadence ; as like it, the downward discrete emphasis is readily dis- tinguishable from the cadence, by the words, and meaning, and pause, that denote the proper close. Of the Emphasis of the Dovmward Fifth. The similarity of this interval to the octave, the diference con- sisting in degree only, renders it unecesary to do more, than quote a phrase in which the less energetic emphasis of the downward fifth may be employed. The word loell, in the folowing lines, from that brief and beautiful adress to the City of London, at the close of the third book of Cowper's Task, may receve the emphatic downward concrete of the fifth. Ten righteous would have saved a city once, And thou hast many righteous. Well for thee, That salt preserves thee ; more corupted else, And therefore more obnoxious at this hour, Than Sodom in her day had power to be. For whom God heard his Abraham plead in vain. The radical change of the downward fifth may be made on the word subject, in the folowing lines, from the first act of Julius 420 EMPHASIS OF THE DOAVNWARD THIRD. Ckesar. In the second scene, Cassias after exciting Brutus to a proud declaration of his love of honor, continuesj I know that virtue to be in you, Brutus, As well as I do know your outward favor. Well, honor is the subject of my story. If this is alowed to be the emphatic word, the meaning here conveyed, that honor is positively, the very mater he desires to speak of, must be expresed by a downward intonation on the word subject. But the acented sylable of this word is too short to bear the prolonged and slower concrete. The effect is therefore to be acomplished with a discrete descent, by assuming the first sylable sub, at a fifth above the current melody, and returning to the line of that melody, on ject, with the radical skip of a fifth. Some other form of emphasis on this word may, in a n^aner, mark a kind of aposition in the terms, honor and subject ; yet to an ear of discriminative taste, perhaps n'one will give so striking a picture of the identity, as the intonation, here proposed. Oj the Emphasis of the Dotvnward Third, The downward Third expreses a more moderate degree of the state of mind, conveyed by the octave, and fifth. In the folowing reply of Hamlet, the word Queen does not seem to require a stronger emphatic distinction, than that of a faling third. Queen. Have you forgot me ? Hayn. No, by the rood, not so: You are tlie Queen, your husband's brother's wife. Here we may again notice the striking diferenee above reforetl to, of the downward third, when employed as a cadence, and as cmpha.sis. In the former case, if the word Queen should deswnd concretely, from the line of the curcnt mohxly to a third below it, the sentence might seem to be terminatwl at that point by the EMPHASIS OF THE DOWNWAED THIRD. 421 feeble cadence. In the later, when this word skips to a third above the curent line, and then descends concretely to that line, in the maner of emphasis, it does not even with a subsequent pause, produce a close, but rather implies a continuation of the sentence. The emphasis of the downward radical change of the third, may be made by a transition from tlud to too, in the folowing phrase. Cassius. They shouted thrice ; what was the last cry for ? Casca. Why, for that too. Of these last words that is to be taken a third above the line of the curent melody ; and too, at the level of its line. It was said formerly^ the prepared cadence is produced by the radical descent of a third below the curent melody, on a short sylable, or by a descending concrete third, on a long one, preceding the triad. Still this descent alone is not terminative. For after descending by this discrete third, the last sylable does not neces- arily end with the down^vard tone required at a close ; and it will be recolected, that even this downward discrete skip of a third was caled a false cadence, from its not having the satisfactory efect of a period ; and in the concrete preparation for the cadence, the descent of the third can be, at most, only a feeble cadence. Con- sider further^ the structure and meaning of the phraseology have a share of influence, in denoting the end of a sentence. This downward radical skip of the prepared cadence, has in part the meaning of emphasis, by forcibly impresing on the ear the most complete termination of discourse.* The doA\Tiward Second, whether concrete or discrete, being a constituent of the diatonic melody, has no emphatic power. It gives variety to the curent, by ocasionaly taking the place of the rising interval ; and by its concrete on the last constituent of a faling tritone, makes the triad of the cadence. * Let not the Eeader, on this hint, unecesarily multiply terms, and call this the Emphatic cadence, or the Cadencial emphasis. 422 E^rPHASis OF the wave. The downward Semitone lias peculiarity, suficient for a strong emphatic distinction : but I am not aware of its being ever intro- duced alone, into the diatonic melody ; and in the chromatic, it serves only the purpose of variety, similar to that of the down- ward second in the diatonic curent. Of the Emphasis of the Wave. The junction of oposite concretes gives both by its quantity and interval emphatic distinction to sylables and words. If a history of the voice should be writen, from the practice of the mass of readers, and not from cultivated and rare examples of excelence, it would be necesary to add a Melody of the Wave to that of the diatonic and chromatic; as many, and some of the world's great readers and actors too, aply the intonation of wider waves, to every long and emphatic sylable. This, to say the least of it as a fault, gives the impresive efect of the wave to a whole sentence, and prevents its employment as the means of emphasis on a single word. The wave, acording to its form, expreses admiration, surprise, inquiry, mirthful wonder, sneer and scorn ; and is emphaticaly used on long quantities, embracing these states of mind. The dignified diatonic melody is made by the wave of the second ; and this is only a method of ading the gravity of its last constituent, the downward second, to the lighter efect of the pre- vious ascent of that interval ; and of ])roducing at the same time the length of sylable, so escntial to solemn uttu'anoe, witlu)ut the risk of faling into the protracted note of song. But the wave of the second never performs the part of emjiluisis, by its intonation alone. Waves of wider intervals, to give time and dignity to utcrance, double the concrete of which they are respectively com- posed, and have besides, a striking peculiarity when used for em])hatic distinction, in the diatonic melody. Empliatic words of scorn in dignified discourse are denoted by EMPHASIS OF THE EQUAL WA\T:. 423 the vanishing stres, or by aspiration, joined with either the simple rise or fall of a wider concrete, or with the direct or inverted form of its single wave. For there is a degree of levity and familiarity in the double wave, unsuitable to dignity of style. In considering the emphasis of the wave, it is not my intention to ilustrate all its forms. If the Reader calls to mind our history of this expresive sign, he may be able to do it for himself: and the varieties of the wave are so numerous as to prevent an entire description of them. I shall name a few of their forms. Oj the Emphasis of the Equal-single-direct Wave of the Octave. The Equal-single-direct wave of the octave actively expreses admiration and surprise ; and when hightened by aspiration, the vanishing stress, or gutural grating, has the aditional meaning of sneer and scorn. There is a diference in the efect of this sign on a low and on a higher pitch. In the latter case, it has more of the character of railery, or mirthful coment than of wonder, posi- tivenes, or admiration. It was saidj the wave of the octave, restricted to the lower range of pitch, might be used in grave discourse. Under this view, the first sylable of the folowing well-known line, from Hamlet, might receve the emphasis of this expresive intonation. Angels and ministers of grace defend us ! This sentence embraces astonishment, and the purpose of in- vocation. The positivenes of the later requu'es the downward movement; astonishment, M'hich in this case, impKes something of inquiry or doubt, asumes the upward. But the invocation apears to be the engrosing interest ; and for their respective ex- presion, the sylable. An should have the intonation of the direct wave ; for this, by its rising interval gives the doubtful astonish- 424 EMPHASIS OF THE EQUAL WAVE. ment, and by its subsequent fall, the final and more powerful impresion of the invocation. In the folowing notation of this exclamatory sentence, I have set the direct wave of the octave on the first sylable An, which by its indefinite quantity, beautifully receves it. On grace an em- phatic radical skip is made to a fifth above the curent melody, with a subsequent rapid concrete of the downward fifth ; for the time of this word will not bear the slow concrete of that interval. The other sylables have, in the diagram, the concrete, and the radical pitch of a tone ; and the Triad of the cadence, with a downward concrete to each constituent : yet for a full expresion of the state of mind they may take-on, and perhaps, do require a radical trans- fer to the uper line, with a rapid concrete of some wider faling intervals, as we described this form of intonation, in the seven- teenth section; thereby to contribute their positive, but fainter influence, to that of the two emphatic words ; the whole, with the exception of the rise on the first sylable, being ex^iresive of the earnestnes of the invocation.* A n — gels and min — is — ters of grace de — fend us ! 1 7 ^ ^ ^ \ ^ -i ^ X T ^ T ^ T 1 • "^ 1 * I may here refer to the gesture, apropriate to this exclamatory wave. In suposing the Enacting of this exclamation, I see the arms each in horor tosed up alike 'on end,' with palm and finger broadly spread-out in jirotectivc repulsion. The practice of the Stage, after more than two hundred years' close study of the Part, does not acord with this view of it. What intona- tion is given to An, by great popular Actors, I have never, on closely listen- ing, been able to trace: their belief, that such intonation cannot be taught, has kept t/icm from hearing enuf, to tell us. This sylable together with the whole lino is, on the apcarance of the Gliost, so sudenly shot-out, that the report is in-and-out of hearing in a moment. Astonishment and Invocation, on instinctive vocal interjections, are goneraly if not always, made on long quantity: and we see how admirably the word (inr/fls is used by the Poet, to give ' smoothnes to the torent' of c.vclamatiun on its emphatic sylable. But the Actor's violence and hury soem to be directed by anger and impatience, enforced in the vehement trick of striking oil" Itis bonot. If the bonct is to drop by the agitation of horor, let the true personating of horor throw it off, EMPHASIS OF THE EQUAL WAVE. 425 When the single-equal wave of the octave is inverted, the em- phasis has the character of interogation, from the ascent of the last constituent. Oj the Emphasis of the Equal-single-direct Wave of the Fifth. This form of the wave caries a less degree of afirmation, and surprise, than that of the octave; as in the folowing example, from the contest between Satan and Death. And breath 'st defiance here and scorn, "Where I reign king ? and to enrage the more, T/iT/ king and lord I Whoever will read, with its proper dramatic efect, the whole scene in Milton's second book, from which these lines are taken, will flndj the wave now under consideration may be set on the sylable thy, as a full expresion of the positivenes, vaunting authority, and self-admiration, on the part of Death. To show the diference in character, between this direct wave and its invented form, let the later be substituted in the above reading. The interogation produced by the ascent of its last constituent, will not only obscure the expresion of the poet, but absolutely cross out his meaning ; for it will seem to make Death insinuate a question, when he intends to be unanswerably afirm- ative. not a dextrous manuver, when the hands should be fixed, or only trembling aghast. I would not here wish to insinuate, that the bonet is cast oft", to turn aside or confuse a scrutiny of the faults of intonation and gesture; for with that ' genius ' and acomplishment, which the Great Actor is siiposed to admire and afectj the admision of eror, is imediately folowed by an atempt to corect it ; but certain]}', nine-tenths if not more, of what ought at that moment to be a listening Audience, are by forcible distraction, made to be only Spectators of a Cap-trap on the floor. After the date of our fourth edition, I saw an Actor, excelent in many points, quite carefuly hand his cap .to an atondant. Oh, worse still! We have now, time and quiet to muse upon the transfer : But, ' Zounds ! how had he leisure,' to think upon it calmly then. 28 426 EMPHASIS OF THE UNEQUAL WAVE. We need not give an example of the wave of the Third in its equal-single form. If we supose a reduced degree of its expresionj all that was said of the character of the wave of the fifth, both direct and inverted, may be ascribed to the wave of this interval. It is more comonly employed than the fifth. 0/ the Emphasis of the Unequal-single Wave. It was said formerlyj the unequal wave is used for the ex- presion of admiration and surprise, or of inquiry, acording to its direct or its inverted course. With a wide variation of the relative extent of its constituents, and its union with aspiration, or vanish- ing stress, or gutural vibration, it becomes a forcible sign of scorn. The last word of the folowing contemptuous retort of Coriolanus, on the Volcian General who had caled him a ' boy of tears,' might perhaps be given as an instance of the ascent of a fifth, and the subsequent continuous descent of an octave. False hound 1 If you have writ your anals true, 'tis there That, like an eagle in a dove-cote, I Flutercd your Voices in Corioli ; Alone I did it. Boy. It is not here the place, to notice the strong aspiration nccesary to exprcs the scornful stiite of the speaker. I have heard this syl- able pronounced on the Stage, with the simple downward emj)hasis. There is more cool wonder and self-satisfaction in this intonation, than belongs to the vexed pride of the Roman, and to his vehe- ment retort of a charge of inconstancy, which he nuist have half- acknowledged to himself. In the folowing lines, from the contention between Brutus and Cassius, the word yea may bear a dircct-unocjual wave, consisting of the rise of a tone or third continued into the fall of a third or fifth. 1 EMPHASIS OF THE UNEQUAL WAVE. 427 For, from this day forth, I'll use you for my mirth, yea, for my laughter, When you are waspish. If this word be given without aspiration, vanishing stres, or gutural vibration, the expresion will perhaps scarcely difer from that of the equal wave. The sneer must therefore depend on a union of some one or more of these several vocal signs, with the simple uterance. The intonation of complaint, on the word wrong, at its second place, in the folowing line, may be taken as an example of the emphasis of an unequal wave, with its first constituent, a semitone, and its second, a downward third or fifth, acording to the force required by the plaintive appeal. You wrong me every way, you wrong me, Brutus. I do not give an ilustration of the double wave of ^vider inter- vals. Serious and elevated discourse can have all its purposes of thot and pasion fulfiled without it ; and it is not the design of this esay, to point out to children and drolls, the scientific mode of derisively imitating the surprise of their neighbors, by the curling mockery of this vulgar intonation. How far the double wave of the second may be employed, for temporal emphasis, I leave others to determine. There is little to be said, on what, in the forty-first section, we call the Time of the concrete, as a means of emphasis. Its varia- tions are realy perceptible by strict atention ; but they are so closely united with the forms of stres, that a separate coiLsideration of them is unnecesary. 428 EMPHASIS OF THE TREMOR. Of the Emphads of the Tremor. The tremor may be aplied to a limited succesion of svlables, and in a maner, constitnte small portions of a tremulous melody. We have here to consider its ocasional aplication to one or two words, in the curent of speech. The tremor on a single tonic, or subtonic element, in any inter- val except the semitone, is the sign of laughter ; and consequently joins to the emphatic meaning of words, the expresion of joy and admiration. Thou art the ruins of the noblest man, That ever lived in the tide of times. There is a degree of dignified exultation, and a suj^erlative compliment in this eulogy, that cannot be properly expresed by the simple movement of the concrete. The first sylable of the emphatic word noblest, utered with the tremulous intonation of the wave of the third or second, on the subtonic n, as well as the tonic 0, gives a vocal consumation to the earnestnes of the admirative state of the speaker. The tremor of the semitone or its waves, on a single tonic ele- ment, constitutes the function of crying. In the chromatic melody, it gives a marked distinction to emphatic words of tendernes, grief, suplication, and other related states of mind. The folowing lines from a dramatic part of Paradise Lost, in the tenth bookj if read with the personal action of the dialogue, call for the highest coloring of the semitone, and of the tremulous movement. Forsake me not thus, Adam ; witnes, Heaven, Wliat love sincere and reverence in my heart I l)car thee, and unweeting have ofended, Dnhapily deccvcd; Thy siipliant, I hog, and clasp thy knees ; berove me not, AVhereon I live, thy gentle looks, thy aid, Tiiy counsel, in this utermost distres. My only strcngtii and stay. Forlorn of thee. Whither shall I betake me, where subsist? While yet we live, scarce one short hour perhaps. EMPHASIS OF THE TREMOE. 429 Between us two let there be peace : both joining, As join'd in injuries, one enmity Against a foe by doom expres asign'd us, That cruel serpent. On me exercise not Thy hatred for this misery befalen ; On me already lost, me than thyself More miserable ; Both have sin'd ; but thou Against God only ; I against God and thee ; And to the place of judgment will return. There with my cries importune Heaven ; that all The sentence, from thy head remov'd, may light On me, sole cause to thee of all this wo, Me, me only, just object of his ire. By the lines that folow in the Poem, Eve is said to have ' ended weeping/ and her suplication, to have been acompanied ^with tears that ceased not ilo^ving. ' Speech atended with tears always employs more or less tremor. Should the semitonic tremor how- ever, be aplied on the whole of these lines, the efect would be monotonous, and the characteristic concrete of speech be lost in the agitated voice of crying. The mingled expresion of these two forms of intonation may be apropriately shown, by using the tremor, only on selected emphatic words. It may be well however to remark, that the above lines are not entirely subservient to the maner of uterance here required; for some of the sylables em- bracing the deepest contrition, have not suficient quantity to alow the eminent intonation of the tremor. The word beg, and the acented sylable of utermost are of this character ; and tho they admit of the tremulous function to a slight degree, still their limited time does not fuly satisfy the demand, for a free extension of the voice. The words bereave, only, forlorn, thee and more, by their indefinite quantity, give ample measure to intonation. On these and others that might here be pointed-out, the tremor may be efectively set ; the rest of the melody having the smooth concrete of the semitone. 430 EECAPITULATIXG VIEW OF EilPHASIS. A Recapitulating View of Emphasis. On a close consideration of the foregoing subject, it will be difi- cult to draw a definite line of separation between emphatic words and the rest of a ciirent melody ; inasmuch as some of the fainter cases of emphasis may scarcely difer from the simply acentual and temporal distinction of sylables. To what case then is the term emphasis to be aplied ? Not to that of one sylable, which difers in any measure of time, or degree of stres from another. For by this rule, we may consider half the words of language emphatic ; as they are perpetualy inter- varying by slight diferences in force, and quantity. Still however, certain impresive forms of uterance always atract the atention of an audi- tory. Marked degrees of stres with abruptnes, extreme length in quantity, wide and impresive intervals of pitch, and a peculiar vocality, when set on certain words, are variously the constituents of emphasis. But under what mental state, these atractive signs, first become emphasisj and at what point, in the respective grada- tions of stres and time, the emphatic character excedes the comon quantity and acent of the melody, cannot be asigned, and perhaps need not be known. Emphasis has, in the preceding parts of this section, been re- garded as thotive, interthotive, and pasionative, under the agency of the five modes of the voice. Emphasis may likewise be considered in reference to other Purposes. These are : First ; to raise one or more words above the vocal level of tlie rest of the sentence, Avithout regard to their special cxpresion, or antithesis. Second ; to contrast certain words with each other, or to contradistinguish them. Third ; to suply an clipsis, and thereby complete to the ear the gramatical con- struction. Fourth ; to mark the syntax, on ocasions when it might be doubtful without i\\c a.sistance of cnqihasis. Another view of this subject might be taken, under the divisions of the Parts of Speech. When om])hnsis is laid on the article, it contradistingm'slics a subject as definite or indefinite, singular or plural. On a noun, it may either point out the relation of exist- RECAPITULATING VIEW OF EMPHASIS. 431 ence, or of genus, species, and individual ; or it may raise one substantive-thot above the rest of the sentence, without the ime- diate view of any special antithesis. On an adjective, the rela- tions of atribute and degree. On pronouns, its distinctions are relative to gender, numbei^, case, and person ; or it may indicate, as on the article, the definite character of a subject. On the verb, it may show the relationship of states of being, acting, and suf- ering, of time, and number ; or distinguish without palpable an- tithesis. On the adverb, the distinction of time, place, negation, afirmation, and inference. On the preposition, the antithesis of motion, position, and cause. On conjunctions, the contrast of conjunctive and disjunctive relations, and of condition. On the interjection, emphasis serves only for pasionative expresion, with- out embracing an antithesis. On the whole, whatever is the meaning of any part of speech, emphasis may not only raise it into imjiortance, and distinguish it from some other meaning, but may likewise suply an elipsis, and point out the syntax. It has been said j every case of emphasis includes contrast. This does not seem to be true of emphatic interjections ; at least the antithesis is not obvious. And with regard to the cases included under the detail of other Parts of speech, the contrast in many instances is not at the moment, a subject of atention, even should an antithesis be embraced within the th5t. Nor does it apear to be true of the ElipsLs, and of the Punctuative, and the Emphatic tie. It • is not within the range of my design, to ilustrate all the cases of emphasis, set-forth in the above surs-ey of the parts of speech. I here exemplify the four general heads, of its Purposes. First. The distinction of one word above others, without the striking perception of antithesis, is here shown. But see! the angry victor hath recal'd His ministers of vengeance and pursuit, Back to the gates of Heaven. The first phrase contains an interjective emphasis ; yet I cannot conceve with what see is in contrast. Surely Satan, in drawing the atention of the eyes of Beelzebub, did not mean to signifyj he should not otherwise perceve the recal of the pursuit : and to 432 EECAPITULATIXG VIEW OF EMPHASIS. supase see to be in antithesis to his not having looked before, or to his having a contrasted interest with some previous purpose, is a mere refinement. The case is the same with most interjections, whether they are properly the simple tonic elements, or with greater latitude, any of the several parts of speech. Second. The marked antithesis is exemplified in the folowing lines : I yielded ; and from that time see How beauty is excel'd by 7nan\y grace, And wisdom which alone is truly fair. This is the most frequent form of emphasis. Third. The use of strong emphasis, in an eliptical sentence, is remarkable in the folowing example, from the first book of Milton. Into what pit thou seest ! From what hight fall'n ! so much the stronger prov'd He with his thunder. Taking these lin&s as a complete construction, they are un- gramatical, and uninteligible. To one acquainted with the con- text, it is scarcely necesary to remark that the Poet meant to sayj See to what a dreadful pit we are doomed, consider from what an imeasurable hight we have been hurled, and learn thereby the degree of his superior power. Or again; as far as the horors and the depth of this pit are removed from the bliss and hight of heaven, so far has the thunder of the Almighty surpased the strength of our colected arms. This full meiining can be clearly brought-out from the eliptical phraseology of the Poet, only by skilful emphatic intonation. If the word icluit, in its two })laces, limited as it is in quantity, be given with an emphasis of the rapid downward-octave, forcibly aspirated, and with a loud concrete ; and if the suceding words within the notes of admiration, be also intonated with downward intervals, but of diminished extent, it will vocaly denote an astonisliment at the precipitation and at the doom, not fuly conveyed by the words alone. And further, if a cadence and a pause be made at falCn, and if so much be strongly emphatic, in any form that seems j)refcrable; the com- parison of the degree of strength in the thunder, to tlie measure RECAPITULATING VIEW OF EMPHASIS. 433 of the hight, will be obvious ; and the whole thot and expresion ■svill come upon the ear, with tliat laconic eloquence, in which the admirers of the Poet will be ready to beleve, they Avere united and condensed, in the excursive and selecting circuit of his per- ception. Fourth. When the structure of a sentence is so much involved, as to produce a momentaiy hesitation in an audience, about its con- cord or government, the syntax may be rendered perspicuous by means of emphasis, as in this example : He stood, and call'd His legions, Angel forms, who lay entranc'd Thick as Autmnnal leaves that strow the brooks In Vallombrosa, where the Etrurian shades, High over-arch 'd, imbower ; or scater'd sedge Afloat, when with fierce winds Orion arm'd Hath vexed the Red-sea coast. If this passage were readj Thick as autumnal leaves in Val- lombrosa, or scater'd sedge ajioatj the gramatical construction would be clear. But the chain of parenthetic specifications between leaves and or, together with the picturesk alasion, and the beauty of its phraseology, makes us for a moment lose sight of that intended transition to another subject of ilustration, which should be im- ediate and perspicuous : the substitutive purpose of the conjunc- tion or, not being at once aparent, the phrase scater'd sedge, might at the instant, be prospectively taken as a nominative in some new course of the description. Sliould then, the phrase thick as autumnal leaves, be emphatically raised into memorable notice j and the suceding words, extending to the semicolon, be huried yet becomingly, and with a somewhat monotonous course of melodyj a subsequent emphasis on scater'd sedge afloat, will at once refer the ear back to the last similar emphatic distinction of the voice, on auiumnal leaves, and indicate, that the Angel forms lay likewise as thick as the scatered sedge afloat. This maner of denoting the syntax and the meaning was caled, in the section on Grouping, the Emphatic tie ; and certainly in the present case, it has no other object than to join these disevered thots; for a more direct and perspicuous arangement would not 434 EECAPITULATIXG VIEW OF EMPHASIS. require the emphatic distinction. And the same is true of the like empliatic use of the Punctuative reference. Having enumerated the various modes of time, vocality, force, abruptnes, and intonation, hy which certain words or sylables are strongly urged upon the ear, the Reader is prepared to receve the term emphasis, with a wider definition than is usually given of it. Emphasis is a generic term for the extraordinar}' impressivenes of the tliotive, interthotive, and pasionative meaning of words; these three species of impresion being respectively produced by the varied uses of the several Modes of the voice. From this view it apears, that Emphasis, and Avhat we have caled th(3tive and expressive speech, may be considered in most cases, as convertible generic terms : for emphatic ■words difer from such as are unemphatic, only in the use of those vocal signs which denote the mental states of thot and pasion. The preceding analysis Avill enable us to display the whole com- pas of the art of reading, with some amplitude of plan and acuracy of delineation. Words may be considered as representing simple thot ; an enforcing of it ; and as expresive of pasion. The prog- res of the voice in speaking is caled melody. The course of melody under the direction of simple thot, is by the interval of a tone in the radical sucesion, with a concrete rise of a tone from each of the radicals. But the portions of discourse representing simple thot are limited ; thots are to be enforced, and pasions to be ex- presed. The drift of the simple diatonic melody is therefore often interupted, by an ocurence of longer quantity and of Nvider inter- vals of the scale, both in the concrete and discrete forms. It was shown, at the close of the sixteenth section, that besides the seven forms of radical pitch, caled the phrases of melody, other radical sucesions of wider intervals were by the requisitions of speech, in- troduced into the Curent ; and on the same ]MMn('ij)le which directed the construction of those i)hrases, we have the phrases of the third, fiftii, and octave, both in the rising, and the falling succession. Having learned liow these wider phrases are employed, in \\\v im- RECAPITULATIXG VIEW OF EMPHASIS. 435 portant purpose of emphasis, we may distinguish them by an apro- priate term. And as we called those formed on the radical suces- ions of the secondj the phrases of melody or the Diatonic Phrases, let us call those formed on the radical transitions of wider intervalsj the Expresive Phrases, or Phrases of Emphasis. If the foregoing history has been suficiently clear, the Reader may now be able to take a discriminative survey of that prearanged system of plain melody, and contrasted expresion, which has been so long bearing its part in the course of human th5t and pasion, without an ear to measure j and a tongue to name its well adjusted waysj or a voice, with a use of the perceptive means, to fulfil its purposes : and if his mind is large and liberal enuf to let in other thots than those of profit and fame, he may herein posses and contemplate at least the picture of a wise and beautiful ordi- nation of Nature, if he cannot, ambitiously offer it either for gain or aplause. The exercise of an atentive ear, together with a resolute prac- tice, will be necesary for the precise recognition and skilful em- jDloyment of the various forms of vocal expresion. But as all the constituents of speech are on ocasions, at the comand of every tongue, however eroneously they may be apliedj a full perception of the principles that should govern an educated and elegant use of these constituents mayj even without the power properly to execute themj enable us to overlook the exercises of others, with the decisive comendation or censure of an inteligent criticism; and as in Painting, knowledge alone, without an aplication of the rules that direct an Artist, may authorize a conclusion on the merit of his workj so, in the art of Reading, founded upon science, the silent aplication of its precepts may, without our being practical Elocutionists, equaly authorize us to cary the steady arm of knowl- edge against the self-conflicting councils, and changeful orders of individual, or conventional caprice ; to hold-out against eror with the strong defenses of a learned and cultivated taste ; and to join the delightful but pasing perceptions of the ear, with the continued and busy pleasures of mental discrimination. When the Reader reviews the preceding history, he is requested to consider j its purpose has been to record the phenomena of speech, without a limitation of that purpose, to points readily conizable in 436 EECAPITULATIXG YIBW OF EMPHASIS. ordinary uterance, or practically important in oratorical instruction. As these phenomena were heard, so in strictest acordance, were they set-down; for there is in this Work, no Contribution to knowledge, which has not been drawn from Nature, by patient observation and experiment, conducted within the limits of that little space, between the Tongue and the Ear. Many parts of the detail will at once be recognized by the competent Header ; others will be afterwards receved into the growing familiarity of his in- quiry ; whereas some of the descriptions even if admited, will still be considered as refinements, beyond the reach of perception and of rule. As a physiologist, I have done no more than my duty, in this abundant record, however aparently useles some of its minutiae may be. Much of the acumulated wealth of science is not at interest ; but the borroAvers may one day come. It is readily granted, that some distinctions in this history may be at present practicaly disregarded. The several forms of stres are described as palpably difering functions^ and they are so in speech ; yet I have not ventured to insist on the importance of the diference in all cases. So in describing the intervals of the scale, it was not designed to exclude the fourth, sixth and seventh, or intervals even beyond the octave, from the speaking voice. Nor is it to be sup- osed that some of the intervals of intonation may not on ocasions, be used as substitutes for each other, without afecting the force or precision of speech. I was also, far from ascribing particular expresions to all the posible forms of the wave. In here opening the way for the change of Elocution, from an imitative Manerism, witli its inherent defects, to a directive Science, or rather, an Art Founded on Nature, with all its constituent use- fulnes and beauty, it was necesary to set-forth every function of the voice ; that the materials might be thereby furnished towards the future establishment of a system of instruction, for tlK)se who have the rare aim in scholarships of seeking its liighor acom[)lish- ments, in the abundant encompasing of principles, and the con- densing economy of systematic means. Tliat the investigation of this subject has produced much that will be imperceptible to the first scrutinies of the general ear, nuist be infored from ihe past history of human improvement. Tlie mysterious subject of the Speaking Voice has been at all times so despairingly considered DRIFT OF THE VOICE. 437 beyond the reach of analytic perception, that the suposed imposi- bility alone, will jjerhaps raise a stronger oposition to the claims of this Demonstrative Esay, than all the Author might despondingly have anticij>ated against his prospects, in undertaking this ' forlorn hope' of scientific inquiry. Many who in fine organization of ear, a capability of delicate analysis, and a power of comprehensive survey, poses the means for succesful investigation, will too prob- ably, shrink from the labor of experiment, and seek to justify infirmity of resolution, by defensively asuming the hopelesnes of trial. SECTION XLVII. Of the Drift of the Voice. He who has the rare gratification to hear a good reader, may perceve, that while his voice is adapted to the thot or exprcsion of individual w^ordsj there is a character in its continuous movement, thru parts or the whole of his discourse; identical during the prevalence of that movement, and changing with its variations. Every one recognizes this diference in maner, between a facetious description j and a solemn invocation from the pulpit; between the vehement stres of angerj and the well known whining of com- plaint. It is to this continuation of any one kind of vocal curent or style, whatever may be its thot, or pasion, that I aply the term Drift of the voice : and which I briefly noticed in the sixth and eighth sections. This subject is not unecesarily specified by a name, nor uselesly ofered to the studious atention of the Reader ; for if a particular drift is required on a portion or on the whole of discourse^ any marked change of its asumed and apropriate character, will do equal violence to expresion, and taste. The introduction of a tone or second, into the plaintive drift of the chromatic melody, would no less ofend against propriety of speech, than the erors of time in music, would shock the sensibility of an acurate ear. The importance of the subject of drift being admited ; let us 438 DRIFT OF THE VOICE. consider j Upon what it is founded ; and how many diferent styles it employs. Drift is founded on tlie various forms of the four modes of vocality, time, force, and intonation. These forms have been described individualy, as representing thot and pasion, for the ocasional purpose of emphasis. We here consider the maner of aplying them, and their peculiar efect, when employed on a part or the whole of the curent melody. The questiouj How many diferent characters drift may asume, is to be answered by ascertaining, which of the uses of vocalitA', force, time, and pitch, will bear a continuation ; some not alowing extended repetition without producing a disagreeable monotony. In general, most of the forms of time, stres, and intonation, may as ocasion requires, be severaly a curent melody, Avithout violating propriet}^ or taste ; others can be employed only on a phrase or a solitary sylable, and therefore should not be made a drift in discourse. Altho the character of a drift may pervade the whole sentence, yet the peculiar form of voice which produces it, is in some cases aplied only to certain sylables. Unacented sylables cannot bear the prolonged time, required for the drift of dignity; still the dignity is spread over the whole sentence, by its long quantities alone. We here enumerate the various styles of drift. The Drift of the Second, or the Diatonic Drift. Tlie diatonic, or as we otherwise call it the Thotive melody, is used for simple narative and description ; and having no remarkable cxpresion, should be, under Nature's ordination, one of the most comon forms of drift. The employment of expresive intervals, when not required, in the plain diatonic curent, violates a leading law of fitnes or decorum in speech. Let a gazcte advertisement be read with the solemn drift of a long quantity, or in the plaintive style of the seraitonej and all, at least of our New school of Criticism, will acknowledge the improper a})liciition of time and intonation. In the usual course of the diatonic melody, perhaps tlie upward concretes predominate; the downward vanish of the second, being ocasionaly introduced for variety; yet when recpilred by the gravity of the subject, the use of this downward second may without monotony, constitute a drift. DRIFT OF THE VOICE. 439 The Drift of the Semitone. Enough has been said on the sub- ject of the chromatic melody; it exemplifies the present head. This form is used in discourse of a plaintive, tender, and supli- cating character. It was shown in its proper place, that every interval is practicable on every kind of quantity ; the semitone therefore, in its drift, is heard on every sylable, however short; and even when unacented. JTie Dnft of the Dowmcard Vanish. It was saidj the faling second is sometimes used as a drift. The downward third and even the fifth is ocasionaly heard in continuation. Their curents expres positivenes; and an earnestnes of conviction j with resentment, when enforced by stress. The folowing indignant argument from the pleading of Volumnia, in Coriolanus, bears the slow- concrete of the downward fifth on all its emphatic, with a rapid concrete of the same interval, on its other sylables. Come let us go : This felow had a Volcian to his mother ; His wife is in Corioli, and this child Like him by chance. A continued use of the downward intervals, is as we have learned, a form of drift in exclamatory sentences. The Drift of the Wave of the Seeond. This is used in contin- uation on long quantities, for ocasions of solemn, deliberate, and dignified speech. I do not sayj this wave may not be aplied to sylables of moderately extended timej and even rapidly executed on those we caled mutabfe ; but it is on long-drawn or indefinite quantities that its efect as a drift, becomes remarkable. With an ocasional use of a wider wave, longer quantity, and the median stres, it constitutes the Reverentive or Admirative Drift. The Drift of the Wave of the Semitone. This is the most comon form of a pathetic drift : for the states of mind directing the chromatic melody, generaly call for slow time and continued quantity. Under this, and the preceding head, both the direct and inverted form of these Avaves are used interchangeably, in their respective melodies. The rise and fall of the simple second, having no peculiar character, the variation if any, in the efect of the terminating-interval of its direct and of its inverted wave. 440 DRIFT OF THE VOICE. may be disregarded. A\Tiereas, the strong expresion of the wider simple intervals produces a striking diference in the respective closing concrete of their direct, and of their inverted waves. The Drift of Quantity. Atractive characters of speech are formed on Time. In discourse expresive of gayety, mirth, anger, and other similar states, the uterance is quick ; and this is gen- eraly combined with the simple concrete of the second, together with a radical or vanishing stres. The drift of long quantity on the wave, is employed in all solemn, plaintive, and dignified siDcech. We might make a threefold division of the temporal Drift, into that of quick, slow, and median time. The Drift of Force. Loudnes and Softnes, or with preferable co-relative terms, the Forte and the Piano, respectively heard in continuation, do impres the ear with their peculiarities ; and the failure to fulfil the purpose of expresion on either of these points, must be included among the faults of speech. Who will denyj that on some ocasions the drift of comparative piano would be ridiculous; and others again, when that of forte would be disgust- ing bombast. The Drift of the Loud Concrete. This is only reading or speak- ing with more than usual force ; it may therefore constitute a drift, and may be refered to the preceding head. The Drift of the Median Stress. This is necesarily conected with long quantity ; and generaly with that of the wave of the second and the semitone ; for their prolonged time is always the sign of that dignity, which for the most graceful display, requires the median swell. These nine forms of drift do, by their continuation, impres a peculiar character on extended portions of discourse. Of the other expresive modes of the voice, none are alowable in that continuation which, acording to our previous acount of drift, would properly constitute it. Yet as the aplication of some of them extends beyond the limit of emphasis, they deserve a place next in order to the full or Thoro drifts. If the Reader is disposed to give them a name, they might be calcd Partial : and we havej T/ie Partial Drift of the Tremor. The trenudous movement is proper only on short and ocasional pasagcs, of what might be DRIFT OF THE VOICE. 441 called sylabic crying. But the tremulous expresion, both in the plaintivenes of the semitone, and in the gayety and exultation of the second and of wider intervals, is too remarkable to be long continued in the curent of discourse. For tho drift is a kind of monotony, it is only disagreeable when unduly continued or improperly aplied. The Partial Drift of Aspiration. States of mind requiring aspiration are like those of the preceding head, generaly limited to temporary portions of melody. When so aplied, the character of uterance justly entitles it to the name of partial drift. The Partial Drift of the Gutural Vibration. The use of this scornful form of expresion is sometimes continued for more than the time, and the solitary ocasions of emphasis : and thus produces a limited drift. The Partial Drift of Interogation. The rising third, fifth, and octave are the interogative intervals. Their use in jjartial intero- gation, excedes so slightly the extent of their employment for em- phasis, as scarcely to deserve the name of drift. In declarative, and other questions requiring the thoro intonation, the predomi- nance of these impresive intervals, gives that peculiar character which the comon ear at once perceves and comprehends. Still, as questions are but portions of discourse, and as these wider inter- vals are never used in continuation for any other purpose, this form of drift must be considered as partial. The Partial Drift of the Phrases of Melody. The IVIonotone and the Alternate j)hrase are sometimes, severaly used in continu- ation, to an extent that might constitute a partial drift. In the twenty-ninth section, a peculiar character is respectively ascribed to these two phrases, when continuously employed. It may be a question^ How far vocality on a part or the whole of discourse, might constitute a drift. The fulnes of the orotund may give a character of dignity, at once distinguishable from the meager huskines and forceles efforts of uncultivated speech. These are the several drifts, respectively continued thruout dis- course ; or restricted to the partial limits of a sentence or a clause. Some of the constituents of vocal expresion will not bear repe- tition ; and are therefore not admisible among the drifts. It was saidj interogative sentences of the Thoro kind might be 29 442 DRIFT OF THE VOICE. regarded as carrying a partial drift of the third, fifth, or octave. AVith the exception of this case, these wider rising intervals are never corectly used in continuation. The minor third, used plain- tively in crying and song, is in no way alowable as a drift j Nature, for some wise purpose, having excluded this sign from what she intended to be agreeable and efective speech. Its peculiarity will be shown when we treat of the faults of speakers. A current of these wider simple intervals being forbiden in melody, their combination into the wider waves cannot be ex- tended beyond the limited place of emphasis. There is however, a drift of this kind observable as a fault in readers ; nay, some, in their ambitious eforts can comand no other form of intonation. But the least cultivation of ear rejects the undue repetition of these florid constituents of speech. Of the streses, none except the Median and the Loud concrete are employed as a drift. The Radical would perhaps, be made a curent style in a language of only emphatic and imutable sy lables ; • and some bad speakers, particularly Pleaders at the Bar, who think thereby to hammer-in their argument j do use this stres, as if their own had been so constructed ; it is however too forcible to bear continued repetition, without ofending the ear and distracting the mind. The Vanishing and the Compound, are too remarkable as well as too violent, to form a drift : and it need scarcely be saidj the Emphatic vocule cannot be so used. As to the Thoro Stress ; whenever it shall be generaly employed as a boorish drift, on long quantitiesj the peculiar music of speech, every oratorical grace, and the comon social and wayside decencies of the tongue, will long before have left it. There is a point worthy of some attention, in the art of read- ing, and nearly related to the subject of this section. I mean that notable change of voice, required in the transition from one para- graph or division of discourse to another. It may be suposed, this is already included in the foregoing history of drift. Siiould there be a strong or peculiar expresion in the new paragraph, it will be plainly distinguished by its proper character. Yet with- out seeing the page, we sometimes know tliat a reiuler is pjising to a new subject, even when there is no striking alteration of style : and when the plain diatonic melody continues, after the transition. DRIFT OF THE VOICE. 443 The recognition in this case, is produced by several means. First. By the period preceding the change, being made with that most complete close, the prepared cadence ; this indicates the termina- tion of a preceding, and the transition to another subject. Second. By a pause, longer than that between sentences nearly related to each other. Third. By the suceding sentence or paragraph, be- gining at a pitch above or below the line of the previous curent. Fourth. By a striking contrast between the triad of the cadence preceding a pause, and the outset of a folowing phrase. These vocal indications make the change of subject obvious, when a peculiar construction of the sentence imed lately folowing the period, defers the development of its thot or expresionj and renders it imposible to ascertain, by the few first words, whether the proximate sentences are imediately or remotely related to each other. From a review of this subject j it apears that many of the vocal signs may be continuously used as a drift, without producing monotony ; some admiting of repetition, only to a certain extent ; others cannot be aplied beyond the solitary place of emphasis. By a beautiful fitnes, and consistency, these signs when inadmisible as a drift, have a very striking character, and are reserved for only the ocasional purposes of emphatic distinction. From this cause, the downward eighth, with its impresive intonation, is never used in drift. The case is similar with the wider forms of the wave ; and with the rising third, fifth, and octave, when not employed for interogation. After what has been said, a little atention will show that several drifts may exist at once, in the same melody. A curent of the second, of short time, and of loudnes, may be united. In like maner we may have a combination of the drifts of the piano or the forte, with a wave of the second, a long quantity, and a me- dian stress. The Reader can ascertain which of them may be combined, by knowing the compatible characteristics of the several means of expresion ; for they are united in every practicable way. It is not necesary to give extracts from authors, to ilustrate the various kinds of drift. With a knowledge of the modes of the voice, and their forms, together with the foregoing history of their general and particular uses, further explanation is unecesary. For 444 DRIFT OF THE VOICE. I am not less solicitous to limit the pages of this esay, than desirous to extend the measure of its instruction. We have si3oken of the material of drift, variously consisting of the several modes of the voice. It may be otherwise regarded as directed by thot and pasion, which respectively employ the forms, degrees and varieties of those modes. From this view, and from what w^e have learned in previous parts of this esay, it apearsj the modes of the voice may be generalized with every other voluntary and designed animal action ; and shown to be like them, directed by a preceding mental condition. This being the entire proces of the mind with vocal signs, it folows that the indi- vidual state of thot or pasion, and its directive mental curent or Drift, each produces respectively, its individual vocal sign, and its intended vocal curent. Nor can there be good reading without it ; for an apropriate mental drift is required to direct and sustain the varied character of uterance. A dignified curent of unexcited thot, with its proper constituents under full comaud, and with suficient practice, will always insure a just execution of the plain diatonic or thotive drift. A reverentive and admirative curent will direct a still dispasionate, but more solemn and dignified uter- ance of its curent sign. And in like maner, the mental curent of the various pasions will direct the proper vocal curent for each. If then the mental curent of the three several styles should be interupted, tliere must be a change in the uterance : and we may percevej that a well-ordered state of mindj a full knowledge and comand of the constituents of the voiccj an acurate ear, and an inteligent exercise of it, are four })rincipal causes of corect and elegant speech. We learned formerly^ there is no long continued curent of these several states of mind, nor of their vocal signs; and that the dii'erent states, with their signs often interchangeably displace each other. This does not liowever afect tlie acordance between the mind and the voice; the groat esential of a true and elegant elocution ; for the vocal curent changes with the state of mind, and speech is still consistent with its rule. • DRIFT OF THE VOICE. 445 From a proper physical investigation, this apears to be the uni- versal means for executing the united purposes of the mind and the voicej destined under the influence of education and taste, to suplant the delusions of that metaphysical ignorance, or a knowl- edge of nothingj in which every asuming Individual gropes among his own conceits, for the elocutionary Intuition that may enable him to read with proper 'understanding and feeling;' but with its Legion of different Individualities, can never frame for itself a general rule of vocal expresion ; and that with the contentious temper of contradictory notions, can only set the Intuitive 'feeling and understanding' of one individual, against those of another. I will ilustrate this subject of mental and vocal drift, by a familiar example. Let the Reader give an important direction to a servant. He will perceve in himself, an earnest and moderately imperative state of mind, the drift or curent of which is not to be broken, except by explanation, or by a pasing reflection. The vocal drift of this Direction is diatonic, with the downward third or fifth, on the acented sylables, acording to the earnestnes of the case. Under this vocal sign the direction will accord with the state of mind. And whenever we shall ocupy ourselves on the state and action of our minds, with as much interest as we take in our selfish wants, and acts of folly or erorj that state and action will be as self-jDcrceptible as the vocal sign which denotes it. We will aply this principle of the acording mental and vocal drift, to the scene of Hamlet with the Player. Hamlet's part has three purposes : Direction j and as Shakspeare could not or never would write, without themj Coment, and Re- flection. The first is here distinguished by italics ; the coment by curved, and the reflection by angular brackets. The purpose of the inclusive interlinear braces will be stated presently. Ham. Speak the speech, I pray you, as I pronounced it to you, tripinghj upon the tongue : (but if you mouth it, as many of our players do, 1 had as lief the town-crier spoke my lines.) Nor do not saw the air too much loith your hand, thus ; but use all gently : for in the very tempest, torent, and as I may say, whirlwind of your pasion, you must acquire and beget a temperance that may give it sm.oothness. [0, it ofends me to the soul, to hear a robustious periwig- pated felow tear a pasion to taters, to very 'rags, to split^ the ears of the groundlings ; who for the most part, are capable of nothing but inexplicable dumb-show and noise: I would have such a felow 'vvhiped, for o'erdoing' Ter- 446 DRIFT OF THE VOICE. magant ; it out-lierods Herod :] Pray you avoid it. Be not too tame neither, but let your own discretion he your tutor : suit the action to the word, the word to the action; with this special observance, that you overstep not the modesty of Nature ; (for any thing so overdone is from the purpose of playing, whose end, both at the first, and now, was and 'isj to hold as it were, the miror up to Nature; to show virtue her own feature, scorn her own 'jniage, and^ the very age and body of the 'time, his' form and presure.) Noio this overdone, or come tardy off, tho it make the unskilful laugh, cannot but make the judicious grieve ; the censure of which one, must in your aloicance, o^erweigh a whole theater of others. [O, there be players, that I have seen play, and heard others praise and that highly, not to speak it profanely, that neither having the acent of Christians, nor the gait of Christian, pagan, nor man, have so struted and belowed, that I have thot some of Nature's journeymen had made them, and not made them wellj they imitated humanity so abominably.] Player. I hope we have reformed that indiferently with us. Ham. 0, reform it altogether, and let those that play your clowns, speak no more than is set down for them: (for there be of them, that will themselves 'laughj to set on^ some quantity of baren spectators to laugh too ; tho in the meantime, some necesary question of the play be then to be considered ; that's vilainous; and shows a most pitiful ambition in the fool that uses it.) Go make you ready. The mental and the vocal Drift for the Directive part of this Advice, was described under the preceding example of a strict order to a servant. The Coment being something explanatory, or ilustrative, or questionablej and employing a diferent state of mind, is to be utered with a less positive intonation. The Re- flective portion embracing the mental condition of disaprobation, or derision, or contempt, should receve the more forcible expresion of earncstnes, and sneer. And both the Coment and Reflection are to be given with a variety of upward and downward intervals, and wavesj as the knowledge and the taste of the speaker, grounded on the philosophy of the voice, may direct. To ilustrate some of our principles of stres and intonation^ I have merely marked with the comon accntual symbol, what apear to be emphatic words ; but have not time to asign causes for the choice. At six places I have included under interlinear braces, certain words to be caried beyond their apointed and still preserved pauses, on the plirase of tlie monotone. The })in'pose of this monotone is to unite upon the car, the act with its cause or pur- pose : as in the first casej the tearing to rags, is to split the ears of the groundlings ; in the second, the cause of the whipiug, is tlie DRIFT OF THE VOICE. 44T o'erdoing of Termagant ; in the third, fourth, and fifth, the pur- pose of playing, is severaly to hold the miror up to nature^ to show virtue lier own feature, scorn her own image, and the body of the time, his form and presure. In the sixth, the idle laughj is to set- on idle spectator to laugh too. In this reading, it is the monotone bridging as it were the pauses, with its level reach of voice, that agists raaterialy in conecting the cause and purpose with their object. There is an example of the emphatic tie on the words players, play, praise, that, and havej with a moderate flight, and abatement on intermediate clauses. The design of this grouping is to conect by vocal means, five words separated in the construc- tion ; thereby to bring to the foreground of perception, the player, his habit of bombastic action, and his unmerited praise. If in this instance, who were substituted for thaij the chain of the em- phatic tie would be stronger and brighter, from the greater stres practicable on its tonic element, and indefinite quantity. The tie is also to be aplied to judicious, and which one; to overstep, and so; to end and hold and miror. I would set a feeble cadence on ground- lings ; and a rising third on the laugh, that folows unskilful; a faling third on grieve; and a faling fifth on well, after made them. On the subject of mental drift, I would ask the Readerj if he does not know when he is angry, or pleased, or sorowful, aston- ished, or inquisitive ? For these are curent states of mental drift, which j if bad example has not confused or destroyed the original conection between the mind and the voicej will enable hira to speak properly, under a general rule of Educated Nature, that Shakspeare here aludes to, but did not turn aside to explain. In practicaly regarding the comprehensive bearing of these masterly hints of advice, I might show it to be an exemplification of a pasing thotj that if generaly, a player is, in his human char- acter, as obviously educated to bad reading, as the ' sparks fly up- wardj' Nature, by the instinct of her Dramatic Favorite, has shown, in his unusual endowment, how 'prone' she is to perfec- tion, by the indication of her laws of a true and expresive elocu- tion, enfolded within these general but sagacious precepts. And must I draw atention to it ? There is not, alas ! thruout the whole leson, except in the vague direction about actionj an alu- sion to the important mode of Speaking-Intonation ; which how- 448 VOCAI. SIGNS OF THOT AND PASIOX. ever, from the Author's many metaphoric references to it, and from his fine musical earj must have strongly afected him. Nor can yve avoid infering, that in Shakspeare's day, the subject of 'the tones of the voice' with their only nomenclature of high and loio, was suposed then, as this 'age of progres' regards it nowj to be beyond the reach of analysis, and consequently without a claim to be tat. And here the Great Philosopher-Poet, strangely unlike himself, in ceasing to observe and reflectj went-alongj as Bacon the Great Poet-Philosopher did with his belief in a metaphysical Spiritj harnesed-in with the unthinking mind of the crowd. Enuf has been urged in this volume, against the self-suficient 'genius' of the Actor, and the 'natural maner,' of the old school of elocutionj to prevent what is here said, from encouraging a conceit, that with only an instinctive thot and pasion, and a voice to uter them, we can spontaneously speak with propriety and taste : a notion altogether as vain, as that with the best instincts of virtue and sagacity, the great mass of us can, under the present narow and conflicting systems of scholastic, moral, political, and religious education, ever hope to be wise, or hapy or great. —•»e ©»«••— SECTION XLVIII. Of the Vocal Signs of That and Pasion. In describing the various modes and forms of the voice, I severaly named and exemplified, the most striking distinction between the Diatonic vocal-signs, denoting the simple state of mind, we caled thots; and the Expresive signs of that active state, variously and vaguely termed in comon language, 'emotion, senti- ment, feeling, and pasion.' This should, to the extent it propose**, satisfy the Reader; for it describes, in its own general way, all that to me at least, is audible and capable of measurement. But former systems of Elocution, having embraced a detailed enumera- tion of the pasions, without however, posesing the means, and VOCAL SIGNS OF THOT AXD PASIOX. 449 without perceving the necesity, of designating the special and apropriate voice for these various states of the mindj a like enu- meration, closing the vocal sign respectively with the thot, and the pasion, may perhaps be demanded here. Thei'e is a kind of hypocritical compliment always paid to originality, with this inconsistent purposej that mankind are eager to receve what is new, provided it is told in the old way. I can supose a Reader who, after all that has been said on the states of mind, and their vocal signsj may from the habit of a scholastic method and a term, still look for a separate section on the ' Pas- ions,' embracing the many unmeaning atempts to describe their expresion. To change this habit, if a habit can be changed by any thing entirely diferent from itselfj and to satisfy an expecta- tion by an unexpected substitute for its erorsj I ofer in the present section, a more systematic view and conected detail of the subject, and at the same time enlarge and further ilustrate our former acount of the vocal signs of thot and pasion. I had ocasion in the introduction, to notice the limited degree of our knowledge, in some of the scholastic departments of Elocu- tion ; and having, from the first, resigned myself to the authority of observation, have endeavored far as posible, to avoid that refer- ence to old systems and opinions, which might produce both con- troversy, and quotation: knowiugj there is within the limited pretensions of these departments, much that is uninteligible, and more that is eroneous. We are now about to leave, for a moment, the definite and luminous prototype of Nature, to contrast her lights, with the mysterious shades of the opinions of men. No author, as it apears, has paid more atention to the subject of Inflection or the rise and fall of the voice, particularly in its practical aplication, than Mr. Walker. Indefinite as he is on this point, he excedes in specified rule, all that is said by Aristotle, Cicero, Dionysius, Quinctilian, and the Older Musicians. It is true, Mr. Walker owes his superficial analysis to them; but in his knowledge of the purpose and use of Inflectionj infering from their records j he fairly ' treads upon that Greek and Roman glory, ' which national vanity first proclaimed, and the subsequent cre- dulity of European scholarship was simple enuf to magnify and repeat. 450 VOCAL SIGNS OF THoT AND PASION. Let US hear then what ISIr. Walker says of the vocal represen- tation of the pasions. ' It now remains,' observes this author,* ^to say something of the pasions and emotions of the speaker. These are entirely inde- pendent on the modulation of the voice, tho often confounded with it; for modulation relates only to speaking loudly or softly, in a high or in a low key, while the tones of the pasions or emotions mean only that quality of sound that indicates the feelings of the speaker without reference to the pitch, or loudness of the voice. ' Again in the hundred and sixty-sixth page. ' The truth is, the expresion of pasion or emotion consists in giving a distinct and specific quality to the sounds we use, rather than in increasing or diminishing their quantity, or in giving this quantity any local direction, upwards or downwards. ' And again in another work.f ' As to the tones of the pasions which are so many and so various, these in the opinion of one of the best judges in the kingdom, are qualities of sound ocasioned by certain vibrations of the organs of speech, independent on high, low, loud, soft, quick, slow, forcible or feehle.'X It often happens with modern aspirants after some of the sciences in the schoolsj as it did with those who anciently under- went the mumery of admision to the mysteries of Eleusis^ to hear themselves adressed in an incomprehensible 'language. What in- struction, for instance, can be gathered from this definition, if it strictly deserves the name ? ' The tones of the passions mean only that quality of sound that indicates the feelings.' Here instead of an explanatory description of a thing, we are presentetl with a truism in a periphrase. For, as the terms '-pasions' and 'feelings' must here be synonymous, as well as those of 'tone' and 'quality of sound,' the varied proposition may stand thus : ' the tones of the {or the tones which indicate the) pasions, mean only the tones which * Elements of Elocution, pac^^ 308, Am. ed. ■}• Observations on Greek and Latin quantity, apended to Walker's Key to the pronunciation of ancient proper names. I Let us here consider, that Mr. "Walker's oj)inions have been, for the greater part of a century, and still are, the source from which nearly all the school- books on elocution have been drawn, in this Country, and thruout tho British Dominions. VOCAL SIGNS OF THoT AND PASION. 451 indicate tlie pasions :' or with less waste, ' the tones of the pasions are the tones of the pasions.' The second extract however, seems to contain a real distinction between the subject and the predicate : as by 'quality' the author may mean that mode of the voice, specified in this esay, by the termsj full, harsh, slender, natural, falsete, whisper and orotund ; for these are the only existing forms of vocal sound, besides those which Mr. Walker has excluded from his definition. But if pitch, wdiich is here meant by 'local direction,' be denied a place among the signs of pasionj where shall we class the plaintive wave of the semitone, the rising intervals of interogation, and the downward vanish that conspicuously mark the various degrees of surprise? AVhere arrange the efect of the diferent measures of time, and the various degrees of stres, if speaking 'loudly or softly,' and 'increasing or diminishing the quantity' of sound have no agency in the vocal representation of pasion ? The real motive of Mr. Walker, in excluding intonation, stres, and time, from among the signs of the pasions, and in his assign- ing the expresion of speech to a certain unexplained cause called 'quality,' is clearly manifested in the last quotation; for here, this opinion, on the expresive power of his term quality j as it is no more than a wordj is ascribed to 'one of the best judges in the kingdom.' After all then, this confused notion concerning the pasions was adopted upon authority, by Mr. Walker ; and this confesion of his faith in others, certainly did not acord with his repeated claims to originality of observation. An original observer holding himself responsible for his report, cros-questions the testimony of his senses ; the borower of opinions is always less scrupulous^ as he himself never designs to stand security against the folly or mis- chief of his promulgations. What has been recorded in our previous history, may induce the Eeader to smile at the above quotations ; and enable him to perceve, that the vocal signs of the pasions are no more than the every-day audible sounds of the manifest Modes, Forms, and de- grees of Vocality, Time, Force, Abruptnes, and Pitch ; and that the greater part of these signs are derived from those very causes, which are declared by Mr. Walker, to have no agency in impas- ioned uterance. With regard to the 'specific quality' here asumed 452 VOCAL SIGNS OF THOT AND PASIOX. as the vocal material of expresion, it is not alowable to supose, the mode of voice calecl in this essay, Vocality or Kind, is meant by Mr. Walker's term; his acount of 'quality' being complicated with an atempt to derive its proximate cause, from some uninteli- gible system of 'vibrations.' Let the whole pass as an instance of that unatural paternity in instruction, which when asked for bread, dispenses nothing but a stone. And at the same time let it apologize for any aparently unbecoming expresions that may have droped from my pen, wlien unavoidably brought into contact with those grosser erors of indo- lence or authority, whichj viewed along with the means, and pre- tensions of Magisterial as distinct from Natural Science^ seem to be almost unpardonable. In reconsidering the subject of Expresion, under another view, it is not my intention to go into a disertation on the pasions, or to contend with authors about the scheme of their arang-ement. I shall describe them with reference only to the purpose of the present section, without designing to regard their other relation- shijjs. In the sixth section, we described three diferent conditions of the States of Mindj and three forms of the vocal signs, that sev- eraly represent them : but here for a moment, clasing the inter- thoughtive with the pasionative, we regard the states of mind, under two divisions. To the division of Simple Thot, the inter- val of tlie second is alotted. To that of Pasion, the numerous forms and varieties of the other intervals, and the impresive forms of vocality, time, abruptnes, and force. These two divisions of the voicej the thdtive, and the pasionative, include the Natural signs, which instinctively denote their respective states of mintl. But other means for denoting tliot and pasion being still re- quiredj Artificial signs were devised. These artificial signs are words, convcntionaly formed to describe tliese same states of mind. To ilustrate the purpose and use of botli tliesc chisscs of signs, and to show their relation to each other, I will here briefly again present, under its two divisions, our former view of the states of mind, on which we founded the distinction of their several signs. The human mind is the place of representation of all the ex- VOCAL SIGNS OF THoT AND PASION. 453 istences, actions, and relationships of nature, within the limit of the senses. These representatives we call perceptions. Percep- tions are either the pasive pictures of things ; or they exist with an activity, capable of so afecting the physical organs, as to impel us to seek the object that produces them, or to avoid it. This active or vivid class of perceptions comprehends the pasions. The states of mind here described, exist then in diferent forms and degrees, from the simple unexcited thot, to the highest energy of pasion ; and the comon but indefinite termsj 'idea, sentiment, emotion, feeling, and pasion' are the vague verbal-signs of these degrees and forms. Nor ,does there apear to be, where they interjoin, any line of clasifi cation, for distinctly separating the mental conditions of thot and of pasion; as simple thots without changing their meaning, do from interest or other excitement often asume the degree and brightnes of a pasion. This being one of the many views to be taken of the states of mind, we pass to the consideration of the efects produced on the visible and vocal parts of the human frame, by those thdts and pasions. These efects have been caled their signs, or physical ex- presion. They are of many forms and places ; and are severaly marked by sound, feature, change of color, and variation of mus- cular action : but we are at present concerned only with vocal sound. The voice, as just stated, has then two distinct clases of signs : the Natural or vocal, so to distinguish it ; and the Artificial or Verbal. The Natural or Vocal consist severaly of time, force, abruptnes, vocality and pitch. They have a two-fold agency ; for in their various ways, and by their unasisted means, they are sometimes significant of the states of mind ; but they may be, and generaly are joined with the artificial or articulated signs. In the former state they are the voice of infancy, before the period of complete articulation ; are comon to man and the sub-animals ; and are used thro life, both alone, and combined with the Artificial or Verbal, to denote the animal pasions of surprise, love, anger, fear, desire, search or inquiry, sorow, afection, joy, pain, comand, and other states of mind that may be resolved into these. The Artificial signs or words are acquired after infancy. These 454 VOCAL, SIGNS OF THOT AND PASION. may denote any and every state of mind, •when joined with the Xatural, or may describe those states, %cithout them. Tliey are produced by the use of the articulative mechanism both on vocality and aspiration ; and as descriptive signs, are more numerous than the natural. These are the two classes of oral signs, severaly and jointly representing the diferent states of mind, in thot and pasion. Some of these states are vocal or instinctive, and have the natural signs. Others are the result of human inteligence, and the social relations, and have no such signs, as those ordained by Nature in her own original mental and vocal creations. The mind has natural or vocal signs for pain, surprise, and anger ; but none of any definite character for hope, contentment, and gratitude. Here then are two essentialy diferent means for representing the various states of mind ; some of these ' thots, emotions, passions,' call them by what indefinite term we will, being denoted by cer- tain forms of stres, time, vocality, and pitchj Nature's instinctive signs, in the voice ; joined to a verbal or conventional language ; others can be described only by a verbal or conventional lan- guage, which may not cary the natural or vocal-signs. We signify comand by the downward fifth, or octave ; complaint by the semi- tone; and the meaning of these intervals. is the same in all nations, under any conventional sign. But it is not in our power, to expres the states of gratitude, and iresolution, except we describe these states of mind, by apointed and arbitrary words, that may vary in every diferent language. Let us then, by terms, clearly distinguish these two classes of signs. When we denote thot and pasion by means of Vocality, Time, Force, or Intonation, either with or -without conventional words, we Avill call it, the Instinctive or Natural or Vocal sign. When we describe or indicate thot and pasion by a sentence, a phrase, or a word, without the use of vocal signs, co-expresive with the wordsj we will call it, the Conventional or ArtifiiMul or Verbal sign. Altlio it apears we have not an instinctive or vocal sign for every state of mind ; yet every state of mind may be exprostnl by a conventional sign ; for one can verbaly, and in the plain diatonic melody, inform anotherj he is astonished, and convey a knowletlge VOOAL SIGXS OF THOT AND PASIOX. 455 of his being under that state ; as certainly as he can by the most striking use of the downward octave, which is its natural sign. When astonishment is to be represented on a word or phrase, wliich does not describe it, it is uecesary to employ its instinctive or natural sign. AVe have seen in the seventeenth section, that a question may be asked by a gramatical construction alone, with- out the aid of intonation. And further, an iuterogatory can be distinctly conveyed, merely by the verbal statement, that a ques- tion is asked : and this is often done in writen discourse, without afixing the 'note' of interogation. In consequence of there being Instinctive signs in the larangeal voice alone, to denote pasion, and Artificial signs in language, to describe itj one instinctive sign can with the asistance of the arti- ficial, represent two or more pasions or their degrees ; for, of tw^o phrases with the same vocal, but with a diferent verbal signj the vocal sign bemg the same, camiot in itself severaly signify difer- ent states of mind ; a specification, by the verbal terms, describes the diference, under the identical vocal form. Supose, for in- stance, one should use the imperative phrase, be gone, with a forci- ble downward vanish of the octave ; and again, with the same intonation, should say, icell done; the diference between the two states of mind, in comand, and in exclamatory aprobation, would be distinctly represented respectively by the imperative verb, and by the interjective phrase, notwithstanding their identical intona- tion. Thus too, the same semitone is used for the expresion of pain, discontent, pity, grief, and contritionj and yet in all these dif- erent cases, the states of mind are marked by the conventional lan- guage on which the semitone is employed. We are now prepared to take a general view of the subject before us; which, to borow a technicality from another art, may be called the Semiotica of Elocution ; a term which as yet incomprehensible, in its Into- native meaning at least j is, by embracing the full and just adap- tation of the voice to the mind, destined hereafter to be receved as comprising the whole esthetic and practical philosophy of speech. To repeat the important distinction j the Semiotic ways and means of Elocution, or the several signs of Thot and Pasion, arej First. Instinctive or Natural ; consisting of the forms, degrees, 456 VOCAL SIGXS OF THoT AND PASIOX. and varieties of the five modes of the voice. And Second. Arti- ficial or Verbal ; having the descriptive power of conventional language. In the uses of discoursej and we here return to our three-fold divisionj natural signs, under one condition of the modes of the voice form the thotive narative or diatonic Drift.' Under another of moderate expresionj the reverentive or admirative. And under the use of all the expresive powers of vocality, time, force, abrupt- nes and intonation, the vivid character of the pasionative. The Artificial have, in themselves, neither the character nor the voice of the natural ; but can by words, universaly describe their efects, and may represent thot and pasion, equaly with the natural signs. A union of the natural and the artificial gives the most exact and irapresive vocal representation of the thotive, the inter- thotive, and the pasionative jiurjjoses of the mind.* * The Verbal and the Vocal means for denoting the states of mind, are each so esential to the purposes of speech, that it is dificult to determine which is most significant of thot and pasion. The power of giving a diferent pasion- ative meaning to the same word, by a varied vocality, stres, time, or intona- tion, would imply the vocal or instinctive signs, to be more efective than the verbal or conventional. But other facts lead us to conclude^ we are some- times as much indebted to the descriptive agency of words, as to any expresive eficacy of the voice. It will hereafter be shown in the analj'sis of Song, that every function which we have ascribed to speech, is employed in its Elaborate style of execution; and tho it is truej the semitone has a plaintive character, even if sung with- out words ; still the rising and faling concretes of the third, fifth, and octave, when 7iot set to words which describe the expVesion of these intervals in speech, are constantly heard in what are caled songs of Agility, without denoting in- terogation, positivenes, or surprise. In like maner, the various forms of strea which are properly expresive in sylabic uterancc, seem to be almost without meaning in the inarticulate movements of song. A still more striking view of the power of conventional language, as tho means of exjjresion, when contrasted with the power of instinctive intonation, is displayetl in the voice of sub-animals, particularly that of birds. Wlicii a familiarity with our history will have given the means of discrim- ination, it will be jterceved that birds emjiloy all the vocal signs of speech, without expresing surprise, interogation, positivenes, and scorn, together with the rcj)ose of the cadence; which would be plainly conveyed by those signs, joined with words that describe these several mental states. The ex- presion of j)laintivenes by the semitone, in the voice of the dove, and of pleasure by the tremor on other intervals, in the horse when snufing his food, are indeed made without a verbal sign, and yet are identical with tho display VOCAL SIGNS OF THoT AND PASION. 457 We have learned that the means of expresion are always aplied in combination. There must be at least two conjoined, and tliere of similar states by the human voice. Still it must be recolectcd that laugh- ter and crying, the analogies to these sub-animal expresions, are in speech, generaly inarticulate, and are to be considered as merely instinctive animal signs, in man. It is then the union of an arbitrary Verbal designation of a state of mind with its natural or Vocal sign, that constitutes the true and esential means of expresion in speech. I must here beg the Keader to excuse a digresion from our subject. In the course of this esay many analogies might have been shown between the human voice, and that of the sub-animal : but'I designed to avoid mingling these two comparative subjects of natural historj-. Speech is a select agregate of the vocal and articulative functions, dis- persedly exercised, b}- all animals: for there is scarcely a form of vocality, time, intonation, force, abruptnes, and even of articulation, which is not comon in severaltj-, to many of the sub-species, and to man. Man employs more of these signs than any one species, but perhaps fewer than all; the principal diference consisting in his power over the structure and chain of the literal and sylablic function. Upon the ground of this identity, and with the asistance of an eiact meas- urement, and definite nomenclature of the human voice, aforded by this esayj What is there to prevent the voices of aniynals being taken as one of the designa- tions of species, m the sgstonatic arayigeynent of Zoology ? Naturalists have sometimes atempted this in a rude waj-, by a reference to alphabetic sounds, and to the modes of time and stres in words and phrases. When boys without the least atention to the diference of vocality in the cases, find a resemblance in the shrill suraer-whistle of the American partridge, to the words ' bo-bob-white ; ' and think they pronounce the short repeated phrase of the ' whip-poor-will ; ' in its name, which some of the native In- dians with closer imitation, call muc-ha-iois ; the similarity lies between the impresion of the acentual stres and the time of uterance in the two cases ; for the whistle and the phrase, as well as many mechanical noises, resemble, at the whim of the listener, an}' words with an equal number of sylable-like impulses, and the same condition of quantity and acent. Birds in the endowment of voice, have First; A single Chirp, including severaly, every variation of vocality, time, and force, with every form of in- tonation, from the feeblest efort in the simple interval, to movements of wider concretes and waves, in the cry, the shriek and scream ; and in some cases, even the note of song. Second ; A phrase, of two, three, or four constituents, severaly of every vocality, time, force, and every form of intonation. Third ; A Medley, composed of a heterogeneous sucesion of chirps, and phrases. Fourth; A Melody, such as it is, of rapid concretes, of the singer's ' j)ure tonej ' in ' liquid,' smooth, and briliant vocalityj of varied force, and intona- tion ; but without bar, cadence, or key. This melody is distinguished by its continuous course of greater or less duration, without the disjointed interup- 30 458 VOCAL SIGNS OF TH5T AND PASION. may be more. Gutiiral grating, aspiration, and the (liferent fornLS of stress are necesarily aplied to some interval of pitch. The tions that ocur in the medley. Some birdsj I omit their s^-stematic namesj have only the chirp ; as our sparow, king-bird, swalow, the woodpecker tribe, the blue-jay, and various hawks. Others, as our yelow-bird, robin, red-bird, partridge, blue-bird and whiperwil, have the chirp and phrase. Others again, the chirp and melody, as our thrush, cat-bird, wren, and perhaps the oriole, meadow-lark, and black-bird. The mocking-bird, and the canary, have the chirp, and the medley, as a remarkable case : and a few others properly caled singing birdsj but of which I cannot speak from observation^ may have the chirp, the phrase and the melody, under the most agreeable character. The exact and broad observerj for the peering Naturalists do not yet seem to know, what comparative phonology means, nor that the subject of the voice is part of natural history^ will kindly excuse the erors of this descrip- tion. It is ofered only as a faint and broken light, obscurely showing one of the outer doors of this interesting department of knowledge : and now held- up, with the asistance of our present analysis, from memory of rural and pastime observation made at school on the borders of the Susquehana before my thirteenth year. And would I could forget how often, in thotles pleasure, I may have given disquietude or pang to those inocent lives, that aforded the means of my present contented ocupation ; and that still bring up so many juvenile memorials of time and place, in recording the forms of their intona- tion. After what is here said, on the general character of the voices of Birds, and with tlie light of clasification and description contained in this esay, a culti- vated ear would not have much diticulty in ascertaining, whether the chirp of a bird is in the concrete or the radical pitch of a semitone, second, or other interval ; of how many constituents the jihrase consists; what, in the medley, are the places of pitch ; with the kind and order of its phrases; and what, the concrete and discrete in the melody. As far as observation extends, we know:j the voice of birds is unchangeable in the species ; it is therefore as well entitled to nomenclature, provided it can be asigncd definitel}', as the fethers, beak, and claws. If language had never furnished discriminative names for color and form, even these characteristics, like those of the voice, would never have been known in the descriptions of ornitliology : or rather, ornithology as a chisitication, would be unknown. Witliout extending our obworvation to the whole range of animals, within which we might severaly find all the varieties of the human voice, even to the protracted note of song, in the frogj I hero give an outline of the vocal functions of the Mocking-birdj ilustrative of the powers which generaly belong to its class. The Mocking-bird has every variety and degree in Vocality, from the deli- cate chirp of the sparow, and harsh scream of the jay, to the gutural baas of the clucking of the hen. He uses every variation of Time, from a mere point of sound, to the quantity of our most pasionute interjections, lie htts VOCAL SIGNS OF THOT AND PASION. 459 interval of pitch must be united with time, -whether the quantity is long or short. The natural sign may be heard joined to the coniand over all the intervals of the scale, both ascending and descending, in the discrete as well as the concrete pitch. His simple concrete exhibits the proper structure of the radical and vanish. He executes the wave in its equal and unequal, its direct and inverted forms; yet I cannot say, he uses its double movement. He exhibits all the forms of Stres on the concrete : the compound constitutes his shake. It is the diatonic shake, and consists, on its diferent occasions, of from five or six lo ten or twelve iterations. It is not so rapid as the human shake, and consequently wants its liquidity; nor does it ever end in a ' turn,^ but passes carelesly to any efort that folows. This shake is sometimes made on a wider interval than the second: but it is a slugish movement, and consists of only two or three repetitions, as we some- times hear it in singers, of great execution. And it is worthy of remark, that in this slownes, the compound stres is plainly distinguishable. He uses the tremor, both on a continuous line, and with its rising and falling tittelar skips. All this comprehensive exercise of the throat, has individually the form of either chirp or phrase. The continued rounds of voice, which at night, sometimes last for hours, form therefore a medley of chirps and phrases, without sucesive simihiritj- in the relation of time, vocality, force or pitch ; and altogether without rj^thmus, cadencial close, or key. In this medley the phrases cxcede the chirps in number ; but I cannot say, how many of each are used. Perhaps twenty kinds would include them all : and supos- ing these to be diferenced by time and vocality, there would be more. Each set of the chirps and phrases, as it returns thru the medley, may vary in the number of its repetitions. A chirp may be single, or may be repeated two or three times, or oftener. A phrase of two constituents may in the returns of the medley have three, four, or more repetitions of these two ; or as sometimes bapens in the shake, ten or twelve: and it is the same with a phrase of the tremor. The phrase of three or four constituents, which last is rarely heard, has fewer repetitions than the more simple ones ; the chirp is most frequently heard only once. The whole medley then, has no regularity in the return of its several voices, nor in the number of their repetitions, to constitute it a Melody. It was first said by Somebodyj perhaps himself a parot in human characterj while this bird mocks all others, he has no ' notes ' of his own : and then Everybody, mocking somebody's say, Nobodj- thot of doubting it. Yet upon this very notion of exclusive property in the voice, he has more ' Notes ' of his own than any other bird : and having within his compas, almost the whole constituency of song, whether human, or Volucrali for Ornithology wants this adjective^ it would not be surprising, if other birds should recognize some of their suposed property, in his. When frequenting farms, with pigeons, hens, turkeys, and guinea-fowls, all around him; and when in the fields of Virginia, all day pierced by the whistle of the i)artridge;j with his own ' notes ' almost stifled at night, by the panting voices of a whole settlement of whip- erwils, he has never, within my knowledge, been heard to mock their phrases ; 460 VOCAL SIGNS OF THoT AND PASIOX. words of the artificial; and of the natural, there must be two combined, and there may be more. Not one form of expresion can exist separately ; and we may have under a single sylabic im- tho master perhaps of all the simple sounds that severally compose them. And certainly no Indian Farrinelli ever gave him an example of the shake. Miniik then, as with his own natural voice, they would make him, it would have been a kindly restraint on those who have slandered him, to have had a natural ear of their own to prevent it. We have learned^ the vocal constituents of the song of the Mocking-bird, like the vocal signs in speech, are few in number ; but in each case, our igno- rance of the individual signs, leaving us to regard only their numerous com- binations, has created a belief that they are infinite. A certain vocality, or an interval may be heard under a variation in time; and the same concrete, or tremor, or shake may difer in vocalitj', and in its places of pitch. The rule for the signs of pasion, in speech, is strictly aplicable to the voices of sub-animals, as regards those sounds which are purely vocal and separate from words. The repeated chirp, which seems to be the idle and unmeaning diatonic voice of birds, is generaly a short quantity, on a single rising or faling concrete second, or third, and rarely, as far as I have observed, on the wider intervals. A prolongation of the chirp is usualy expresive of their pasions and apetites. Pain, love, and fear, are always exhibited in the movement of the semitone. But I am agreeably led on towards an arange- ment, when I designed only to propose the scheme to others. The limited and perhaps imperfect maner in which, from a neglect of full observation, I have described this single instance of volucral intonation, may however show, that as there is now a system and nomenclature for the voices both of the garulous, and mischievous Demagogue of American Asemblies, and of this harmlcs Polyglot of the American grove, there would be no great dificulty in clasifying with precision, more manageable individualities of sound, in the other departments of vocal Zoologj'. This subject is at least curious, if not useful ; yet it lies out of my way. The sciences have large volumes of compilation : let us have from some Naturalist with a good ear, a little book of original truth, on the inquiry here proposed. Let it be done by pure and personal observation. Let the author not lose his strong breath of usefulness and fame, by a puerile precipi- tancy after reputation ; nor hasten with his unripencs, in tlie market-like fear of being forestalcd. Patient, enthusiastic, and unostentatious studj-j independ- ent observation and thotj and a disinterested love of truthj with their sure and great results in science, are always solitary in an age, and cannot there- fore bo forestaled ; and on this point, as in promises under another name, it will be with those who seek the unaltered, and unalterable truths of nature, that the last in its proper season, shall be First. I add at the time of this si.vth Edition, that forty years ago, the jirecoding Note was ofered to the atcntion of the Naturalist ; who witii a prying and industrious ambition to Inive a new Bug, or an Old Fossil-bone named after VOCAL SIGNS OF THOT AND PASIOX. 461 pulse, a long quantity, a wide interval, aspiration, and strcs, all sinuiltaneous in efecting a particular purpose in speech. The folowing is a sumary of the instinctive or vocal signs, de- noting' the states of mind, we have caled thotive, reverentive, and pasionative. In the thirty-fourth section, it was proposed to employ the terms Piano, and Forte, for the degrees of force, respectively above and below the distinct and becoming audibility of that well-bred conversation, which equaly avoids an overbearing loudness on one side, and a fashionable mincing, or a faint-mouthed and perplexing afectation, on the other. And first ; Tlie Piano of the Voice. Some states of mind, together with certain conditions of the body that may be combined with them, are properly expresed by a piano, or moderated voice, in curent discourse. These states, and conditions are those of humility, modesty, shame, doubt, iresolution, apathy, caution, repose, fa- tigue, and prostration from disease. They generaly employ the simple diatonic melody : some however, with a piano or a feeble uterance, use the semitone, and the wave of the second. Of this kind are pity, grief, and awe. The Forte of the Voice. This sign, as the reverse of the last, is apropriate to states of mind directing muscular energy, and vivid degrees of pasion. Some of these states are signified by a high degree of force ; for in adition to those which employ it as a leading characteristic, such as rage, wrath, fear, and horor, some that depend for their exjDresion, chiefly on intonation or acentual stres, do at the same time asume the character of forte or loudnes. Of this class are astonishment, exultation, and laughter. Quicknes of Voice. Inasmuch as quickness of the curent melody generaly goes with Short Quantity, in individual sylables, we do not make separate heads for these two subjects. Some states of mind, under this division, are likewise expresed by other signs, particularly by Loudnes; as anger, rage, mirth, railery and im- patience. Many states having their principal signs in forms of intonation and stres, are joined also with quicknes of voice. himself, so narows the scope of his duty, as to render him indiferent to the fact, that the sub-animal voice is embraced by Natural History, and is an interesting^, if not a distinguishing part of Zoological clasification. 462 VOCAL SIGNS OF TH5T AND PASION. Slownes of Voice, Speakers who have no comand over quan- tity, afect to be deliberate, by momentary rest between their words. But slow time in discourse, if not made by extended sylabic quan- tity, would from its frequent pauses, be monotonous and formal. Slow time and long quantity are an esential cause of dignified uterance, and are efected on the wave ; this being the continuous return of an interval into itselfj one of the means for producing an extension of time, without destroying the equable concrete of speech. Slownes of time, with its constituent long quantity, is properly employed for many states of mind; as sorow, grief, respect, veneration, dignity, apathy, contrition, and all others embracing refinement, and moderation. Vocallty. It is unnecesary to repeat here all the terms denoting the forms of this jNlode. The folowing are some of them, with their respective states of mind anexed. Harshnes is directed by anger, and imperative authority : gentlenes by grief, modesty and commiseration : the whisper, which is an aspirated voice, by se- crecy. The falsete is heard in the whine of peevishnes, in the high tremulous pitch of mirth, and in the piercing scream of teror. The full body of the orotund, in a cultivated speaker, gives satisfactory expresion to solemnity and grandeur. The Rising and the Faling Semitone. The simple rise of the semitone is not a frequent form of expresion, as most plaintive intonations call for long quantity, and are therefore properly repre- sented by the wave of this interval. Still complaint, grief, and other states of like imj^ort, may sometimes be made with an earnestnes, requiring a short sylabic time. In this case the voice cannot bear the delay of the wave, and efects all the purposes of semitonic intonation, by the simple rise or fall of the concrete, with the adition when necesary, of the radical or vanishing stres. The Rising and the Faling Second or lone. Those states of mind, called thots, in contradistinction to pasionsj those naratives or deserii)tions, which denote things as they are in themselves, without reference to our relation to tliem, on the point of j)lea.sure or pain, desire or aversion, interest or injury, are all represented by the plain unobtrusive interval of the second, cither in its ui)ward or downward course. Tlie vtu-ious uses of the voice, properly called Expresion, have something so striking in their VOCAL SIGNS OF TIIOT AND PASION. 463 character, that the atentive observer may easily recognize them. Wlien there is an absence of this expresion, he may conclude^ the curent of speech is in the diatonic melody. The Rising Third, Fifth and Octave. These intervals scveraly express diferent degrees of the same state of mind : the distinc- tions between the states themselves are designated by the verbal signs that describe them. In their varying extent, tliey represent interogation, as moderate, dignified, or earnest. Combined with other vocal means they add to the question, particularly on the octave, the character of quaintnes, sneer, and derision. With as- piration they have the efect of the downward intervals, and indi- cate serious surprise and its congenial states. They expres a con- ditional meaning, on emphatic words. Gutural vibration adds scorn to a question on the wider of these intervals ; and joins to their character in emphasise haughtines, disdain, reproach, indig- nation, and contempt. As the deliberate execution of these inter- vals requires long quantity, they have not the extended time, and consequently, not the solemn and dignified character, they assume when doubled into the wave. The Downward Third, Fifth and Octave. These severally ex- press, both diiferent degrees of the same state of mind, and states different among themselves. They are emphatically the signs of surprise, astonishment, wonder, and amazement ; and altho these states are not identical, still, each in its peculiarity, is represented upon these falling intervals : the specific diiference being marked, either by their varied extent, or by the conventional phrase to which they are applied. These intervals also denote a positive- ness, and a settled conviction on the part of the speaker ; hence they are given to phrases of authority, command, confidence, and satisfaction. A downward movement, we have learned, also pro- duces tlie terminative repose of a cadence ; and consequently when not joined with force, Ls well suited to express the state of quie- tudej in resignation, despair, and the condition of mind which attends fatigue. And yet any diiference, under all these cases, of a similar intonation, is distinguished by their respective conventional language. The Wave of the Semitone. The expression of the simple rise and the fall of the semitone was noticed above ; but its return or 464 VOCAL SIGNS OF THoT AND PASION. contrary flexure into the wave, is the most common form of this expressive interval. There is scarcely a vocal sign which repre- sents so many and such various states of mind ; the specific dis- tinction of the cases, being made by the descriptive phrase. The wave of the semitone diifers from the simple interval, in its ex- presive dignity derived from its extended quantity, from a repe- tition of the simple interval in its returning descent. Sorrow, grief, vexation, chagrin, repining, contrition, impatience, peevish- ness, compassion, commiseration, condolence, pity, love, fondness, supplication, fatigue, and pain, with whatever varieties may exist among them, are still, by the difference of the conventional sign, all expressed by the wave of the semitone. The Wave of the Second. The interval of the second, either in a rising or falling direction, being the voice of plain unim- pasioned thot, is purely a diatonic sign, and not a means of ex- ■presion. Still as the downward return of this interval into the form of the wave, produces a long quantity, it necesarily adds to the second, the peculiar effect of that quantity^ and when duly extended, gives to discourse its full character of dignity, and grandeur; to the exclusion of the intrusive, and therefore in- apropriate use of force, qualit}", abruptnes, and the wider intervals of intonation. The Waves of the Third, Fifth and Octave. The forms of tlie wave are so various, that it would far excede the design of this Work to enumerate thenij and to asort them with the pasions. The principles that govern their expresion were unfolded, in the twenty-fifth, and six folowing sections. The chai'acter of the constituent intervals of these waves has great influence in deter- mining their respective expresions. The upward vanish of the last constituent of i\\Q inverted form has the efect of interrogation ; and the downward course of the last constituent of the direct, that of surprise. If then these two contrary forms of the wave have, respectively, in their final constituent, the same character as the separate and simple rise and fall of the interval, there might seem to be no necesity for their use. Yet suposing the purposes to be identical, which however, may not always be the casej the wave afords besides, important means for extending the quantity of sylablcs, and consequently for expresing certain states of mind, I VOCAL SIGNS OF THoT AND PASION. 465 ■with deliberate dignity. In the double form, the wave denotes sneer, mockery, petulance, contempt, and scorn ; still these last two are more conspicuously exhibited by conjoining aspiration with the single wave. The Radical Stres. From the forcible character of this stres, it is employed for increasing the impressivenes of the other vocal signs of the pasions, ca])able of receving it. It is more particu- larly aplicable to imutable sylables, yet when we read rapidly, it is used even on those of indefinite quantity : but rapid reading necesarily weakens its force. Mirth, impatience, anger, and rage, are generaly utered with haste, and therefore take on this stres, in emphatic places. It is employed on imperative words ; for it has a degree of positivenes, similar to that expresed by the downward intervals of intonation. The Median Stres. The radical stres is used for abruj)tly en- forcing expresion on short sylables. The median gradualy and smoothly swells the voicej and this requires a long quantity, to- gether with a deliberate and graceful uterance. I say, together with deliberation ; as long quantities do sometimes asume the ab- rupt opening of the radical, or the final jerk, of the vanishing stres. The states of mind, caling for median forcej particularly on the dignity of the second, and the plaintivenes of the semitonej are those represented by waves of the various intervals. Of these kinds are awe, respect, solemnity, reverence, and suplication, that make our division of inter-thotive expresion. This median stres may perhaps, be executed on an extended rise or fall of the simple fifth and octave; or the wide downward vanish of surprise, and wide upward vanish of interrogation, may sometimes be invested with this graceful form of force. The Vanishing Stres. This stres, and its expresion have been so particularly noticed, in a former section, that it is unnecesary here to repeat the detail. Far inferior as it is in dignity, to the median, it is sometimes highly expresive of the state represented by the semitone and wider intervals^ in grief, surprise, and intero- gation. Impresing the extremes of these intervals on the ear, it points out their several ranges more distinctly than they are marked by the atenuated vanish. It may seem to be a nice dis- tinction, but it is ncvertheles true and practical, that care must be 466 VOCAL SIGNS OF THOT AXD PASIOX. taken, not to let tliis stres run into the thoro form; for this, as before remarked, rather obscures the interogative expresion. Compound Stres. So much was said, on this subject, in the thirty-eighth section, tliat the Reader is refered to it. Tlie com- pound, like the median, vanishing, and thoro stres, and the loud concrete, cannot be made on short sylables. On prolonged quan- tity, it is the sign of energy or violence, in the pasion represented by it. The Thorough Stres. We refer to the thirty-ninth section, for an acount of this sign of rudenes, and vulgarity, when aplied to long sylabic quantity, in curent discourse. By the 'hardnes of its touch, ' it destroys the graceful outline of the equable concrete ; and heavily overlays that delicacy of gradation in the tinted vanish, so esential to the refined picture of thot and pasion, in the wonderful design and coloring of true and natural speech. On the subject of the Loud Concrete, as a sign of expresion, I have nothing to add worthy of record, beyond what has been previously said. The Tremor of the Second and of Wider Intervals. The tremu- lous movement of these intervals designates a number of states of mind widely diferent from each other. And here again we have an instance of a principle widely influential in the expresion of the passions ; for these diiferent states, though set within the same general-frame of intonation, have their specific divisions marked by the conventional terms which describe them. The tremor of the second and of wider intervals, is employed for exultation, mirth, pride, haughtines, sneer, derision, and contem])t; and in these expresions, the tittles may move on the simple rise or fall, or on the wave. The Tremor of the Semitone. The tremulous movement of the semitone, on a tonic element, is a form of the crying-voice. Used in sylabic intonation, it implies a deeper distres than that of the simple semitone ; and exprescs in a greater or less degree, the con- dition of sufering, grief, tendernes, and suplication; yet widely as they may difer from each othei:, they alike fall, when caried to exces, into the tremulous intonation; their difference being marked by the tionventional })hrasc. The Aspiration. The pure vocality of the tonics and subtonics, VOCAL SIGNS OF THOT AND PASIOX. 467 when partly obscured by its union M-itli aspiration, denotes many and widely diferent states of mind ; yet M'ith the aid of the con- ventional signs, it can clearly expres them all. It acompanics the force of vociferation ; is the faint sign of secrecy ; and is joined with energetic uterance, when this is not strained into the falsete. It also indicates earnestnes, curiosity, surprise, and horor. On a former ocasion, contempt, sneer, and scorn, were asigned to the wave, i>articularly in its unequal form. Yet even this does not carrv the full measure of their expresion, if not conjoined with aspiration : and further, the union of aspiration even with simple upward and downward \\^der intervals, may represent these several states of mind. The Gutural Vibration. This is a harsh and grating vocal sign; and denotes all those states of mind classed under ill-humor ; in- cluding dissatisfaction, peevishness, and discontent. It likewise ajDpears in the strained ferocity of rage, and revenge, and is the common sign to children and others of an emphatic rebuke ; and has an import of sneer, contempt, and scorn ; all of which, under the same natural or vocal sign, are distinguished by the conven- tional word or phrase. Of the Emphatic Vocule. This is exclusively an indication of force, and in the final abrupt elements of particular words is the sign of anger and rage, and of vehemence in any pasion. It is however of rare ocurence ; and being almost needles in cultivated elocution, ought perhaps to be even more rare than it is. The Broken- Melody, The Curent melody of Narrative style has been represented as a succession of diatonic intonations ; yet em- jjloying occasionally, for dignified expression, a longer time, a fuler quantity, and a wider appropriate interval, both of concrete and of discrete pitch ; and intersected by pauses, aplied as often as the thot, or expresion may require. Sometimes, particular states of mind overrule the ocasions, and gramatical proprieties of pausing, thereby producing notable rests after very short phrases, and even after every word, without reference to the conections of syntax. I use the term Broken-Melody, to signify the interuptions, sometimes produced by the exces of certain pasions. The character of this function will be perceved in the physio- logical explanation of it. 468 VOCAL SIGXS OF THOT AND PASIOX, In the section on the mechanism of the voice, two kinds of ex- piration were described; one resembling the act of sighing, whereby all the breath Ls sent forth, in a single impulse of greater or less duration ; within which, scarcely more than one or two words can be articulated with ease. The other is used in comon speech. Within it, we are able to uter whole sentences, by a frugal use of the breath, in giving out small portions at a time, to sucesive sylables. From the former maner of expiration, seeming to draw- oif all the contents of the lungs, it may be called the Exhausting- breath : and the latter, from its being held-back, to be dealt out in such portions as sylables require, may be caled, for want of a beter name, the Holding-breath. It was said formerlyj an infant begins to speak in the exhaust- ing-expiration. It occurs likewise when we are ' out of breath, ' from exercise ; and in the extreme debility of disease. Hence in these cases, there is often only one sylable heard in a single act of expiration. The breath of the tremulous movement of laughter and crying, is of this kind. The tremor docs here create a slight diferenice; but if the Reader will for a moment make the experi- ment, he will percevej he quickly laughs and cries himself, so to speak, to the bottom of his breathj which is one cause of the distres, and even pain felt in excesive laughter; nor can he, without an inhaling pause, continue the tremulous function, for that ex- tended time, of expiration, which is so easily efectcd on the breath of comon speech. Young children, in violent crying, sometimes so exhaust the lungs, that a considerable pause ocurs between the ebb and flow of respiration, much to the alarm of inexperienced mothers. This exhausting-breath may be produced by a high degree of pasionative excitement. Deep distress involuntarily creates it, in the form of a sigh. Hence, in the exces of mental sufering, or bodily pain, the holding-power is lost, and we speak in the ox- hausting-breathj with but one, or at most, two or three words within a single act of expiration : and by these repeated intersec- tions of the inhaling pauses, the Broken-melody is produced. The case will be the same, should an exces of excitement blend the tremor of laughter or of crying, with the curent of discourse; for by the exhausting-power of these functions, the melody nuist be I VOCAL SIGNS OF THoT AND PASION. 469 interupted, by the frequent necesity for inspiration. It may be asked, wliy the breatli cannot be rapidly recovered, as in the mo- mentary rests of speech that are sometimes scarcely perceptible. The cause is thisj In the holding-expiration of comon discourse, all the breath is not discharged from the lungs ; such a quantity only is gradualy spent upon the words, as may be imperceptibly and instantly restored. But in speaking with the exhausting-ex- piration, there is a discharge of nearly all the breath by an extreme contraction of the chest ; and the subsequent act of re-filing the lungs requires a degree of expansion and a depth of draft, that cannot be imperceptibly performed, and that ocupy the time of the remarkable pauses in the Broken-melody. It is not necesar}' to sj^eak of the phrases of intonation, employed in this peculiar melody. They may be of every species ; tho, from the many interuptions of the curent, the relationships of the phrases are not so perceptible nor so important in practical efect, as in the more conected sequences of a comon melody. I have here endeavored to open the way for a full and more precise description of the vocal signs of th5t and pasion, and for a systematic arangement of them, with the states of mind they severaly expres. They have been regarded as individuals, altho not one is ever heard alone ; in some instances many are united in a single act of expression, and they may be employed in every maner of compatible combination. A feeble and a forcible sound cannot exist in the same impulse of uterance ; yet either of these conditions may be conjoined severaly with all the forms of pitch, or vocality, or time. No one interval of pitch can, during the same sylabic impulse, be another interval; but any interval may as ocasions require, be simultaneous in execution with any form of vocality, time, or force. So in the wave, the intervals may be consecutive in all posible ways ; and these ways, either in interval, or arangement, may be conjoined with every exercise of the voice, not at variance with their definition. By the use then of the comparatively limited number of Vocal signs here enumerated, together with the asistant means of Con- 470 VOCAL SIGNS OF THOT AXD PASIOX. ventional language, the aparently infinite forms of expresion in speech are produced. Tlie preceding detail of these signs, and the numerical limitation of the terms of their nomenclature, at once aford an observer the means to survey, in the composure of a clasifying reflection, the whole extent of this suposed infinity ; and thereby, to change a vulgar and distracting wonder at imensity, into an inteligent admiration of the obvious union and intermuta- ble variety of a few distinguishable constituents. The Reader may now perceve why I have considered the forms of expression, in their separate state ; or have regarded only a few of their combinations. To give an extended detail of their posible groups, would be beyond my design in seting-forth the broad Philosophy of speech. Nor is it necesary under a practical view ; for having analytically resolved the aparent complexity of speech into its asiguable constituents, we cannot be at a loss to synthetic- ally combine them, when necesary, for every purpose of expresion. From a review of our history of the Instinctive signs of thot and pasion, and a reference to the limited amount of their modes and forms, compared with the unlimited variety of mental condi- tions to be expresed, we are struck with the disproportion between their respective numbers : and learn, how the deficiencies in the instinctive signs are suplied. For in the First place. The same vocal sign is used for more than one state of mind : as in the numerous class, respectively denoted by the semitone, and by the downward intervals. Second. Some of those states, genericaly represented by the same natural sign, have yet their specific diference marked by the artificial sit^n, or conventional language that describes them. The downward octave expreses equaly, comand, and astonishment ; their diference, under the same intonation, being signified by the imperative word, and by the phrase that declares the astonishment. Third. A great number of the mental states have no instinctive or vocal sign, but de})end, for their expresion, altogether on de- scriptive language. There is no vocal sign by which a speaker can inform us, even if he would, of his avarice, his vanity, or his remorse. They must be shown in personal action, or be confosed by his verbal declaration. The posible combinations of all the modes, forms, degrees, and varieties of the voice, may furnish a VOCAL SIGNS OF THoT AND PASION. 471 sign for every thot and pasion. This estimate and clasifieation having never yet been made, the subject must lay-over, for an age of the Physical Philosophy of the mind, as well as of the voice. Having in the preceding sections particularly described the constituents of speech, Avhich in their various and respective uses, denote the mental states of thot and pasionj I must ofer a few remarks on the subject of that dificulty which a long habit of ignorance and eror, in the old school of Elocution, may create in acquiring a practical comand over the true and Natural System of the voice. When the meaning of our terms for tlie states of mind, and for their coresponding vocal signs is known, there will be no great hesitation in recognizing their exemplified distinctions, nor in acquiring a facility in executing them ; and it Avill then be foundj the use of all the aparently novel modes and forms of the voice, in the maner proposed by our Scientific System, which has raised the alarm of dificulty, is only a returnj after ages on ages of conventional theory and delusionj to the instinctive and truth- ful purpose and practice of what must have been the natural Archetype of Speech. For the developments of this volume have brought me to the conviction, that the system of plain diatonic melody, as a ground for the exjiresive intervals, is the true ordina- tion of the speaking voice : and a reference to the universal wisdom of Nature, even under the vicious habits of man, shows, that as in the benevolence of her final causes, she is prone to good and not to evilj so, to give a particular instance, the voice is prone, 'as the sparks fly upwards,' to this ordination for denoting the two leading conditions of the mind. Under this view, it would apear, that when the design of Nature has not been perverted or overruled, we should ocasionaly find examples of greater or less acordance with her adjusted system : and I must say, in suport of this infer- ence, that altho I have never found a Speaker, conforming in all points to our proposed rulesj yet I have met with some instances, in which a natural tendency has so far prevailed, that its purposes have in a great measure been acomplished ; and others, in which it has not been so much confounded or thwarted by coruj^t exam- ple, as to prevent our scientific method, from developing the latent resources for proper and elegant speech. I here refer to science, as universaly, a true picture of the things and laws of Nature ; 472 VOCAL SIGXS OF THOT AND PASIOX. and, in our present case, as the means of preventing the influence of bad education and example, on the instinctive tendencies of the voice. He Avho has a kno^yledge of the constituents of speech, and of their powers and uses, is the potential master of the science of Elocution ; and he must then derive from his ear, his perception of propriety, and his taste, the means of actually applying it with success. When this is accomplished, it Avill be foundj the per- formance of Scientific speech, is no more difficult to the Actor, than the performance of music is to thousands of little girls when- ever they are taught it: and that with a proper notation of the vocal signs of the former, one will be as easily read and executed at sight as the other. I have read somewhere, that the Ancients practiced what they called Silent Reading. It is possible, they meant, going over in mental perception, the forms of intonation, and of the other modes of the voice ; for we knowj this unuttered reading is practicable, and may be employed, both on our own peculiar manner, when we think of it, and on that of others, when we have the memorial power of silently imitating them. This is the process of the' Mimic ; for his memory of any peculiarity in the vocal sign of those he imitates, must silently jsrecede his audible iitterance of it. The faculty of Silent Reading can however be efectively exercised, for pleasure and ijnprovement, only under a clear mental picturing of a scientific system of the voice, and of its precise nomenclature. By our present analytic knowledge of the states of mind, and of the vocal signs of thot and pasion ; and a conventional notation of those signs, we may with a perception of our own maner of speak- ing, and a memory of the speech of others, be able to silently practice the proprieties of elocution, and to corect its eroi-s, by the silent use of an instructed intelcct. We know that the perceptions of the several senses are represented in the memory ; that the images on the eye and vibrations on the ear, are clearer and more readily revived, than on the others ; and that we may memorialy think of any j)eculiarity in the voice. In intonation, the difercnt intervals; in force, the diferent streses; in time, tiie difercnt quantities; and the various vocalities and pausesj when once per- ceved and named, have their respective characters so impresed on I THE MEANS OF INSTRUCTIOX IX ELOCUTION. 473 the inemoiy, tliat we can think-them, in its silent reading. This proces of memorial perception \vitli audible, is like its proces with visible signs. The Painter has on his memory the ocular image of a real, or of an invented subject ; and lays on his tablet the visible copy of his memorial lines and colors. The musical Composer has in his memory, impresions of all the constituents of song ; and silently aranging them by his mind's ear, notes doAvn his melody and harmony, for others either silently or audibly to read. There is no diference then, between the method in a silent reading of music, and that of a silent reading of speech. Indeed, from the less complex structure of its melody, the reading of speech should be the easier of the two. I have near me at this moment, notations from scenes in Hamlet, and in Lear ; sent to me by one, who acquired a full knowledge of the Scientific system, and its jiractical aplication, from an unasisted study of this Volume; as the volume itself was writen from the study of Nature alone. Whether these notations, and my opinion of them, are corect or otherwise, I can both silently and audibly read them ; and thereby have the means of ilustrating to others, the truth and the practical aplication of the subject before us. SECTION XLIX. Of the Means of Instruction in Elocution. I HAVE offered to the Reader, a copy of the all-perfect Design of Nature, in the construction of Speech. It is nccesary, if we may still carry on the figure, to furnish at the same time, a ' Work- ing plan,' to him who may wish to build up for himself, a delight- ful Home of Philosophy and taste, or a popular Temple of Fame, in Elocution. If the Reader is one of those, who from disapointment in higher hopes, have at last resolved to receve their Station in life, under 31 474 THE MEAXS OF INSTEUCTION IX ELOCUTIOX. the aprobation of ignorance ; and who in their acomplishments are careles of rising above the discernment of their unthinking Ad- mirers, let him pass by this section. A little will serve his pur- poses ; and the instinct of his ambition, without the wise designs of human asiduity, will enable him to be easily the file-leader of his herd. But if he beleves in that fine induction of the Greeks, that ' good things are dificultj ' if he sees the sucessful pretender, still restles and dissatisfied, in having made captives only of the Ignorantj if he desires to work for high and hard masters, and to take his ultimate repose by the side of their ever-during aproba- tion, he may receve from the folowing pages, some asistance towards the acomplishment of his resolution to acquire the art of Reading- Well. Can Elocution be taught? This question has heretofore been asked by ignorance. It shall in another age, or I mistake the prevailing power of science, be asked only by folly. The skeptics on the subject of the practicabilit}' of teaching elocution, appear under three classes. To the First belong those, who knowing the ways of the voice have never been broadly and distinctly traced, beleve they never can be reduced to asignable rules. This opinion is grounded on the belief that the expresive efects of speech procede from some ^ ocult quality,' or metaphysi- cal working of the ' spirit ; ' which however, is neither high nor low, loud nor soft ; nor any of the physical and apreciable modes of vocal sound. They who carelesly overlook the due revelation, which Nature never withholds from the close and fervent observer, seem to have that notion of vocal expresion, which poetical school- girls liave of the smiles, and ' side-long glances' of their interesting young admirersj that they are not a palpable efect of the pliysical form of the face, in its state of rest, and in its various motions ; but a kind of imatenalism, which darts from the eye and breathes from the lips ; a ' soul,' as it were in the countenance, whicji is yet, in the words of the song, * neither shape nor feature.' The skepticism of the Second class asumes that acomplishments in elocution are the result of cei'tain indescribable powci*s of 'genius,' and that the hapy poscsor of tlicm is the prodnction of one of ' Nature's moments of enthusiasm,' Such sleight of tongue, to hide the plain agency of natural causes, is not disdained by many THE MEANS OF INSTRUCTIOX IN ELOCUTION. 475 who poses powers, suficient to set them far above the stale-grown tricks for reputation. He wlio has the truth and modesty of a master in his art, knows that he Ls distinguished from the thou- sands who suround him, not more by a superiority over their vulgar notions on the subject of ambition, and the chances of success, than by a singlenes in purpose and zeal, and the acumu- lative power of a self-gathering docility : nor does he withhold instruction, in the fear of rivalshij) ; for with justified confidence in a wel-tried knowledge, he persuades himself, that if any useful purpose should make it necesary, he can afterwards, always keep pace with a competitor, and then surpas himself. Thoge who constitute the Third class are too inteligent to beleve in this mystical doctrine of the 'Inspiration of genius;' yet they hold, that the art of reading-well can be taught only by imitation. Elocution may unfortunately too often have satisfied its faith with the creed of Imitation ; and thereupon, set-up its diferent Idols, for public worship. But when has the world, on a single subject of inquiry, ever found, in that faith or fiction which sees evidence' in what is not to be seen alike by all, any other result than that of sophistical labor, without product, and illiberal quarels, with- out end. Hence the vain conceit of forming a school of Imitative Elocution : for the several partizans of diferent favorites will never agree to raise any one individual, to exemplary superiority. An example to be useful and permanent in art, must be set-up with the consent of all : and that consent can be drawn only from a comon and acessible source of instruction and knowledge, not from individual or party admiration. It was therefore, under ignorance of there being a comon source of knowledge in the few and clasified constituents of speech, that such a Avavering notion as Imitation became the deceptive guide of Elocution, in absence of that yet wnleading Cynosure to every eye alikej the stedfast unity of Principles in the Art. It is the design of this csay, to furnish from Nature, and not from variable examples of human authority, those describable truths, on which all may begin their agreement ; and by extending this consent, may at last raise an observative and universal school of Elocution. I must here notice the objection, often made to teaching Elocu- tion by systematic rules j that it will necesarily produce a formal. 476 THE MEANS OF IXSTRUCTIOX IX ELOCUTIOX. and afected, or as it is caled without foundation, a theatric style of speech. This charge is made either by those M^ho do not, in all cases, know the meaning and power of instructive principles, which are only the exponents of a clasified knowledge in the arts; or by those who have had tlie experience of some very loose and narow rules for their own narow and unsucesful schemes.* ■^ An especial form, and the fulest force of this objection has lately been embodied into a so-caled system of Elocution, carelesly woven out of comon learning, and fair-faced 'reasonings,' first published under the Article, Rhetoric, in the Encyclopedia Metropolitana ; and subsequentlj'' under the name of a profound, as all obscure writers are thot to be, and acomplished Archbishop ; thus ading an authority of high oficial and personal character, to the outspread influence, and confirmatory suport of a sworn brotherhood of British Contributors, of the foremost rej)Uted inteligence, learning, taste, and Scientific Hank, in the United Kingdom. In one of our prefaces, we recorded the magisterial decision of the Presi- dent of the American Philosophical Society, that any analysis of the ex- presion of the human voice is imposible. And I have now to quote from a high dignitary of the Church, the equaly dogmatic declaration, that the em- ployment of a sucesful analysis, far from leading to a proper, energetic, and elegant use of the voice, would entirely pervert and corupt it. In the Fourth Part of his Rhetoric, the first chapter, and fourth section, he says : ' But there is one principle running thru all tlieir precepts,' [tlie precepts oj those who would teach elocution by precept,) ' which being, acording to my views, radicaly eroneous, must, if those views be corect, vitiate every system founded upon it. The principle I mean is, that in order to acquire the best style of De- livery, it is requisite to study analyticaly the emphases, tones, pauses, degrees of loudnes, which give the proper efect to each passage that is well delivered ; to frame 7-ules founded on the observation of these ; and then, in practice, deliberately and carefuly to conform the uterance to these rules, so as to form a comjjlete artificial system of Elocution.' ( Whether the writer had ever seen the ^ Fhilosophi/ of the Hicvian Voice, ^ does not apcar ; and the case is the stronger if lie had noi^ for, hud he attentively read it thru, the objection could not have been more directly pointed at its analysis and rules.) ' That such a plan not only directs us into a circuitous and dillicult path, towards an object which may be reached by a shorter and straightor, but also, in most instances, completely fails of that very object, and even produces, oftencr than not, efects the very reverse of what it designed, is a doctrine for whicli it will be necesary to ofer some reasons,' Now, the good Prelate's 'reasons' are employed, on the one hand, against an analytic methodj which, from not coniprcliending, as it seems, the jiur- posc of resolving the voice into its constitutMits, he thinks would ]>roduce an Artificial manor of speech, and on the other, in favor of liis notion of what he calls the Natural manner; not drawn, as it should be, from the ordination of God and Nature, but founded on tiie folowing »«fountled remark, by Adam THE MEANS OF IS'STEUCTION IX ELOCrTIOX, 477 This objection is grounded on some nietliod, suposcd to be free from this analytic formality, and 'preceptive afectation j and ealed, the ' Xatuml Manner.' But this maner having no describable standard of its own truth, propriety and taste, is vaguely refered to an ' ocult' animal instinct, under that boastful term of human vanitv, Prerogative ' Genius : ' which, by its untrained and wayward igno- rance, would, with an impudent claim to an inborn privilege, reject the wise and prevailing eforts of educated art. Yet instinct even when nominaly dignified into ' Genius,' seems to be nothing more than the result of an organization prepared by nature to receve the impresion of directive causes, Avhich thereupon act necesarily, to excite the organic power, limited as it may be, and to exercise it to its end. As this organization of instinct begins to loorh itself into mind, the knowledge thereby acquired^ for we perceve mind, only thru knowledgcj creates by slow degrees, another state, or another more complicated and efective mental organization, so to speak ; on which the objects or facts of an art act more broadly as directive causes, to excite the no less necesary and unering pur- poses, and practical ends of science. The practical ends of Elocu- tion, as an elegant art, are, to denote our thots, and pasions, with truth, propriety, and taste, and consequently without the eror and deformity of awkwardnes, or afectation. When therefore, bv Smithj towards the close of his reflections on 'the Imitative Arts,' already refered-to at the end of our nineteenth section. ' Tlio in speaking, a person may show a very agreeable tone of voice, yet if he seems to intend to show it^ if he apears to listen to the sound of his own voice, and as it were to tune it into a pleasing modulation, he never fails to ofend, as guilty of a mostdisafree- able afectation.' To show the general bearing of this ' reasoning,' we here make an analogical aplication of Adam Smith's and the Prelate's th5t to another related esthetic art. Tho a Painter might please us in executing a well invented subject of a picture^ yet if he seems to intend to show his skill, or to look at his own composition, and as it were, to aprove of the principles of his art, in their acomplishment of his design, his coloring, and shaded light, thereby to bring his purpose to a finished efectj he never fails to ofend, as guilty of a most disagreeable afectation. It has been one of the objects of our Work to answer ' reasoning ' by fact : and tho we here notice the Prelate's adopted, and unsifted faith and notions, the serious argument against them, whicii we do not require, others will heri'- after draw, for their satisfaction, from the demonstrative answer of Observa- tion and Time. 478 THE MEANS OF INSTRUCTION IN ELOCUTION. analytic knowledge of the constituents of an artj principles, or clasificatious of its facts, for some efective purpose are framed, these principles become, as it were, the scientific instinct of the new and more complicated organization of the mind, in its state of acquired knowledge : just as in its own way, the original and more simple organization of nature, exercises its limited and merely animal instinct. And as this instinct, or call it ' genius, ' of the Old Elocution produces what the objectors to the use of Analytic Rules, asume to be the propriety and grace of its ' Natural Manner; ' so the regeneration of the mind, as we describe it, to a new life of acumulated knowledge, has necesarily a tendency, in its scientific instinct, towards the natural maner of a more comprehensive, refined, and efective Elocution. It is then the limited animal instinct of the Old School, and its ignorance of the wide resources of the scientific instinct of the New with its analytic, more exact, and exalted natural manerj that does realy produce in itself the formality, and the theatric afectation, wliich it deprecates and blindly charges on a beter system. For it must be borne in mind, that the important vocal Mode of Intonation, outlawed as it is from all inquiry, has with its power of expresion, been heretofore employed, whether by those who adopt, or who reject the rulesj for there is little diference in the event of their failuresj only with the intonative, and limited resources of the brute.* It has been the oversight and misfortune of the Old school of Imitation, that even Math the striking analogies of Rhetoric, * This charge of a Theatric manor on any pompous or afootod speaker, is one of the inumerable instances of the inconsistent and miidled human mind. The world of Taste goes to the Theater to hear the jmrest stylo of Elocution, and thinks it so, or it would not continue its aprobation. Dignitaries of the Church and their plebean folowcrs, who do not go to this Wicked Place, would dej)reciate the character of an elegant amusement they dare not, with worldly motives, enjoys and therefore condemn it. From some of their metapliysical notions, or from Shakspeare's caricature of a particular ' robustious fellow tearing a pasion to ragsj ' they speak of any ostentatious maner, whether in school-boys, or the Pulpit, as theatric. And acording to the objector in the present casoj instruction on the principles of vocal Time and Intonation must necesarily produce this Tiieatric afectation. I cannot, by the scale of our analysis, positively decide on tlu* Archbishop's cxomplilicafion of his ' reasoning and argument,' from n(!ver having had the oportunity of hearing him read. THE MEANS OF INSTRUCTIOX IN ELOCUTION. 479 Music, Painting and the Landscape, severaly founded on the re- lations of these Arts, to capacities and principles in the human mindj they never perceved, tho they obscurely used without j^er- ceving, the equaly elegant, and for human purposes, the more esential relations of the modes and forms of the voice, to the mental states of thot and pasion ; and therefore remained deaf to the cries of sister-principles of propriety and taste, craving to be admited into the Esthetic family, as the New-born art of Elocution. From what is here said, we may ofer three remarks on this ob- jection to the use of Rules in the Art of Readmg. First. An atempt to teach by rules, under a partial knowledge of the con- stituents of speech, could never in the old school, except by chance, have been elegantly right; and must have been often for- maly and afectedly wrong. Second. It was from the want of the Universal Rules of Speech, drawn from a full analysis of its con- stituents, that led the old school, to concludej there could be none. And it was this want, that led its folowers, in groping after an in- definable excelence, whether natural or artificial, to fall into their inherent constraint and afectation ; the real causes of which they had not a suficient light of analysis and rule, to enable them to avoid. Third. The efect of our proposed system of analysis and principles for teaching the art of reading, and for insuring its freedom from formality and afectation, will be the same in every other art, whether useful or esthetic. In all, it is necesary to know what is to be done, and what means are to be thotfuly employed, to do it well ; to practice its rules, at first perhaps awkwardly, in closely and slowly thinking of their aplicationj and by this frequent repetition, to enable the act, so far to wean itself from the di- rective purpose, as to become an eficacious habit; and finaly, to use a full knowledge of the art, with almost the unperceved power of what we have metaphoricaly caled a scientific instinct. The purely acquired human art of Swiming, unasLsted by in- stinct, tho learned with tedious efortj directed by earnest thotj and only mastered at last by careful atention to every imitative and embarasing motionj is afterwards, from that atention fading into habit, suc^sfully employed in danger j with the thot only of the shore to be reached, and the life to be saved : and in like nianer, 480 THE MEANS OF IXSTRUCTIOX IX ELOCUTION. the purity, propriety, energy and elegance of rhetorical composi- tionj which slowly perceved, and only thoroly learned, by close atention to their particulars and to the rules that should govern them, as our unfriendly Prelate must have known by self-expe- riencej are afterwards, without a perception of those particulars, aplied in public oratory to the broad purposes of a well instructed and sucesful eloquence. I have often been led to consider the oposite characters of propriety in the style of Composition, and of impropriety in the Vocal habits of speakers. Our Western World is overrun by itinerant lecturers, and ubiquitous speech-makers of every sort; the same in class with the Older Sophistsj but without their care- ful Rhetoric, and the candid Avarning of their Name : yet however humble their subject-mater and their taste, the most insignificant and iliterate so to call them, are often as conected in their words and sentences as the orator of higher j^ower and scholarship; while in their respective intonations, and other modes of the voice, they are sometimes both-alike, often no more than negatively agreeable and corect, and generaly, in various degrees indistinct, afected, monotonous, outrageous, or false, to a cultivated ear. Two causes at least may be asigned for this diference. Onej that the crowd of the world is too often satisfied with a careles maner in its aifairs ; and as the greater part of what is caled Oratory, compared with the permanent words and works of ^^"is- dom, relates only to the events and opinions of the dayj it is looked upon as unecesary to waste atention on tlie voice ; especialy under the belief, that Nature spontaneously directs what is here required. This is exemplified by the many instances of deformed elocution, among the renowned dialectic speakers of the Senate, the Pulpit, and the Bar ; with whom the vocal j)art of education, being considered as not csential, the Orator in his ambitious con- tentions, and delusions, thinks or finds, he does not need its asist- ancc. Hence with a Slavery-agitator in the American Congress, and an Abolition-preacher about tlie streets, there is equaly an ignorant disregard to the proper, and certainly to the elegant uses of the voice. The other cause shows why speakers are equaly corect, or nearly so, in the gramatical character of their discourse. For having by THE MEANS OF IXSTRUCTION IX ELOCUTION. 481 truth or sophistry, to convince or to persuade their liearers, it must be with a conected order of discourse, however defective or false the intonation. To render their language comprehensible, they are obliged in childhood to learn the right perceptions of Avords; afterwards to acquire by book or imitation the proprieties of gramar, with the meaning of phrases and punctuation ; and finaly to folow examples of a ])roper arangement of words and sentences. In this case the speaker is compeled to acknowledge his ignorance and his obligation to learn. And as neither the Speaker nor the Audience perceve a diference between the right and the wrong in the voicej ignorance with both being their defense against knowl- edgej neither thinks it necesaiy to learn, and the speaker, like our Learned Prelate, regards the power of properly using his voice as a natural gift, which would be forfeited by the interference of systematic instruction. We can here perceve the causes why respectively, Parliamentary Burkesj and itinerant Fanatics with other Demagogues, folow the same rules of gramar and composition in their style ; and folow no rule at all, in the corupted instinct of their intonation. This is our view of some of the objections, made against an attempt to teach the Esthetic uses of the voice, by systematic and comunicable principles. We will not confer importance on them by special refutation. In so doing, we should only record some vain opinions of this age, which a future one need not know. At the present time, let us not be concerned if the history of the voice contained in this esay, and the Plan of instruction founded upon it, should be ' either stumbling-block or foolishnes,' to the groping school of mystagogues and imitators.* * In aclition to the iniposibility of influencing those, who in the present age pass for Philosophers and Thinking men, and who asert that Elocution cannot be tat by analysis and rule; it is no less hopeles to persuade those to learn, who, not quite so impenetrable as the former, only maintain j it would give no return for the trouble. "Why should we labor, they ask, to acquire an art which when needed will be no more than the spontaneous result of thot and pasion ; or why improve that which some visionary and interested re- former tells us, is not well done already ? This question is so broadly answered by the record of facts in this volume, that I shall here merely ilustrate its eroneous suposition, by comparing our humble subject of Elocution with the transcending subject of Government : 482 THE MEANS OF INSTRUCTION IN ELOCUTION. The preceding history furnishes materials, for raising elocution to the condition of a Regular Art, if not of a Science ; and we must look to the comparisons, and conclusions of taste, for precepts the principles of which, equaly with those of speech, everj' one thinks he comprehends by intuition. Unlike as these subjects may seem when thus presented together, they have thro ages, each in its own misguided eforts, shown the same proportion of grave pretensions, of unfounded or ill-aplied facts, of erudite discusions, of indefinite precept, of contradictory practice, and of deplorable failure in its boasted promises. Each has had a thousand diferent and contending schools; more than thousands of examples of individual authority ; with schools, and authorities variously overthrowing one another, and neither able to furnish a general principle, or instance, for universal aprobation : no Speaker, whether by his ' Genius ' or his 'Imitation ' able to answer the acurate demands of the mind and ear: no sovereign Despot or Democratic sovereign, able to satisfy the wishes and the wants of the subject or the citizen ; and each from a simi- lar cause. One has no uniform rule of expresion, drawn from nature, f'>r di- recting his speech ; the other no uniform or consistent rule of Law, Morality, or Keligion, to control his conduct. The speaker, ignorant of what is proper or elegant in the voice, falls into his 'natural manner,' and disputes himself into enmity with the ' natural manner ' of another ; the Governed, not finding what is wise and just, falls into the selfishnes of his pasions, and brings his diference with others to a civil war. The Statesman narows-down the great problem, on the causes and cure of the anti-social vices of pride, vanity, ava- rice, ignorance and ambition, to the futile question of the comparative wisdom and the rights of the Many, and of the Few : just as the Elocutionist has nar- owed the great purpose of the vocal means in nature, by a paltry clasification of the disciples of the Art, into those of 'Genius' and ' Imitation.' But, in artful transformation, the Few in government thru pride and wealth, asume the power of the Many : and the Many, by falsehood and fraud, asume the cuning of the Few. The many in government, are then made to beleve, that man is incapable of any other perception, than that of being a slave to the Prime management of a Eoyal Minister, or to the Prime Knavery of a self-serving Demagogue. The Many in Elocution are made to beleve, they can speak-well, only by the ' Inspiration of Identitj',' or the ' natural maner ' of the School. And bad readers, under the restrictive authority of the Old Elocution ; and miserable suferers, under make shift Monarchies and Repub- lics, are alike led to comfort themselves, respectively in their bad taste, and unhapines, by these similar questions of pasive submision: Why should we raise the ire of the Old School, with trying to read by the new analysis ? and why should we disturb a Government by tr3-ing to reform it? when the Mas- ters of vocal instruction and Imperial and Mass-meeting legislators, themselves so incorigible, cannot admit, that the art of Speech in one case, and "f luimnn hapiness in the other, is not as perfect under the present order of things, as the purposes of knowledge and taste, and the rights of man can ever posibly require ? THE MEANS OF INSTEUCTION IX ELOCUTION. 483 to direct the use of these materials. Our history -will not only aford the means for reducing the arbitrary fashion of the voice, to something like that method and rule, to which the other fine arts have been already brought, among their educated and reflect- ing votariesj but it opens a new field on the subject of instruc- tion. All arts when reduced to their elements, have been reconi- posed into systematic order for teaching by the Primary School of those elements ; and it now becomes us to try what time may be saved, what old views may be cleared from obscurity, and what wider knowledge obtained, by a rudimental plan in describing the several modes of the voice, conveying the mental states of thot and pasion. Language was long ago resolved into its alphabetic elements, and its Parts of speech. "Wherever that analysis is known, the art of gramar is with the best suces, conducted upon this method. If then the thotive and expresive uses of the voice should be tat by a similar analysis, the advantage would be no less, than from the alphahetic and gramatical resolution. In this way Ave teach a child its leters and their union into words : surely then, there is no cause why a clear perception of the varieties of stres, of time, and of intonation, and the power of knowingly employing them in curent uterance, should not be acquired in a similar elementary maner. The art of reading-well consists in having all the constituents of speech, both alphabetic and expresive, under complete comand ; to be by Nature's directive instinct, properly aplied, for the im- I^resive and elegant representation of every state of the mind. I shall not however in this section, consider the modes of the voice as expresive of thot or pasion : but shall describe the means for providing the manageable material of speech, whenever the pur- poses of the mind may require its use. If I were a teacher of elocution, I Avould frame a didactic sys- tem of elementary exercises, similar to that which taut me, what- ever the well-read critic may find to be new, in this volume ; and would asign my pupil a task under the following heads : Of Practice on the Alphabetic Elements. Notwithstanding we are all taut the alphabet, we are not taut the true elements of speech : I would therefore require the pupil, to exercise his voice 484 THE MEANS OF INSTRUCTION IN ELOCUTION. on the elements, as they are sounded in a strict analysis of words. In the present school-system of the alphabet, many vowels have no peculiar symbol, and nearly all the consonants when separately pronounced, are heard as sylables, not as elements. If h and k and /, be sounded as respectively heard in 6-ay, and Z;-ing, and Z-ovej or, if we jDause after these several initial sounds have es- caped the organs, we have the real element, instead of the com- pounds he, kay, and ell, as they are universaly taut : and the like is true of all the consonants. Let the first lesson consist of a separate, an exact, and a re- peated pronunciation of each of the thirty-five elements, thereby to insure a true and easy execution of their un mingled sounds : the pupil being careful to pronounce, not the alphabetic sylable of the school, but the pure and indivisible vocal element ; however unusual and uncouth that sound may in some cases, be to his ear. It may be askedj if a careful pronunciation of words, in which these elements, combined with others, must still be heard, would not give the necesary exactnes and facility ? I beleve it would not. When the elements are pronounced singly, they may receve an undivided energy of the organic efort, and therewith a clearnes of sound, and a definite outline, that make a fine preparative for distinct and forcible pronunciation in the compounds of speech. And perhaps no one who has neglected this elementary practice, is able to efect the vocality of b, d, and g, with the force, fulnes, and duration, required on ocasions, for the higher powers and graces of elocution. The eficacy of this separate practice, in giving a comand over the alphabetic sounds, is most remarkable in the r. The element r is a modification of the vocality of the subtonics, and denotes two diferent articulations. One is made by a quiet aplication of the tongue to the roof of the mouth ; the other by its quick percusion against that part. The r produced by the first organic position, (lifers very little from the short tonic c-rr, and may be caled the Quiet r. That made by percusion, the Percussive r. The later has a distinctnes of character and a body of sound, not posesed by the former^ and if the metaphor can be apreciated, the [)arts concerned in its formation seem to have a firmer grasp of the breath. Yet this Percusivc r, even with its THE MEANS OF INSTRUCTIOX IX ELOCUTION. 485 vigor, and satisfactory fulnes, will be agreeable only when it con- sists of one, or at most, two or three strokes and rebounds of the tongue : for should it be a continued vibration, the efect will be ofensively harsh, if not expresly designed for a ruf or energetic uterance ; but even this should be avoided. The perfect r, for the purposes of distinct and impresive speech, shud consist of a single slap and retraction : and it can be made in this maner, by diligent practice, on the solitary element. Besides the dificulty of acquiring strength and acuracy in this se^Darate pronunciation^ certain combinations of the r, with other elements can be efected in an agreeable maner, only by asiduity. A subtonic or atonic that employs the tongue in one position, will not readily unite with an element, requiring a quick remove of the tongue to another part of the mouthj even when the element is produced, as in the quiet r, by a simjile presure of the tongue ; but the dificulty of transition is much increased, by the velocity necesary for the percusive r. Let us for instance, take the syla- bic step from d to r, in the word dread. As the formation of d requires the tip of the tongue to be aplied to the uper fore-teethj should r be taken quietly, the confluence of these elements may be easily made, by retracting the tongue to the contiguous place for forming the r. When however we roughen the word by the per- cussive r, the tongue is brought down from the teeth, towards its bed, in a kind of drawing-otf, for making thereby, a suden im- pulse against the roof of the mouth ; and it calls for both efort and skill, to acomplish these sucesive movements with that quick- nes, which sylabic coalescence requires. There is also considerable dificulty in uniting the percusive r with some of the tonics ; and the cause is analogous to that above described. When the percusive r is set be/ore the tonics, the coalescence is easy, as in I'ude, reed: but it is not so when it folows certain of these elements. If the tonics are of long quantity, there is in some cases, only the slightest dificulty ; as in glare, war, far, peer, mire, our, your. Should the short-tonics e-rr, e-nd and i'-n, and most of the other tonics when pronoiniced short, precede the per- cusive r, there will be the unpleasant efort of a hiatus, together with that peculiar efect of a union of tonic and aspiration, which 486 THE MEANS OF INSTRUCTION IN ELOCUTION. forms one of the characteristics of speech in the natives of Ireland. This will be perceved, upon pronouncing the words, interpreter, world, iritate, intercourse. The cause of the hiatus and of this inevitable Irishism apears in the folowing explanation. The tonic sounds, tho in greater part laryngeal, are in some cases modified by the agency of the tongue and li])s. The tongue in sj)eech is employed in varying positions, from the deepest depres- sion in its bed, till nearly in contact with the roof of the mouth. Its place in the uterance of a- we is the lowest; and the highest in ee-\, c-nd and i-n. If these short tonics precede the percusive r, there is a hiatus, from a dificulty in making the percusion ; and this changes the tonic into a semi-aspiration. When a-we precedes r, the tongue being in its bed is in the proper position for making the impulse, and the combination of this a-we with the r, is easy, and is free from aspiration, as in aurelia and reward. In the case then, of the short tonics preceding the percusive r, it is necesary to bring down the tongue from its short- tonic posi- tion at the roof of the mouth, to its bedj to give it starting-way, so to speak, for gaining its percusive velocity. The aim to efect this in the quickest time, produces the hiatus of pronunciation. Yet with every endeavor, there is still a perceptible interval be- tween the change in the position of the tongue, from its short- tonic place down to its bed, and subsequently up to the roof of the mouth, the place of the percusive r. And as there is no cesation of vocality during the time of the change, the depresion of the tongue, or some other cause, gives that vocality its asjurated char- acter. This mingling of aspiration with the short tonic, and the percusive r, produces the disagreeable efect in the uterance of these conjoined elements ; nor can it be altogether avoided, except by using the quiet r. Tlie dificulty of executing the r, under the circumstances above- mentioned, will I fear, be insurmountable to those who are not persuadcdj the perfection of their acomplislimcnts nnist at last be due to their own habits, their knowledge, and their industry. Those who know how necesarily a fruitful desire of improvement is the result of wise docility of mind and heartfelt resolution, have only to learu that it is within the capabilities of time and exertion. How long it may take to overcome the dificultics here abided to. THE :meaxs of ixstructiox in elocution. 487 must depend on instinctive facility of uterance : nor need it be told to those who deserve instruction, and will have succes. To such persons, it is enuf that it may be done. An exact pronunciation of the elements according to the rule of the day, is a mater- of importance, not with reference alone to the law of fashion. It has a claim of greater dignity. When states of mind are to be comunicated with precision and force, it should be by well-known words, not peculiar in sound, nor striking by length, nor by dificult uterance. There should be no remarkable contrast between them ; no atractive and disturbing similarity ; nor anything in the language, to alure atention from the thot conveyed by it. A writer, who frequently employs un- coraon words, except in technical instruction, never has vividnes or strength, or may I say transparency of style. For the acom- plishment of these objects, sounds should slip efectively into the mind, almost without the notice of the ear ; and the meaning of an Author not conveyed slowly under obscurity but at once, thro the clearest light of simplicity and truth. What is said, on the distractions produced by novelty and peculiarity of words, aplies equaly to the pronunciation of alphabetic elements ; as the least deviation from the asuraed standard, converts the listener into a critic : and it is perhaps sjieaking within bounds to say, that for every miscaled element in discourse, ten suceding words, if not more, are lost to the observant and reflective part of an audience. I have therefore recomended a long-continued practice on the separate elementsj for acquiring that comand over them, which not only contributes to the elegance of speech, but at the same time, may helj) to remove all obscurity from the vocal picture of thot and pasion. Of Practice on the Time of Elements. Enough has been said in former pages, on the necesity of a full comand over the time of uterancej for efecting the important purposes of elocution. A^^hen the pupil has acquired a true pronunciation of the ele- ments, he should not, acordi ng to the usage of the primer, pass at once to combine them into words. They are emj^loyed in speech under various degrees of duration ; and diligent practice on these degrees will create a habit of skilful management, not so well nor so easily acquired by exercise on the comon curent of discourse. 488 THE MEANS OF IXSTRUCTION IX ELOCUTIOX. Let the pupil then consider the alphabetic elements as a kind of Time-table, on which he is to learn all their varieties of quantity. The power of giving -well measured length to sylables is so rare among speakers, that I have been induced to draw especial aten- tion to this elementary method of instruction. Altho a prolongation of the atonies is of little consequencej let the pupil reiterate his practice on the tonics and subtonics, until he finds himself posesed of such a comand over them, that he may at will, give the quantity to their sylabic combinations. The elements 6, d, and g, admiting of only a slight variation of quantity, on the prolongation of their feeble vocalityj a strenuous practice on their individual sounds is necesary to render them aplicable to the purposes of oratorical time. When r is to be prolonged, and the rapid iteration would be inapropriate, the quiet form of the element should be employed ; the percusive r, made by a single stroke and rebound of the tongue, being necesarily short. Tlie element s, when alone and prolonged, is a sign of con- tempt. In sylabic combination it is ofensive if much extended in quantity; under its shortest time, it still performs its part in speech, and loses mucli of the character of the hiss. Let the pupil therefore practice the shortest quantity on this element, by abruptly terminating the breath, or by separating the teeth at the moment its sound is heard ; for this at once cuts it short. Here is not the place to remark how carefuly a repetition of this element in suceding words, particularly if emphatic, is to be avoided. Of Practice on the Vanishing Movement. This subject should perha})S, have been considered under the last head ; for an atcmpt to prolong the elements without reference to the equable concrete of speech, is very apt to produce the note of song. The difercnce between these two forms of intonation even on a single tonic, will be perceptible to an experimental ear, by keeping in mind at the moment of trial, the well known and })eculiar efect both of speedi and of song. The pupil then, witliout confusing his ear by other particulars, should exercise his voice on tlie simple form of the radical and vanish, on all extendible elements. An unering power in executing this function, however long the quantity maybe, will TIIE MEANS OF INSTRUOTIOX IX ELOCUTIOX. 489 ahvays insure to speech, an entire exemption from tlie protracted radical. In this elementary intonation of the equable concrete, atention should be paid to the structure of the vanish. The pupil must therefore endeavor to give it that delicate expiration which may render the point of its limit almost imperceptible : for this is its proper form, except some purpose of expresion should require a more obvious demarkation. We often lean the ear in delight, over this smooth breathing of sound into silence, by singers; and the master m elocution shall hereafter know, that one of those 'graces' which he could never name, and even thot 'beyond the reach of artj' but which Art conjoined with Science, is now ready to teach himj consists in this atenuation and close of the sylabic impulse, here recomended as a lesson for the school-boy. Of Practice on Force. It is scarcely necessary to say how loudnes of voice, or the forte, is to be acquired. It Ls not esential to our discipline, that the elements should be utered separately vrith regard to force. When the other constituents of expresive speech are brought under comand, exercise on this mode may be efected during the curent of discourse. Still the ends of instruc- tion would be somewhat easier atained by the elementar\' proces in this particular. Few persons perceve the influence that loud speaking or vociferation has on vocality. We have already learnedj it is one of the means for acquiring the orotund. It takes the voice aparently, from its meager mincing about the lips, and transfers it, at least in semblance, to the back of the mouth, or to the throat. It imparts a grave fulnes to its character ; and by creating a strength of organ, gives confidence to the speaker in his more forcible eforts ; and an unhesitating facility in all the moderate exertions of speech. Of Practice on Stres. Altho the elementary exercise on force as a general rule, may not be necesary, I must urge its importance, in particular sylabic stres. There is a nicety in this mater, that will be definitely recognized, and consequently can become familiar, only after the deliberate practice and unembarassed observation, aforded by trials on the separate elements. It was said formerly, that radical stres is made with emphatic strength only on the tonics ; still, an atempt to aply it to the sub- 32 490 THE MEANS OF INSTRUCTION IN ELOCUTION. tonics is not to be entirely neglected. The full power of radical abruptnes in the tonics is efected, by opening the elements into uterance, with a sort of coughing explosion. The pupil cannot be too strongly urged to a careful practice, on tliis subjectj that he may thereby acquire the habit of giving abruptnes, instantly and with moderated force. Here its peculiar character as a Mode of the voice is aparent, and its clasification' defensiblej in making a satisfactory impulse on the ear, without the hamering strokes of an uncultivated pronunciation. For this fault of reading lies not only in the repetition or curent of a sharp and loud radical stres on every word, but that stres is sometimes caried into the concrete, if not thro it, on acented sylables of moderate quantity. The use of the median stres or swell, requires no particular direction. It is generaly employed on the wave, and its practice may therefore be conected with exercise on pitch. The vanishing stres may be practiced, by asuming in speech something like the efort of hicup for the wider intervals ; and of sobbing, for the minor third and semitone. We do not recomend practice on the minor third, with reference to its alowable use in speech ; but to render it so familiar to the ear, that it may be avoided as a fault. Elementa,ry exercise on Compound stres, and the Loud Concrete, will give facility in the comand of these forms of Force. Practice on Thoro stres, with a strict comparison of its efect, on long quantity, with the efect of the equable concrete, is here recomended, that the jjupil may by his own knowledge, per- ception of propriety, and taste, rather than by any authority of mine, be guarded against this vocal sign of phlegmatic rudeness. Of Practice on Pitch. The several scales used in speech were described in the first section. The order of proximate intervals in the diatonic, and the skip of its wider transitions, must be learned from an instrument, or the voice. AVith a few days' atcntion to the various rising and faling movements, on the keys of a piano-forte, or in the voice of a master, a pupil who has the least nuisical ear, will be able to execute the same succsions in his voice, and to recognize the concrete pitch, and change of radical, on elemental and sylabic utcrance. After this first lesson, let every interval of })itch, both by con- crete movement and by radical change, be practiced on every tonic THE MEANS OF INSTRUCTION IN ELOCUTION. 491 and subtonic element. The semitone is easily recognized in a plaintive intonation : and when exercised on all the elements will readily become obedient to the states of mind requiring its ex- presion. The efect of the simple and uncolored interval of the second must be negatively described by sayings it is not the semitone, with its plaintive character; nor the rising third, or fifth, or octave, also well known as the sign of interogation ; nor the down- ward movements of positive declaration and coraand ; nor the wave, with its admiration, surprise, mockery and sneer. If then, in sylabic uterance, none of these efects are produced, it may be concludedj the voice is in the simple second of the diatonic melody. By practice on this interval, on all the tonics and subtonics, the pupil will atain a comand over the constituent of this plain into- nation; nor will he be in danger of destroying its apropriate char- acter by the whine of the semitone, the sharp inquisitivenes of the fifth or octave, or with the more ofensive afectation of the wider forms of the wave. The pupil will be able to recognize a downward interval, by familiarizing his ear to the efect of the last constituent of the triad of the cadence. This will teach him the character of the faling second ; and by studiously repeating the tonic and subtonic elements in this movement, he will have nearly as clear a percep- tion of the peculiarity of the interval, as of the sounds of the ele- ments themselves. When prepared with this downward vanish, he may contrast it with the rising second, and thereby become familiar with the audible character of each. Upon knowing the second, the wider faling intervals M'ill be jjerceved by continuing the downward progress, till the intonation asumes the expresion of comand ; the extent of the downward movement by a third, or fifth, or octave, being proportional to the less or greater degree of that expresion. Let these wider intervals be compared with those of a rising direction, and the diference between the intonation of a question, and a comand, will be strikingly manifest. When the pupil has gone over the elements, on the simple rising and faling intervals, let him turn to their combination, in the wave. Here his practice must be governed by his perception of the simple intervals which variously compose its diferent kinds. 492 THE MEANS OF INSTRUCTION IN ELOCUTION. The wave of the second is of great importance, in the grave and dignified character of the diatonic melody. I cannot by direct description, bring it before the ear; but in giving prolonged quan- tity to indefinite sylables, if the efect of the upward or downward wider intervals is not recognized^ nor the peculiar note of songj nor the marked impresion of the wider wavesj nor that of the plaintive semitonej it may be concluded, the voice is moving in the wave of the second. Of Practice on Melody. An important purpose on this point is the perception of the radical changes of the second, in the cur- rent of discourse. If the pupil has a musical ear, he may easily acquire the habit of varying the several phrases in the maner for- merly proposed. Should he not have a nice perception of sound, nor ingenuity in experiment, he must learn the diatonic progresion from the voice of a previously-instructed master. Melody is a continuous function ; practice under this head must therefore be made on sucesive sylables. The best method is to select a portion of discourse, to keep in mind the diatonic maner in which it should be read, and at the same time, to uter only the tonic element of each sylable ; and by a sort of vocal short-hand, or instayit hackings of a momentary cough, to go thro this doted outline as it were, of the melody. In this case, the ear not being embarassed by the subtonics, the diference between rise and fall in radical pitch, will be more aparent, and consequently the power of avoiding monotony, and of mingling all the phrases in an agreeable variety, more easily atained. Of Practice on the Cadence. Tlie cadence is an important part of the melody of speech ; and readers being therein liable to fre- quent and striking faults, the subject requires discriminative aten- tion. Here particularly the elementary practice is to be employed ; the pupil bearing in mind the difcrent forms of intonation for ter- minating a sentence^ and exercising his voice separately on one, two, or three elements or sylables, considered as a close. By elemcntiiry practice on the various species of the cadenccj comand over their intonation will be exercised, with a perceptible acuracy, never yet within the incoherent purpose of any ancient or modern system of Imitative disci j)line ; for many of these pur- poses were only dreams. After the proper time devoted to th6 THE MEANS OF INSTRUCTIOX IX ELOCUTION. 493 plan here recomended, the pupil will be provided with an ample fund for every variety in his periods ; nor will he then find liim- self at the end of his sentence, with a sylable that seems to have got out-of-joint with its intonation. Of Practice on the Tremor. The tremulous movement should be practiced on individual elements. With a knowledge of its various forms, the pupil may corect himself in his task, and finaly acquire the acuracy, so esential to this remarkable expresion. If the habit of lausrhino- and cryino^ does here furnish a wide field of practice, it is to be recolectedj we laugh and cry instinctively, upon our own delight and sufering. When the tremulous expresion is employed to afect an audience, governed in its tastej as it may come to pass hereafter, by the knowledge and principles we are here unfoldingj it should be done, not only acording to the dictates of Nature, and within the iluminated circle of her truth, but with that refinement, and finish of execution, which her incipient in- stinct may not have had the purpose to acomplish ; while yet ready to acknowledge their entire consistency with her prospective and progresive laws. Of Practice on Vocality. Vocality is capable of improvement ; and the practice in this case may be either on the elements, or on the curent of discourse. Yet as this mode of the voice is most perceptible on the tonic sound, perhaps the elementary leson is the best for instruction. In whatever maner the improving exercise is conducted^ by it, harshnes may be somewhat softenedj a husky voice be brought nearer to pure vocalityj the piercing treble re- duced in pitchj and the thin and meager voice indued with greater fulnes and strength. There is, however, a misconception on this subject, which may be noticed here. The characteristic Vocalities, or, as confounded with Pitch, and vaguely caled, the distinguishing ' tones,' of the voice, are said to be unlimited, and like the face, peculiar to each individual. We do not often forget or confound the known voices of individuals, however numerous they may be ; a popular proof, that M'e all have an instinctive and discriminative ear, for the things of Speech,, without having names for them. But the distinct recognition is here made upon combinations of the specific degrees, and forms of •494 THE MEANS OF INSTEUCTIOX IN ELOCUTION. force, pitch, and time, rather than on the single mode of vocalitv. One speaker is characterized by a constant use of the vanishing stres ; another by that of the radical ; one employs the interval of a third in the curent melody instead of a second ; some a long, and others a short quantity on every emphatic word. By a varied permutation of these features, a counties number of diferent, yet distinguishable faces, is given to the body of speech. And here, as a coment on the prevalent notion, that speech with its 'occult qualities,' is too subtle, imaterial, or, to use the Platonic ' slang ' of the nineteenth century, too 'spiritual,' to be made a subject of physical investigationj let us remark, that all these faces, features, aye, and delicate expresions of speech are practically conizable by comon perception. There is as great a variety in vocality, as in any one mode of the voicej and more than of some ; the amount however, falls far short of the almost endles combinations of the various forms of the Modes with each other. We may learn that vocality is not always its distinguishing markj by atending to the prolonged note of song ; for this makes it more obvious. In perceving a prolonged note, exclusive of any peculiarity of stres, time, or intonation, it is not easy to distinguish voices, that widely difer when heard under the mingling modes of speech, in only a single sentence. Of the speaking voices of a thousand persons, each would be distinguishable, by its peculiar manner of using the various permuted forms of pitch, time, and stress. If the same voices were severaly to be indicated by a single prolonged note of song, the diferences in vocalit}^ might be reduced to a few classes. There would be forte and piano voices heard among them, shrill and hoarse, clear, aspirated, harsh, full, meager, dull, and sub-sonorous : and to these a few others might be added. Yet even these would, in some cases, be perceptible only to a cul- tivated ear ; and of the whole tliousand, above suposed, perhaps not more than twenty clases of vocality, as subjects of recognition could be found, to constitute twenty diferent kinds. Of the Orotund as a kind of voice, we spoke in a former sec- tion ; and there described the means by which the fulnes, power, and graver character of this voice may be atuincd. It miglit per- haps asist the lieader in using the proper moans for acquiring the THE MEANS OF INSTRUCTION IN ELOCUTION. 495 orotund, to know, that the vocality in this case, is apt to change into wliat we formerly caled the basso-falsetej producing that ' double-lung' kind of speech, of mingled bass and treble. Of Practice in Rapidity of Speech. Extreme rapidity of speech may be employed for ataining comand over the voice. The difi- culty, of making transitions from one position of the organs of articulation to another, requires an exertion which tends to increase their strength and activity ; and this enables them to execute the usual time of speech, without hesitation. I would recomend the utmost possible precipitancy of uterance ; taking care not to outrun the complete articulation of every element ; and this makes it ad- visable to set the leson on some discourse, long fixed in the mem- ory, that no embarasment may arise from the distracting efort of recolection. There is not much advantage to be derived from elementary practice on Aspiration, the Emphatic vocule, and Gutural vibra- tion. The exact and forcible execution of these functions, does not require the exclusive atention, directed by the rudimental sys- tem of practice ; nor is anything to be efected thereby, that may not perhaps, for all practical and tasteful purposes, be acomplished in the current of discourse. This is a brief enumeration of the articulative, the thotive, and the expresive constituents of the whole asemblage of speech. An interesting inquiry isj whether we should aim to acquire a full power over these constituents, by exercising the voice on their combinations, in curent discourse, or by separate and repeated practice on their individual forms.* * Perhaps the analogy would be too remote, to draw an example of the elementary and synthetic method of instruction, from the gradual process of infant speech. But I cannot, while the subject is before me, avoid a few remarks, on what apears to be the order of that proces. Altho we should reject every fictional date, and they are all fictional:; for the origin of language; and every suposition of one or of many parts of the earth as well as of the maner, in which it did begins still the sucesion in the instinctive eforts of present infant speech is freely open to investigation. In a Note to our section on Time, there is a pasing question^ Whether the 496 TPIE MEANS OF INSTRUCTION IN ELOCUTION. It is needles to oifer arguments in favor of an elementary didactic system to those, who, from experience in ace^uiring the abrupt elements were not prompted by sudden instinctive impulses, at that almost inconceivable event, the beginning of speech. Since the date of our fourth edition in eighteen hundred and fifty-live, I have read in the Introduc- tion to Mr. Charles Eichardson's Etymological Dictionary, the clear exempli- fication of his analyticaly tracing many of the full-formed words of cultivated language, to roots of a primary meaning in the individual elements : and not- withstanding the philological Ethnologist, and the writers on the Mind have not had the curiosity or time, to learn how far our history of the voice might assist their researches, I will still endeavor to draw their attention, by aply- ing some of the principles of nature to the present fashionable inquiry into the origin and language of man. It is known, that in the ful-established system of the vocal signs, the states of mind variously emjiloy the modes of vocality, force, time, abruptness and intonation ; and that the first audible eforts of infant-expresion are purely vowel sounds, under the forms of cry, scream, and of fainter vocalities called humming and cooing; together with a varied time, force, and intonation of these sounds, and even of their suden break into abruptnes. These vowel signs, as well as we observe, denote the first perception of pleasure or pain or of physical wants. So far then, these individual elements have a meaning, and are the real and simple roots of language, in the signs of infant perception^ for we cannot give the then state of mind the name of thot or pasion. The consonants next folow, in the progres of speech ; and still to found the origin of language in nature, certain instinctive muscular functions prepare the vo- cal mechanism for the production of these elements. The early act of draw- ing nourishment strongly exercises the muscles that close and open the lips ; and furnishes the organic means, which with the acompaniment of vocality, or aspiration^ already prepared by instinctive efort^ produce in the former case, the elements B, M, and V, and in the latter, F, and P. In the same act the aplication of the tongue to the palate, and to the uper and the lower gums, constitutes the mechanism, that with vocality, or with aspiration, severaly forms G, K, D, T, N, R, 2%-in, and Th-an. The next instinctive-elemental and significant sign would perhaps be the incipient tremor on the interval of the tone or second, or wider interval, for the expresion of infantile satisfaction ; and sobing, with the tremor on the semitone for distres. Coughing would early give a comand over abruptnes, and prepare for the radical stres, and distinct articulation of perfect speech. We do not asunie that single consonants are at first, mental signs; nor after- wards, except in the expresive asj)irations of s, and h ; and as it would bo steping aside from the caution of j)hilosophy to supose, that in some infantile eforts they may be so, wo leave this subject for those who think it deserves stricter investigation. The instinctive vowels with their intonations are the first signs of the pleasures, pains, and wants of the child : and observation teaclies^ tliey denote these perceptions, as certainly as they can be denoted by the full-formed words of conventional language. THE MEANS OF INSTRUCTIOX IX ELOCUTION. 497 sciences, have formed for themselves economical and efective plans of study. Let all others be toldj that one, and perhaps the only- cause why elocutionists have never employed such a system, is, that they have overlooked the analytic means of inquiry into the subject of vocal expresion ; and have therefore wanted both the knowledge and nomenclature for an elementary method of instruc- tion. Science and art have too many proofs of the suces of this rudimental method, to alow us to supose, the same means would not have been adopted in elocution, if they had been known to the master. Xot to cite instances from those graver studies which procede by the synthetic steps of elementary principles ; and with no in- tention to shame the 'genius' of an elocutionist and his gramar of imitation, let us go to the Ring, and see the Science of muscular atack and defense, an over-match for the best eforts of strength and pasion, when undirected by gymnastic skill. The 'Fancy' have realy made no slang-like or degrading aplication of the word. Science, as we usefuly regard it, does no more than lay-down for art, those general principles, and eficacious rules which sagacity has drawn from observation and trial : and tho it may not always enoble the subject it touches, it does keep from it, that char- acteristic of brutal it}" j the instinctive execution of what, in its causes and efects, is not perceved by the agent. Yes, even the Pugilistic Art, low in purpose yet skilful as it is, has for the There is a further adition to primary speech, -when the consonants are acidentaly combined with vowels, into the sylabic impulse ; as in Ap and Am, or reversely, Pa and Ma. The sense of hearing then becomes observ- ant: imitation folows, and monosylabic language with its capacity for endles combination into words of varied extent begins. It may therefore seem, that by Mr. Richardson's observations, the ultimate roots of languages are the significant elements. Under this view, the roots of all languages must have a comon origin ; displaying the unity of nature, not only in the prevalence of the same principles of articulation and of vocal ex- presion, in every age and nation, as we have after close analysis, represented itj but in the origin of that articulation, and expresion, in whatever part or parts of the earthy or in whatever age or ages it may once or oftener, have ocured. Should future observation confirm Mr. Richardson's view, and the few remarks we have aded to it, it will be learned, that the five modes of the voice, which combine to make the vast variety of mature and expresive lan- guage;! are found in limited use, to constitute what on like principle we may call the incipient expresion of infant wants, and pleasure or pain. 498 THE MEANS OF INSTRUCTION IN ELOCUTION. time, outstriped the philosophic eforts of Elocution ; and claimed for its method and precepts, the justifiable name of Science. And beleve me, Readerj the elementary training in its positions and motions, caries not more superiority over the untaught arm, than the definite rules of elocution, founded on a knowledge of the constituents of the voice, will have over the best spontaneous achievements of pasion. Let me not be mistaken on this point. Altho I do not say, the method of instruction here proposed, can create the esential powers of a speakerj futurity will probably show, that some such system alone can direct, enlarge, and perfect them. ^Passion/ says a writer, 'knows more than art.' It may, in its own way, know more than the Old Elocutionary art ; but the Art of Science, so to speak, in its own way, like prudence in human afairs, sometimes knows beter than passion. A display of the pasions in speech, is not always adresed to persons under the sympathetic influence of those pasions. When it is, or when at moments, the speaker can raise that sympathy, and pasion becomes the selfish party-Tyrant of the mind, all is right, however wrong, that pasion does. When pasion is no longer the despot either of words or Mall, and we are caled upon to make some proper use of its active perception, with- out its waywardnes and partizan exceses, such comparisons arise between our own state, on ocasions of excitement, and what we perceve in othersj that we are obliged to call upon observation and taste for some educational rule, of Things as they Should bej to settle an uncertainty of opinion. Pasion as we know it, is only the Enacting of a certain character of expresion ; and being with none, except fools and madmen, an Outlaw of the jNIind, is still amenable to its purposed and directive, the excited authority. We need not go far, for the true history of what is caled the Natural Maner in Speech, prompted by spontaneous and uneducated pasion ; for pasion is a wise instinct of nature, but is always pervertal, if never improvingly taut. The everyday vulgar triumphs of popu- lar eloquence, in which the demagogue, and the sectary, load away an audience, eager to pursue the same selfish schemes of profit, or vanity, or fanatical delusion, are ]>roof of what this oratorical sym- pathy is ; and what a wild and artful pasion alone can sometimes do, without the aid of truth, or honesty or taste : for in these a;^ in THE MEANS OF INSTEUCTION IX ELOCUTION. 499 other popular relations, the more an orator influences the pasions of others, the more those pasions make a slave of himself. We look for no more, from a well devised practical system of elocution, than Ave are every day receving from established arts. All men speak and 'reason,' in the comon way, for these acts are as natural as pasion ; but the arts of gramar, rhetoric, and thinking teach us to do these things in the best raaner, or rather, doing them in the best maner is signified by the name of these arts. The subject of elementary instruction may be otherwise re- garded. The human muscles are, at the daily call of exercise, obedient to the will. There is scarcely a boy of physical activity or enterprise, who on seeing a circus-rider, does not desire, in some way to imitate him; to catch and keep the center of gravity thru the varieties of balance and motion. Yet this will not pre- vent failure in his first atempts, however close the conection be- tween his will and his muscles may be. For without trial, he knows imperfectly what is to be done; and even with that knowl- edge, is unable, without long practice, to efect it. Many persons, with both thot and pasion, have a free comand of the voice, on the comon ocasions of life, who yet uterly fail, when they atempt to imitate the varied power of the habitual speaker. When the voice is prepared by elementary practice^ thots and pasions find the confirmed and pliant means, ready to efect a satisfactory and elegant acomplishment of their purposes. The organs of speech are capable of a certain range of exertion; and to fulfil all the demands of a finished elocution, they should be caried to the extent of that capability. Actors with both strong and delicate perceptions, and who earnestly expres them in speech, are always aproximating toward this power in the voice ; and with no more than the asistance of a habitual exercise which enlarges their instinct, do in time, acquire a comand over the forms and degrees of pitch, and stres, and time; without the Actor himself being at all aware of the how, and the what, of his vocal atainments, or having perhaps, one inteligent, or inteligible per- ception of the ways, means, and efects of their aplication. The elementary method of instruction here proposed, being founded on the analysis of speechj at once points out to the Actor what is to 500 THE MEANS OF INSTEUCTIOX IX ELOCUTION. be desired and atained ; and how every vocal purpose of thot, and pasion should be fulfiled. It was not until long after the invention of the Bow for the gliding touch of chorded instruments, that its use was subjected to acurate atention. A few belonging to that class of mankind who thru precise and enlarged observation, with its steady aim, find out for themselves, the best way to efect their object, may have exhibited rare instances of skill in its management. As soon however as the celebrated Tartini had made an analysis of their dexterity, the master was able to point out to the pupil the mus- cular sleight of wrist and arm which its handling requires ; their combined and sucesive motions; together with that full perception of the will as it seems, present in the muscle, which insures unde- viating steadines in every sweep, and gives the power of a sort of voluntary spasm for the purpose of a momentary touch. When these points were ascertained, instruction began to adopt the econ- omy of elementary rules ; and confidence, rapidit}', precision, smooth nes, and variety of execution, became comon acomplish- ments in the art of Bowing. When an atempt is made to teach an art, without comencing with its simple elements, combinations of elements pass with the pupil for the elements themselves, and holding them to be almost infinite, he abandons his hopeles task. An education by the method we here recomend, reverses this disheartening duty. It reduces the seeming infinity to computable numbers ; and I have suposedj one of the first coments on the foregoing analysis, may refer to the unexpected simplicity of means, employed to produce the unbounded permutations of speech. Nay, this esay itself will fare beter than other similar eforts in science, if some of the perishing criticism of the day should not find suficient motive with itself, for overlooking the dificulty, of penetrating the mys- terious thicket of speech, and of tracing its interwoven branches to their palpable roots, by being told how few and how acessible they arc. In our proposed method of instruction, we have in view tlie strictest j)r()priety, and the highest finish of the voice. An ordi- nary and even vicious use of Spcecii, as we all know, may serve for Buying and Selling, either in the common course of Trade, or THE MEAXS OF INSTRUCTION IN ELOCUTION. 501 in Election-Frauds, and Legislative Bribery. When the powers and beauties of the voice are the subject of reflection and taste, it is necesary to employ the most comprehensive and precise means for its cultivation. It would be posible, even without regard to the alphabet, to teach a savage to read, by directing him, word by word, to folow a master. And it has been proposed to teach elocution, by a similar process of imitative instruction. But the atentive Reader must now know with me, and others may know anions: themselves hereafter, that the analvsis of words into their alphabetic elements, and the rudimental method of teaching insti- tuted thereupon, do not give more facility, in the discriminations of the eye on a written page, than the means here proposed will aford to the student of elocution, who wishes to excel in all the useful and elegant purposes of speech. The master having now at comand a knowledge of the vocal constituentsj which already fore- tels, and by future aplication will furnish a precise and universal system of music in speechj let him adopt that elementary method of instruction which has made another music familiar to the minds of children, and spread its refined and heart-felt pleasure thruout the civilized world. To begin this elementary, and only sucesful method of teaching the otherwise unteachable esthetic art of speechj let the master and his pupil, or his whole school, meet at first, without their little text- books ; the master having already tlie great Book of Nature by heart. Let the master then exemplify the five constituent modes of the voice ; the formation of the musical scale, with the expla- nation of its divisions and uses ; the four scales of speech ; the concrete and discrete pitch in all its forms ; the graceful gliding of the vanish, with the efect of the second and of other intervals. Let him make the pupil sensible of the diference of these inter- vals by separate and by contrasted uterance ; of the peculiarities of a rising and of a faling movement ; of the waves ; of the diatonic, and the chromatic melodies ; of the cadences ; and of the streses ; making the lesons an exemplification of every constituent function of speech. Let the pupil practice all this v/hen he retires ; and on returning, let it not be to hear his master read, and vainly try to imitate himj but to repeat his elementary task, thro all the available modes, forms, and varieties of the voice. When he is 502 THE MEANS OF INSTRUCTION IX ELOCUTION. completely familiar with these rudiments, then and not before, let him begin to read. Should high acomplishment in elocution be an object of am- bition, the system of instruction ofered in this section, may until a better method is proposed, furnish the easiest and shortest means for suces. With all these rules however, the best contrived scheme will be of little avail, without the utmost zeal and perseverance on the part of the learner. It is an impressive saying by an elegant 'genius' of the Augustan age, who drew his maxim from the Greek Tragedy, and ilustrated it by his own life and fame, that * nothing is given to mortals without indefatigable labor ;' meaningj that works of surpasing merit, and suposed to procede from a pe- culiar endowment by Heaven, are in reality, the product of hard and unremiting industry. It is pitiable to witnes the hopes and conceits of ambition, when unasisted by its required exertions. The art of reading-well is an acomplishmentj all desire to possess, many think they have already, and a few undertake to acquire. These, beleving their power is altogether in their ' Genius,' are, after a few lessons from an Elo- cutionist, disapointed at not becoming themselves at once masters of the art; and with the restles vanity of their belief, abandon the study, for some new subject of trial and failure. Such cases of infirmity result in part from the wavering character of the human Tribe ; but chiefly, from defects in the usual course of instruction. Go to some, may we say all of our Colleges and Universities, and observe how the art of speaking, is not taught there. See a boy of but fifteen years, with no want of youthful difidence, and not without a craving desire to learnj sent upon a Stage, pale and choking with aprehension; being forced into an atempt to do that, without instruction, which he came purposely to learn; and furnishing amusement to his classmates, by a pardon- able awkwardnes, that should be punished, in the person of his pretending but neglectful preceptor, with little less tlian scourg- ing. Then visit a Conservatorio of nnisic; observe there, the elementary outset, tlie orderly task, the masterly discii)line, the unwearied superintendence, and the incesant toil to reach the utmost acomj)lishment in the Singing-Voice; and afterwards do not be THE MEAXS OF INSTRUCTION IN ELOCUTION. 503 surprised that the pulpit, the senate, the bar, and the cliair of medical profesorship, are filed Avith such abominable drawlcrs, mouthers, mumblers, cluterers, squeakers, chanters, and mongers in monotony : nor that the schools of Singing are constantly send- ing abroad those great instances of vocal wonder, Avho triumph along the crowded resorts of the world; who contribute to the halls of fashion and wealth, their most refined source of gratifica- tion ; who sometimes quel the pride of rank, by a momentary sensation of envy ; and who draw forth the admiration, and receve the crowning aplause of the Prince and the Stage.* * It is remarkable of the Science of the Voice, that the sucessful cultiva- tion of the department of Song, thru the close and beautiful analysis of mel- ody, and harmony, should never have extended the ambiticgi of its inquiry and suces, into the more important, and equaly esthetic department of speech. Having, after a long and active search, colected quite a library of good, bad, and indiflerent works on elocution ; and, with the exception of Mr. Steele, Mr. Odel, and Mr. "Walker, finding them all, both ancient and modern, to be composed of the same comon materials of the art, aranged and detailed with a varied ability : I had some curiosity to know the practical method of emi- nent Vocal Institutions. During my residence in Paris, thru the winter of eighteen hundred and forty-five — six, I sought by every due efort, to obtain from direct, and personal observation, a knowledge of the instructive Course of Declamation employed in the Conservatorio, I learned however, from a friend of some influence in this matter, that by a general rule, admision could not be obtained. Upon information derived from a Vocalist, at that time under tuition, for his apearance in the Opera:; who described to me, the directive, and examplary means of the master, the imitative practice of the pupil, and the detailed rotine of the task:; I was led to conclude^ they had no knowledge, out of the comon way, on the construction, and intonative meaning, either of Declama- tion or Kecitative ; nor one spark of a Philosophy of Speech, to throw the least light of explanation upon them : and tho the exclusion of visitors, might be no deprivation to the studious observer^ the duties of the Institution would by this precaution, be saved from the vexatious intrusion of the tens of thou- sands idle, restles, and ennui'd Sojourners in the great Metropolis. That the French, like the rest of the world, have not the least perception of a system of the voice, founded on the ordination of nature, and denoting the diferent states of mind in thot and pasion, must apear from their Histrionic Elocution. If the Glory, Wisdom and Taste of France, strangely concen- tered, as it is self asumed to be in Paris, should ever acknowledge the posi- bility of there being any imperfection in its state; and cease to think, it has already reached 'the highest degree of civilization ; ' it will perhaps, perceve the peculiar and bombastic system of its intonation ; and then atempt to corect it, by some other means, than that of the rule of its own exagerated 504 RYTHMUS OF SPEECH. SECTION L. Of the Rythmus of Speech. In the section on Time, some alusion was made to the subject of Rythmiis. I there described the circumstances under which stress and time, or as they are otherwise caled, acent and quantity, pro- duce by their alternations the agreeable impresions of verse. I and habitual expresion. The English, phlegmatic as they are suposed to he, are prone to ergploy an over-proportion of vivid constituents in that curent which should be a plain diatonic melody. But the French, far exceding them in this use of the wider intervals and waves, do not employ the diatonic melody, or only ocasionaly, in their oratorical and dramatic speech. We have learned how rarely the plain and dignified forms of the second and its waves are heard even on the English stage ; and that, without an ad- justed intermingling of the expresive and the inexpresive constituents of speech, no Actor can atain tragic distinction, or long maintain it, with an audience of educated perception and taste. In this improper use of wider intervals and waves, the English, from the construction of their Language, have less apology than the French, for the exceses of their intonation. It is well known, that the acentual character of the English language consists in a forcible stres on certain sylables, with a feeble stres on othersj the later being more numerous ; and the diference in degree of the streses being so fixed and remarkable, as to furnish a rythmus of acent or quantity for the construction of its Blank-verse ; which serves the further purpose of roleving the monotony of its rhj'me, by the variety of a strong and atractive acent, sucesively faling on a different syhibic sound, and by the cesural pause, in the course of the line. With the French language the case is diferent. It has a perceptible varia- tion, in the force of its acents, and the duration of its quantities; but not suficienlly marked, nor of such a systematic character, as to make an available prosodial meter. The French Epic and Dramatic lines, for they cannot be caled prosodial measures, properly consist each of twelve sylables ; tho they have sometimes ten or eleven. Among them is ocasionaly found, a sucesion of acent and quantity resembling the various structures of English verse. There is an example of our anapestic measure, in the first Cunto and second line of Voltaire's Ilenriade, Et par droit de conquete et par droit de naissancc. Alowing for the manor of tho French, in jirolonging their .sylables, many RYTHMUS OF SPEECH. 505 now ofer a more formal acount of this mater, with the design to speak of the Rythmus of prose ; and to notice in as few words as like corespondencies to the usual English measures may be gathered from what they call their heroic rhyme. But all such cases are acidental in French versification, and do not acord with the general character of its iregular sucesion : a sucesion, shocking to tlie English ear, and uterly without a flowing rythmus either as poetry or prose. We pronounce the word acominodation with a strong accent on the second and fourth sylables, and a contrasted feeble one, on the third and fifth : whereas the French, with whom it has six sylables, as ac-com-mo-da-ci-on, make but a slight variation in the degree of stres among them. Hence, if the word be moderately caricatured by a full stres on every sylable, it will resemble French pronunciation. And in general, to mimic that pronunciation, in English words, it is only necesary to substitute de, for the; to give, to the English ear at least, an afected prolongation to certain sylables, and a like degree of aoent on all. It may be perceved that the French language, in its acent and quan- tity, does not admit of Blank-verse ; as no proper prosodial meter can be given to its lines. Under this condition, instead of altogether rejecting the vain atempt at measure, and employing plain but dignified prose, in their Epic and Dramatic composition^ they endeavor to suply the want of a regular temporal and acentual rythmus, by the poor regularit}- of an equal number of sylables in each of their lines, and by terminating them with rhyme : and on this ground alone to raise the verbal structure of their poetry. May we not there- fore admire the esthetic choice of the ' amiable' Fenelon, who tells the grace- ful and instructive story of Telemac/ius, in the unembarassed dignity of Prose, by excluding the puerile counting of sj-lables, and chime of words, in French heroic versification ? I would submisively propose as a subject of future inquiry among the French, whoj whenever they look at themselves, by the light of an analytic speech, will be the best judges in the case^ whether this peculiar construction led to their use of the florid and exagerated form of their Histrionic intonation : and whether, in the desire to withdraw the ear from the paling efect of the equal count of sylables ; and to lesen the monotony of the rhymes, they did not purposely endeavor to produce, thruout the curent, and particularly at the close of jiroximate lines, a contrast of striking intervals and waves; such as that of a rising interval, or an indirect wave, at the end of one line, and a reverse movement on the next; without those intonations having the least regard to a natural propriety of expresion. ' For we must remember;; the monotony of French rhymej which under English law is not always canonical^ and of its equal number of sylables, is not i-elevable by the atractive rythmus, of the English maner of acentual or temporal measure. And finaly, whether by this atempt to avoid monotony, they did not substitute, that equaiy strik- t ing and more eroneous monotony, which is always produced by impresive I, intervals improperly aplied. ■ This is the view, which our ' Philosophy' of speech ofers of the universal I 33 m 506 EYTHMUS OF SPEECH. posible, the originul and practical system of Mr. Steele, on the subject of acentuation and pause : this being among the first results, in modern times, of an inquiry into the philosophy of spoken language. Speech would not be suited to the interchange of thot and pasion, if every sylable of every word were sucesively and equaly acented. For by this uniform acentuation, it would want that vocal light and shade, and that pronounced relief, required for a distinct picture of mental and audible perception j consequently thots would not be easily distinguished from each other ; and speech would be inconveniently slow. Whether this slownes would result from the hiatus, in pasing from one acent to another, each with a full radical upon it, we need not here inquire. It is enuf to know, that if the folowing, or any other sentence be read with every sylable acented, the delay will be unavoidable. The Eight of suf-frage in a Ke-pub-lic, will, thru the suc-es-ive Oli-gar-chy of weak and am-bi-tioas Knaves, al-ways end in the Wrongs of the Peo-ple. Although this political axiom should be deliberately read as well as closely laid to heart ; still, with an impresive acent on every sylable, the pronunciation of this eternal truth would far excede in time, even what its solemn uterance deserves. Let us take another example, to be read with forcible and proximate acent. The dif-er-ence be-twoen the two great An-tag-o-nists a-niong na- tions, is this : In a Des-pot-ism, the gov-ern-mcnt preys up-on the peo- prevalence of the remarkable intonation in French Tragedy : a philosophy, drawn from the ordination of nature in the human voice, and that should make no ulowance for national self-deception, and its self-solacing vanity. Be this view admisible or not, my observation ventures to afirm this exoesive use of florid intervals, in all the French Tragedians I have heard, including an Actress of the day, whom the Critics of Paris, with unbounded eulogy, but without the least vocal discrimination, present to the world as the para- gon of Tragic Art. I say nothing here, of gesture and other acom])animent3 of this vivid and false intonation : nor of Comedy and Vaudeville, which tho employing a somewhat oxagerated form of coloquial speech are altogether most admirable. Could I have had tho oiwrtunity of personaly observing the method of teaching Declamation in the Conservatorio, I might have spoken with more fulnes, and acuracy on this subject. RYTHMUS OF SPEECH. 507 pie. In a De-moc-ra-cy, the peo-ple prey up-on the gov-orn-ment. The life-blood is drawn a-like by each. - In one case by the Ea-gle ; in the oth-er by the Hats. It is from this alternation of strong and weak acent, with the variations of long and short quantity, that the graceful flow of style, and much of the power and beauty of speech are derived. This being the character of the acentual function, Mr. Steele, by an original view of the relations between acent, quantity, and pause, made divisions of the line of speech, analogous to the Bars of musical notation. These may be caled Acentual Sec- tions.* AVe will atempt to explain part of the system of Mr. Steele, by the folowing sentence ; using italics in place of his symbol for the acented sylable; the numeral seven for the pause; and marking the sections, merely for reference. 12 3 4 5 6 I 7 In the | sec ond | cent u-ry | 7 of the | christ ian | e ra | 7 8 9 10 11 12 I 7 the I em j)ire of | Rome | 7 com-pre | hend ed the \fair est | 13 14 15 16 17 18 I part of the | earth 7 | 7 and the [ most 7 | civ i-lized | 2^or tion | 19 20 I 7 of man | kind. \ Mr. Steele first asumes the time of the several bars to be equal, like that of the bars in music; the term bar, meaning, not the vertical lines, but the space between them. He next subdivides a sentence into bars, each of equal time ; that time consisting, either altogether of verbal sound, or of a verbal sound and of a silent time or pause. Suposing then a bar, or acentual section, to con- tain, in its verbal time, one, and never more than one, acented * The Greeic Rhetoricians gave the name of Prosodial Feet, to certain ar- angements of long and short sylablesj these being identical in place however, respectively with the acented and unacented; metaphorically implying the regular progresion of poetical lines, by the measured steps of quantity and acent. A foot with its first sylable short and its second long, or its first lightly and its second strongly acented, was caled an Iambus, as consume. "When this order of quantity and acent is reversed, a Trochee, as morn-ing. A foot of three sylables, with the first long and the other two short, or the first strongly and the others light)}' acented, a Dactyl, as grdce-ful-ly. Mr. Steele's purjiose was to ajily to prose-reading, a rythmus founded on these principles of poetic construction. I 508 EYTHMUS OF SPEECH. sylable, or heavy Poize, as he calls it ; and one or more unacented, which he calls the light Poize; the begining of the bar is always ocupied by the heavy acent, and the end by the light, or in their absence, by a respectively equivalent silent time or pause. In the first bar of the above example, there is no hea\y accent, for the sentence begins with two light sylables, but its time is indicated by the symbol of a silent pause : the two light are set at the end of the acentual section. The word second, in the next bar, has a heavy sylable folowed by a light one, and thus makes a full and audible time. In the third bar, the word century has a heavy, folowed by two light sylables. The fourth has the same time in sylable and pause, as the first. The fifth and sixth are of the same construction as the second. The seventh has one light acent, and a pause in place of the heavy. The eighth is like the third. The ninth and twentieth have each one heavy acent ; for each syla- ble being a prolongable quantity, the time may be extended to an equality with that of the other bars. The fourteenth and six- teenth have each, like the last-named, a heavy ; but wanting the light, its time is suplied by a pause : for the short quantity of these words does not alow their prolongation to the full time of a bar. The other bars are only resjjectively, repetitions of those already described. If we supose so many sylables within a bar, as to require an improper precipitancy of uterance, to make the time of the sections equal, it becomes necesary to add a new bar, for the redundant light sylables, and to set them at the end of the new bar, and the symbol of a pause, at the begining, in place of the heavy or acented sylable. In the example, we might put [ century of the | into one section ; but when the sentence is read deliberately, this section is too long. It is beter ordered in the example, by a subdivision, and by a pause in the place of an acented sylable. An imcdiate sucesion of long quantities may alow a change of the rythmus. In the eighth bar of the example, em lias the first place, as the acented sylable ; and it may be em- })haticaly prolonged to the time of an entire bar; butjJiVeis so impresive by its quantity that it also may form the first part of a bar, and the division may he; \ em | pire of | Rome | . It is the same with the seventeenth ; where tho civ is the acented, lizcd is tlic longer sylable, and we may have the divisions; | ciu i | lized | ; RYTHMUS OF SPEECH. 509 the last long sylable, from its quantity suplying the time of an entire bar. With this general explanation, the Reader is refered to Mr. Steele's work, for a more particular acount of the svstem. Perhaps I have not properly marked the bars of this sentence. My purpose however, being only to ilustratej others may vnih an ear of taste, improve the reading for themselves. Yet it is worthy of remark, that if this sentence is read without its linear divisionsj the voice of a good reader is disposed to make its pauses in those very places, and of that duration, visibly indicated by the symbol of the pause, both in the light and heavy parts of the bar ; show- ing the instinct of the voice ; with the powers of analysis, and the originality of Mr. Steele. It will perhaps be asked herej What is the meaning of these divisions? And what useful purpose they serve in instruction? All works on elocution before the time of Mr. Steele, recomend the acurate acentuation of words, and a strict atention to their separation at the proper places for pausing. And altho Mr. Sheridan gives particular examples of notation for rhetorical em- phasis, and for pause, he lays-down no formal rule, to direct a pupil on these points, as Mr. Steele has done, by his divisional bars placed before the heavy accent. The importance of the sub- ject in our early schools, may be learned from the maner in which children begin to read; for their hesitating uterance, and their close atention to the single word, lead them to lay an equal stres on every sylable, or at least on every word. This habit continues a long time after the eye has acquired a facility in folowing up dis- course ; and in some cases infects pronunciation during subsequent life : as it is not till the tongue goes triping, or rather halting, with its firm and its tender step on words, that the ear becomes sensible of the use and beauty of acent. Mr. Steele's notation having a symbol for the degrees of stres, here marked by an italic sylable, presents a visible analogy to the light and hea^^ impresion, and furnishes a child wnth the picture of his leson on acent, and with a monitor to his ear. I do not sayj this object would not be ataincd in a degree, by employing the comon mark of stres on all acented sylables : yet even this is never done ; could it have the generality of a precept, or be as definite for elementary instruc- tion, as the conspicuous division by bars ; nor would it include the 510 RYTIIMUS OF SPEECH. indication of pause, together with other points embraced by the system of Mr. Steele. One of the objects of a scientific institute is, to point out what is necesary in an art, even should it not be able to direct the exact maner of executing it; and perhaps no one who has atentively looked into Mr. Steele's notation will hesitate to aknowledgej it has set the subjects of acentuation and pause in an entirely new light before him. This notation is founded on a knowledge of the conventional acents of English words, and tho it W'Ould not inform a child what sylables are of long quantity, or emphatic ; nor, where the pauses are to be placed; it will enable a master, who knows how to order all these things in speech, to furnish his scholar wdtli a visible ilustration of his task, and a rule for subsequent use. If a boy is taught by this method, he acquires a habit of atention to the sub- jects of acentuation and pause, that may be readily aplled, without the notation, in ordinary discourse. I have gladly embraced an oportunity to notice the ingenius originality of Mr. Steelej who was among the first to shriek-out at the incubus of ancient prosody, which had crouched so close on the bosom of his own, and of every modern language. The rythmical portion of his work while observati ve, is neither full nor systematic ; and his distinction of what he calls Poize, from the efect of quan- tity and stres, apears to me to be altogether notional and cloudy. Notwithstanding his philosophic turn for realy hearing speech, he seems, on the subject of his light and heavy Poize, to have falen almost into the mystfcism of ' Occult causes.' Still I have taken a short and perhaps unsatisfactory view of this part of his esay, as prefatory to the few folowing remarks on the subject of rytlimus.* The Rytlimus of language is produced by a certain order of acent, quantity, and pause. Or in other words, a certiiin sucesion of sylables, having diferent degrees of stres, or of quantity ; and this sucesion being divided into portions by pauses, constitutes the * Mr. Steele first published his views, under tho title cited in the introduc- tion to this esay. A few years afterwards he gave a second edition of his work, with the ])hrase of ' Prosodia Rutionalis.' This lust has very little adi- tion to tho former ])rint: and its Latin words servo only to t)bscurc the simple explanation of his early English title. RYTHMUS OF SPEECH. 611 agreeable impresion of the curent of spcceli, called Rythmus. And further, certain perceptible relations, between the various sounds of the elements and of sylables joined with the flow of that rythmns, serve both in prose and verse, to extend and to highten its esthetic character. These relations regard an interesting branch of Rhetorical inquiry; embracing those delicate audible percep- tions, either agreeable or otherwise, of the similarity and contrast of elemental and sylabic sounds, which cannot have escaped the notice of a cultivated ear ; and which may have been instinctively observed, and practiced, in Greek and Roman Elocution, yet never described or reduced to system. And if what is here said may not be perceptible to every Reader ; some perhaps, may folow- up this hint on the subject of those graceful acompaniments of rythmus, which I am not at this time prepared to pursue. Two methods of aplying the alternate force and remision of stres, and the variations of quantity are employed in the construction of rythmus. One procedes by a regular repetition of the same order of impresions, in Versification. The other, in Prose, has no formal arangement of its strong and weak, or its long and short sylables. The system of the order of sylables in verse constitutes what is caled Prosody. This subject having been ably treated by authors, and being beyond the design of this esay, we here pass it by, with the remark, that if English prosodists would listen to their om'u lan- guage, when they undertake to regulate it, and would scrutinize what the older gramarians have said upon the subject of Timcj which, Ave have some causes for beleving, they themselves did not strictly analyzej their science would be more- Intel igible, and their rules of practice more useful to the student. The broad distinction between prose and verse consists in the more iregular sequence of acent and quantity in the former : still they seem to compromise their diferences to a certain degree, in their respective atempts at excelence. For the best poetic rythmus is that which admits ocasional, and wel-ordered deviations from the curent of acentuation ; these deviations however, not continu- ing long enough to destroy the general character of regularity ; the order returning before the ear has forgoten its previous impresion. Prose, on the other hand, is constantly showing the begin ing of a regular rythmus : but before any order of acent or quantity has 512 RYTHMUS OF SPEECH. time to impres the ear with its measures the cros-purpose of a new series destroys the order of incipient verse. The sources of variety, beauty, and force, in rythmus may be learned from the folowing general view of its structure. In ordinary pronunciation there may be several sucesive mono- sylabic-words marked by the abrupt acentj the abruptnes necesa- rily producing a momentary pause between them : or there may be an acented sylable folowcd by one or more, and not exceeding five unacented ; the average proportion being about one acented, to two or three unacented. From this it apears that the divisions, in- cluded between the vertical lines of Mr. Steele's notation, caled here, acentual sections, may consist of from one to five sylables, and with peculiar arangement, and care in pronunciation, perhaps of six. Consequently, if a rythmus were formed on the function of acent alone, a series of these diferently constituted sections, would furnish the ground-work for considerable variety. In the above example, the sections consist of from one to five sylables, for the third and fourth may be thrown together by omiting the bar and the pause, without ofending the ear ; and these sections being aranged in varied sucesion, is one of the causes of the agree- able rythmus of that sentence. Perhaps the Reader will now admitj the ear is as strongly atracted by quantity, as by stres. When, therefore, these two functions are combined, the means of variety are multi])lied. In the folowing sentence, slightly altered from Gibbon, I have marked in italics those sylables which make an impresion by their quantity, and add dignity to the varied acentual rythmus. The masters of the fairest and most wealthy climates of the globe, funi'd with contempt from gloo)ny /lill.s, amiVd by the wintery tempest, from lakes conccal'd in mist, and from cold and lonely heaths, over which the deer of the forest were chased by a troop of naked barbarians. Besides the variety and impresivenes arising from stres and quantity, the rythmic efcct may be further diversified by including one or more axientual sections witiiin the boundary of pauses. If the useful economy of the term may be alowed, let us call tlie por- tions of discourse so formed, Pausal sections. They may consist of a single word ; and the structure of style, and ea.se of uterance, EYTHMUS OF SPEECH. 513 rarely admit of tlieir containing more than twenty sylables. In the folowing example the pausal sections are included between the upright lines, that the order and variety of the sucesion may be surveyed by the eye. The lines designate only the place of the pause in clear and impresive reading, without denoting its several durations. It is gone | that sensibility of principle | that chastity of honor j which felt a stain ( like a wound | which inspired courage | whilst it mitigated ferocity | which enobled whatever it touched | and under which | vice it- self I lost I half its evil | by losing all its grosnes. | * The agreeable efect of variety- in the pausal sections will perhaps be more remarkable, by contrasting it with the monotony of the antithetic stjde. The following sentence exhibits, not the art, but the artifice of rhetorical construction. When I took the first survey of my undertaking | I found our speech | copious I without order | and energetic | without rules | wherever I turned my view | there was perplexity | to be disentangled | and confusion to be regulated | choice was to be made | out of boundles variety | without any established principle of selection | adulterations were to be detected ] with- out anj- setled test of purity | and modes of expresion | to be rejected or receved | witho\it the sufrages of any writers of classical reputation | or acknowledged authority. | Such measured divisions used ocasionaly may give variety to discourse; but as a characteristic of style, they become tiresome to the ear;? and aiming to be forcible merely by verbal contrasts, often weaken the more important force of thot. There seems too, to be a want of dignity in this kind of rythmus ; and those Avho afect it, scarcely perceve how nearly they aproach to the principle of the ludicroiLS : for when its features are slightly surcharged by caricature, it realy becomes so. The principle Ls that of a re- semblance in sound, with a difference in meaning. The similarity in the number of words, together with the like places of their acents, and the equal count of sylables, under which it has some- * The maner in which lost, here forms by itself, a pausal section, is ex- emplified in Mr. Steele's method of notation : I Viceh I self! \ lost! \ half its \ I e vil. I A good reader would pronounce this clause, with emphasis on lost, and a pause before and after it: thus acording with Mr. Steele's principles of Acentual division. 514 EYTHMUS OF SPEECH. times been the literary practice to set-forth the strongest antithesis in meaning, has not exactly the contrasted imagery of a pun, but it reminds me of it. The monotonous efect of a series of similar pausal sections, is conspicuous in the folowing example from the poems of Ossian. It is however, fair to remark, that as the extract has only two trisylabic words, and not one polysylable, this peculiarity must be taken into acount, with the other defects of its composition. And is the son of Semo falen ? | mournful are Tura's walls. | Sorow dwells at Dunscai. | Thy spouse is left alone in her youth. | The son of thy love is alone! | He shall come to Bragela, | and ask whj^she weeps? | He shall lift his eyes to the wall, | and see his father's sword. | Whose sword is that ? | he will say. | The soul of his mother is sad. | Who is that, | like the hart of the desert, | in the murmur of his course? | His eyes look wildly round | in search of his friend. | Conal | sonofColgar | where hast thou been | when themighty fell ? I Did the seas of Cogorma roll round thee ? | Was the wind of the south in thy sails ? | The mighty have fallen in batle, | and thou wast not there. I Let none tell it in Selma, | nor in Morven's woody land. | Fingal will be sad, j and the sons of the desert | mourn. The pausal sections are nearly all of equal length, and this cause, together with the frequent ocurence of the cadence, produces the wearisome character of its very comon language, for it does not deserve the name of rythmus. Doctor Johnson once saidj many men, and women, and children in Britain, could write such poems as those ascribed to Ossian. I have too many agreeable and grate- ful recolections of Scotland, to quarel with her partiality, if she has any, on this point: but surely, there is not a Koscius, who can read them. We have a vast fund for variety, in the constituents of speech ; but we may doubt their suficiency to meet the demands of this rhetorical rigidity, without transgresiug the rules of a just and expresive intonation. Indeed, tlie pasage, like many othei'S by betcr poets, cannot be read to the satisfaction of a discerning ear. Let us compare the preceding extract, with the first few lines of Burke's episode on the Queen of France; which in elegance, variety, and impresivenes of mere rythmus, and exclusive of some hyper- bok', and des(!riptive ostentation, is not surpased in the English language. That both the acentual and the pausid sections may be graph- EYTHMUS OF SrEECH. 515 icaly made, they are here presented under ]\Ir. Steele's notation, omiting the symbols for the light and heavy acent. The acentual sections are marked by upright bars, the pausal, by the numeral seven. I 7 It is I now I sixteen or | seventeen | years | 7 since I | saw tlie queen of I France, 7 | then the | Dauphines, | 7 at Ver | sailles : [ 7 7 | 7 and I surely I never | lighted on this | orb, | 7 which she | hardly | seemed to I touch, 7 I 7 a I more de | lightful | vision. | 7 7 | 7 7 | 7 I | saw her | I just a I bove the ho | rizon, | 7 7 | decorating and | cheering | 7 the | elevated | sphere j 7 she | just be ( gan to | move in; | 7 7 | glitering | 7 like the | morning | star ; 1 7 7 | full of | life, 7 | 7 and | splendor, | 7 and I j^y- I I Oh ! I what a | revo | lution ! | 7 7 | 7 and | what a | heart 7 | must I | I have, I 7 to con | template | 7 with j out e | motion, | that 7 | 7 ele | vation | I 7 and I that 7 1 fall. I The agreeable effect of this rythmus may be traced to the folow- ing causes. First. The alphabetic elements are varied ; and except the sim- ilarity of sound in teen and Queen, and in the words ligJded and deUghtfu], c/ieering and sphere, they do not press upon each other. Second. The words have from one to four sylables ; and these are finely alternated with each other. The acentual sections vary from one to five sylables in extent. Third. The Pausal sections consist of from two sylables to ten ; and their diferent lengths are intermingled in sucesion. Fourth. The efect is still further varied, by an ocasional coin- cidence of the temporal acent with that of stres : and the dignity and force of the phraseology is hightened, by the ocurrence of these long sylabic quantities, at the several pauses, in the wordsj years, Yersailles, orb, horizon, sphere, move, star, joy, and fall. Fifth. The order of the rythmus has just enough regularity to produce the smooth efect of verse, without alowing the reader to anticipate a systematic prosodial-measure. The only exception to be made to the comendation of this ex- tract, is produced by the consecutive acents at its close. A cadence, with its last two sylables strongly accented, if not designed for some extraordinary case of expresion, or for variety in a series of short sentences, or if its harshnes is not modified by some extended 516 RYTIIMUS OF SPEECH. quantity on an indefinite quantity, is always, to me at least, both awkward and unmanageable. Dionysius of Halicarnassus, in a summary of the constituents of an elegant Elocution, quoted in a Note to our seventh section, describes Rythmus, as suporting or ^sustaining the voice;' and the metaphor is just. For a wel-marked arangeraent of the varying stres and quantity of sylables, does sustain the voice, by keeping it from that careles stagering of sjjeech, if I may so call it, and from that runing of words against each other, which by crosing, and aresting the easy step of language, confuses and thwarts the expectation of both the ear and the mind. The Ancients, with whom Writing was an Esthetic Art, consideredj without rythmus, there could be no grace and dignity of style, whether in its lighter or its graver construction : and we learn, that at the earliest period. Poetry in embodying the mental perceptions of beauty and of grandeur, assumed to itself a coresponding expresion, on the flowing and graceful measure of Verse. All this rare work how- ever, was done by those, who if they did not, from the patience and thot with which they wrote, always beg their bread, did veiy often little more than earn it. Too many, who now use the hasty and profitable tongue and pen, have not time to measure for the intelect, and ear, what they manufacture for the market. The .regular order of Meter that can be counted on the fingers, may for comon purposes seem to require but little instruction. The Ryth- mus of Prose must be studied by the rules of a flowing and efective variety, as the Ancients studied it. It is therefore, at present, neglected : and we are not without Critics, of such indolent or untunable ear, as to suposej we ought to write, even in tlie brief and simple words of scientific description, with the disjointed plaincss of common speech ; and that to satisfy a cultivated taste and reflection, by the varied acentual force, quantity, and pause of a well-adjusted rythmus, is to be stilted and ostentatious: as the old Elocutionists say, that to read by the ]irinciples and rules of analytic knowledge, is to be Theatric, and Ibrnial. Tlie ])reccding examples of rythmus ilustrate its structure and efccts in })rose composition of elevated character. But there is no saying to what inferior level of popular idiom, language may de- scend with dignified safety, when suportotl by the confident wings FAULTS GF READERS. 517 of a gliding acent and quantity, and the upholding energy of pasion and of thot. From the pen of a person of fine rythmic perception, even a leter of busines, with its enumeration of particulars, may flow with graceful variety, and terminate with decisive satisfaction to the ear ; for the Grecian principle of rythmus sustaining the voice in discourse, aplies not more to maintaining a rhetorical dignity, than to preserving comon language from a loose and unmeasured rudenes. It is unecesary to go into a further detail on the subject of rythmus. Much might be said in ilustration of its powers and beauties, as existing both in the curent of discourse and in the conspicuous place of the pause. But we leave this to the Rheto- ricians. SECTION LI. Oj the Faults of Readers. It is a prevailing opinion, that persons who speak their own states of mind, in social intercourse, always speak properly ; and that transfering this ' natural maner ' as it is caled, to formal read- ing, must insure this required natural-propriety. This rule has arisen from ignorance of the functions which constitute the beauties and deformities of speech. Without a knowledge of causes and efects, on these points, teachers have been obliged to refer to the spontaneous eforts of the voice, as the only asistant means of instruction. Seting aside here, what we might insist on, that no one should pretend to say, what the right or natural maner is, before he knows the principles that make it so ; we will admitj the natural maner, or any body's maner, or rather no manor at allj from our being acustomed to it, and having, it may be, a felow-feeling with its faults, is less excej^tionablc than the first atempts of the pupil in reading ; still the faults of ordi- nary conversation are similar to those of reading, tho they are less 518 FAULTS OF READEES. aparent. Perhaps the comon opinion is grounded on a belief, that a just execution must necesarily folow a full perception of the thot, and pasion of discourse ; for these are suposed to acompany coloquial speech. No one can read corectly or with elegance, if he does not both perceve and ' feel, ' as it is caled, what he uters ; but these are not exclusively the means of suces. There must be knowledge, derived from peeping behind the curtain of actual vocal deformity still hanging before the just and beautiful laws of speech ; and there must be an organic faculty, well prepared in the school of those laws, for the representation of thot and pasion. Were it truej this pretended natural maner represents the proper system of vocal expresion, we would no more require an art of elocution, than an Art of Breathing: and the whole world, in Reading and Speaking, as in the act of respiration, would always acomplish its purposes, with a like instinctive per- fection. Yet far from uniformity, we find wide and inumerable diferenccs, in what, with individuals and schools, pass for the proprieties, as well as in what are acknowledged faults of speech. The Elocutionist's natural maner is not therefore, the original ordination of the voice. It would seem, that in the early and unknown history of progresive man, he must, from the perversity atendaut on his ignorance, have learned to Think, Speak, Act, Govern, and to be Governed viciously, before he had learned to think, speak, act, govern, and to be governed wisely and Avell. Man's wJiole executive purposes are directed by his thots and pasionsj the same agents that direct his speech : and, far as history, and well-grounded conclusions inform us, the just designs of Nature, in his moral, religious, political, and vocal condition, M'cre found to be already crosed, or perverted, when he first began to look into her laws, and to turn an eye of philosophic inquiry and comparison, on himself. The self-prompted eforts of speech do exhibit in some instances, pro])rieties of emphasis and intonation ; but these proprieties, like every purposed act without its rule, being but the ocasional result of a narow design, cannot have a generality necesary lor a direc- tive syst(Mn of elocution ; and will be very far from satisfactory to the car of a refined and educated taste. There may likewise be a wide diferenee, between the capability FAULTS OF READERS. 519 of a voice in its coloquial use, and of tlie same voice wlien exerted in a formal atempt to read, Mr. Rice, in his ' Introduction to the Art of Reading,' refei's to a person, who had been known to speak with great energy and propriety, as it was presumed, those very words, which, being shown to him in writing or print, he was able, only after repeated endeavors, to pronounce in the pre- cise ' tone ' and maner in which he had previously utered them. Suposing he did speah with propriety, which the art has never yet furnished the proper means for knowing^ there seems, in the case, to have been no want of a thdtive and pasionative state of mind, nor of flexibility in the voice; and it must have been among those exceptions, in which the natural laws of expresion prevail. But when discourse, denoting either of these states, is read, even by its author, the ocupation of the eye distracts his atention from his state of mindj or permits it to be fully per- ceved, only when directed to a single point. If the meaning is to be gathered from several words, or a whole sentence, the necesary foreruning and retrospection of the eye, render the proper manage- ment of the voice impracticable to those who have not, by long exercise in the art of reading, acquired a facility in catching tlie thot and pasion of discourse, and an almost involuntary habit of conecting with them, the proper form of vocal expresion. If this is true of one who reads what he has before spoken wellj more remarkably must it aply, in reading without preparation the dis- course of another. Whatever may be the cause of the dificulty of reading-wellj faults of all degrees and kinds do prevail in the art. Having therefore prepared the Avay for a history of these faults, by de- scribing what apears to be a precise and elegant use of the con- stituents of speech, I shall point out the most comon deviations from the principles, on which I have presumed to found our system of Propriety and Taste. If we undertake to measure an art by its rules, and it is foolish to atempt it without them, we must cary with our censure, some knowledge of the ways and means of its perfection. Erors are in all cases, contrasts to truth; and in elocution, they are only the misemployment of those vocal constituents, which in their proper forms and uses, produce both the instinctive and conven- 520 FAULTS OF EEADEES. tional method of just and elegant speech : for some of the finest colors of the art, even when well and truly laid-on, are diped from the same sources as its faults. Whoever, with pretensions to taste, declares his perception of blemishes in an art, without having at the same time, some rule for its beaut}', speaks as the dupe of authority, or with ignorance both of his subject and of himself. Let us then try to perform these inseparable duties, by giving the outline of a just and elegant elocution, with a particular account of its faults. While investigating the phenomena, and regarding the uses of sj^eech, I have always kept in view the purest and most elevated designs of taste. It will be little more than recapitulation there- fore to sayj the faultles reader should have at comand the various forms of vocality from the full laryngeal bass of the orotund, to the lighter and lip-issuing sound of daily conversation. He should give distinctly that pronunciation of single elements and their agregates, both as to quantity and acent, which acords with the habitual perceptions of his audience. His plain melody should be diatonic, and varied in radical pitch beyond discoverable monotony. His simple concrete should be equable in the rise, and diminution of its vanish. His tremor should be under ful] comand for oca- sions of grief and exultation. Knowledge and taste must have fixed the places of emphasis, and its various forms and degrees have aforded the means for a varied and expresive aplication of them. He should be able to prolong his voice on ever}' extent of quantity in the wave, and in every concrete interval of the rising and the faling scale. He must have learned to put ofif from the dignified ocasions of reading, everything like that cant- ing or afected intonation, which the artful courtesies and sacri- ficing servilities of life too often confirm into habit ; and to avoid in his interogatives the keenues and exceses of the vulgar tongue. He should have for this, as for every other Esthetic Art, a deli- cate sense of the Sublime, the Graceful, and the Ridiculous. A quick perception of the last is absolutely necesary, to guard the exalted works of taste, from an acidental ocurence of its causes. It may perhaps be considered presumptuous, to propose rules of taste and criticism in tlie Art of s[)eaking. JJefore the analytic development of speech, this could not have been done ; and the FAULTS OF READERS. 521 atempt -would have been equaly the act of ignorance, and foly, the very causes of presumption. We have now ascertained the con- stituents of vocal expresion, sufficiently at least, to advance some steps towards a system ; and it seemed to be no undue antici])ation of what must hereafter form a great purpose in the schools of elo- cution, to have pointed-out a use of these constituents, that may satisfy the cultivated ear. If however, any ascribed presumption should require apology, or justification, let me here say a word on the system I have oferedj and on the maner and means of its production. In embracing the oportunity of investigating the subject of the human voice, which others equaly, and perhaps beter qualified had sufered to pass-by, I brought to the inquiry some instinctive facility of ear, and some acquired knowledge of the science and practice of music. On taking-up the subject of the concrete movement, where the Ancients had left itj and thereupon tracing an identity between certain constituent functions of speech, and of musicj the train of investigation soon led to a discovery, that the individual vocal constituents of speech, like those of music, are comparatively few. This at once unfolded the cause of the mys- tery ; for the delusions of that mystery were the result of a belief either in the inscrutable character of the constituents of intonation, or in the unresolvable complexity of their agrcgates; and this unquestioned belief had deafened all perception of their individu- ality. On resolving these complicated agrcgates into distinguish- able species and individualsj it brought their asignable number and forms within the discriminative power of observation. The greatest dificulty was now overcome ; for by an unobscured percei)tion of the disentangled individual, it was easy to make out the relation- ship between a state of mind, and its vocal sign. With this knowledge, obtained by my own experimental ilustration, I turned to the uncorupted vocal instincts of children and of sub-animalsj to observe the particular constituents of pasionate ex})rcsion ; and then to comon life, as well as to the eminent elocution of the Stagej to compare the ordained constituents of both thot and pasion with their conventional usages in speech. The power of tracing the individual constituents, and of recognizing their single and combined efects, brot me to the belief, that the system here 34 522 FAULTS OF READERS. proposed has its Origin and its Confirmation in Xature ; and is therefore well adapted, by its analysis, to gratify the lover of truthj and by the practical uses founded upon it, to contribute to the pleasures of an enlightened taste. In developing this system of Eficient causation, I was led to perceve a wise conformity of the vocal means, to the expresive ends of speecli ; and to remark therein, at least the consistency of the system, if I did not dare to draw from the suposition of its Final causes, any confirmative evidence of its truth. In our pre- ceding history, a broad and important distinction is made between the vocal functions, representing simple thot, and those expresive of pasion. To one division, we aloted the second and its plain diatonic melody. To the other, the semitone, with the wider in- tervals and waves : manifest diferences in the vocal means, being definitely acomodated to manifest diferences betw^een the thotive and pasionative states of mind. On the ground of this aprojDri- ation of diferent means to a diferent end, it is conclusive, that the rule of rules, nowhere, and never forgoten by Nature^ this Rule of Fitnesj being unknown, or disregarded, or only rarely perceved in the use of intonation, must be constantly violated by speakers : that a current melody of thirds, or fifths, or wider waves, must counteract the Final Cause of Nature, in alotting a diferent vocal expresion respectively to pasion and to thot; confound lier intended contradistinctions ; prevent the repose of the ear on the unim- pasioned diatonic; and wear out its excitability to the emphatic power of wider intervals, when required for ocasional purposes of vivid expresion. There is another consideration, to justify the establishment of a system of some kind, if it should not plead for the one which is ofered here. When the several voices of thot and of pasion are individualy distinguishable, the precision of their use must be- come an object of atention and criticism with an audience ; and under an admited rule, their employment will be more uniform, and therefore more clear and imprcsive. If we vary and confound the aj)ropriatc meaning of the vocal signs, even when they are joined with conventional language, we may come in time to de- stroy, and nuist always weaken, the ciuiracter and force of those signs. If we constantly whine in the chromatic mek)dy, or cry I I FAULTS OF EEADERS. 523 out empliaticaly in the wider intervals and Avavcs, to no purpose of complaint or surprise, we shall in vain seek for sympathy, when the wolf of expresion in reality seizes upon us. In looking for a Rule of excelence in the art of elocution, we are always refered, as in the other fine arts, to Nature. But Na- ture with her laws concealed from the whole mass of Mvstao-offues and Imitators, is when shut-out from the light of analysis, an un- asignable patern ; and seems here, as in so many other cases, to be no more than the omniform parent of sectarian opinion ; and like the changeable features of Liberty with the patriot, of Experience with the physician. Right with the moralist, and of Orthodoxy with the bigotj shows as many faces as there are self-deceving tongues that take her name in vain. If nature, the deformed in- stinct of human nature, I mean, is to be the rule, it can be only by the individual instances of excelence she produces : if her ex- celencies are seatered over the species, it is Art that must ordain this canon, by colecting them into one faultles example. And where is the instance in this corupted nature, worthy of imitation ? Is it to be found in the drawl of the slothful ? In the snapish stres of the petulant ? The short quantity and precipitate time of the frivolous ? In the contmued diatonic of the saturnine ? Or the eternal whine of the unhappy ? Is it in the canting drift of the pasion-masking hypocrite ; or in the voice of those morbid superlatives which live upon exageration ? Shall we look for it in the daily-changing and mincing afectations of the Fashionable- Foolish ; or in the thousand contrarieties of National acent, quan- tity, and intonation, yet each in pride and ignorance, self-aright ? Shall we find this nature's paragon, in the chaterings of the great market of life, that hurries over its melody, denies itself the repose of the cadence, and in uproar after rank and power, and biding for its bargains of ofice or notoriety, strains itself to its hoarsest note ? These are the individual instances of vocal deformity presented by Nature, with sacrilege so called, and daily sufered to pass Avith- out remark, because we are engaged at the moment with other purposesj and which we perccve only Avhen the voice itself as a subject of taste, is the exclusive object of reflective and discrimi- nating atention. 524 FAULTS OF READERS. Altho a Compensating Nature, still holding her regards over the wayward erors of the human voice, may not, under its cor- uptions, deign to show us a single instance of the fitnes and beauty of her lawsj she has, as an indiciition of her means for perfecting the vocal powers of the individual, difused thruout the species, all the constituents of that perfection. A description of the true char- acter and wise design of these constituents, and the gathering-in of their scatered proprieties and beauties, furnish the full and choicest pattern of Imitable-Nature ; which, reduced to an orderly system of precept and example, must hereafter constitute the proper and elegant Art of Elocution. The Canon, so called, of statuary in Greece, which represented no singly-existing form, but which was said to contain within the Rule of its Design, all the master-principles of the Artj was the deliberate work of Observation, Time, and careful Experiment on the Eye, in the very method of reflective and discriminating Selection, we here claim for Elocution ; and was finished at last, by Polycletus, only after previous ages of sucesive improvement. If an individual of nature might be taken as a model in the arts, we should not at this late day be so often obliged to listen to bad readers ; nor to hear such clashing opinions, upon those who pass for the best. The productions of taste would have forerun a present needed cultivation; and in reverse of the tedious growth of centuries, would like those goodly trees in the garden of Eden, have been ripe at their planting. The masters in Elocution, not perceving, that Speaking-well is One, in the beautiful Sisterhood of the Esthetic Arts, and not drawing from a comon fund of colcctcd principles, the precepts that might be aplicable to their ownj have sometimes varied their old and imperfect rule of teaching by Imitation, to something like the system of nature, as they think, by requiring their pupil, not to imitate another, but figuratively as it were, to imitate himself. Supose yourself, says the Master, to be delivering the meaning of an author as if it is your own. Such a direction, in a.suming to be the rule for a just and efective elocution, only requires a pupil to speak as he pleases, or as his own particular mind prompts him ; for by the direction, he is to make- the author's meaning his own; but having, as implied by FAULTS OF READERS. 525 the ncecj^ity of the direction, no previous rule, he is left to uter them only as he pleases by an asumecl rule of his own. At best then, untler this direction, a class of a thousand pupils, in seeking a precept for the suposed exact meaning, would discovery there must be a thousand diferent precepts ; since each must speak by his own. It is then an unnecesary direction of an unthinking master. For no one can read well, except he does spontaneously read as if the meaning were his own : showing the superfluity at least of directing him to make it his own, in order to read well. And again, the pupil w'ho cannot so far knoAv an author's mind, as to be able to represent it from writen description, would be very likely to mistake it under his master's vague direction, that he must try to make it his own. Let us however, suposej this rule of Self-Imitation might serve for comonplace thot, on everyday ocasions. On the other hand, supose the art of reading to be employed .in representing the strictest truth and projiriety of dramatic character, or the most delicate picturing by the higher poetry. How, M-ith the great Crowd of mankind, will the rule of substitution meet this case ? I have more than once, seen among Aspirants of the Stage, the pitiable result of what was suposed to be a representa- tion of the Truth of Nature, by this afecting to become identical with their enacted Character, in asuming the thot of another as their own ; a representation of Nature, without a knowledge of her constitution and laws ; a constitution, coeval with the period of human progres into speech. All the Fine Arts are esentialy A^'ts'j each the ofspring of a fruitful aliance between Knowledge and intelectual facility : the high acomplishment of the Mork by the Artist, and the reflective enjoyment of its truth and beauty by the Votary, being purely the result of scrutinizing perception, extensive comparison, enlightened choice, and a harmonized use of the scatered facts and rules of propriety, unity, expresion, grandeur and grace. Many of the faults of speakers arise from their being taught by imitation alone. As long as there has l)een a history of the Stage, so long, Actors have been clased in the school of some Preceding, or Cotemporary master. But as there is always one, who by chance or by merit is the Leader of the ' lustrum j' and 626 FAULTS OF READERS. even five years is a long life for fashionable faraej it generaly hapens that his faults may for the time, be recognized among a crowd of pupils and imitators. From the want of some definite corective, the bad reading of a Pulpit sometimes infects a whole class of studentsj who circumscribe the active benefits of their master's solemn example by taking-up his sinful elocution. It may be saidj If we establish a system of principles, all readers must be of one school, and this will be equivalent to imi- tation. There would be one school ; a school of acknowledged and permanent precept, with a likenes in its excelence, not in its defects. Many actors who difer from each other in their faults, yet give ocasional short sentences with similar propriety, Avithout exciting a remark on that similarity; for propriety is here, the fitnes of truth. It is only upon some imitated outrage of uter- ance, that in a moment, the whispered name of a prototype is heard in twenty parts of a theater. Serious imitations of distinguished Actors and Speakers, like gay mimicries of them, are generaly made on peculiar pronunciation, monotony, unpleasant quality of voice, peculiar forms of melody, wdiining, false cadence, or no cadence at all, and precipitate and unaccountable transitions.* But, enough of unsatisfactory argument on this subject. The * Strange, indeed ! that such faults should be found among distinguished Actors and Speakers. But I write from observation ; having heard them all. The celebrated j who had a grating and untunable vocalitj', and whose elocution as I recolect it, was afected and monotonous, in a formal melody of wider intervals and waves, with an ocasional minor third in em- phatic placesj would, after some of the Older Poets, pronounce when nobody else did, the plural of ache (ach-es) as two sylables, to the unseasonable meri- ment of those wlio heard him. The use of the minor third however, was not peculiar to him, for it seems to be a vocal tradition, still kept up among the English. The Quakers, particularly their women, in public preaching, employ it to an extravagant degree ; and, from the incorigible character of all sectari- anism, probably had it in the time of Fox; whose folowers may have derived it thro the earlier Protestants, from some awkward imitation of chanting, in the Catholic-service. Bo this as it maj', it is not uncomon, in jirivate life, even with women of the higher classes, in England ; and very comon on the Stage. We often hear it in Actors as well as Actreses who come over to us. Wo had some years ago, one of the later, wliose intonation was almost a melody of minor thirds. As long as she lasted, it was thot very fine ; and was imitated by many American theatric Misses. Its afectation was so re- markable, that it was a subject of mimicry for every shop-girl witli a good car, who heard it. I FAULTS OF READERS. 527 art of Elocution has never yet, by system or rule, reached that consumation, which might be caled, the Canonical Beauty of Speech. The corupted instinct of individuals, has been for each, the universal guide ; and the best management of the voice has, under so poor a master, falen-short of an efective means for the highest oral excelence of an ordained Elocution : while the comon herd of pretenders aford both shocking and endles examples of deformity and eror. It is not the intention here, to speak of the constitutional de- formities of the voice. It is dificult however, to draw a line of distinction on this subject. Too many of the wilful vices of life, under self-delusion, pass for misfortunes : and it can scarcely be made a question, whether the impudent display of even natural fail- ings should not shut-out the subject from indulgent comiseration. Three points are of leading importance to a speaker : and if deficiencies therein are not to be caled misfortunes, we may rank them as great and generic faults. I mean the defects of the Mind, of the Ear, and of Industry. Speech is intended to be the sign of every variety of thot and pasion. If therefore the mind of a scholar be not raised to that generality of condition, which can asume all the characters of ex- presion, he will in vain aspire to great eminence in the art. If his mind is endued only with the diplomatic virtue of unrufled caution ; if it is of that character which compliments its own dulnes by caling energy, violencej and drawls-out in reprobation at the vivid language of truth ; if all its busy goings are jiLst around the little circle of its own selfish schemes ; if it has yet to know itself, as only a compound of thot, and pasion ; and to hear, without being convinced, that suces in every art is not more indebted to the plans of sagacious thot, than to the i)erseverance of thotful pasion ; if the mind, I repeat it, is of such a cast, its posesor may with the resources of elementary knowledge, and methodj atain a certain proficiency in the art, may save himself from its striking faults, and probably satisfy his own uncircum- spect perception ; but he can never reach the highest acomplish- ment in elocution. In speaking of the mental requisites for good reading, we must not overlook our frequent neglect to discriminate between a merely 528 FAULTS OF READERS. forcible, and a delicate state of mind. The latter makes the fall and finished Actor; and it is unfortunate for his art, that en- dowments, which under proper cultivation insure suces, are gen- eral}' united with a modesty that retires from the places and oca- sions for displaying its merits : the former in reaching no more than the coarse energy of the pasions, is able to figure on the Stage, only as the outrageous Herod, the brazen Beatrice, and the Buffoon. The mind, with its comprehensive and refined discriminations, must furnish the design of elocution ; the ear must watch over the lines and coloring of its expresion. The ability to measure nicely the time, force, and pitch of sounds, is indispensable to the higher excelencies of speech. It is imposible to say how much of the musical ear, properly so caled, is the result of cultivation. There is however a wide difer- ence even in the earliest aptitudes of this sense; and granting the means of improvement derived from analysis will hereafter greatly increase the proportional number of good readei-s, and produce something like an equality among themj still the pos- ession of a musical ear must, with other requisites, always give a superiority. I have more than once in this essay, urged the importance of Industry, the third general means for suces. Neglect on this point may be considered as an egregious fault in a speaker ; and it certainly is the most culpable. It is here placed on high ground, along with mental susceptibility and delicacy of ear, those esentials which have been designated by the indefinite term 'genius.' In vain will the mind furnish its finest perceptions, or the ear be ready with its measurements, if the tongue should not contribute its persevering industry. By a figure of speech that took a part for the whole of the senses, a hapy penalty upon mankind, as it was early writen, doomed the taste to be gratified by the sweat of the brow : the ear can receve its full delight in Elocution, only by the long labor of the voice. The faults of speakers are of endles variety: but if I have told the whole truth, they embrace no mode or form of voice, here un- named. It seems as if Nature had asumed, in her adjusted system of speech, all its available signs. The worldly tongue, with his FAULTS OF READERS. 529 corupting habit, in deforming this all-perfect endowment, makes no adition to its constituents, but performs his part in human eror, by misplacing them. In the present history of the faults of speech, we may therefore pursue something like the order, more than once, given to our subject. The five general heads, under which we considered the Modes of the voice, are Vocality, Time, Force, Abruptness, and Pitch. Of Faults in Vocality. This subject is so well known, both in the Art, and in comon criticism, that it is unecesary to be ])artic- ular upon it. Harshnes or rufnes is one of the disagreeable forms of the voice. The nasal is still more ofensive. Shrilnes may rather be called a Vocality than a state of Pitch. It wants dig- nity, seems like a mockery of the voice, and while heard remotely, and drawing atention, it is with the atraction of a caricature. The huskines of aspiration is more apt to be united Avith the orotund. It may not diminish the gravity and sober grandeur of this voice, but it obscures the clearnes of its vocality. The falsete is sometimes used in the curent of speech. We hear persons on the stage, in the senate, the fervent pulpit, and on the scafold of the demao-ogue, who ofend with the falsete onlv oca- sionaly, by the melody, breaking from the natural voice, on a single sy.lable. Every speaker has a falsete ; and the skilful can always guard against its improper use. As a fault, it results either from the limited compas of the natural voice, or from a de- fect of ear in the speaker ; for not having an acurate perception of his aproach to it, he is unable to avoid the evil, by a ready descent of intonation. The falsete is common in the voices of women. It has with them a plaintive character ; and the melody at this high pitch is apt to be monotonous. Of Faults in Time. It is not meant to treat here, of what is caled reading too fast or too slow. There is nothing new to be said on this point. But we who speak English are said, by the report of the compilers of Greek and of Latin gramars, to know nothing of Quantity, and to have none in our language. That bad readers, and persons who will not learn their own tongue may know nothing of its quantity, is readily granted ; still, that it is an esential part of every language, and the neglect of it, a source of 530 FAULTS OF READERS. many faults in ours, must be admitted by those who know the efect of sylabic time, and the proper use of the voice. Quantity, as a fault, may be too long or too short. When states of mind requiring short time, sucli as gayety and anger, are expresed by long quantity, it produces the vice of Drawling. The excessive quantity of this drawling may be either on a wave of the second, or an equal or unequal wave of wider intervals, or on the note of Song. When deliberate or solemn discourse is huried over in a short sylabic quantity, the fault is no less apparent and ofensive. This defect in reading is by far the most comon; and it has been said, more than once, in this esay, because it is well to rouze the Eng- lish ear to this subject, that the comand over time in the pure and equable concrete of speech, is found only in speakers of fervent temperament and long experience. Such persons instinctively acquire the use of extended quantity : as on long sylables, most of their earnest expression is efected. It is from ignorance of this fact, that some speakers, neglecting the variety and smoothnes of the temporal emj^hasis, give prominence to important words only by the hamering of acent. Of Faults in Force. The misaplication of the degrees of the piano and the forte, in the general curent of discourse is sufieiently obvious. But the forms of stres, on diferent parts of the concrete, have never been observed, and consequently, have never been noted as a fault. Many speakers, from a dificulty in comanding variations of quantity, execute most of their emphasis in the form of force ; yet even in this aparently simple efort, they are not free from faults. Some persons, after the maner of the Irish, employ the vanishing stress on all emphatic sylables. This has its meaning in cxprcsion, but it is misplaced, except on the ocasions ft)rmerly pointed out. A want of the sharp and abrupt character of the radical is not an uncomon fault. It ocurs generaly in the dull and indolent : for nothing shows so clearly an elastic? temper in the voice, as the ability to sudenly exi)lode this initial stres. On the other hand it is a more frequent fault, to over-strcs the acented sylable, by that hamering of the voice, which destroys the dignity of deliberate intonation. This ovcr-stres does most violence to the solenni ex- FAULTS OF READERS. 531 presion, apropriate to many parts of the Church-service : for here the waves of the second, on indefinite quantities, whether acented or not j including by license, even a slight extension of the shortest sylablesj should with cautious management, and not unlike the ' leaning note' of song, be caried by a blending quantity from con- crete to concrete, in a reverentive drift of deliberate dignity ; the necesary emphasis being made by a comparative exces of quantity, with the impresive and graceful gliding of the median stres. It is not my intention to notice the faults of emphatic stres, in the comon meaning of the term. They all resolve into a want of true aprehension on the part of the reader. In ignorance of other constituents of an enlarged and definite elocution, which our pres- ent inquiry has taught us to apreciate and to recomend, this well known subject of stres-laying emphasis, has always been considered of the first importance in the art ; and unfortunately in the school of imitation, it has under the critical term Reading, restrictively asumed, at least a nominal superiority over the other modes of speech. 'How admirably she reads,' said an idle critic, of an actres, who, with perhaps a pro})er emphasis of Force, was de- forming her uterance, by every fault of Time and Intonation. The critic was one of those who having neither knowledge nor docility, deserved neither argument nor corection. Emphasis of stres, being almost the only branch of elocution in which there is an aproach towards a practical rule, this single function, under an ignorance of other modes of emphatic distinction, has, by a figure of speech grounded on its real importance, been asumed in the limited nomenclature of criticism, as almost the sole esential of the art. Even Mr. Kemble, whose eulogy should have been founded on whatever- other merits he may have posesed, made, if we have not been misinformed, the first stir of his fame, by a new ' reading,' or a new discriminative stres, in a particular scene of Haridet. Under this view, it would folow, that he who ])roperly aplies the emphasis of force, in the Art of Reading, acomplishes all its purpose ; he reads, or he acentuates well. We have awarded to the emphasis of force its due, but not its undue degree of consequence ; and it may be hereafter admited, that much of the contention about certain unimportant points of this stres-laying emphasis, and of pause, has arisen from critics 532 FAULTS OF READERS. finding very little else of the vast compas of speech, on Avhich they were able to form for themselves a determinate opinion. When, under a scientific institute of elocution, there Mall be more im- portant maters to study, and delight in, it may perhaps be foundj much of this trifling lore of italic notation, now seryiug to keep up comonplace contention in a daily gazette, will be quite over- looked, in the high court of philosophic criticism.* We do not speak of the faults of pronunciation, depending on * Some one, of those who like to make busines in an art, rather than to do it, has raised a question whether the folowing lines from Macbeth, should be read with an acent and a pause at baners or at walls : Mac. Hang out our baners on the outward walls The cry is still, They come. To those whose elocution consists in such ridles, we propose the folowing, from Goldsmith : A man he was, to all the country dear. And pasing rich with forty pounds a year. Let them gues variously, or sharply dispute, upon the question of aplying an emphasis on pasing, or on rich ; thereby to determine either that the good Village Parson w&s pasing or superlatively rich, with his forty pounds ; or that he pascd among his parishioners, as only very well-off in the world. I some time ago noticed the folowing punctuation, in one of those wandering Actors known as Stars. I'll call thee Hamlet, King, Father ; Koyal Dane O answer me. Perhaps, after writing the words King and Father, the Poet's choiceful ear was deluded into the repetition Royal Dane, by the fine variety of elemental sound, and rythmic acent and quantity in the Title. The ambitious reading of the Star was worse than careles, without an apologyj by imploring em- phaticaly of the Royal Dane what he would not of Hamlet, King, and Father. 1 heard another eratic Star of critical ilumination, read thus : How fares our Cousin Hamlet ? Ham. Excelent, i' faith, of the chamelion's dish I eat; the air promise- cram ed. Leaving it to a brighter star-light to show, whether Hamlet, or the air was inconsiderately cranied. Many persons who might be profitably hired to Square Timber, make-show of doing something, by idly whitling sticks. FAULTS OF READERS. 533 misplaced verbal or gramatical acents. Propriety in this mater is set- forth in the dictionary, and the erors of speech may be meas- ured by its conventional rules. Xor is it within the purpose of this esay to notice faults in the pronunciation of the alj)hal)etic ele- ments. Criticism should be modest on this pointj till it has the mental independence to give to the literal symbols of those ele- ments, and to their redundant, and defective uses, more of the char- acter of a work of wisdom, than they have ever receved in any writen language ; till the pardonable variety of pronunciation, and the ear-directed speling by the vulgar, have satirized into reforma- tion, that scholastic pencraft which keeps up the dificulties of 6r- thography, with no other purpose, it would seem, than to pride itself in the use of a troublesome and awkward system, as a crite- rion of education^ and with the tyranny of habit, to opose every promising atempt to corect it. Of Faults in Pitch. Speech has been especialy, one of those many subjects, in which we often pronounce upon the right and the wrong, without being able to say why they are so. If we have resolved the obscurity in respect to the proprieties of intona- tion; it will not be dificult on similar principles, to give some explanation of its faults. Of Faults in the Concrete Movement. I have more than once spoken of that peculiar characteristic of speech, the full opening, the gradual decrease, and the delicate termination of the concrete. As this structure is destroyed by the use both of the vanishing, and the thoro stres, the misaplication of either must be regarded as a fault. The vanishing stres, exemplified by the upward jerk in some of the Irish people, produces a peculiar monotony, when continued in discourse; and the thoro, if not used for especial emphasis, or designed incivility, is a striking and a vulgar fault. Every one must be familiar with what is caled a coarse and un- manerly tone. This, as regards the structure of the concrete, was formerly shown to be the efect of the last named stress. Some readers seem incapable of giving the equable concrete on a long quantity ; substituting in place of it, the note of song. The most remarkable instance of this speech-singing, is that of the public preaching of the Friends, to be particularly described among the faults in melody. 534 FAULTS OF READERS. Oj Faults in the Semitone. Who has not heard of whining? It is the misplaced use of the semitone. The semitone is the vocal sign of tendernes, petition, complaint, and doubtful suplica- tion : but never of manly confidence, and the authoritative self- reliance of truth. It is this which betrays the sycophant, and even the crafty hypocrite himself. They asume a plaintive per- suasion, or a tuneful cant, not merely to implyj they are prompted by a kindly and afectionate state of mind, but sometimes because they distrust or despise themselves, and are therefore influenced by the mental state of servility. Suspicion should therefore be awake, when the show of truth or benevolence is proifered under the cringing whine of this expresive interval ; and in general, when- ever the semitone is used for a state of mind that does not call for it. A beggar should, by the instinct of his voice, plaintively implore ; and it is equaly a law of nature, which abhors hypocrisy no less than a vacuum, that he should give the truth of his narative in a more confident intonation. The chromatic melody is comon among women. Actreses are prone to this fault ; and it is one of the causes which frequently prevent their asuming the matron-role of tragedy, and the dignified severity of epic, and dramatic elocution. AVomen sometimes in- tercede, threaten, complain, smile, and call the footman, all in the minor third or the semitone. They can vow, and love, and burst into agony in Belvidera ; but rarely by masculine personation and diatonic energy, 'chastise with the (orotund) valor of their tongue,' and gravely order the scheme of murder in Lady INIacbeth. We have described the states of mind signified by the semitone. Whenever it suplants the proper diatonic melody, it becomes a fault, and begins to be monotonous ; for when apropriate it never is so. I once heard the part of Dr. Cantwell, in the Hj/pocrite, played in the chromatic melody. Perhaps it suited the pretensions of the pious vilain, but it certainly was a paling monotony to the ear ; and the want of transition, when he threw off the mask, in adressing his patron's wife, was remarkable, lie was the righteous knave and the pasionate lover, all in the same intonation. The efect would have been more a]ii)roj)riate and agreeable, if an abated, slow, and monotonous drift of the second had prevailetlj with the use of the chromatic melody, when required by the pasion. FAULTS OF READERS. 535 Of Faults in the Second. The car lias its green as avcII as the eye ; and tlic plain interval of the second in curent and elegant speech, like the verdure of the earth, is wisely designed, to releve its respective sense from the fatiguing stimulus of undue, and more vivid impresions. The diatonic melody, in a well composed elo- cution, is simple and unobtrusive, and thereby afords a ground-hue for bringing-out the contrasted color of expresive intervals ; yet it does, when continued into the place of this wider intonation, asume a positive character, under the form of a fault. A striking instance of misaplication of the second, is its em- ployment for that state of mind which properly requires the semi- tone. I formerly spoke of its false expresion, ocasionaly heard in the public cry of Fire. Some persons are of such a frigid tem- perament, or have such inflexible organs, even when a degree of warmth does not seem to be wanting, as to apear incapable under ordinary motives, of executing the chromatic melody. Pain, or a selfish instinct may force it on the voice; yet, in them, it is so slightly conected with tendernes, or so little under comand, that the most pathetic pasages are given in the comparatively phleg- matic intonation of the diatonic melody. We sometimes see an Actor of this unchanging drift of temper, cast, on the emergencies of a night, to the part of a lover : and may ocasionaly hear from the pulpit, fervent apeals of the Litany, and humble petitions of extemporary prayer, under an intonation, more apropriate to the task of repeating the multiplication table. Some speakers make an over-use of the second ; for even this plain and inexpresive interval when misj^laced, so defeats the pur- ])Oses of speech that we are sometimes more indebted to gramatical construction, than to the voice, for a perception of their interoga- tives. It is the same too with their emphasis, in those conditional and positive sentences which, for impresive and varied efect, re- spectively require the rising, and the faling interval of the third, or fifth, or octave. The most important function of the second, consists in the succsions of the diatonic melody. The character of these suces- ions, as we learned in the eighth section, is produced by a varied composition of the seven phrases. "We have now to learn how far the comon practice of readers, deviates from the described. 536 FAULTS OF EEADERS. but perhaps as yet only described, perfection of a pure diatonic melody. Oj Faults in the Melody of Speech. If the rule laid down in this esay for constructing an agreeable sucesion of diatonic phrases, is founded in propriety and taste, I must declare, I have never yet heard its conditions strictly fulfiled, in a well aranged, and satis- factory melody. Players spend their time before mirors, till grace of person is studied into manerism, and expresion of feature dis- torted into grimace. Emphasis of stres too, is teazed with experi- ment, on every word of a sentence, and tested in authority, by all the traditions of the Green-Room : but who has ever thot of any asignable rules for the sucesions of sylabic pitch in a curent melody, or suposed therein, the existence of describable faults ! The First fault to be noticed, is the continued use of the mono- tone, on the same line of radical pitch ; the vanish of the second or of wider intervals, being properly performed. I do not here mean the drawl of the parish-clerk, nor the monotony of the reading-clerk of most public assemblies; for these are sometimes the note of song, and wdll be spoken-of presently. The unvaried line of radical pitch, now under consideration, is not so glaring as this old conventicle-tune, nor has it at all the character of song. If the Reader were near me, I would ilustrate the peculiarity of this fault ; and I can only describe it, as preventing the agreeable efect, arising from the contrast of pitch ; the transition in the case of a continued monotone, with a rising concrete, being from a feeble vanish to a fuller radical, only one tone below the sum- mit of that vanish ; in the faling-ditone sucesion of a varied melody, the distance is two tones below the sumit of the preceding vanish. One of the causes of this fixult in public speakers, deserves to be noticed here. I spoke of vociferation as a means for imparting vigor and fulnes to the voice ; but this exercise being usualy on a higlier curent, tends to prevent a pro})cr variation of the melody of speech. Speakers who adress large asemblies, and who Iiave not that clear vocality and distinct articulation which would insure the recpiired reach of voice, generally atcmpt to remedy the dofoct, by rising to iha utmost limit of the natural compas, and continu- ing their current just below the falsete. For fear of breaking FAULTS OF READERS. 537 into this, tlicy avoid the rising- phi'coses of melody ; while the pur- pose to be distantly heard in an elevated pitch, prevents tlieir descending by radical change. They consequently continue on one monotonous line near the falsete, and vitiate their taste by the partial pleas of their own example ; restrain tlieir melodial flexi- bility ; and blunt their perception of the variety of movement in a more reduced curent of pitch.* Second. ]Melody is deformed by a predominance of the phrase of the monotone, together with a full cadence at every pause. This i)erhaps is only found in the first atempts at reading by children and rustics. Third. By a proper use of the phrases of melody within a limited extent, but with a formal return of the same sucesions. In this case, the whole discourse is subdivided into sections, re- sembling each other in the order of pitch; the sections consisting of entire sentences, or of their members. This habit of the voice and ear, in dividing the melody into sections, as well as in forming acentual and pausal divisions, seems to be conected with one of the characters of style : for there is a tendency in some persons to give a like construction, and often an equal length to their sentences. All Actors, except those of the first class, and they are not as finished on this point as they may be hereafterj are prone to this bird-like kind of intonation. They have a short run of melody, which if not forcibly interupted by some peculiar expression, is constantly recurring. The return forms a kind of melodial meas- ure : and I now call to mind an Actres of great repute, whose intonation was filled with emphasis of thirds, fifths, octaves, and waves ; and whose sections of melody could be anticipated, with something like the forerunning of the mind over the rythmus of a coraon stanza of alternate versification. Those who com it this fault, will have no dificulty in recognizing and corecting it, * This cause operates on the enthusiasts of the Pulpit; on many of the speakers, and always on the clerk of the Lowe?- House of the American Con- gress ; where the scrambling cries to be first heard, with the uproar of titular Honorables, overrule the gentlemanly rights, and duties of the voice ; but it is most remarkable in the mouth of the stump and scaffold Demagogue, whose own political designs lead him to address great crowds in the open air. 35 538 FAULTS OF EEADERS. if desirable, when the mirror of full and exact description is held before them. The monotonous efect of a repetition of these similar melodial sections, constitutes one of the signs by which the smart apren- tices of the Pit, and some of their beter-dresed peers in the Boxes, distmguish the voices of famous Actors, and think they represent their real points of excelence, when they mimic only the manerism of their faults. This recuring section of a similar melody may in itself, consist of a proper sucesion of phrases : but being unvaried, you hear it too often and remember it too well. The whole curent in this case, figuratively resembles the old Roman Festoon, which however well adapted to an insulated tablet, was in abasement of Greek architectural taste, joined in monotonous repetition around the frieze ; instead of representing, as a just melody might, that succession of sculpture, which in severe simplicity and expresive design adorned the varied metopes of the Parthenon. Fourth. I have known more than one speaker with this fiiult. Sentences are begun aloud on a high, and ended alrhost inaudibly on a low degree of pitch ; and so continued during a whole dis- course ; producing a monotony, similar in efect, to that last de- scribed. It would be dificult to find out the meaning of this fault, or to discover such a shadow of apology for it, as many worse ofenses in life might claim for themselves. One speaker whom I knew, with this striking afectatiouj for no instinctive, nor conven- tional motive could ever have directed itj was, first by himself it is presumed, and then by the asociates of his long since departed day of popularity, called ' a fine reader.' Such instances of fame may serve to convince us, that with all our blind conceitsj and who among us is without them j there is no art, except that of Thinhing, in which self-imposition is more conspicuous tlian in Elocution. Without an acknowledged rule of excelence, every individual, cultivated or not, makes his own individual taste the standard. Having learned that it is the part of a good reader to represent the thot and pasion of discourse, and as each in his atempt, fulfils his oion conception of an author, he is self-persuaded, that he ])os- eses the full power of the art. This is one cause why Ave find so much delusion on this subject. For, reputed ' good readers ' are FAULTS OF READERS. 539 often not merely negatively deficient; they are often positively bad : and perverse as it may seem, to the overbearing aplauses of a majority, I have frequently gone to observe the faults of speak- ers, when caled to hear some ' star ' of elocution, even when that star was himself a Teacher of the Art. Loud whoops and yells have always been 'the vocal delight of savages ; and noise of every kind is the pastime substitute for reflection in ignorant civiliza- tion : so an exagerated and consequently striking character of the constituents of speech, is always most agreeable to the uninstructed ear. Fifth. The manner of changing the pitch from one degree to another, above or below it, in the diatonic melody, was shown in the eighth section. An inability to comand the radical change, not only prevents variety of intonation, but embarases a reader in pasing from a very high or very low pitch, when he has improp- erly set out in either. Speakers sometimes descend so for, as to leave no voice below the line of curent melody, to alow an audible execution of the last constituent of the cadence. In this case, they perceve the feeble and unsatisfactory efect of their intonation, without knowing the cause of it, and being able to aply the remedy. By the rules of a proper melodial progresion, and of the maner in which the cadence descends, the fault here pointed out may be avoided. AVe noticed formerly, that a reader, with a good ear, has a sort of ^recursive perception of the falsete, which enables him to turn from it, when his melody is moving near the sumit of his natural voice. A similar anticipation of the lowest note, warns him to keep his cadence within the limit of distinct articulation. Sixth. The use of the protracted radical, or protracted vanish, instead of the equable concrete, is one of the widest deviations from the characteristic of speech. For,' a proper diatonic melody consists of an equable movement on the interval of a second, with an agreeably varied radical change thru the same space ; the curent being ocasionaly broken by wider equable intervals, and by difer- ent forms of stres, as the subject may require these aditions upon individual words. Inasmuch as this fault includes that of long quantity, it is not often heard in the hasty uterances of comon life. I have however. 540 FAULTS OF READERS. met with a slight degree of it in a phlegmatic clrawler. Public speakers overwrot by excitement, and straining their throats to be heardj I say, straining their throats, instead of energizing their voices, are most liable to this eror of intonation. Some cases of this fault are conected with a monotonous curent melody, and a very defective management of the cadence. I heard it under the form of the protracted radical, along with other heinous ofenses against good elocution, in one of the public's 'great Actors.' It w^as most remarkable in his endeavor to give long quantity to short sylables ; as in the folowing words of Macbeth : Canst thou not m — inister to a m — ind diseasedj PI — uck from the m — emory. I have here set a dash after the leters on which he continued the protracted radical, until it sudenly vanished in the termination of the sylable. The Actor's fault was the ering exercise of a vocal instinct. He perceved obscurely, the need of long quantity for the purpose of exj^resion ; but being one of those, who having some animal excitability, no education, little intelect, and an inverse pro- portion of vanity j are always looking upon themselves as the center of aplausej it did not ocur to him, that the prolongation of a mutable sylable, might be deformed by an undue quantity ; and that a subtonic at the begining of a sylable, makes no part of the equable concrete ; two points of knowledge that would long ago have been prepared for his ear and tonguej if there had been in the Histrionic art, more observation, and reflectionj with less re- liance on the dream of ' Identity,' and the fatal delusion of 'Inborn Genius.' Seventh. The fault of melody wc are now about to consider, is somewhat related to the last described misuse of the protracted notes. It includes some other forms of intonation, proper to song : the whole being confused in such a manner with the equable concrete, as to destroy every design of speech, and to furnish, even beyond Ilccitiitive, the ultra example of vociil deformity. In the history of man, nothing is more indefinite than descrip- tions of the voice : still there is ground to belevej this extravagant melody is the same as the Puritanical whine, afected so generaly in religious worship by the English Church, above two hundred FAULTS OF READERS. 541 years ago, and which has been changed to other faults scarcely less censurable, in the pulpit of the present day. The Society of Friends alone have retained it as a general practice : and it will not be regarded as either idle or invidious, to look into the structure of this most remarkable intonation, by the light of our preceding analysis. I first give the notation of this melody, and will afterwards particularly explain it. I heard a voice from heav'n saying, write, ^^4^-Al^^ ^ ^f5 ^. ^- bless — ed are the dead who die in the Lord. jiR-~^^^-^-^nes and mo- notony; and I am sure the Reader will be siificiently guarded against this fault, by keeping in mind the ample resources of the voice, for a varied emphasis. FAULTS OF READERS. 547 Those who misplace the third, and fifth, are apt to cary them into the cadence. Such readei-s end many of their plain declara- tive sentences with the characteristic of a question. I might point out, a similar eror of place in the octave ; yet it is of rare ocurence, and only heard in the piercing treble of women. Some persons cannot put a question in the subdued and dignified form of the third or fifth, but always give it in the sharpness of the octave. Of Faults in the Dowmoard Movement. Faults of the down- ward concrete, consist in not giving the emphasis of its intervals in their just extent; in not aplying them properly or at all, to exclamatory sentences, and to certain gramatical questions that require a downward intonation. An improper use of these inter- vals is sometimes characteristic of a morose and saturnine temper, in persons who having no grace within themselves, have no voice of complaisance for others. Of Faults in the Discrete Movement. Of defects in the man- agement of the radical change of the second, in the diatonic melody, we have already spoken. Precipitate falls of the third, fifth, and octave, sometimes ocur in the cadence of children and others, while learning to read. Some again are unable to make those upward and downward radical chang&s, by which acom- plished readers may hereafter acurately efect all the discrete transitions required for emphasis. Of Faults in the Wave. The wave of the second, both in its direct and inverted form, is plain and dignified in character, and therefore admisible into the diatonic melody as a drift. It is not so with the waves of wider intervals. They have their proper ocasions as solitary emphasis ; whereas the continued repetition of them becomes a disgusting fault. The wave, comonly afected by a certain puling class of readers, is the inverted-unequalj the voice descending on the second, and rising on the third, or fifth. This fault is most remarkable in reading metrical composition ; arising perhaps from our familiarity with the union of song and versej and from a conection of the art of reading, with the imi)re.ssive intervals of its tune. Persons who 'read in this way, give a set melody to their lines ; certain parts of each line, as far as the em- phatic words permit, having a prominent intonation of the wave. I 548 FAULTS OF READERS. Much of every form of tlie wave prevails in convei'sation ; and the general character of daih' dialogue often makes it apropriate there. I have heard the coloquial twirl, even exagerated by an Actres of great temporary reputation. H^r style consisted of a continual recurence of identical sections of melody, composed prin- cipally of the wider forms of the equal and unequal wave ; show- ing a vocal pertness, and a sort of vivid familiarity^ but wanting the briliant projDriety of execution, due from a performer of Higher Comedy to the Author. Some actors, and readers are prone to the use of the double wave. They make it the vocal twirl for every state of mind, thereby denoting their want of a varied and just intonation. It is an impresive agent, and is therefore, with an eroneous notion both of its purpose and place, often introduced to give prominent effect to melody. It has restrictively, its proper ocasions ; and let it be rememberedj there is a sneering petulance in its character, totaly inconsistent with dignity. Nothing is beter calculated to show the propriety of the plain ground of the diatonic melody, than the repeated use of the wider waves. It includes the faults in the third, and fifth, and conse- quently gives a florid and monotonous character to speech. When such striking intonation is set on every important sylablej how shall we mark emphatic words, except by an excess in vocality, time, or force ?* * The distinction, so often refered to in this esay, between the diatonic ground-work of melody, and the ocasional cxpresion of wider intervals judi- ciously employed upon it, is a great escntial of efective and elegant elocution. According to our system, this diference was an ordination, to meet the re- spective demands of th6t and pasion. Without regard to it, no one can ever succede in tragedy, or in other dignified uses of speech ; the diatonic melody alone, having the character apropriate to awe, solemnity, reverence, and grave deliberation. And altho the Art of Speech, almost stone-deaf to the causa- tive agency, not to the cfects of intonation, has never yet been aware of this diference; still the purposes of truth and boauty in the voice, have herein never been without a witnes. For he who advocates the principles of this Work, may, by now finding ocasional instances of the use of the diatonic melody, admit, that being founded on tlie thdtive state of the mind, it must have been heard in every age of cultivated speech. Its rarity in the voices of women, is one cause why so few among them, are able to rise to the tragic dignity of the stage ; notwithstanding a pretty face, and other prety atractions, may for a time servo them well enuf, yet not over-well, in Comedy without it. FAULTS OF READERS. 549 Oj Faults in Drift. The purposes both of truth and variety, in the art of Reading- Well, are efected by a delicate regard to the corespondence between the states of mind, and their vocal Tliey have so acustomed an undiscerning audience, and so habituated them- selves, to a puling affectation, which consists in a curent melody of the wider intervals and waves, the semitone, ;and minor third; and are so ignorant or careles of their vocal duty, they do not perceve, and therefore will not be told, this is one among other causes of their frequent failure. For as the obscurity of histrionic description and criticism alows the inference, it is not improbable that Mrs. Siddons, in the early part of her career, may, to an impresive de- greej while ignorant of its construction, and its rulesj have instinctively em- ployed the diatonic melody. An incident related by her biographer, Boaden, will perhaps, if elucidated by our analysis, lead to this conclusion. On her first interview with Garrick, Mrs. Siddons, then Miss Kemble, 're- peated some of the speeches of Jane Shore before him. Garrick seemed highly pleased with her uterance, and her deportment ; ' and ' wondered how she had got rid of the Old So)ig, and the provincial Ti-tum-ti.' All former criticism on intonation being, we may say uninteligible, we are left to discover, by the light of our analj-sis, what these terms. Old Song, and Ti-tum-ti, mean. As the construction and the plain yet peculiar efect of the diatonic melody of speech, are widely diferent from the construction and the more vivid character of song ; and as a too frequent and improper use of the wave, the wider concrete and discrete intervals, the semitone and minor third, ■with their impresive intonations, when employed in speech, tho far from being song, do yet more nearly resemble it than the diatonic melody does;, and further, as the term and notion of the trisylabic foot Tir-ttim-ti, seems to be a rythmical perception of the ear, produced by a sort of regular return of florid and misapplied intervals, described in the text, under the present head of faults of the wavej I cannot avoid thinking that Mrs. Siddons did, at this early periodj as I personal}' remember she did in after-lifej either in part if not altogether, instinctively execute the just diatonic melody: and that Garrickj aware of its peculiar character, yet as ignorant of its analysis as his Call-boyj had no other means for describing his perception of its dignity than that of giving to a contrasted and strongly ofensive style of uterance, the names of Ti-tum-ti, and Song. Nor can I avoid beleving, that Garrick, who could thus perceve the peculiar character of the plain or diatonic melody in others, must himself, without being aware of its structure and principles, have employed a well-marked expresion of wider intervals, on the simple ground of a dia- tonic intonation; tho never with its finished propriety and grace, under his then limited and imperfect knowledge of the resources of the Art. Looking then to the two eminent instances now before us, I would be loth to regard them under that condition, which Guido so satiricaly asigned to singers, unenlightened by Science; but which may with truth be asigned, not unkindly, to many a Roscius, even with all his so-called 'profound' and un- wearied study and practice in his artj ' Nam qui facit quod non sapit, delinitur 550 FAULTS OF EEADEES. signs, in individual words; and to the Drift, or continuation of a given state of mind, and form of voice, on one or more sen- tences ; whereas a neglect of this adjustment will, acording to its degree, weaken the impresion of speech, or shock the ear and taste of an auditor. Some readers continue the same vocal drift under every change of thot and pasion ; others vary the character of the uterance, without adapting it strictly to these changes. We have learnedj the most complete close of a paragraph or chapter, is made by the prepared cadence ; and that certain vocal means, and changes in the jjlirases of melody, formerly described, may be employed to prepare an audience for the hegining of a new subject, and to indicate the full consummation of the previous sectional or paragraphic pause. The neglect of a speaker on this point, may be considered a fault in partial Drift. As the reverse of this fault, we have the unexpected transitions from one style of uterance to another, without a coresponding change of subject. I once heard an actor set the whole House into a hum of meriment, by making that answer of Jaffier to the conspiratorsj Nay by Heaven I'll do this, in the curling quaintnes of the Avave. The character of Jaffier, the bestia.' 'For he who acts without a plan, Kesembles more the brute than man.' It may perhaps be askedj how I could well discriminate the diatonic melody, at the time I was ignorant of its constituents and construction. I did not at that date know it by analysis, as it may now be known ; yet its peculiar character and dignity, in the personations of Mrs. Siddons,so caught my ear, that after more than half a centurj', the efect of what I then heard, is still a subject of my memory. And now that the Baconian system has, in its own words, warned us, not to raise" experiments soley xtpon experiments, nor works soley iipon works ; but upon the ^for-ms ' or goicral principles of works, to lay-down a broad foundation for progresive experiments; and by further showing the proper use of the senses, it has taught, and enabled me to unfold some of the principles of speech ; I find the efect on my memory, of the in- tonation of this remarkable Actress, is altogetiicr similar to that of the now known, and named Diatonic Melody. This is by no means, an after-thdt of conceit ; for by a like remembrance, of an Interlude of Dancingj which folowed her evening apearance in Voltim- nia, or in Lady Macbeth, at Covont-Gardenj I still retain at conuvnd, the just time and intoiuition of a simple Gavot-Meludy, tlio licard only there, and only once. FAULTS OF EEADEES. 551 solemnity of the ocasion, and tlie purpose of liis entrance among the conspirators, are all at variance with the levity, conveyed by this sneering intonation. Severity of resolution is the ruling state of mind in Jaffier ; and this calls for the energy of stres, together with the positivenes of a downward emphatic interval. And it seems to have been a perception of the ludicrous, from a contrast between the seriousnes of the Character, and the pertness of the player, that caused the meriment : for the case, when duly con- sidered, produces an impresion of the instinctive propriety and taste of the Audience, and of the absence of both in the Player. They, unaware of the principle, laughed at what was laughable. He, in the conceit of ' genius, ' could not be serious at what was grave ; and perhaps satisfied himselfj their laughter at the ridicu- lous, was to him, a complacent tribute of aplause. I have tried in vain to find a term for the extraordinary transi- tions, sometimes heard on the Stage. They belong to the head of the faults of Drift : but we must speak of them as vocal pranks, without a name. I mean to designate, those abrujjt changes from high to lowj from a roar to a whisperj from quick to slowj harsh to gentlej from the diatonic melody to the chromaticj from the gravity of long quantity, to the levity of sneer, to the quick stress of anger and mirth, or to the ra])id muterings of a madman. AVe had here, some years ago, a celebrated foreign Player from whom I draw this picture ; yet for impressive ilustration, perhaps slightly caricatured. His imitators, who have already disapeared, caled themselves the school of ; a blank noNv to be well filed up, as the school of Ignorance and Outrage, with benches crowded by vociferating, I had nearly said 'Roivdy/ admirers. A system of elocution may be defended, on either of two diferent grounds. The one, that it is a copy from nature : the other, that it does artificialy best answer the ends of speech. No apology for such flagitious transitions can be derived from either of these sources. I have seen persons under the highest excitement of natural not theatric pasion, and changing from one degree and kind to another; but I have never heard any thing even distantly like the harlequin- transformations of voice, above alluded to, as aplauded on the Stagej excei)t in a paroxysm of womanish hysteria. On the otlier hand, suposing the practice to be founded on an artificial systemj 552 FAULTS OF EEADERS. we would make no objection, provided it could acomplLsh by con- ventional agreement, all the expresive purposes of speech. But what plea can that system urge, which perverts all the beauty and frugality of rule ; which destroys, by its anomaly and abruptnes, all the pleasures of habit, and anticipation; and takes from the fine arts, a delight in the boundles images, arising from the busy exercise of well-established knowledge. Where this fault of exageration does not arise from blundering ignorance, or from slavish imitation, it is purposely asumed with the view to produce what the small vocabulary of dramatic criti- cism, calls 'Effect.' The Actor being deficient in the means of that truth and variety of expresion, which only a knowledge of the resources of the voice, not the practice of the Stage, can aford, tries to help-out his uninstructed 'Genius' by breaking the even tenor of an apropriate Drift, with some ear-starting stimulus or some unexpected colapse. We should however, do some Actors the justice to beleve, that with a jDroper estimate both of nature and art, they must secretly disaprove of such things. Yet how shall we absolve them from the charge of submittino; to what they nuist know to be only a blind conformity to the capricious fashion of aplause ; and of being 'wiling to deceve the people because they will be deceved?' the easy art and resource of weaknes, with cunning ; and the wretched apology of ambition and knavery. It is the part of elevated in- telect to undeceve the world, even by unwelcome truth ; to make all men at last bow down ; and to be the master of demonstration, instead of the slave of popular conceit. Faults in the Grouping of Speech. The Intonation at Pauses denotes the degrees of eonedion between the suceding sections of discourse j and between related words, within the limit of each. Grouping is variously intended to keep these sections in a measure, independent of each other; to unite tiie train of thot Avithin these sections, when broken by expletives, or by gramatical inversion ; and to bring together on the ear, separated words, even from (lif- erent sections. In this way the Temporal rest makes a distinct group of a section l)y dividing it from others. The I^hrases of melodyj by the monotone, the rising ditone, and tritone ; conect gramatical concords, when separated by intervening constructions. FAULTS OF READERS. 553 The Abatement groups as it were, within brackets of the voice and keeps together, what is heard under a reduced, or piano form of force. The Flight limits to itself, the meaning of what is em- braced in a huried uterance. The Emphatic-tie and the Punctua- tive-reference respectively, by stres and pause, group within the field of hearing, words and phrases, separated in construction, from each other. Faults in grouping arise from not aplying these several forms as their purposes require ; and ignorance of their design, and apro- priate use, cannot fail to mar the perspicuity of oral discourse. He who has a full knowledge of the means and eficacy of group- ing, will, on this subject, be able with just principles, to criticise and corect the faults of others. Fault of 3Iimicry. In a previous page of this section, it was remarked, that imitations of speech, either serious, or for mirth, are geueraly copies of its faults. I am here to speak of the efect of Mimicry in corupting the principles and practice of vocal expresion. Under the prevalent creed of the Old elocution, this purpose may need explanation. The creed is, that all who speak with a perception of the thot and pasion of their subject, speak with pro- priety. Nearly all persons both read and speak so diferently from each other, that we plainly distinguish the intonations, joined with the other modes of the voice, in each individual. It is intonation, with other modes, which constitutes the expresion of speech : and we must alow that individuals universaly uter their own thots and pasions. This creed then caries with it the conclusion, that speech is not directed by a universal system of corespondence between the state of mind and the vocal signj but that each individual must have for his states of mind, a peculiar system of signs, pro- ducing that distinguishable diference from all others, which we perceve in both his reading and his speaking voice. It would therefore folow, from the pretensions of this creed, that mimicry, by amusing itself with the peculiarities of all, so far from being injurious to the powers of speech, must on the contrary, tend to suport and improve them. For, by this belief, all being suposed to speak their respective states of mind corectly, while all speak diferently, the mimic, who can asume the proprieties of each, must 36 554 FAULTS OF READERS. poses the faculty of acquiring the excelencies of all. It is well known, that the efects of mimicry depend on contrastj and the contrast in this case, must be made, with some standard in the human voice. By the condition however, or consequence of the creed, the standard of each individual is his own individuality ; and thus the standard is destroyed by its endles variations. Mimicry then, being able to asume the vocal ability of all, cannot, from the want of a standard, asign to any one a comparative excelence, or superi- ority : and tho it may, by universal imitation, add to its powers a superfluous flexibility, it cannot, from the want of this measure of excelence, improve or exalt itself. And as it must necesarily, from the vast amount of worldly falsehood and bad taste, be more frequently employed on vulgarity and exageration, than on truth and refinement, its constant tendency must be to eror and degradation. Mimicry in speech is the exact, or caricatured imitation of its faults. It must therefore be founded on a perverted, or extrava- gant employment of the various forms of Vocality, Time, Force, Abruptness and Pitch. Mimicry is the result of the ignorance and eror of man, in the uses of his voice. With all his imita- tionsj except they remind him of his own defects of body or mind, or of his want of dignity in the imitatiouj he cannot turn into ridicule, the unviolated law of nature within the whole range of the sub-animal voice. In the deformities, and erors of his own, he is the fit subject of his own contempt. Had the true and ex- presive system of that voice, been developed and taught, there would have been, as in gramar, few faults, except upon the vulgar tongue ; and perhaps no mimicry in speech, worthy of an intcli- gent smile. The order of Nature, with all things aright except untoward Man, has by its fitnes, its self-acordancc, its serious truth, and its beauty, excluded every cause of the Kidiculous from her works : and an elocution that elegantly obeys her laws, cannot be mimiced for the anuisement of a discerning and respectful ear. Mimicry is not only founded on faults, but it contributes to multiply and to (confirm them. It nuiltiplios faults, by confound- ing those just })crceptions, that might discern and prevent, or corectthcm; and it confirms them in the mimic, by giving to a FAULTS OF READERS. 555 habit of distortion, the force of second nature in his voice. Mim- icry weakens and perverts the powers of expresion, by confusing its signs, in representing the same state of mind, as diferently expresed by diferent individuals : when in comon consistency it should always have the same apropriate vocal sign. One cause of our not readily perceving the true system of speech is, that the ordained conection of sign and state of mind, is in the corupt prac- tice of the greater part of mankind, confounded, by the same state being expresed in so many diferent ways. How much then, must the mimic be at fault, and the whole purpose of his speech per- verted, by the endles variety and exagerated degree of false ex- presion, constantly upon his ear? Few mimics are able to rise to the character of dignified uterance ; and when they even seriously imitate acomplished speakers, it is always in their acidental defects ; for these only give the amusing characteristics. Some of the beter class of Actors posses a jDOwer of mimicry : but as I have known them, they have wanted a high refinement and finish, in the truth- ful representation of thot and pasion. And so it ought to be : and so it will be regarded hereafter, if in our present l\istory of Nature there is a true representation of the system of her wise and eficient laws. And here let me not unmindfuly say, that if observation had not, by acident, aforded me the light, and the defense of this natural ordination of the voice, I would not have dared, nor even wished, to touch the mantle of renown, that wraps the Histrionic character of the Imortal Garrick. But when I see him, in that Emblematic Portrait of his fame, equaly afected to the Comic, and the Tragic Muse ; and hear, that he could both by taste and habit, mask the expresive features of his elocution, by an exager- ated and distorted mimicry, I grieve to think that my memorial perception must lose a single ray, from the bright and welcome vision of his canonized Perfection. Such, from its very character, must, to a greater or less extent, be the influence of mimicry, even on the finest mould of nature in the unenlightened human voice. How far a full and acurate knowledge and use of all the means, ordained for truth and ele- gance of expresion, with a perfect discrimination between the right and the wrong in speech, may enable an acomplished Actor 656 FAULTS OF READERS. habitualy to practice the deformities, Avithout infecting the graces of uterance, must be determined by the oportunities of future experience. At present, it is well to keep the tongue away from the contaminating company of its own infectious faults. For it is with our voices, as with our morals ; the habit of doing only right, most efectually preserves us from wrong : and it is no less danger- ous, to play with mischief in the one, than to amuse ourselves with mokery in the other.* An inquiry into the subject of mimicry, will afford a further view of the consistency of the whole science of expresion, set-forth in this esay. For if corect and elegant speech requires the em- ployment of the vocal constituents, in their proper places, in their proper sucesions, and in due proportion to each other, it will furnish, if the Reader yet doubtsj some suport to this recorded system, to findj the violation of its rules, by a misplaced, or over- proportioned, or exclusive use of certain of these constituents is productive of a paling monotony, or a grotesk caricature. Of Monotony of Voice. This is an old term in elocution ; but it is here used with a more extensive signification than formerly. It means in general, the undue continuation of any function of the voice. One can scarcely point-out an ocasion, on which the simple rise of the second, or the diatonic wave, has this efect ; for acording to our system, these are properly the most frequent of the continuous styles of discourse. The use of the second, in place of another interval, may sometimes be an eror in expresion, but we do not call it monotony. The chromatic melody, as a continuation of the impresive interval of the semitone, is not monotonous, if its plain- tivenes is suited to the state of mind : but many other constitu- * lu the early period of life, I had to a certain degree the power of mimicry ; and the ability to imitate the human and sub-animal voice, has asisted me ia discriminating by contrast, the graces of utcrance, in recording many of its faults. Since the development of the vocal constituents, with a habitual prac- tice of the means, and experience of the efects, of a true, apropriate, and ele- gant speech, the readines and precision of that mimicry is much impaired ; and partially lost : without however, the least diminution of exactnes in tho measurement of time and tune, when now in my eighty-second year, en- larging the sixth edition of this Work. I cannot say how it would have been, had mimicry been a purpose of businesor ambition. FAULTS OF READERS. 557 ents, when spread over discourse, ofend by this fault. A repeated sucesion of the same phrases in the curent; the same kind of ca- dence, particularly if it frequently ocurs ; a melody formed on the third, or fifth ; a restriction of emphasis to the third, or fifth, or octave ; a constant use of the acent and emphasis of the radical, the vanishing, or the thoro stressj of the tremorj and of the down- ward wider intervals; too free a use of remote skips in the radical change, both in the curent, and the cadencej of the wider and un- equal wavesj with the protracted notes of song, may each become the cause of monotony. And it may be again remarked, that all constituents severally alotted to the rare ocasions of emphasis, seem to be protected against the fault of undue repetition, not only by their violating the vocal rules for thot and expresion, but by pro- ducing at the same time, an ofensive monotony. Of Ranting in Speech. This fault consists in the exces of certain functions. These are loudnes ; violence in the radical, and the vanishing streses; and in general, an over-doing of just expresion, when united with unecesary force. Of Afedation in Speech. This consists in an imbecile perversion of the proper use of articulation, and of the intervals of pitch, with a mincing awkwardnes, that always attends the actions of personal conceit. Of Mouthing in Speech. This belongs properly to the head of the faults of articulation ; and refers to deviations from standard pronunciation; of which it is not my intention to speak particu- larly. Mouthing consists in. the improper employment of the lips in utterance. Some of the tonic elements, and one of the subtonics are made by the assistance of the lijjs. They are o-we, oo-ze, ou-v, and m. When these abound it may, without precaution on the part of the speaker, lead to mouthing. All the other subtonics may be to a degree, infected with this fault. It slightly infuses the sound of the o-we or oo-ze into their vocality; for the protrusion of the lips, gives something of this character even to a lingual element. Mouthing may be called a form of affectation. I might here give a particular description of the voices of Childhood and of Age : for these may be looked upon as faults, 558 FAULTS OF READEES. when compared with the full-fonned, vigorous, and varied uter- ance of intermediate periods. Our analysis will enable an ob- servant Reader to discover their respective characters. He will find the voice of childhood to be high in pitch, vividly monotonous in melody, and defective in cadence, with nothing, except parental doting to reconcile the ear to its screeching intonation ; which in its piercing and untunable noise from mingling hundreds 'just let loose from school' is a nuisance well deserving the rod of a Correctional Police, in every community that vainly hopes, by a little reading, writing, and arithmetic, to banish ignorance, raise up a comonwealth of industrious, wise, and virtuous citizens, and to quiet the disorderly pasions of mankind. He will find old age to be slow, with frequent pauses, feeble radical stres, tremulous, ocasionally breaking into the falsete, and piping the childish treble in his voice. The faults here enumerated, are more or less coraon among those who pass for good, and often the best Readers and Actoi*s. When instruction shall be derived from the Natural Philosophy of speech, and not from the egotism of untaught 'genius,' nor the varying and contradictory examples it pretends to set-up for Imi- tatiouj the defects and deformities of uterauce from these sources, now equaly prevalent in the higher and the humble class of read- ers, will like the faults of gramar, be confined to the uneducated and the careles. I have described the faults of speakers under general heads, and in their separate forms. They are heard in bad speakers, under all possible combinations : but the pcrnnitations would defy every atempt towards a useful arangemcnt. The contemplation of the subject is therefore left as a task for the Reader. Should the principles of this Work ever prevail, and Speech hereafter become a Lil)eral and Elegant Art, it may be foundj the faults described in this section, as infecting the whole world of elocution, will have so far passed away, that the i)icture here ex- hibited, will seem to have been overdrawn. ]5ut when were the exceleneies of Art, or Wisdom, or Worth, ever univi'rsal or even comon? There will always remain in this motly world, posterity enough of those who now defeat the designs of Nature, and mar the mind-directed music and expresiou of speech, to show to FAULTS OF READERS. 559 another age, that I may not nnfairly have recorded, the ahnost universal prevalence of this deafnes and deformity, in the great family of their vocal ancestors.* In describing the faults of readers, and on other ocasions in this esay, I have refered to eminent, as well as to exceptionable exam- ples, in the vocal practice of the Stage. The Actor holds both for purpose and oportunity, the first and most observed position in the Art of Elocution^ and should long have been our best and al-sufi- cient Master in its School. The Senate, the Pulpit, and the Bar, with the verbal means of argument or persuasion almost exclu- * Having shown, that the descriptions ofered in this esay, are drawn from Nature^ to furnish the sure foundation of a system for all times, and for all cultivated nations; and having further, shown that faults, being a misaplica- tion of the constituents of a just and elegant speech, must of necesity, be universal}' of a similar character, among those who disregard the principles of that just and elegant speech : I have only to add here, as it might perhaps be required, some suport to this conclusion. During my residence at Rome, in the winter of eighteen hundred and forty- six — seven, I was present at an annual exhibition of the scholars of the Propa- ganda. From pencil-notes taken at the time, on the margin of a programme of the exercises, and briefly recording my perception of the character of the elocution, I make the following sumary. The speakers numbered from fifty to sixty, men and boys ; aparently from the age of twelve to five and twenty ; of various colors, visages, and lan- guages ; and from countries of different degrees of ignorance, and of civiliza- tion, between the longitude of eastern China, and that of the Alegany moun- tains. As each and all of these individuals must have had the respective forms of their intonation, and of the other modes of the voice, determined and fixed by early habit in their native country^ they could have undergone no material change in the Roman school. Yet the proprieties of speech, if any, and all its faults, whether in form, degree, or misaplied expresion, were the same as those we have enumerated in the English voice. No matter, to what .sylabic sound, or structure of language they had been born, there was colectively among thom, the same vicious variety in the uses of time, force, vocality, abruptnes and intonation, as with ourselves ; and as with us of the Saxon, Celtic, Gaulish, Teutonic and Slavonic tonguesj one vast predomi- nance of faults. Still, when closely listening to the right, the wrong, and the peculiar, I heard nothing in form, or even in queernes or exageration, that I had not seemingly heard before. In short, the destined swarthy wan- derer of the Propaganda, with his aimles and chaotic eforts in speech, and the acomplished Queens of song from the Conservatorio, with their desecra- tion, so to speak, of expresion in Recitative, are more nearly asimilated, in these vices of intonation, than their diference in complexion and in glory will alow the pride of the Opera to aknowledge. 560 FAULTS OF READERS. sively before them, having so earnestly, or artfuly pursued these leading interests^ they have not observed, nor apareutly, M'ished to observe, how far the cultivated powers of the voice might have asisted the honest or the ambitious purpose of their oratory. But with the Stage, speech is in itself, the means and the end of His- trionic distinction ; for however the Actor may be unduly influ- enced by aplause, this aplause is suposed to be atainable, only by the expresive powers of his voice. It has therefore been towards the Stage alone, that criticism has shown a disposition, formaly to direct its vague and limited rules of vocal propriety and taste. The Stage however has not fulfiled the duties of its position; for while holding the highest place of influential example in the art, and enjoying the immediate rewards of popularity, it has done little more than keep-up the tradition of its busines and rotine^ and tediously record the personalities, engagements, retirement, and every sort of anecdote of its renowned Performers ; without one serious thot of turning a discriminative ear to their vocal ex- celence, and thereby afording available instruction, on the means of their succes ; its distinguished Performers themselves, apear- ing more culpably, in the condition of too many others in exalted stations, who have not so much desired to fulfil the trusts of their Stewardship, as to acquire wealth and influence and distinction for themselves.* * Shortly after the publication of this "Work, I was asked by a friendly Judges how I came to write it ; for he had suposed it would have been writen by some Public Speaker. But Judges deliver opinions; and the whole line of historical 'Reports' furnishes only a single Case-in-point, to my friend's suposition : for of all the Orators, Demosliienes alone is said to have tried vocal instruction^ in teaching himself to jironounce the elements, by holding pebbles in his mouth. Tiie invention and the belief of this silly story show the ignorance and the credulity, on the subject of the voice, among the An- cients. Yet the ' theory ' of the proces seems to have been no less impracti- cable then than it is now ; for it appears, he never had a second scholar in the same pebble-way. And generaly, it would be strange for an Orator to teach elocution, when he beleves it to be a heaven-born gift, that cannot be taut. Tho I have heard and heard-of, Great Speakers who have won 'golden opinions' by their 'silver tones^' I have always found, it was what thoy said, not Jmw they said it, that set their party whipers-in, beneath ' Hotel-win- dows,' and around ' the table,' in a roar. True liowever it is, that Orators with tho exce])tion of Quiiu'tilian, if ho was one, neither write books on Elocution for others^ nor read books on Elocution to instruct themselves. FAULTS OF READERS. 561 For this particular state of Histrionic Art, there must be a causej and as the preceding analysis has enabled us to explain some faults universaly infecting the voice, we may here properly inquirej why elocution has not been able to asume an inteligent, systematic, and respected authority on the Stage. Speech is the audible sign of the thotive and pasionative character of man ; it will apear then, the peculiar faults of the Stage procede from a limited and a mystic state of mind in the Actor. I therefore devote a few remaining pages to the subject j Of the Faults of Stage-Personation. The most general and in- fluential cause from which many of the faults of the Actor seem to arise, and under which, knowledge in his art has never been either comunicable or progresivcj is the delusive asumption, so fatal to a clear and practical use of the mind, that his purposes are efected by certain 'innate powers' or 'spiritual gifts' independ- ently of all instruction ; that so far from being the result of the plain and universal rule of sucesful physical thot and actionj the expresion of his Enacted Character, like that vulgar notion of the 'fine madness' of poetical invention, is the result of a peculiar his- trionic ' phrensy ' of pasion, with the ' inspired embodiment ' of its signs in the countenance and the voice. This mysticism of the school of Acting has divided its eminent disciples into two Clases. The First has a sort of double exist- ence, consisting, at one time, of its comon animal atributes of mo- tion, sensation and thot ; at another, of the ' spiritual ' representa- tion of the language of the poet. In one of these lives, the actor prepares for his part, acording to his own conception of it, or to the traditionary rules of the Green Roomj and for his scenic relation- ships to the rest of the Company, goes to Rehearsal, with his everyday mind, speech, and aparel. This is the personal life of the actor. In the other life he is before the audience, and has entered into a 'spiritual existence' with the poet. Here, all self- perception is lost; he is sensuous to nothing, and has only an in- describable notion of the comingling of his own enacting 'soul,' with the rhetorical 'soul' of his author; thus entering with him into one co-eficient expresion of gesture, countenance, and voice. This state of an actor, in losing his 'consciousnes,' in the meta- physical 'ideality' of the character, is called Identity. And as I 562 FAULTS OF READERS. can comprehend his bodily and mental condition, the actor seems to think, move, and speak in a peculiar kind of Trance.* * An Actor, or Personator on the Stage, whatever his fictional school may teach, can no more, intelectualy and pasionately, beleve or feel himself to be the character he represents, than he can, in physical perception feel the pain of his friend, or taste the food that gratifies him. If he should in mind, for he cannot in person, be or apear to himself to be another, he must, in mind, cease to be himself: and therefore cannot, in thot and pasion, become another, except, if even that is posible, in delirium or a dream. Nor is there the least necesity that he should in acting, apear to himself to be another, in order to Act well. Wicked and foolish as man is in most of his afairs, it would be apaling to think what he might be, if human nature had not been made, in all things and everywhere alike. "We are therefore, by birth and education, identical with one another; without its being a peculiar aim of 'genius ' in a Player to feign himself so, and this is the opinion of the world ; as we all know, what a social, moral, political, and religious comotion is produced by a single individual of name and station, who questions conformity, and observes and thinks for himself. He is marked as a dangerous character. Diference from the rest of the world in observation and thot, which are the charm of life, is rare ; but in pasion, which is almost the whole life itself of man, it is imposible. If by internal motive, or external impresion, thots are excited into pasion, we must show or enact it, in like maner with others. For with some variation of degree and maner, the pasion itself, in mental perception and outward action, is similar in all. It is not necesary then, to ' enter into ' or ' feel ' the pasion of another ; we are already in it, by a similar constitution ; and have only to perceve and expres it, as properly our own, when excited within us either by the voice of the orator, or the writen language of the historian and the poet. In ilustration, let us suppose an Actor to have the education, thot, pasion and physical means for expresion, like the best of his class ; and to enact the part of Hamlet, before the Ghost of his Father. He has then in his mind, the thbts of doubt, disbelief, inquiry, and of the present supernatural event. The pasions or vivid perceptions that absorb, not entrance him, are horor, aston- ishment, reverence, afection, and revenge. These comon th6ts and pasions are, either from Nature or from habit, so at comand, ' that a man might play them j ' as Shakspeare analyticaly and truly describes itj by ' forcing his soul to its ow)i conceit,' not into Identity with the thOt or conceit of another: for as they have been experienced, and no further, can they be mcntaly known, and expresed. No one has felt them, in the case before us, with the vividnes of life, but tlio suposed once-existing Hamlet: and therefore the Actor may raise within himself a certain form and degree of those thOls and jiasions, but cannot become identical with Hamlet, even if good acting should require it. He is then only identical, so to speak, with himself, upon the experienced forms and degrees of his own pasion and thOt. The Actor's jicrccption of Idenfltij, compared with the plain phenomena of the mind and the voice, would seem to have arisen from one of these visionary FAULTS OF READEP^. 563 The Second Class, altogether diferent in its character from that of Identity, is no less mystical in its acount of itself. But as I do not comprehend the acount of that unthinking and inexpresive histrionic machinery, by which an Actor afects an audience, I shall, in noticing the subject, be obliged to quote the words of the initiated, who pretend to describe it. It has long been a question among Actors and Stage-criticsj whether he who excites most pasion in his audience, is necesarily views of Stage-personationj either that the state of mind ascribed to a Char- acter, is to be represented by the Actor being realy excited to the exact state of mind ascribed to that character, which is but a metaphysical notion ; or by his trying io forget himself, and in thot and pasion, to become, as if abso- lutely another, which is a hopeles metaphysical task. How far, in the case before us, the Actor is to become identical with the Poet, is another subject for consideration : and this leads to the inquiry, how far Shakspeare designed to identify himself in thot and pasion with the think- ing and sufering of the once-existing Hamlet. If a Poet should become iden- tical as he thinks, with some pre-existing model, and upon that identity, should draw the character from himself; the Actor, in identifying himself with the character, would necesarily become identical, so to call it, with the poet. I have nothing to say here, on what a poet might think of himself; for he may have his delusions, as well as the actor. With all respect however for the poet, even one in truth and greatnes of thot, we maintain, that he, in no case becomes identical with the character he describes. How it may be with a character he altogether creates, if a poet ever did so create, I leave for poets, who work with ' transcendental spiritualities ' to decide. When the costume, together with the language of a Character, is asumed by the Actor ; and he has to move and to speak like that character, he might posibly seem to him- self to have some slight cause for beleving, against his senses, that he is the very character : like Christopher Sly in the Play, who, with so many per- suaders towards his delusion, exclaims at last, 'Upon my life, I am a Lord indeed.' But how can the poet find a point of aproach to similarity, much less enter into Identity with his character, either historical or created^ when spreading his memorial perception for his task, he gradualy and line by line, selects from its amplitude; and roaming, in his excursions after everything, returns with a gathered choice of thots, characters, maners, imagery, and lan- guage : and all this efected in time, and succession, by a Shakspeare^ only a high example herej identical with his own clasifying power, and the grace and grandeur of its taste. What has he, in drawing the character of Hamlet, to do with contracting himself into a fixed and momentary identity with such a pasing and everyday personage as a former Prince of Denmark ? Leaving Identity then to its own Notional fate, the case seems to bej that the Poet should, or does add what he pleases, to the original traits of a char- acter furnished by history ; and the Actor adds what he has learned, to be the proper vocal-representation of a character furnished by the poet. 564 FAULTS OF READERS. excited and directed by pasion within himself. This Platonic, or soul-dealing, and thercifore disputatious and interminable question, seems so clearly, to have arisen from a belief in the 'Spirituality' of Expresion, suported by a determined ignorance of the dascrib- able forms of the speaking voice, and of their physical power in representing thot and pasion, that I need not show, by our present light of analysis, in what maner it has contributed to prevent a progresive observation of the exact and beautiful co- relation between the mind and the voice. The maxim of Horacej ' if you wish me to weep, you must yourself first ^feel ' your woes,' has so far either convinced, or misled his readers, that, under either of these two influences, I would not have here introduced the subject of this confounding question, if I had not met with the folowing confounding attempt to anounce it. ' The actor of an oposite school,' says the Autobiography of an Actres, chapter thirteen, ' if he be a thoro artist, is more sure of producing startling efects. He stands unmoved amidst the boister- ous seas, the whirlwinds of pasion sweling around him. He ex- ercises perfect comand over the emotions of the audience ; seems to hold their heart-strings in his hands, to play upon their sympa- thies, as on an instrument ; to electrify or subdue his hearers by an efort of volition; but not a pulse in his own frame, beats more rapidly than its M^ont. His personifications are cut out of marble ; they are grand, sublime, but no heart throbs within the life-like sculpture. Such was the school of the great Talma. This abso- lute power over others, combined with perfect self-comand, is pronounced by a certain class of critics, the perfection of dramatic Art.' And then, to show the diference between the actor who draws from the depth of his identical ' soul,' and him who only apears to do so, we have the folowing fact. ' I have acted with distinguished tragedians, who after some significant bursts of pathos, which seemed wrung from the utmost depths of the soul, while the audience were deafening themselves, and us, Avith their frantic aplause, quietly turned to their brethren, with a comical grimace, and a fe\v mutered words of satirical humor, tliat caused an iresist- iblc burst of laughter.' The reader, if ho looks for meaning and precision in language, must find out if he can, and then s:iy for himself, what all this acount of Great Acting means, whether in FAULTS OF READERS. 565 the school of Identity, or of Talma. In me, it produces not a single definite perception of the kinds, degrees, purposes, and efects of thot and passion, nor of the character and management of the personal and vocal signs that expres them.* * In addition to this visionary atempt to describe the maner of an acom- plished Actor, by transforming him into a ' stoic ' of the Stage, ' a man without a tear ; ' and still further to justify our opinion of elocutionary discrimination, I select from a fashionable authority 0/ the day, the following atempt, of a somewhat diferent character, but quite as uninteligible ; and showing that delusion of the mind which at times, overcomes us all when with words alone, we make a picture to ourselves, wherein no one else can recognize a clear representation of things. Madame de Stael, whom I quote at second hand, from an English writer, somewhere speaks of Talma in these words : ' There is in the voice of this man a magic which I cannot describe ; which from the first moment, when its acent is heard, awakens all the s3-mpathies of the heart ; all the charms of music, of painting, of sculpture, and of poetry ; but above all, of the language of the soul.' It is always of great importance, to distinguish between a particular expla- nation of an object or action, and the self-absorbed writer's description of his own thots and feelings upon it : a point neglected in nine cases out of ten, in all past and present histrionic criticism. If a writer, in the selfish agonies of his own delights, and in the vaguenes, of his ' transcendental abstractions,' declares that the maner of an Actor, 'cannot be described,' the reader who is obliged to rely altogether on description, is not to be reprehended, especialy when there is 'soul and magic' in the case, if he can have no perception of it. In general, as an apendage to such a rhapsody as the preceding:; a writer, after acknowledging his inability to explain the thing itself, should at least, atempt to describe what he means by his own metaphysical notion of it; a task perhaps still more diticult. It is my misfortune never to have heard the celebrated Talma. Nor has that loss been otherwise suplied : for with due respect to the memory of an Actor whom I did not know, I would fain not ascribe to him a florid and outrageous intonation of wider intervals and waves, that I once heard from a declaimer, who was said to be his pupil and imitator : and all the descriptive terms I have met with, in critical eulogies on his elocution, have given me only an indefinite acount of his knowledge and management of the voice, whatever that may have been : and the egregious misperceptions among the few as well as the many, on subjects like thisj together with what I know by our principles, to be the exagerated intonation of French Tragedyj would leave me equaly open to belief, or to doubtj were a question on this point to be raised on the reality of the merit universaly ascribed to him. If this declaration should shock the partiality, I do not say impeach the discrimination, of an admirer, it may perhaps moderate his revolting aston- ishment, when he has studiously read this volume, and compared it with the 566 FAULTS OF READERS. In seeking instruction from others, not only in pbilosojihy, but in tlie higher poetryj for this has taught me much even of physical nature, and more of the human mindj I have so acustomed myself to regard the simple truth-prints of traceable description, that my comprehension is often at fault, in the trackles pursuit of a meta- physical meaning ; whether in the mischievous visions of Plato, with his ' arithmetic mediums, ' and his ' procreations of the soul ; ' in the equaly incomprehensible, yet far less rhetorical and methodic dreams of his later pupils, Jacob Behmen and Emanuel Kant ; or in the unasignable notions of histrionic principles and criticism. And altho we may be unable to folow the mystic visions of the schools of Actingj it is not so dilicult, with a little patience on the part of the Reader, to inform, or remind him Avhence they are derived. The Greeks, unfortunately in some things our teachers, receved so much of their Philosophical Fiction from Egypt and the East, that it is imposible to say, to what extent they invented, or how far they only altered and dresed-up the fable : it is however cer- tain, that having contrived, or adopted the imposition, they after- wards blindly went along with it. It was according to the vain and groping purposes of the Greek philosophers, that when they desired to know the truth, they could not find a metaphysical, and- would not take the plain and physical way, to learn it. Observing how much time and labor were necesary for acquiring a knowledge of the frame and laws of nature, by what apeared to them a tedious use of the senses, they resolved to acomplish it more easily by a 'pure intelcction of the soul.' In this fictional proces, asuminc/, acording to the human method of Design and Construction, that the world was made from an ' ideal design, ' or what they caled a Patern-Form of the world previously existing in the mind of the Creator; and that the mind of man, made in tlie image of the Creative-Mind, was a humble finite ofspring of its al-glorious infinity. And further, observing', for they did add an ahnvcd mite of experience to their fictionsj realy observing, I say, the luniian mind to be capable of unlimited improvement, they thereupon conceited that in abstracting itself from the uninstructivc anil leaves whence it was cc)})icil, in tlie great Biblos of Nature, always open for reference, before him. FAULTS OF READERS. 567 contaminating company of the senses, as well as from all other disturbing influences of this mortal life, it might, by a long and contemplative exercise of its own powers on i>ts uncorupted self^ hopefuly ascend towards the Creative Mind, and reach at last, its Parent-state of intelectual perfection, and imortality : that the Mind then purified, returning to its omnicient Father, and being made partaker of his knowledge, might come at last, yet still re- siding within an earthly form, to behold his patern of creation, and by aces to the constructive designs, be able to comprehend the plan, the purpose, and the workmanship of all things. This pro- ces of Contemplation, was a product, and part of what the Greeks termed the sublime Abstraction of their First Philosophy ; now indeed to us, first and greatest in fictional pretension, but last and least, in usefulnes and truth ; and which, if not originally de- signed to impose on ignorance, did subsequently pervert the mind to that state of metaphysical credulity, by which it still imposes on itself. It was this, together with other distracting fictions of the First Philosophy, that so early and so fataly confused and corupted the now, alas ! irestorable simplicity of the Christian Religion ; a religion intended by its Author to be practicaly a general moral blessing; andj in discarding the quarelsome notions, and verbosity of the Grecian School j to embrace an unconteutious system, with its decisive meaning of Yea, or Nay, for those who have ' ears to hear' unworied truth: not a religion of Platonic figments, and Aristotelian quibbles, for those M'ho deafen their perceptions to the unarguing brevity of these two short verdict-words of Belief or Denial ; and who by rejecting this unsophistic, this al-sufficient, this conclusive, this practical, and this peaceful purpose of the Original Christianity, have, with a heavy responsibility for their evil-doing, given themselves up, universaly and world-without- end, to doctrinize, to wrangle, and to hate. This, which withdrew the Platonic Pietist from the visible world, to contemplate with inward but with filmy eyes, his own fanatic selfishnes; thereby to raise himself to a comunion with angels and saints, at the right hand of his Maker; and to pro- claim, with audacious triumph, his acomplished Beatitude. This, which led the Hermit and the Monk, to Platonic war against 568 FAULTS OF READERS. the senses ; to retreat to the savage wiklernes, and the Cell, be- fore the overpowering civilization of their truth ; and to seek a refuge at last, by trying to think, and to mortify themselves into Heaven. The Greeks began their philosophical but foolish method. Math only disregarding the Truth of the Soises. The religious Anchorite, folowing up his Platonic creed, ended with the Impious atempt to thwart the purpose of his God, in ordaining its supremacy. It is this ireligious sundering of heaven from the universe of material things, that ' God has joined together,' which still haunts the narow-minded Bigot ; who under the venerable authority of his Pagan philosophy, continues to sejDarate the senses from con- templation : but which, in the fulness of wisdom, and of works, the beneficent Bacon, in mental saviorshij^, has taught us to re- unite. It is this Contemplation, still uncontroled by physical per- ception, and faling into visions, that enables every new Sectarian Leader, to conceit his owm way to the will of his Maker, and to bring back from his own egotistical invention, another, and still another mesage of grace, to overfil the world with discord and with dreams. A modification of this system, still makes the Physician of Every School, pretend to see with his mind's eye, and that a blind one, those fictions • of invisible causation in the human body, which produce the infinite sucesion of quarelsome Speculations, the ever-varied Nomenclature, and the never-satisfying Practice of his Dogmatic Art ; yet so inseparable from the weaknes and indecision, always co-existent in the mind, with fictional and fashionable changes in opinion. It is to the universality of this vice of thinking and beleving without the Mastership of the senses, that, acording to our igno- rance, or our ill use of knowledge, we owe the wildnes of Grecian Spiritualism, still imposed upon usj in the dates and postponements of Mik-nnial Prophets; in conjuring-down the Raping Phantoms of the dead ; and in the Epicurean doctrine of atoms, revived in modern chemistry, with no other prospect than that of giving way in time, to some new suposition. And finaly, a view of this Vice will discover the source of that absurd 'idealism' of the Actor, and of his self-suficient metiiphys- FAULTS OF EEADERS. 569 ical 'genius' in his atempt to describe his own conception of his characters, and of himself. If there is no cause for a work, the cause being here, only the adaptation of means to an end, there can properly be neither be- gining nor end to the work ; and if not eminent causes, there can be no excelence. Nature certainly has wise purposes in her work, and altho she never tells them, except by her spontaneous actions, she does not always prevent our finding them out by experimental inquiry. An Actor may have purposes for all his endsj and some system for self-instruction ; but as he never has satisfactorily told them, we must, as in the case of Nature, be contented, if he does not prevent our eforts to ascertain them. Without therefore posi- tively asertingj he has no means of instructing himself, or of being instructed, beyond his comon school of Imitation, we may, if un- able to discover his intentions or rules, particularly on the subject of the voicej be alowed to state our view of the causes why, with an exception of some local rotine, and the busines of the stage, he has none, above the instincts of gesture, countenance, and voice, comon to him and the rest of his company. One influential cause, afecting at large, the whole power and purpose of the Actor, not chargeable on him alone, and which encourages this mediocrity, if it does not realy produce itj is the too frequent absence, from a public audience, of those watchful Masters, Knowledge and Taste ; masters who make greatnes, wherever they rule, because they will have nothing else ; and who in deciding on the faults and merits of an actor, teach him at the same time, to know himself. This however, is a general cause, arising from a neglect of instruction, comon to the Actor and his audience. Leaving this point for the consideration of others, we will here briefly show particularly, not only why he has not a knowledge of very important requisites in this art, but why circumstances render it almost necesary that it should be so. In the First place, then, the vocation itself of an actor is apt to over-ocupy, and thereby thwart any broader purpose of his mind, with memorial eforts upon wordsj and with a perpetual and varied sucesion of thot and pasion, strongly excited for the moment, yet too fugitive to become mentaly familiar, or direct- ively useful in the higher designs of expresion ; and therefore not 37 570 FAULTS OF EEADEES. calculated to lead his atention, or inquiry, beyond tlie comon topics of bis art. Second. The wliole mind of an Actor, with all its jealous hopes, is involved in the disturbing interest of his suces. His suces is measui'ed by public aplause ; and public aplause, the very life and support of Egotism, rarely asists or enlarges the intelect, even on the subject of its ambition ; but is apt to weaken its power, and l^revent its advancement in everything else. Third. The actor, by that necesary law of a wholesome and a happy life, which directs us all to some physical or intelectual industry, goes to the stage, in nearly every instance, as a means of suport ; and too often without the preparatory education to give jjower to his purpose, and dignity to its efect ; alured in the unreflective period of youth, by a dream of prospects and hope, rather than by a view of the influential realities and important consequences of hLs choice ; and beset by an early and restles ambition to be known, necesarily most urgent with him who, being unknown to others, is at the same time very probably un- known to himself; of a temperament, not always sedate and steady, nor extended and permanent enough to form the habit of looking into things as they are, and of fairly estimating the dificulties of a task. ' O I never think so nicely as that,' said an actresj the sijoilt-child of the populace of two Hemispheresj to one, who remarked, that singing might be as articulate as speech. As it is much easier, gradualy to change a vague perception into positive eror, than to work-up exact and comprehensive ob- servation into systematic truthj it is almost conclusive, that minds born, or fashioned by circumstiinces, to the condition we have just described, would turn from the labor of cultivating the united powers of observation and reflection, to the amusement of in- dulging in wavering opinions; and become a prey to the so})histry of Platonic fiction, or as it is now called, * Ideality,' or ' Trans- cendental thot.' And such apears to be the state of mind, i'ar as they have explained it, of that class of actors, who surrounding themselves with visions of more than enthusiastic pasion, perform their part by the mystic means of Identity. I can say nothing of the state of mind of the second Class, that electrifies its hearere, by 'volition;' by 'grand and sublime per- FAULTS OF READERS. 571 sonations cut out of marble;' and without a Mieart-throb of its own within its life-like sculpture,' stirs up its audience, to ' deaf- ening themselves with their frantic aplause.' Its power, in its own estimation, is most wonderful ; but its ways, and means are beyond my eomj^rehension : for to me, the acount of these so- thought Frigidists, equaly with that of the former Class, taken from their own dreams about themselves, contains not one asign- able image in description, not one useful word of instruction, and nothing but words, in the purposes of histrionic criticism.* Snposing then, the dificulty or imposibility of our comprehend- ing the above description of the two great clases of Actingj to be as strict a consequence of its obscurity, as if it was designed to be uninteligible : how are we to corect the actor-ism of Actors, in being either by ignorance, or self-will, incomprehensible in their notions of themselves j which the 'Genius of the Lamp' of inate and self-suficient light, has strongly encouraged, if he did not originaly introduce it into the stroling Company of Thespis? Simply by removing their delusions about personated ' Identity,' and Frigid personation ; by inviting them down from ' the realms of cloud-land, where they dwell with the ideal creations of the poet ; ' and by clearly teaching them the physical and measurable signs of th5t, and pasionj their own natural and iuteligible state of mind if representable by countenance, gesture, and voice, can be distinctly conveyed to others. Since then the Observative Philosophyj the Real Author-power of this Work, under my humble namej has for the benefit of the Actor, furnished the materials for a beter condition of his Art, let the Actor listen for a moment, to the Observative Philosojihy. All that has been gropingly sought in the 'spirituality' of Plato, and the Actor-ism of the Stage, may be here set down in the clear Baconian language of the Senses. An actor, in his personations, is not a 'disembodied being of cloud-land' 'kindled by Prome- * It appears, from the preceding description, that as the Actor of the second class holds no extatic Identity with his Author, and returns no grateful 'feeling' to the 'frantic aplause' of his audience, he must have under his 'sculjitured suit of marble,' some very peculiar extacy within himself. As I vaguely look upon this strange afair, and would write it down, in something like its own fantastic figures; the Actor's 'soul' sits al-secluded, a self-suficient Monocrat, without a single minister of pasion. near the throne. 572 FAULTS OF READERS. thean fire' and 'taking the audience by storm;' with 'an upward gaze,' and in contempt of sensuous things, 'treading external cir- cumstances beneath his feet.' He is like the rest of usj tho he may not admit this 'identity^' an earthly animal, of flesh and blood ; with the means of movmg, and of plainly or pasionately thinking, and speakingj which he is visibly and audibly to aply with inteligence and taste. The thots to be declared, are set down in his Part, and are comunicable, by gramatical and apropriate speech. The pasions to be expresed, are described or implied in the words of his author. These thots and pasions, at least all that can, and ought to be represented, are comon to mankind, and are therefore readily excited in an audience, by their well-known physical signs. The actor being thus kept down to the level of humanit}-, on the points of th5t and pasion ; the Baconian method of working- out the practice by the principle, precedes to the maner of ex- presing them. This is shown in the person, the countenance, and the voice. Spiritualism has never gone so far, as to asume the mystical direction of personal Gesture. The exalted, the downcast, the averted, the asenting, and disenting head ; the hasty, the digni- fied, and the starting step; the fixed, and the 'suplosive' foot; with the 'chironomy' of the arm, in its unumbered motions and meanings, are all, in their consonance of character and expresion with the countenance and voice, no more than obvious muscular movements, prompted by nature, confirmed in their uses by habit, and exercised Avith propriety and taste. In the countenance, the Baconian eye of observation sees nothing in character and expresion, but physical form, outline, and move- ment, together with the smooth and the wrinkled, the pale and the' red ; all variously combined, and yet so plainly conected with their respective thot and pasion, that your dog, hapily freed from Pla- tonic notions, in a moment pcrceves them in your face. But here the actor begins to raise his 'Pcrturbhig Spirit;' and not contented with nature's own physical suficiency for his thotive and pasiou- ative signs, and whicii, if left to itself, would acomplish all his face is fit forj only forces it to the distortion of 'electrifying looks,' by ' throwing his soul ' into his eyes, and nose, and mouth, and brow ; FAULTS OF READERS, 573 and perhaps, in violence to tlie just expresion of well-closed lips, even into the grining of his very teeth. And what does the Baconian observer find in the Actor's voice? He hears that some of his words are of longer quantity than others ; some more forcibly pronounced ; some are harsh, others smooth ; some acute, others grave ; hears, not in his soul's ear, but physically hears, the Modes of vocality, force, time, abruptnes and pitch, with their various forms, degrees, and practical distinctions, detailed thruout this Workj by a pupil of only a lower Form, in the Baconian school, who is yet hapy in his present, and looks with hopeful patience to his future tasks. Having all these phe- nomena within hearing, and only unrecognized because unamed, the Platonic Thinker, seeking something above vulgar observa- tion, has by notional ^movements of the spirit' and figments of ' ocult causes,' not only prevented his own spontaneous perception of the vocal phenomena, but worse still, has so far contributed to obtund, as fictional habits generaly doj both the senses and the intelect, as not to let him listen, much less atempt to comprehend, when told by others, that the Expresion of Speech is only one part of measurable and describable physical nature. Upon all that has been said, perhaps some of those who would degrade the Fine-art of Acting, to a level with the visionary Sychology of our poetic young ladies, may ask if we have not given a too prosaic, or ' matter of fact, ' acount of the material and formal causes of the Art? What, says the ' cloud-capt' transcen- dental ist, is to become of the actor's grandeur, pathos, and grace, if they are to be deduced from physical, and not from ^spiritual' causes ? We answer, that with those states of mind, the proper use of the physical means for vocal and personal expresion, will, under the observative system, display those states with more uni- formity, and consequently with more force : for the expresion not depending on the individual caprice of visionary personation, will have a more invariable character, and therefore be more clearly and generaly perceved. To me however, the cause is not aparent, why the mystical 'soul' under the fiction of Identity, should be brought into Stage- Personation, more than into any other art. Why should not the Sculptor, Painter and Architect, when they studiously, and choicely complete their designs, and then practicaly 574 FAULTS OF READERS. execute them with propriety and taste j claim to have this myste- rious light of esthetic inspiration ? We once heard of a French- man, who, having made a certain Miniature Shoej ascribed his suces soley to the influence of 'a moment of enthusiasm.' And it has long been a by-word of the concentrative and transmuting influence of a Sheffield work-shop, that a buton-maker, as a 'glar- ing instance' of Ideniity, does in time become a very Buton. Nor are such jocose notions less absurd, when aplied to an Actor or when asumed by himself. The Fine arts are figuratively represented as sisters ; and they are a closely related family, far as the elegant Avork of their hands is directed by a unity of the general principles of beauty in the esthetic mind. When these principles have perceptibly and prac- ticaly taken-on their separate sister-formsj any atempt, mariage- like, to join two of them by a metaphysical rite, into one, Avould defeat the design of varied departments in taste ; and be repug- nant to the thot of a confederate-independence among themselves. From a few elements of mater and motion, or perhaps from single mater and its motion. Nature produces her countless diferences of function and form. The same radical and governing principles of fitnes and beauty in the arts, that create the delightful imagery of the poet, direct the just vocal expresion of the actor. When the principle embodies itself into perception, the unity of the principle is divided, and pases, if I may so sjjeak, into the varied diferences of its exemplified forms. The principle with the poet, is a train of directive perceptions, conizable to others only by its efect in his writen imagery and sign. The principle with the actor, is the train of directive perception conizable to others only by the efect in the pro])er audible sounds of his voice ; and strange as it may seem, until further explained, we have a unity in the mental root and stock of those principles, but cimnot have a direct resemblance between the several branches of the arts, which those j)rinc'ij)les produce. Somebody once made a doubtful metiiphor, in caling Dancing, tlie ' poetry of motion.' It wants just as nuich, the clear picturing of a true and consistent trope; and it is altogether out of place, in serious discourse, to speak ol' the Poetry of the Stage. It has had too, an influence on unthinking .Actors, and on Critics who should think, to turn their atention from the asignable merits FAULTS OF READERS. 575 of the art, to its vague and wandering mysticism ; and to en- courage the Aveak-minded, to gosip with others, as well as to enter into their own reveries, about the ' magical and dreamy in- fluence of pasion.' If poetry j flimsy, spirit- woven, merely self- inteligible poetry I meanj belongs to the Action of the Stage, then with the reciprocity of a metaphor, we might sayj the Action of the stage belongs to poetical soaring, even in its transcendental flights ; which is absurd. Let me ask one question of the dramatic Mystagogue, both as critic and actor ; for if not of one notional school, they would soon go their way from each other; whence does the poetj yes, emphati- caly for this case, the Poetj who being a participant-' spirit' in stage Identity, should in his own art be a bright example^ whence does he draw this grandeur, pathos, and grace, which the Actor in his cloud of idealism, has only at second hand, to express ? Ask the Homers, the Virgils, the Shakspeare, the Milton, the Thom- sons, the Popes, and the Cowpers, in their various powers ; and from their unmystified delineation of nature and of life, their analogies, all drawn at last, from that physical nature alone, not poeticaly sung, but clearly spoken to the ear in vivid representa- tion of the objects of every other sensej and learn how they have become to us, in the recognized exactnes of their bright and ex- alted pictures, the Baconian philosophers of fiction, and the great 'Secretaries' of nature and art; recording with iluminated faith- fulnes, the history of existing, and of posible, but not of pre- tending truths. They copied, each in his own hand, what was, and what had been : and set down even what might be, with the clearnes of a waking and a writen thot. Let then the infatuated aspirant of Stage-Personation, who thinks we have been too i^ro- saic, about his 'Genius of Identity,' learn under his dramatic Mastersj from whose language he must draw the audible material of his art, or it would only be the pantomimic ' spirit ' of his vocal expresionj how they performed their high poetic part of grandeur, pathos, and grace, thro all the breadth and depth of pasion : with- out any real ' nightly visits of i\\Q. muse;' with no 'extacies' of the Delphian Tripod; no 'stiring the waters of the soul' to a state of poetic Identity ; but on a humble seat perhaps, and without en- chantment, drawing their 'goodly thouts' in the truth and strength 576 CONCLUSION. of simplicity, from life and books, and things unwriten ; with tlie jjrivilege of descriptively exalting the physical realities of nature to perfectional degrees of the beautiful, and the sublime. CONCLUSION. Here I finish the histoiy of the speaking voice : having therein designed to record no anecdotal wonders ; no magnifying traditions of how far Whitfield could be heard; no prodigies of earliest infant speech ; no ultra case of a stamerer, who could not be even heard at all ; no echo past counting; nor ventriloquism past belief. On a subject worthy in itself of serious inquiry, I was reminded to pay more respect to the Reader who might value this Work, than contrivingly to entice him on to principles, by a distracting detail of 'startling' facts; having endeavored to set before him an in- structive story told by Nature ; whose wisdom being the broadest principle and power of all generality, is, if it admits the term, a single Wonder, Uncompared. It has been my purpose in this Work to subject the voice to a studious examination ; and by the simple but suficient direction of the Ear, to unfold its suposed mysteries with philosophic precision. How far this has been acomplishcd, the inteligent Reader must determine, Avith that alowanee for minor crors, which the historian of Nature has perhaps, in an arduous task like this, a right to claim, and which the liberal and reflective critic, who may have been told of the inscrutable intonations of speech, will not refuse. Those to whom the subject of Elocution, in its higher meaning, is new, will receve this history witliout prejudice; and even if they may not have ocasion for its practical rules, will still admire the beautiful economy of nature, in the ordination of speech. Those who have spent a life of labor, by the dim and scatered light as yet reflected from the art, and who are too })roud or ourelos to take-on a new mind, witli the advancement ol' knowledge; will at letust learn from this esay, the deficiencies of the old scheme of instruc- CONCLUSION. 577 tion, tho tliey may not admit the deficiencies are here supplied. If the development now ofered, were only an adition to the artj per- sons of the later class might discover traces of their former opinions, and thereby have some preface to admiting it. But finding here, the history of what may seem to be a ne^v and therefore a revolt- ing creation in science, they may reject it altogether, because they cannot recognize the definitions, divisions, rules, and ilustrations of their familiar school-books on elocution. HoM^ever Philosophy and Taste may admire the Wisdom and Beauty in the Natural system of the voice, which we have en- deavored to describej it is to be regarded as a curiosity only, if it does not lead to some Practical aplication. I have therefore atempted, on the unalterable foundation of our physiological his- tory, to establish a method of directive precepts, and of elementary instruction. If we infer from prevalent opinions, we must beleve, the distinct methods of a good elocution are endles ; for every one with self- satisfaction thinks he reads wellj yet all read diferently. There is however, under a varied aplication of just principles, but one method of reading-well ; and we are now enabled, from a knowl- edge and nomenclature of the constituents of the voice, to furnish from Nature herself, and not from the endles fashions of the igno- rant tongue, the efective means of that only-method. AVithout some system of generalized facts and principles in Elocution, drawn from the pervading unity of Nature, there can be none of that felowship which so esentialy contributes to the advancement of an art. Yet even with an instructive ordination of certain vocal signs to certain states of mindj conventional diferences, unrectified by rule, tend to confound that ordination and weaken its authority. If some uniform system of the voice be instituted, similarity of knowledge will insure greater acuracy in the use of its signs ; for intonations, like words, will hav^e more precision and force, when not varied from their fixed and apropriate meaning. In colecting and framing the precepts of Elocution, I have taken into view the strength, the propriety, and the beauty of expression. The system represents an inteligible, and dignified method of the voice, under that form of severe but eficacious simplicity, which is not at first aluring to him who is unacustomed to regard the 578 CONCLUSION. exalted purpose, and efect of an enduring taste. AVith the art of reading thus established, its excelence must grow into sure and ireversible favor, whenever it receves that studious atention, which raises the pursuits of the wise above those of the vulgar. I might, from anotlier art, relate the story of the great Painter, who with his mind filed with anticipative reflections on the merits of llatfaelle, was disapointed at his first sight of the walls of the Vatican, and disconsolate after his last. The florid style of elocution, formed by wider intervals than are proper to the diatonic melody, is the result of a sway of exager- ative pasion like that which prevails with tlie child and the savage. The thotless excitability of noise-loving ignorance, which delights in the florid intervals of speech, demands a perpetual change to faults of a like vivid character ; and capricious alteration takes the place of enduring improvement. The system of plain diatonic melody, with the ocasional contrast of expresive intervals, for which, as the Advocate of Nature, I would plead, has in the charm of its simplicity, an impresive influence on the educated mind, which the studious use of observation and reflection in an art, must always insure. If this ofered system of Elocution should, on the grounds of propriety or taste, be objectionable, let another be formed by him who is better qualified for the task. Only, let a consistent, tho even a conventional, system be formed. And as in the other esthetic arts, we can turn to an 'Apollo,' a 'Parthenon,' and a 'Trans- figuration'; to the Rules of the Oratoria; the Landscape of Whately, and of Price; the 'Institutes' of Quinetilian, and the Precepts of Horace, and of Pope ; let Elocution be able hereafter, not only to bring forward the name of a Roscius, a Garrick, a Sid- dons, a Talma, and a Boothj let it at the same time lay-ui) in the Cabinet of the arts, a history of the available ways and means of their vocal superiority; thereby investing the art of speaking- well, with that corporate ciipacity, by the preservative sucession of which the practical influence of its highest mastei's shall never die. A kindly felowship among the votiiries of the arts, and tlie bad temper of disagreement, turn so entirely on a harmony in opinion, that whoever has examined this subject would, for social sympathy CONCLUSION. 579 if not for truth and taste, prefer a factitious system, if well-ordered and consistent with itself, as a substitute for the varying and con- tradictory rules, constantly proposed by ever-changing authority, in individual cases, of what may be caled comon or unenlightened speech. The Philologist, in the study and eolation of languages, esti- mates those which have receved their clasified and concordant method from the arbitrary institutions of gramar and prosody, above those which arise with less conection or analogy, from the wants and pasions of a barbarous people. Where shall we find the natural prototype of that elegant and precise science of Heraldry, which makes the enthusiast, over his armorial ensigns, delight in the purely invented system of the Escutcheon and its Charges, and read their artificial but methodic disposition, by the brief and luminous rules of Blazonry ? AVhat book of Botany can designate the fluted stem and sheath- ing leaf of the free-handed floral volutej the symetric lotusj the scroled acanthusj the varied cupj the indented leafing, with its delicate traceryj which altogether constitute the beautiful and endles combination of ornament, in the contrasted and harmonious grouping of Greek and Roman Ideal or Esthetic Foliage ? These three subjects are all the systematic yet conventional crea- tions of art ; and it would seem, that objects of intelectual taste, as well as of sensuous perception, are sometimes more satisfactory when the latter are enjoyed under the impresive habit of acquired apetite ; and the former thru artificial and therefore to the dog- matic mind, less changeable arangements and rules : and we know that what is caled acquired apetite, is always governed by the influence of some habitual principles, however arbitrary these principles may be. Without a system founded either on Nature, or on general Convention, I am at a loss to know by what authority criticism in Elocution is to be directed. Its rules have too frequently been drawn from the very instances which are the questionable subject of investigation. Garrick is to be tried ; and by the Comon Law, for there is no Statute here, the former case of Garrick is the rule of critical justice. Hapy for an art, when such authority can be cited ! But what is to be said when presumption pushes itself 580 CONCLUSION. into the front ranks of elocution, and thdtless friends undertake to suport it? The fraud must go on, till presumption quarels, as often hapens, with its own friends or with itself, and finaly dissolves the spell of its fictitious character and merits. The preceding history develops many principles of instruction, and criticism, and makes some efort towards their aplication. Pronunciation, pause, and stresful emphasis are the only points of elocution which have been reduced to the precision of particu- lars : and on these only have critics been able to show anything like definite censure or aplause. By directing their inquiry to the details of Intonation, they will learn how far emphasis depends upon it: and when a perception of its universal influence in speech is awakened by exact description, and nomenclature, they will then first perceve how the comprehensive purposes of em- phasis, in its fulest relation to thot and pasion, may be mared by defects in the delicate schemes of melody, and intonated ex- presion. Read over a review of dramatic performance. It may have words enough for its thoutsj and very good gramar. You cannot however, avoid observing a strong disposition on the part of the writer, to say something, when he has nothing to say : hence, with some transcendental notion, and some uninteligible analogy to explain it ; together with a parot- vocabulary of unmeaning terms, generaly misaplied, and always mawkish to an instructed and delicate taste, such as ' chastenes,' ' by-play,' ' undertone,' ' fresh- nes,' 'harmony,' 'effect,' and 'keeping^/ the writer soon makes his way to surer ground, in noting the number and dres of the audience ; the comfort of the seats in the orchestra, with thanks to the manager, for recent alterations in the rules of the housej the habit of slaming doors, and the noise of iron-shod boots : the whole acompanicd with copious extracts from some well-known dramatic scenes, and perhaps a reprint of one of Cumberland's criticisms. But how can I withhold an example of the ' fine phrensy' of one of those ' briliant hits' of histrionic criticism? 'To hear ****,' said and seriously too, not an ilustrious, but a madly ilustrating and modern English Poctj 'to hear **** act, is like reading Shaksj)care by a flash of lightning.' A meteoric leson on Elocution, gesture, and the countenance, worthy of the CONCLUSION. 581 transcendental teacher ; and quite satisfactory to those who thot themselves thus brightly instructed.* * To exemplify the uninteligible generalities of the greater part of his- trionic criticism, under the indefinite verbiage of the old Elocution^ I select the {blowing article from a Charleston newspaper of the seventh of February, eighteen hundred and thirty-eight. It is a ' cloud-land ' analysis of the maner of a foreign Stroling-Actor, Staring at that time, over the United States^ whose real excelence on many points could not however, under the old system, guard him against that transcendental fog of rapsody, which destroys every perception not only of an identity with his enacted character, but even of any likeness in the description to the character of the Actor him- self. After stating that the Theater was crowded, which we do comprehend, he goes on with what we do not : ' His reputation rests upon a charm that gathers strength with time — his excelenoe is not particular, not resting upon starts, marvelous eckentricities, miraculous shreds, that like diamonds in rubbish astonish us by mere contrast with neighboring dulnes — his excelence is general, it interests and absorbs you, not by the finish of a movement, the richnes of a smile, the complication of a sneer or the preternatural power of a tone, but sweeps you on in the broad, bright stream of the profoundly estimated and distinctly developed character. You live in his personation — you feel your own blood sensibly coursing in the veins of his Hamlet, your own soul rocking with his indecisive will, j'our own brain gathering in the dim and awful musings that swell in his. It so dawns upon you, ever casting a light before its aproach, that you receve it as the realization of your own ideal, rather than start at it as an unhoped for won- der. You are not reminded that you had never thot of such, or such a con- ception before, and therefore you are never compeled to remember that the scene is without, foreign to you, on the stage and not in your own soul. You go with the personation, in it, a part of it, and not like parasites, bowing in mock astonishment at the heels of the show. This may be a little mystical, (0/ clouds and darkness, not a little,) but it is as near as we can arive to a corect acount of the impresion which Mr. has made upon our own minds. He is evidently a scholar, a man of thot, who has worked out his ideal with all the careful labor and intense dreaming that it costs the sculptor to perfect his. The consequence of this is, that he is aways the character, always Hamlet — for instance, acting, feeling, imagining, sufering, like — no, not like, for that denotes a comparison of two things where there is not only resemblance but difference — it is rather Hamlet himself, Shakspeare's Ham- let, bursting the cerements of his blackleter sleep and walking out from the volume upon the stage. There is a freslines, a reality in it that would give it all the charm of novelty on repetition. It could no more grow tame than the eternal truth of the poefs own creation.' Again, at the close we have something that we do comprehend. ' The play was witnesed with earnest interest. We have not time to make a record of cheering, &c., but in the course of the evening Mr. was 582 COXCLUSION. The preceding Esay furnishes principles and definite terms, by which the specific merits and defects of an actor, or a speaker may be distinctly represented ; by wliich the indescribable mysteries of speech, as they are caled, may be inteligibly told to other ages than those that hear them ; by Avhicli arogance and imposture in this art, may be wrested from their hold on the beter part of man- kind, and their cornpting influence left undisturbed over that great. majority, always ready to suport the small, and too often the greater frauds of lifej and which, in its way, does receve a sort of pleasure from the changing pictures of its credulity. The same close and comprehensive observation which makes an interpreter of nature, makes a Prophet in the arts. He can tell us, that in the future history of elocution, as it now is with song, the masters of its Practice must always be masters of the Science ; that they will, with the confident aim of principles, adress them- selves to the elect of inteligence and taste, by whom their merits will be rated and their authority fixed. And if in acquiring fame or fortune by their voice, they should receve asistance from this essay, I shall be contented to think it may be even a humble contribution to the means, by which the works of Esthetic Art have in all ages, delighted the inteligent and educated portion of mankind. Finally, I would recomcnd this analysis, and the practical in- ference wliich may be drawn from it, to those who declare that elocution cannot be tat; that the just and elegant adaptation of the voice, to the states of mind, cannot be an act of self-per- ception, and must therefore be the work of carles, cycles, and thouglitlcs 'Genius' alone. Such persons look upon this suposed peculiar-power of the mind, as a kind of sleiglit ; the ways and means of which are unknown and imeasurable. But 'genius' as it apears from its productions, is only an unusual aptitude lor that broad, reflective, combining, and persevering observation which percevcs and readily acomplishcs more than is done without it; and is therefore in its purposes and uses, not altogether removed beyond a submision to knowledge and rulej tho in its course of instruction, 'genius' is oftenest the pupil of itself. ciilod out, and amidst loud and long ajilausc, tendered his acknowledgments to the House.' CONCLUSION. 583 Let those who are deluded by this vulgar notion of 'genius/ turn themselves from mystics, who wrap-up only to misrepresent the simple agency of the mind, and who cannot define its high productive power, which through their own delusive veil they do not comprehend ; let them ask the great Sachems of Science, the encompasing, and far-seeing Chiefs of Thot, and learn from the real possesors of it, how much of its maner may be described. They will tell us that 'genius,' if we must use this loose and oft- perverted term, is in its broad and productive meaning always earnest, sometimes enthusiastic, but never fanatical ; always char- acterized by steady perseverance ; by the love of an object in its means as well as its end ; by that unshaken self-confidence in its unobtrusive powers, which converts the evil of discouragement into the benefit of suces ; which cares not to be alone, and is too much engrosed with its own truths, to be disturbed by the opinions of others : with a disentangling purpose to see things as they might be ; and the energetic means to execute them as they ought to be ; soaring above that musty policy which, in its wary thrift of the expedient, would with a world-serving quietude preserve them always as they are : having the power to acomplish great and use- ful works, only because it wastes no time on small and selfish ones; and pasing a life of warfare in detecting the impostures and folies of its own age, that the unenvious verdict of the next, like the celebrated response by the Oracle of Delphi, may pronounce it the chief in wisdom and in virtue. BRIEF ANALYSIS OF SONG AND RECITATIVE. ■ iiiie 9 9«"»- When the phenomena of Speech, Song, and Recitative, are regarded independently of verbal distinctions, they display a nearer resemblance than is discoverable by a general view of their efects and names. It is the Disclosing duty of Philosophy to show us the real existences of things ; to remove many of those lines of subdivision which the poor conveniences of clasification have adopted, and to exhibit, as available with finite resources, that clear and comprehensive picture of Nature, surveyed at once and always, by the Discernment of her own self-present, and self- percipient eye. To the comon ear, speech and song are totaly diferent. Let us examine their relationships .by a comparison of their several constituents. In taking up this subject, I have no new vocal function to de- scribe. Song and Recitative are respectively only certain combi- nations of the five modes of sound, and their forms, degrees, and varieties, including the protracted radical, and vanishj enumerated in the preceding history of speech. It is my design in pointing out briefly, the maner of these combinations ; to complete the survey of vocal science; and if the expresive use of the voice does at all admit the Pretensions of Recitative^ to show the rela- tionship between its three leading divisions. 38 (585) 586 A BRIEF AJSTALYSIS OF SONG. OF SONG. The art of Vocal Music has long been studiously cultivated ; and altho it has never yet receved a full elementary analysis, either of its constituents or their agency, its investigators have acu- mulated a mass of observation, and framed a body of rules for governing the great and brilliant results of its practical execution. It is at this time, beyond botli my design and ability to ofer a detailed consideration of the topic before us. The oportunities for inquiry on the subject of Song, as well as on that of all the Esthetic Arts, are too limited in this country, to aford useful com- panionship in knowledgej the broader rules of tastej and eminent Examples of inteligence joined with executive skillj to furnish a record of facts and principles, in that order and with that clearnes which always characterize a direct transcript from nature. It becomes the American, in considering this subject, to contribute only his own personal observation ; leaving a further description of the singing-voice, to the ample means of European experience, education, and exact inquiry. I propose to give a general acount of the functions of song ; leaving it to those whom it may pro- fesionaly concern, to make a practical aplication of the facts and principles here developed, or to regard them only as a pastime of knowledge, in natural history. As song consists in certain combinations of the five modes of the voice employed in speech, the proposed analysis will be given under the same general heads : and firstj Of the Pitch or Intonation of Song. Song has every direction and extent of intonation ascribed to speech ; together ■\vitii two forms, which do not belong to the later. In the second section of the analysis of speech, I dcscril)ed those peculiar modifications of the concrete; the ProtractcH.1 Radi- cal, and Vanish. In their most simple form they consist respect- ively of a faint and rapid concrete thru the interval of a tone, joined to a. level line of ])itch. Ijct us call the former of these constituent movements, the (iuick-concrete ; and the latter the A BRIEF ANALYSIS OF SONG. 587 Note. Of the quick-concrete and prolonged note, there are two conditions. In the Firstj the quick-concrete rises and terminates in the note at the sumit of the interval ; constituting the Protracted Vanish. The ascent by this continuation of quick-concrete and note, thru the seven places of the musical scale is ilustrated by the folowing notation of time and pitch. -if^- ^^^^e^ ^^ In the Second condition, the prolonged Note begins on the radi- cal line. At its termination, the quick-concrete rises to the sumit of the interval ; constituting the Protracted Radical. In ascending the scale, by this combination of note and concrete, the progresion is made acording to the folowing notation. ■ —4.0 4'-^'' By these two conditions, we learn that the note always has the quick-concrete, before or after it; Song variously employs both these movements ; the protracted radical less frequently perhaps than the protracted vanish : the voice in its instinctive intonation, apearing to fall more readily into the later. Not having however suficiently examined this point, I leave it for future inquirers. Regarding the vocal efed or expresion in these two forms of the protracted note, there seems to be no diference between them ; and should no betor cause be found for the singer's choice in taking one or the other, it might per- haps, in some cases, be decided by the character of the elements on which it is executed. The radicals of the dipthongs, a- we, a-h, and ou-i, having more volume than their respective vanishes e-rr and oo-ze, would be chosen for the protracted note. When a 588 A BRIEF ANALYSIS OF SONG. subtonic begins, and a tonic ends a sylable, tlic protracted vanish would be taken. When a subtonic both begins and ends a sylable, there may be a motive for a choice between them. Hence a singer, with reference to the more agreeable sound, and more impresive efect of a long-drawn note, would use the protracted radical, or protracted vanish, as the construction of the sylable might alow. The time of the concrete-rise in the foregoing scales, is repre- sented by a semiquaver, and that of the note, by a semibreve, two comparative terms in music, expresing the proportion of one to sixteen ; yet the proportion may vary. In the great System of Song, there is a Simple, and a more Complex structurej formed respectively, by the discrete, and by the concrete movements of the voice. The sucesions of pitch in song, represented by the preceding scales, being made with a discrete skip to proximate degrees, with- out a continuous slide from one note into anotherj a vocal melody founded on these scales, forms the Plainest kind of song, resem- bling the discrete music of a flute. In this kind of melody, the length of the note, when compared with the concrete, is diferent, acording to the time of the musical composition. Its longest quantity may excede the proportion represented in the above scales. In its shortest, the note is droped ; and the double form, of note and quick-concrete, thereby changed to a single equable concrete. This ocurs in quick-timed songsj which therefore strongly resemble speech ; and were it not for an ocasional prolonged note with wide skips of radical pitch, and a bared rythmus, they would pass for it. Much skill is therefore not required to sing a comic song, the greater part of its intonation being in the equable concrete. The foregoing diagrams of the tone, represent the most simple form of the united quick-concrete and protractotl-note of song. But other scales of wider concretes may be constructed. The following diagram represents the protractceech. As the inward flow of inspiration permits the utterance of only a single word, or at most three or four, the effect of inward sjDeech resembles that of infants, upon their first attempts in expired speech. We have not for the purpose of inward speech, the Holding-breath, as we for- merly called it, and therefore the act of inspiration, bearing its single word, immediately fills the lungs, as the Exhausting-breath with the infant, reversely drains them, and cuts off the coursQ of utterance. thoro stress of the protracted note proper to song. Would not the imitation of speech be nearer, if the sound were by its instrumental cause, formed into the equable concrete ? On the whole, I shall be sory if any one should lose his labor by a vain working at this problem. It is not the odd-ends of time that ever do anything well : and if the schemer should be disposed to devote one useful day, to the wasteful hazards of mechanical ingenuity, in such maters as here proposed, let him take, at the same time, a hint of caution. 594 A BRIEF ANALYSIS OF SONG. It may then be made a question, \vhether by a practice as long and assiduous as that which gives command over the time of ex- piration, the same holding-breath might not be attained in inspi- ration ; and, should the vocality of this inward voice, be im- provable, M'hether it might not be employed in the purposes of singing, for sustaining the voice indefinitely, and for insuring a continuous intonation in the higher intricacies of execution. It is knownj this power has been attained in whistling, both as regards shrilness, and the accuracy of pitch : and tho in this case, the command over the holding-breath of expiration, far surpasses the command over that of inspiration, still, the turning point for inhaling may be rendered almost imperceptible, under the con- troling power that does exist. It has been proposed to apply the command over inspired speech, to the cure of stammering: but this irregular articulation may depend on unknown causes, in tlie mind as well as in the vocal muscle, and on a defective consent between them ; in which case, no advantage would be gained by inhaled articulation.* Of Force of Voice in Song. Force has reference either to the general drift of the voice, or to its individual movements. We shall consider it only in the latter relation. All the forms of strcs we have ascribed to speech are found in song. This is true, not only of the equable concrete, sometimes used in the short impulses of the singing voice ; but the radical, the median, and the vanishing stress, are also severaly aplied to the protracted note, and to every course and extent of the wave. The full and abrupt radical being always preceded by an oclusionj it may have a place at the outset of all the forms of the concrete j and at the outset of the protracted radical or the note, represented in the two conditions of the preceding diagram. A note at the termination of a rising or of a falino; concrete cannot receve the radical stress. The greater duration of time, aloted to the diferent forms of the concrete and to the protracted notes, beyond that alowable in * The Opera, and Concert Hall, in their Aiietions of Fame, hid high for tho execution of vocal dificulties. Here then is the chaneo of an enormous pay, for suces in what, as known, has never heen done hefore ; and what at tirst thot, may seem to bo imi)osihle. A BRIEF ANALYSIS OF SONG. 595 speech, gives rise to a modification of the median stres or swell, not practicable on the sylabic concrete of discourse ; for more than one of these swells may be set on the same note ; or the force may diminish and increase alternately. The median stres may also on a protracted quantity, slightly resemble respectively that of the radical and of the vanish, by sudenly enlarging in the course of the prolongation and gradualy diminishing ; and by the reverse. This however, is a physiological refinement ; and we are not yet ready for its practical use. Some of the streses are perhaps aplicable to the radical and vanish, on the short sylabic intonation of comic song. A very remarkable use of force is made by the compound stres, in that vocal ornament caled the Trill, or Shake. The shake is described to be, a rapid alternation of a lower with an uper note, on proximate degrees of the diatonic scale. In stricter definition, it is a rapid alternation of two vocal or instru- mental momentary sounds, for they are not 7iotes, on the extremes of a tone or a semitone. Let us call these two constituents of the shake, its Co-sounds. We learned that every concrete impulse on a tonic or subtonic element, necesarily consists of a radical and vanish. Conse- quently, when we make two sucesive impulses on diferent degrees of pitch, each must have these two esential portions of the con- crete. But as the radical with its vanish consumes more time than the radical alone ; and as the radical is an abrupt opening, after an oclusion, there would be, in this maner of making the shake, a delai/ from employing the whole time of the two portions of each concrete ; as well as a momentary 2^nuse, between the close of the vanish on the first, and the opening of the radical on the second. The shake then being a rapid iteration of two co- sounds, without aparent interuption, it cannot be made by a series of concrete impulses each having its radical and vanish. For should a singer try to execute a shake by taking the whole of the di})thong a-le, as one of the co-soundsj he cannot, by any efort, give its characteristic rapidity, when the first sound of a-le is the begining of each of its sucesive co-sounds ; as the vanish, c-ve must necesarily folow the radical a-le, we employ the whole time of both the radical and vanish j which makes each co-sound too 596 A BRIEF ANALYSIS OF SONG. long for a rapid execution of the sliake. By asigning each of the co-sounds respectively to the radical, and to the sumit of the vanish of this dipthong, thus forming the Compound Stres, there will be no insuperable dificulty in its execution. And the same is true of a shake on the other dipthongs, their respective co-sounds being diferent in elemental vocality. In the case of the monothongs, their several co-sounds are the same. The rapid execution of the shake, and the momentary impulse of its co-sounds, make it a dificult subject of investigation. The resemblance however, of the intonation of the vocal, to that of an instrumental shake, afords a proof that the former like the latter, consists of two sounds on diferent degrees of pitch. It also apears, from the like ilustration by an instrument, that the co- sounds, tho of diferent degrees of pitch, are of equal time, volume, and force.* * It may seem, that the shake might bo made by each of the co-sounds being the momentary uterance of what we caled the rapid concrete : and as this instinctively flies over -ivith the radical and vanish, aparently as quick as a single co-sound, our explanation of an artificial and very dificult maner of deriving the fluent and rapid movement of the shake, from the slow acentual- eforts of the compound stress 7nay seem to be unecesary or incorect. It may seem, being by the mass of mere Thinkers, from interest or other motive, so readily changed into it is^ there is no calculating the mischief it has done. I will not therefore opose what viay seem on one side, by what ??irn/ secrn on the otherj for we should then have to invoke the aid of Plato, Aristotle, and the ancient as well as the modern itinerant and lecturing Sophists^ but will only state, that the m,ay seem, on our side, has already been submited to de- cisive observation, and experiment, in the instinctive tremor of the voice ; and we have in the Gurgle of the throat, an iteration of the rapid concrete with hoik lia radical and vanish. Now this is not a shake; nor can any skill or velocity ever make one of it. Vocalists call it the ' Goat's Quiver,' or some such name, without being able to show the diference of structure between tho Quiver and the Shake. Our history tolls us that the Gurgle or Quiver is formed by tho Tittles of the second or of the semitone, on the tremulous scale; the Shake, by a rapid execution of the compound stres, on either of these in- tervals. Before the invention of the shakej which is altogether Artificial, and is said to be of comparatively recent aplication to songj this Gurgle, or ' Trem- bling,' as tho French formerly caled it, was used as a vocal ornament. It is instinctively practiced for Laughter and Crying, and for other purposes in the human voice; is found among sub-animals of all clases: and is distin- guished from the shako by tho sliglitly abrupt and chatoring radical of tho tittles. In tho aspirated grating, scratohiiig or cliatoring of the insoct-voioo, the tremor is exemplified by our comon Black Cricketj Achcta abbrcviata ; and A BRIEF ANALYSIS OF SONG. 597 From our previous views, the formation of the shake may be described under two conditions; in each, the delay that might arise from every impulse having both a radical and a vanishj which we have shown, creates the whole dificulty of the casej is obviatal by a subdivision of the concrete movement into the Compound stres. For representing the first formative condition^ let the sumit of the concrete impulse, or the vanishing portion, be enforced to an equality with the radical. We shall then have one impresive sound at each extreme of the impulse, joined by a smooth transi- tion of the fainter concrete, and forming the first two co-sounds of the shake ; which, in this case, are both made within the time required for one impulse, when that impulse contains both a radi- cal and a vanish. The vanishing stres, or what, in this instance, is improperly caled the uper note of the shake, being terminated by an ocluded catch, as in the sob and hicup^ the voice is enabled by an immediate opening of that oclusion, to begin a new radical stres, improperly caled the lower note ; and by breaking from the ocluded vanish of one impulse into the radical of the next, and so, saving the time of transition on one whole concrete with both its radical and vanish, the rapid and aparently united co-sounds of the shake are efected. In the folowing diagramj 2 4 TtrrD the lines a and 6 denote two proximate degrees of the scale. The figure 1 the radical stres, or lower co-sound of the shake : 2 the vanishing stres, or uper co-sound, on which the voice is ocluded. In an imperceptible instant, this oclusion breaks out into the next radical stres 3. The voice is then diminished in force ; and again increased to its vanishing stres, and oclusion at 4. the shake, tho not a rapid one, with the median swell on its course, by the Cicada pruinosa, or Anual Locust of the Middle Slates. 593 A BRIEF ANALYSIS OF SONG. When made in this way, the shake may be considered as a rapid iteration of the compound stres, between the extremes of a tone or a semitone. For tlie second condition, let us take tlie first two of the co- sounds, or as we may call them, co-streses, described and ilustrated above. Deliberate trial will prove that an aplication of stres to the u[)er extreme of the rising concrete at 2, and to the lower at 3, as represented in the last diagram, in no way, prevents the voice, from making a downward continuous turn, from 2 to 3, in one case, and an upward continuous turn, from 3 to 4, in the other, into the form of a continued wave : and by an alternate sucesion of these radical and vanishing streses, or expansions, joined by the fainter concrete, but without an oclusion of voice, we are able to produce a rapid iteration of the co-sounds of the shake ; as represented in the folowing diagram^ where the voice opens at 1, with the radical stres ; then diminishes to the faint concrete ; subsequently enlarges to the vanishing stres at 2; then lolthouf an oclusion, turns down- ward, and after diminishing to the faint concrete, enlarges to the stres in the radical place at 3 ; and in this way, when rapidly exe- cuted, forms the proper co-sounds, or co-streses, or co-expansions of the vocal shake. 2 4 7mm 1 3 Under this view, the shake is a rapid alternation of the com- pound stres, on the rising and faling constituents of a continued wave of proximate degrees. And by it we learn, that the iterated co-sounds are not notes, but emphatic streses of no assignable time, on the points of contrary flexure in the wave. ]5ut as there can be a sudcn fulnes of the voice, only on a fii'st outbreak of the radicalj an engrafting of the vanishing stres on the concrete, at the place of the second or uj)er sound, nuist be made by a swell or expansion into the fulnes of that stres. From 2, the I'ulnes being diminished, is again sweled into the lower sound at 3 ; giving A BRIEF ANALYSIS OF SONG. 599 the shake the form represented in the diagram. This junction of the streses by an intermediate and atenuated concrete, witli the gliding of one into the other, is the cause of the smoothncs, and of the 'hquidity,' as it is caled, of a skilful and finished execution of this vocal ornament. The peculiar maner of uniting this double stress with rapid intonation, in the shake, not being part of the coloquial and slower uses of the voice, for the compound stres in speech consists of but tivo co-sounds, it is not surprisingj the power of executing it, is unattainable by most singers, and only acquired, in any case, after a long time, by great industry and perseverance. This is an atempt to explain the maner of combining stres and intonation in the shake. And yet, I am unable to give an unques- tionable description of it. By a slow and measurable movement of my own voice, I perceve, it can be made under each of the con- ditions above described. When it is quickened to its character- istic rapidity, the distinct perception of its structure and motion is lost, and I find it imposible to decide, which of the conditions is then employed: tho strongly inclined to think it is the later. With the asistance of the analysis here ofered, some other observer may describe it more definitely. Perhaps the explanation here given, may furnish a rule for teaching the practice of the shake. A method founded on this analysis, enabled me, Muth no other instructors than Observation and Industry, to atain a comand over it, with a precision and rapidity, suficient for the purposes of the present investigation : which certainly, could not, unasisted by a Master, have been as easily, if at all acomplished, without a knowledge of the com- pound stres, experimentaly aplied in reference to the radical ex- plosion, and the vanishing sob. It would be dificult to say, how far the aid of our description might lesen the time and labor of the Conservatorio, in teaching the practice of the shake. As the compound stres is practicable on every interval, so a shake might be com}X)Scd of an iteration of that stres on the ex- tremes of wider intervals: and a slow shake of this kind, is some- times heard among the tricks of the Florid song : but it is not technicaly clased with that ornament. It has a singular, and as I have heard it, not an agreeable efect ; and the M'idth of the con- 600 A BRIEF ANALYSIS OP SONG. Crete, preventing the rapidity of the proper shake, it has not its liquidity, nor its hovering pre-cadencial character. It is a question among vocalists, whether the 'acent' as they call it, is on the uper or the lower 'note,' or as we now regard it, co- sound of the shake. From our preceding acount of this ornament, no cause apears, for a diference of opinion in this case, and for anything like an acent on either. There may be the usual ryth- mic perception of acent on the bar or bars on which the shake is sustained ; and with this mental b&d, there might be a slight mo- mentary swell on the co-sounds, at the points of these beats. But I ciinnot hear even this ; and cannot therefore beleve there is an altetmate acent of force, much less an inequality in time, be- tween the upper and the lower co-sounds. Once admit it, and there would be an alternation both of stress and of pitch that would destroy the even and graceful undulation, and the liquidity of the shake ; and change the function to that of the tremulous gurgle. Vocalists have described several kinds of shake. With its proper structure and efect, I can observe but two; the diatonic and the semitonic, severaly formed on a tone and a semitone. What has been caled a Rising and a Falling shake, is perhaps only the gurgling, or rising and faling radical pitch of the rising and faling of the tremor ; for as the tremor is not made up of co- sounds, or compound streses, but of rapid concretes Avith each its radical and vanishj the terms rising and faling, which do aply to the course of the tremor or gurgle, and not to the continued line of the shake, have been improperly retained, after the introduction of the peculiar iteration on proximate co-sounds. This true shake, after continuing along its level line of pitch, may be skipped a de- gree, or perhaps more, and then continued on this new line. ' But when caried directly upward or downward, by proximate degrees, on more or less of the scale j which would make it a rising or falling shakej the course of the co-sounds is caled a Division, the structure and movement of which will be presently described. Other shakes enumerated in books, are only particular uses of that ornament ; or only combinations of it, with various forms of intonation. The meaning and peculiar efect of the shakcj for it cannot except A BEIEF AXAIA'SIS OF SONG. 601 on tl)e semitone, be called Expresive of the state of mindj may be stated under Five heads; and First. The most striking and agreeable character of the shake lies in its refined, its tunable, and as it were, its polished vocality ; which however I here consider with reference, exclusively to the high pitch of the Soprano voice. In men, generaly speaking, the shake, like most of their florid execution, denotes in their lower pitch, and rougher vocality, little more than a muscular dificulty ; for a low pitch, with a holow ful- nes, as we learn from instruments, destroys the esential elegance of the shake ; yet perhaps the harmony of a tenor and soprano, where the later takes the lead on the ear, produces the most delightful efect of this ornament. Second. There is in the shake, what has been called, its Liquidity. This arises in part, from its vocality, and in part from the smooth and rapid gliding of the concrete into the expansions of the co-sounds ; and is therefore more efective in the higher voices of women. Third. An agreeable effect is pro- duced by the variety of one or more swells, in the continued line of the co-sounds. Fourth. The preceding remarks aply equaly to both the shakes. But the semitone is distinguished by a pathetic character, moderated perhaps, by the rapidity of the transit of the concrete and its co-sounds thru the interval ; and by an overruling impresion of vocality; with the. liquid pouring from one co-sound to another, in the curent of their intonation. Fifth. I am dis- posed to class the eject of the shake, particularly the diatonic, with that of a downward skip, or a concrete of the third, in the Pre- pared Cadence of speech : for, as it seemsj the balanced suspen- sion or hawk-like flutter of a prolonged shake, before its final stoop to the key-note, creates the expectation of a descent, and calls for the imediate close of song, similar in maner and efect, to that of the faling of a third, for the prepared and reposing cadence of discourse. * There is another ocasion, on which the compound stres is used in song. When an extent of the whole compas of the voice, greater or less than the seven degrees of the scale, is ra2)idly traveled, but with a marked designation of each degree in the flight, it is ealed, ' running a Division.' We have seen, in the formation of the shake, that adjoining points of the scale cannot be marked in rapid 39 602 A BRIEF ANALYSIS OF SOXG. sucesloii by concretes, where each contains both the radical and vanish ; it is uecesary therefore in executing a Division, that the compound stres should be used, under one of the two conditions of its rapid execution, above described. In the first, the concrete receves the radical abruptnes, and the vanishing ocluded catch. This oclusion prepares the way for a second radical, and by sucesive concretes of compound stres, with a momentary but imperceptible oclusive catch between them, the degrees of the Division are rapidly traversed, and distinctly marked. For the second condition, we must supose the voice to make a concrete movement on the scale, to the whole extent of the designed Divisionj and the expansion of an emphatic stres to be aplied on each of the proximate degrees of the scale, \vithin that ex- tent. This may be ilustrated, by suposing the chain of oblique figures in the second diagram of the shake, drawn-out vertically to a straight linej representing the streses on the proximate des'rees of a risino- or a fallintj; scale. A Division is then, a rapid iteration of the compound stres, on every proximate de- gree of the scale, for a given extent, in an upward or downward direction. Song has various ways of runing a division, or as we may call it, a Chain of compound stres. In long sweeps of agility, the whole compas of the voice may be pased over in one continued chain of an upward or downward, so to call it, knoted movement ; or the progres may be less extensive ; or it may be made by varied groups of compound streses, with a pause between the agrcgates. In short, the compas may be traversed in numberles ways, by the pitch, time, and maner of sucesion, of the co-sounds. ISometimes the run is by the proximate step of a semitone : but whatever the movements may be, they are all performed on the principle of the compound stres. ' Of the Melody of /Sbn^r. 'Having described the particular forms of pitcli, time, and stress, we may now take a general view of their combinations into Melody. The structure of melody exhibits every variety in the number of its constituents, and in their interchangeable sucesion, from the use of a simple protracted note with its (piick and almost imper- ceptible concrete of a second, which we called DLscrcte-songj to A BRIEF ANALYSIS OF SONG. 603 that of every form of the concrete, and of every form of stres, particnlarly the compound j constituting 'airs of agility' or 'florid execution;' which we called Concrete-song. This distinction however serves only to mark the extremes of a varied use of the voice ; song being rarely heard in the strictly discrete form ; and when once the concrete movement of wider intervals than the second is admited, no definite line of separation can be drawn between the constituents of its structure. It was shown, in de- scribing the drift of melody in Speech, that the three divisions of the states of mind and of the voice, manifestly diiferent in their several exclusive and restricted uses, often so run into each other, as to prevent a systematic separation of their intermingled signs. And we have the same dificulty of clasification with the intercurent melody or st}de of Song. In general terms then, and without pretending to describe the confines of each, I would call the Discrete-melodyj That which moves by proximate degrees, and by radical change, under the form of intonation represented in the first two scales of the pro- tracted radical and vanish ; and showing ocasionaly, because it can scarcely be avoided, a concrete movement of some of the wider intervals, and of the wave. This is the style of song used by the Church, when the Choir is asisted by the Congregation. It is suited to the comon capacity of the voice, and resembles the in- strumental efect of the organ which acompanies it. I would call the Concrete-melody j That disposition of the note, concrete, wave, compound stres, and every form of time and into- nation, which, united with the Discrete, constitutes, within due limits, the delightful union of nature and art, in the expresion of song ; but which forced beyond the just bounds of vocal facility,, produces the extraordinary and unmeaning flights of a fantastic and wonder-working execution. An execution that has too often cuningly joined the profits of the Artist with the mere dificulties of his art; and with all Avho do not see thru the vicious combination, confounds a fanatical interest in the vocal artifices, name, and fashion of a Singer, with the cultivated feeling and taste of a musical ear. An execution that has at last brought an audience, too often to mistake a faling-in with the noisy aplause of a surounding crowd, for their own individual perception of the expresion of 604 A BRIEF ANALYSIS OF SONG. melody, and to the harmonizing richnes of its perfecting acom- paniment.* Upon this, and our previous histor}^, we are now prepared to sum up the diferences between the construction of song and speech. TJie Discrete melody of song, resembling in a few points the melody of speech, is still remarkably distinguished from it, by the efect of the protracted note, and by the more frequent ocurrence of wider transitions in the radical change. In the Concrete-melody of song, under its most complicated form, for I choose an extreme case, the difference consists still further in the kind, number, and uses of its movements. The range of its melodial corapas excedes that of proper speech. The compound stress, under rapid iteration in the shake, and in the rapid run of divisions, is the most frequent constituent of airs of agility; by the speaking voice it is used only in the two co-sounds of a slow and single concrete. A function comon to both is the equable concrete, which is sometimes set to the short sylables of song; tho comon perception does not then recognize it as a char- acteristic of speech. The wider waves too, ocasionaly used for emphasis in discourse, ocur perpetually in the florid song. Oj the Expresion of Song. Expresion in song, and in other music is the condition or state of mind, which in this case Ave * When this medley of the vocal constituents, with all its studied ditlcultics, was first taken over to England, for salej it was advertised as tlie Italian Maner : and indeed its manerism was then regarded, and properly too, as a caricature; for certainly its Bravura-song is an exageration, and its Recitative a misplaced distortion of the natural voice of expresion. But wonder and novelty are the chief Idols of popular Taste ; and whoever then posesed a little vocal facility soon began to imitate the long-drawn concretes and waves of the New Importation. To this we owe the monotonous Squeel, taught by the Singing-Master in the Italian Style, with its ever-and-anon returning wave, surging upon the ear, and drowning-out the rest of the song: a sad fato to a Taste that ha|)ens to be in the neighborhood of a fashionable young lady who frequents the Opera, and of the sowing-girl over the way, who has learned from her, to execute those every half-minute Squeeling waves, equally well. It is often easier to find causes, than excuses for an ofense. Perhaps tho universal fashion, of our Italian-taught Misses afeeting this repeated Por.ta- inento and Sostenido, in a high Soprano wave, with its median stres, is en- couraged by a family recolection of tho perverse Squeeling of their little brothers and sisters, and even of themselves; wiien cliildren begin to have their own noisy way in the nursery. A BRIEF ANALYSIS OF SOXG. 605 properly call Feeling', exerted by means of the pitch, time, force, vocality, and abruptnes of sound. It apcars from this definition, that the materials of expresion in song are the same as those in speech : still some diference will be found in their special employment, and respective efect, in the two cases. The Italians who have extensively taut us in musicj and who, with the purpose of their art changed perhaps to a vain- glorious authority, enslave too many fashionable, and often musi- cal ears to their National Manerismj have divided their song, with reference, rather to the style of its execution, and the places in which it is displayed, than to its expresion. I am only hinting at an arangement, upon the points of its rudimental functions and the mental state of feeling. In a general view of the subject of expresion, we findj the dignit}' of Song is produced by the same fulnes in vocality, length of time, gravity in intonation, and limitation of the extent of concrete and of radical pitch, that give an elevated and solemn character to reading. There can be no grandeur m a melody with the reverse of these conditions. A lively style of song, on the contrary, like the sprightly maner of discourse, is made by a lighter vocality ; a quicker time ; wider intervals of concrete, and of radical pitch ; and a greater variety in its sucesions. The Aria Buffa or the Comic Song, generaly consists of such short quantities, that most of its sylabic impulses are made in the true equable-concrete of speech : and the only causes, as it apears to me, why it is known to be song, are its having a barred time, an ocasional long quantity, and a concrete and radical pitch of wider intervals, than those of the curent of speech. The plaintive efect of the semitone, and of the minor third, which is only a peculiar position of the semitone, is similar to the chromatic character of spoken melody. Perhaps as remarked above, we ought to consider the expresion of the cadence as similar in these two uses of the voice ; for the return to the key- note in song, does, like the intonation at the periods of discourse, produce the agreeable feeling of satisfaction and repose. Let us take another and more particular view of expresion, with reference to the diferent kinds of melody. And Firstj 606 A BRIEF ANALYSIS OF SONG. Of the Discrete-Song. This is not without expresion, tho it falls short of what is efected by a judicious use of the more extended, and varied vocal movements. Its sources are derived from vo- cality, pitch, time, and stres. The tunable sound of a prolonged note may give a peculiar character to song. Fulnes produces in the hearer the state of solemnity ; smootlmes that of grace ; and in the grotesk eforts of the comic song, the extreme and distorted variations of Vocality excite a perception of the gay or the ridiculous. On the subject of this last named modej the principles of expresion are similar in speech and song : but perhaps its efect is more obvious in the later. The expresion of Pitch consists in the transition on certain inter- vals. The discrete-melody can therefore display the plaintivcnes of the semitone, and ocasionaly of the minor third ; together with what may be efected by the sucesions of other intervals of the scale. The Discrete-song may, by its Time, be either grave or gay. It apears, that the longer quantity of song is more agreeable than the short sylabic impulses of speech, even when they each have the same melodial order of pitch. This perhaps arises from a memorial conection of the jjrotracted notes of song, with the expresive efect of long quantity in speech ; for extended quantity both in speech and song, is always the sign of either an energetic, or dignified state of mind. The radical and the median stres are aplicable to the protracted note of the discrete-melody ; but a varied swell of the median, constitutes the principal means of expresion. The protracted note may also bear the tremor. Some of the less expresive forms of the wave may be admited into what I have called, without asigning a very definite boundary to it, the discrete-song. Our limited knowledge, in time-past, of the constituents of speech, together with our vague and imperfect notions and nomen- clature of the states and actions of the jnind, has created a diliculty in aranging the intermingled vocal signs of thot and pasion. It is the same with song. We can asign no exact line to the diference between the discrete and the concrete melody. It may however asist the purpose of system and nomenclature, to make an intcrme- A BRIEF ANALYSIS OF SOXG. 607 diate division, similar to that proposed in our sixtli section, for the Inter-thoughtive or E-everentive style. We will then aply the term Mixed melody, to a style consisting in part of the constituents of the other tAvo. From some very general descriptions, and some known particu- lars of the Greek song, it might be infered that its most esteemed melody was of this JNIixed character, enriched with all the concrete graces of expresion, admisible into its simple structure. I speak of song, rendered touching, self-relying, and unambitious ; song, with its al-suficient melodial, andj as far as then known, its pecu- liar harmonic resources for delightj free from vain intrusion of hard-taught dificulties ; and restricted to itself by the efective principles of Grecian taste. For we must supose, nay we know from a satirical recordj there was a like cold caprice in composi- tion, and a like dificulty in execution sometimes shown-off for the profit of the Singer, and for the noisy excitement of an Athenian Audience, that at present so often slight the natural and universal feeling of the ear, to exalt the fantastic vanity of the fingers and the throat. In the intermediate style of Mixed melody, the simple dignity, pathos, grandeur, or gayety of the discrete, is combined with the more varied and expresive constituents of the concrete melody, forming a peculiar style of song. A style, which employed under the direction of feeling and taste, produces efects in the highest degree impresive and delightful. A style that has been, is now, and ever will be, the most generaly gratifying to the instinctive and estheticaly educated ear. For, while perceving and wonder- ing at muscular facility and precision, yet it rarely feels any efect from concrete flourishes, and agility in vocalization, striving to re- fine upon and to surpas itself j and which requires the delightful melody of the ' Aria ' to preserve the fantastic mancrisni, and mongrel recitative of the Italian Opera from the sadnes of a meager audiencej except of those who go to look at one another's dreses, and to think of themselves. It has been thotj the Ccintus i^lanus of the early Christian Salmody, improved afterwards to the Ambrosian and the Grego- rian Chant, is a traditional descent of a form of Greek Temple- Music, thru the old Roman ritual. However this may be, there 608 A BRIEF ANALYSIS OF SONG. is a striking analogy, both as to structure and efect, between the Diatonic melody, and the Plain-Chant, in its early simplicity. This Chant, we are told, employed but four lines of the staff in the range of its pitch ; the sucesion of its notes was by proximate degrees, in the radical pitch of a second ; it never set more than one note to a sylable ; and used but two divisions of time, the long and the short. In. this acount, substitute the term Equable con- Crete for that of Note, and the resemblance is in many points re- markable. The Plain-Chant is an example of what we have caled the discrete-song, and in its use had originaly, and when not dese- crated by 'modern improvements' of wider concrete and discrete intervals, and by afected graces j still has, in its holy purpose of worship and prayer, that deep and long-drawn note of solemn dignity, which is but a transcending degree of the character, given to epic and dramatic reading, and to parts of the Church-service, by the fulnes and quantity of an orotund voice, in the diatonic melody.* * We have in the course of this Work, pointed out similarities between the principles of Music and of Elocution, and have shown their very materials or tunable constituents, with the exception of the Note, to be comon to both. The further we look into the Arts, the more closely we iind them by their principles, related to each other: yet who will say, there is a resemblance between Architecture and Speech ? To the eye and ear of the Doorkeeper, who within the grandeur of the Capitol, was obliged to listen to Cicero, there could have been none. But turn an inquiring and reflective mind to a con- sideration of the causes that constitute, or create, a similarity between thenij and observe how, in the analytic Perspective of a philosophic taste, their conditions aproach each other ; and with a still extended view, how, by the principles that direct them, they mingle into one. I have long perceved the analogy to which I here alude ; but bcleving it might pass for a metaphoric extravagance, rather than an ilustration, I have not till this last moment, the date of the fourth Edition, dared to cull the Dia- tonic Melody, the Doric order of Speech. In this country at least, I have met with none, so much interested in the Esthetic principles of these arts, as to wish to discover, or desire to be told their points of resemblance. When however, I think of a Doric Perii)toral Temple with its marble-purity, brightly distinct in structure and outline, to the neighboring eye, yet still distinctly traceable in distant prospectj with its compendious Design at once upon my memory, in clearnes of image second only to reality; I see an am- bitious samencs in form and liglit, yet varied in line, and shadow, just to show- forth the striking elegance of its Unity^ a Grandour rising above lu'avines, till it iipears in Grace; and a Simplicity, with only such apropriate ornaments A BRIEF ANALYSIS OF SONG. 609 Second. Oj ConcrcieSoiig. This melody, in its forms of into- nation, time, and force, is varied from the limits of the Mixed style, to that intricate and afected composition of the extreme Bravuraj "which by turning words into vowels, destroys the mean- ing of language ; and by a continued whirling of these vowels, confounds every feeling excited by the more natural song. The means.of expresion in the unexagerated forms of this melody include those of the Discrete and the Mixed ; with the adition of other more elaborate forms of intonation. The further use of the radical and median force on the rising and faling concrete, as well as on the wave, adds a briliant variety to its character. We have in the Bravuras and Volatas of this kind of song, all the extraor- dinary coloring of the compound stres, in the production of the shake, and of the endles run of Divisions on their course of stres and intonation. It likewise comands the powers of the Tremulous scale, both on the plaintivenes of the semitone, and the laughing movement of wider intervals. All the forms of expresion, both in the Concrete and the Dis- crete song, M'hether of the grave, the gay, or the plaintive ; and whether produced by pitch, time, vocality, or force, are to be con- sidered as independent of any purpose in thought or meaning: for it will be shown presently, that except in some acidental or habitual conections, song has, apart from the words which may acompany it, an ^tnintelectual expresion altogether of its own. As song employs in its composition, the expresional means of speech, it might be suposed that certain movements must have in each case an identiail efect. Yet it is not always so. We have learned that some signs, as the semitone, the laughing and crying tremor, and long quantity, do rejjresent the same state of mind in both : but many forms of intonation lose their meaning and force when separated from words, and transfercd to song. On as make them harmonious parts of nn unclividecl whole. With this picture before me, it brings-up iu related efect, the liUenes of Roscius again upon the Stage, breaiiing his silence, with the gravity and fulnes of the thotive orotund ; and impresing the respectful ear by a simplicity in time and into- nationj varied only to give grace to its dignity ; and rising ocasionalj', with contrasted interval, and force, to beautifj' and not to destroy the jilain and impresive unity of diatonic speech. 610 A BRIEF ANALYSIS OF SOXG. the subject of the vocal signs of thot and pasion, it was shownj their purpose is not only modified by conventional language, but is sometimes purely dependent upon it. This was ilustrated by reference to the voices of birds : and song afords a still more satisfactory proof. For as its elaborate structure does employ all those forms of concrete and radical pitch, and of the wave, which produce the expresion of speech, it Avould seem, we ought during the varied course of its melody, to be constantly recognizing the vocal signs of interogation, surprise, positivenes, sneer, contempt, and railery ; whereas the florid song which makes the freest use of these signs, never conveys any of these states except when joined to language that describes them. Song, nevertheles, without the use of words, may be powerfully expressive ; and it is so by the use of these very concretes, quan- tities, waves, and swelling streses, that give the thotive and pas- ionative meaning to speech. The expresion of song is produced in a maner ^peculiar to itself, and in very few, if any instances has relation to the thot or pasion of particular words or phrases. Persons who enjoy the melody of song must percevej the feelings created by it are so indefinitej they are not able to refer them to any other source, than that of primary perception, or of subse- quent memory ; nor to reduce the expresion to anything more than certain clases of efects. Upon this subject I would ask two questions. Has song a sys- tem of expresion properly its OAvn, and does our indefinite percep- tion of its forms arise from this system never having been analyzed and rendered familiar and specific by names? Or does the ex- presion of song depend on some conection between its vocal move- ments, and those of speech ; the former asuming the agreeable efect of the latter, without their definite meaning? By a comparison of the characteristics of speech and of song, it apears that song has a system of expression of its own, dis- tinct in most ])oints from that of speech. If the Reader luis fol- owed me atentively, he nuist admitj the vocjil expresion of the latter is derived soley from the concrete and discrete intervals of intonation, with the other modes of the voice; and that he has at least heard of the precepts for that expresion, if he has not the power of acurately executing them. Still we here ofer A BRIEF ANALYSIS OF SONG. 611 in pardonable repetition, a few remarks on the expresion of both song and speech. And first. No thought, term, proposition or meaning is directly conveyed in song. By the melodial sucesion alone of its notes, it excites a state of mind, which we distinctively caled feeling ; always agreeable, except under some acidental and pervertive circum- stances. In song we are further pleased with the vocality of its notes; in which its prolongation, is more agreeable than in the concrete of speech. It is a question so inviting to dispute, that we will not stop to considcrj whether these agreeable feelings are exclusively the direct result of the simple vocal impresion, or are in- directly derived from memory, and in a maner, conected with thot. These feelings produced by the melodial sucesion of notes, and by their agreeable vocality in prolongation, are therefore peculiar to song. After the preceding view of the distinction between speech and song, we are prepared to hear, that a sucesion of intervals in song, when joined with the other modes of vocality, time, and force, and properly distributed, is, by the melodial relations of those intervals, marked by its notes, capable of exciting the feelings of Grandeur, Solemnity, Plaintiveness, Gayety, and Grace. And if to these be added a perception of Oddity, or what has been called the Gro- tesk, they will perhaps include all the clases of efects, that inde- pendently of any peculiarities of thot and of the ear, seem to be within the expresive powers of song. We here exclude all those notional and false analogies, between sound and meaning, whichj to try something like a transcendental metaphorj are more remote than far-fetch'd, if a resemblancej but infinitely distant, if at all a paralel ; such as are found in the music of 'Alexander's Feast,' ' St. Cecilia's Day,' and the ' Ode on the Passions,' to- gether with not a few in Haydn's ' Creation,' Handel's ' ISIessiah,' and thruout that once fashionable and serious folly, the ' Battle of Prague.' These pretensions and falsities hold the same relation to the real expresion of song, that we shall endeavor to show the pretensions and falsities of Recitative do to the truth of expresion in speech. Second. The agreeable expression of song by the mode of Pitch, consists in the comparison of one note, Avith others of a 612 A BRIEF ANALYSIS OF SOXG. proximate, or of a remote degree; for song by its protracted notes^ and by its key, which definitely marks the places of the tones, and semitones in the scale, has in the fixed places of its notes, the means for comparing them one with another, that they may be heard under what has been considered, a kind of harmony in melodial succession.* On the effect of this melodial succession of notes alonej without the individual note itself exciting or conveying a thotive or pas- ionative state of mindj the pitch of song altogether depends for the means of producing agreeable Feelings of whatever kind. But the resource of this melodial sucesion of notes, speech does not posses. Its efects are derived from a power in the individual concrete, and individual discrete interval to expres thot and pasion, independently of a comparison with preceding or folowing con- cretes. Third. The expression of concrete, and of discrete intervals, in the melody of speech, difers both in character and cause, from that of the sucesion of the notes of song : tho each is, in its own way, variously agreeable, acording to the susceptibility of the car and intelect of an audience. We have said the intonation of speech, derives its expresion, soley from the extent and direction of the single concrete and discrete interval, and the wave, asisted by the other modes of the voice. Plaintivenes is the efect of the single semitone; interogation and wonder, of the single wider up- wardj anger and comand, of the single wider downward concrete ; dignity, of the wave of the second ; contempt and scorn, of the wider single or double waves : the expression being here derived altogether from the individual interval itself, and not from the * In the musical scale, the First, Third, Fifth, and Octave notes, when heard together, are said to be concordant: and Harmony to the ear, not its theory, is the perception of the efcct of shnulfaneous concordant notes. Melody to the ear, regarding only the mode of Pitch, is the perception of the efect of certain relationships between sucesive notes. The efects of mu.sic arise then, from two conditions of its notes: one simul- taneous ; the other sucesive. But the individual notes which produce har- mony are so impresive, that when heard in sucesion, the ear can compare the instant-pased, with the instant-present note; and thus perceve a harmonious relation between the presently audible and the memorial note. This is what I call in the text, harmony in melodial sucesion. A BRIEF ANALYSIS OF SONG. G13 relation of one interval to another. For tho a Fifth, for example, is emphatically perceptible in speech, by its contrast with a second, in a diatonic melody, it is not that contrast which gives the ex- presion ; as the Fifth is alike interogative, both in a thoro inter- ogative sentence, where it is placed beside itself j and when it is unrelated to any other interval, on a neighboring sylablc. And the same may be said of every expresive concrete, either solitary or in series. The expresion of speech, again to repeat the propo- sition, is therefore derived from the efect of the concrete and dis- crete intervals alone : as speech having no System of Key to direct its progresions, cannot excite musical feeling by thq harmony of melodial siicesions : for the perpetual sliding of its concretes, afords no stationary point nor continvious level line, by which a concord with any other point or line might be recognized. The wordsj second, third, fifth, octave, semitone, and wave, that in song convey the meaning of a melodial relationshipj designate in speech, only concrete and discrete intervals ; which in themselves , denote thot and pasion, by their extent and direction, not by any harmonic or melodial relations to each other. We have saidj the sucesions alone, of melody in song, with their varieties in time, and without embracing thot or meaning, produce its peculiar feeling or expresion. Hence the permutations in the order of these notes for an agreeable sucesion would seem to be inumerable. But the more agreeable sucesions j whether they afect the mind instinctively by the ear, or habit, or by conection with feelings derived from other senses^ might perhaps with their apro- priate expresion, be reduced to a few melodial phrases, and be described and named. As far as I have been able to asign the agreeable efects of melody, to such phrases, the forms do not seem to be numerous ; and are realy so simple, and comparatively so few, that they probably have all been known and used in song, from immemorial time; yet their intermingling sucesions, as it has hapened Avith the long unknown and aparently confused phrases of intonation in speechj have to this day, prevented their being separately perceved and named. Composers are often charged with plagiary of certain agreeable pasages of melody. But all these pasages, or Phrases of Expres- sion in song, as they may be caled, have long been familiar to the 614 A BRIEF ANALYSIS OF SOXG. ear, and enjoyed by Feeling ; and liave come down to us with- out known Authorship or Date. On the subject of this combi- nation of notes into agreeable phrases in the melodial sucesion of song, there can be no more originality, than on that of the combination of the elements into sylables of speech ; which in all their permutations, have in time, and among nations, already been made. The mass of Composersj like the mass of Writers, respectively, again and again borow and repeat the commonplace phrases of melody and of thotj and only a few, like Bacon and Shakspeare, or Haydn and INIozart, choicely select and combine those striking, if not original thots, in one case, and expresive melodial phrases in the other, which, in their exalted acordance with nature and truth, are so far above being vulgarized by gen- eral adoption and imitation, as to seem to be always new, and destined to please forever. Under the class of phrases of expresion in song, are included those groups of notes called Graces. And here, speech has nothing directly corresponding to the Beat, the Turn and Shake. Per- ha]:)s however, there is a remote analogy, in efed, between the median stress of speech, and the apogiature ; between the Tremolo, and the prolongation of the tremor on one line of pitch ; between the anticipative character of the prepared cadence, and the suspen- sion of the shake preceding a close on the key-note of song. But why has song been without a classification of other phrases, with their peculiar and no less striking expresion, than that of its named ornamental Graces ? That song has its own peculiar expression, in no way connected with thot, or meaning of any kind, is i)roved by a well-known fa(;t in lyric history. It has long been the practice of song writers, to adapt their verses to the music of existing airs; nor, with an exception of the use of the major and the minor mode; of the allegro and pcnseroso, does tliis seem to have been done, under the asumcd fitnes of certain melodial ])hrascs of the Air, to the thot or pasion of the words ; language of every diferent meaning and expresion being adapted to the same air, and receved as satis- factory, without the least perception of a want of congruity.* * From imimoniblc instances of tliis print'i])lo, we select the folowing. Tlicre is a ciilcbrated Ene ; but so ordering the refined imitation, as not to obscure the purjmse and means of the original.' And agaiuj 'If then it is true, that song, like verse in relation to prose, does embelish speech in imitating it, A BRIEF ANALYSIS OF RECITATIVE. 623 thereby throwing an elegant ilusion over its character, we should not reject this aditional pleasure of taste ; and whoever is endowed with a delicate ear, will not complain, on hearing speech delivered in a singing voice.' We are sorry to differ from M. Marmontel : and tho we may not have that delicate ear, and therefore may have no right to complain, yet with a taste acquired in the school of Nature, we cannot aprove. And here, notwithstanding an early resolution, only to observe and record, to which however I have not been able always to adherej I feel myself compeled to ofer a transient argument, in disenting from the unfounded notions on this subject. The theory of Imitation asumed comon conversation, which it caled the 'natural toncj' to be the archetype or patern. The more deliberate and impresive style of the theater, and of public oratory, was caled Declamation ; and was the First remove in ' im- itation ' from the ' natural tone.' This declamation, when Chanted by the voice alone, or with the instrumental company of something like a varied drone-bass, was caled Plain Recitative ; and its fur- ther remove from comon speech, and aproach towards song, was the Second degree of imitation. Recitative acompanied by instru- ments, in a barred and rythmic harmony, formed the Third de- gree of imitation j a still further remove from the ' natural tone,' or comon speech : and Song, or what is called Air, was suposed to have the least resemblance to it. By the light of our history, the Reader may perhaps perceve the falacy of this asumption. Language is a sign of the mind, not a copy of it. Comon speech then, is the sign of thot and pasion, and in no meaning of the term, an imitation of them. Declamation is speech itself, in a more impresive use of its constituents. Plain recitative employs some intonations, not used in speech, and makes a false or garbled aplication of those that arcj and consequently is no imitation. Acompanied recitativ^c has still greater difcrences from speech than the Plainj tho of similar character and efect. Air, or Song having its own })eculiar use of notes and intervals, with its own peculiar expresion, can have no resemblance whatever to speech ; and cannot therefore be an imitation of it. Thus we learn that comon speech is an original function, planed for itself 624 A BRIEF ANALYSIS OF RECITATIVE. alone ; and to speak figuratively, only copied, if at all, from Na- ture's secret patern of its purpose : nor has Nature herself ever copied anything from it. But conceitful man, in trying to beau- tify, by imitating her as he suposedj at last blundered into Recita- tive ; the true or contorted archetype of which is not to be found in the natural voice of all this peopled earth. And if drawn by Plato's First Philosophy from the skiesj when, in the Sacred name of Urania, has any metaphysical audience of the heavenly choir, ever reported an example of its vocal odity and monotonous afectation ! Another opinion, asumed to justify the use of Recitative, wasj that as speech is so widely diferent from song, in its efccts upon the ear ; and as the more acute and forcible sound, and stronger contrast of intonation, in song, together with the peculiar and dif- erent kind of expresion, are much more striking than the ' natural tonej' it was suposed, there should be some intermediate function, partaking of the character of each, to unite their sucesion, with less violence to the ear. The instances of things, both in nature and art, in favor of this medium of gradiial transition, are not more numerous than the instances of abrupt changes that opose it ; and as no argument can therefore be drawn from this source, we must consider the case in itself. On the ground then of our history of the voice, we cannot ad- mit, there is the least plea in good taste, or the demands of the ear, for this interposition of Recitative. How does the princijile aply to that universal function of Speech, the Equable Concrete, when a gradual vanish leads us ovi of the full and abrupt opening of the radical, and not gradualy from silence, into itf Do the fii'st notes of song, in a favorite melody, ever require more than their own delightful impresion, to introduce them from silence or from speech ? Who, in the Church-service, calls ibr a motly mjdway of intonation, in pasing from prayer and benediction, to the chant and the anthem? And what, in the decent {)ride of consistency, becomes of this principle of gradual transition, when the voice pases abruptly from silence to the striking peculiarity of this very Recitative ; and again, when in an unknown language, it j)ases from this giberish, both of words and expresion, to the deafening jargon of melody, harmony, and articulation, in the over-strained A BEIEF ANALYSIS OF RECITATIVE. 625 voices and instruments of a full Operatic chorus ? * The design of this notion of mediation, to prevent the violent contrast between speech and song, has rendered the whole course of the Operaj when not releved by the ocasional variety of the delightful Aria, and by pasages of exquisite orchestral harmony^ a continued mo- notony, to him whose ear has not been contorted by fashion, and who admits our view of the principles of Drift ; for these show that in speech, the ear is guarded against the false and too frequent use of wide and expresive inters'^als, by such a use being always monotonous and ofensive. Nature has no unnecesary chasms in her designs^ tho the works of man are full of them. When there- fore he comes to study her purpose in the voice, he will find no gap between speech and song, to be pased by the Ponticello', no, the Ponte-roUo of Recitative, f * We had lately an instance in one of our Cities, of what an Italian Opera can play-off upon the ignorance or inatention of an audience^ by the first and second Tenor, and Bass, severaly singing and reciting their parts in Italian, German, and French. The next day the amateurs and critics were very in- dignant, at the Troupe-leader's impudence. Strange complaint! when to an English ear, the whole in ' choice Italian,' is impudent enough, without ading two other jargons, that nobody was atentive enough to perceve. f In refering above, to the undistinguishable words and expresion of Reci- tativcf in a foreign language ; and to the deafening vowels of an Opera-Chorus, I do not so particularly alude to the Italian language, as to that uninteligible plain-English, which seems to be the comon mother-tongue of so many of its singers. I lately heard in translation, the Oratorio of ' Joseph and his Breth- ren ;' and in Solo, Duett, and Chorusj Soprano, Tenor, and Bass, I did not recognize, with the exception of now and then an interjection, twenty words, so distinctly, as to know what they were. They had beter have been in Japa- nese, for there would then have been no vexatious longing for what they pretended to be, and no endeavor to translate them. As to that clashing of vocality, and discord in intonation, the necesary vocal vices of a vociferating crowd;} ' Quousque tandem abutere, Coryphaeus, patientia nostra ? ' When will the Mob-like Chorus of the Opera cease its confounding uproar? For while each and all, in musical strife, are straining both voice and instrument into one time-beaten noise;} who has ever heard a smoothly moderated note, or an articulated word from any one of them ? This is not the choice of uncorupted nature in the human ear. It belongs to the whooping savage of an early age. In our own time, it comes from the Composer and the Audience reciprocaly vitiating each other's taste. And it only adds another to the unumbercd in- consistencies of the mind and the senses, when in Christian Countries, after weekly returns, in our Churches, of delight at the impresive grandeur and grace of the subdued harmony of the Choir ; and after once hearing the refined 41 626 A BRIEF ANALYSIS OF RECITATIVE. From the violence ofered by Recitative, to our vocal-liabits, St. Evremond long ago formaly questioned its claims to the merits of propriety, and taste. This is a very strong motive ; for surely, no one ever did recognize or enter-into the expresion of this extraor- dinary intonation, if he had not by the authority, or the daily practice of the Conservatorio, been driled out of the instinct of a natural ear, into a forced belief that it is the only Artistic style for displaying the elevated character of dramatic expresion. But this argument, like that against many other things at first very shocking, may be refuted by custom and time. Our objection is drawn from another source. It has been shown, that speech being founded on a universal and identical meaning and practice among mankind, has a system of verbal and vocal means, for represent- ing the states of mind, often perverted and corupted, but never overruled and changed to a diferent system; that song, like in- strumental music, has forms of intonation altogether its own, for the expresion only of v/hat we caled Feeling, and totaly inde- pendent of verbal signs. From a close observation of these dis- tinctions, and a studious search after any mode of the vocal signs, which for human purposes, might be adraisible, we have insisted, that besides these two functions, speech and song, the voice has no other universal means of expresion ; that from their separate solemnity of the Choral Praj^er in Masaniello, we can bear to be deafened by the brazen-racket of a certain red-headed scene in Norma, as ' got up ' in our Country. It may be said, ' there is a style apropriate to the Church.' And so, it is equaly -proper, that in every place music, in its parts, should be distinctly heard ; its expresion unconfusedly felt ; and the drum of the ear not to be torn by its unmerciful violence. But further, the critic tells us, this scene in Norma presents the true vocal and military costume, and 'carroty-locks,' of the time and place in which the action is laid. Be it so. Arc we therefore in any way, to sacrifice taste to an outlandish costume in sight, or scent, or sound? And because some shouting Celts, like beings of a Hoter clime, 'clashed on their sounding shields the din of war,' and are alowcd, 'highly to rage, and hurl defiance ' against civilized ears, upon a modern Stage ; how could we blame an Author who, in search of novelty, should locate his Opera among a Horde of Tartars, and who, with reference to the dramatic costume, and to the truth of his storj', should bring his Soprano, Tenoro and Bns.